1 //===--- SemaDecl.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Declarations ----------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 //  This file implements semantic analysis for declarations.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "TypeLocBuilder.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/CharUnits.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/CommentDiagnostic.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/DeclCXX.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/NonTrivialTypeVisitor.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/Randstruct.h"
28 #include "clang/AST/StmtCXX.h"
29 #include "clang/Basic/Builtins.h"
30 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
31 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
32 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
33 #include "clang/Lex/HeaderSearch.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
34 #include "clang/Lex/Lexer.h" // TODO: Extract static functions to fix layering.
35 #include "clang/Lex/ModuleLoader.h" // TODO: Sema shouldn't depend on Lex
36 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" // Included for isCodeCompletionEnabled()
37 #include "clang/Sema/CXXFieldCollector.h"
38 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
39 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h"
40 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
41 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
42 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
43 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
44 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
47 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
48 #include "llvm/ADT/Triple.h"
49 #include <algorithm>
50 #include <cstring>
51 #include <functional>
52 #include <unordered_map>
53 
54 using namespace clang;
55 using namespace sema;
56 
57 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::ConvertDeclToDeclGroup(Decl *Ptr, Decl *OwnedType) {
58   if (OwnedType) {
59     Decl *Group[2] = { OwnedType, Ptr };
60     return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group, 2));
61   }
62 
63   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(DeclGroupRef(Ptr));
64 }
65 
66 namespace {
67 
68 class TypeNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
69  public:
70    TypeNameValidatorCCC(bool AllowInvalid, bool WantClass = false,
71                         bool AllowTemplates = false,
72                         bool AllowNonTemplates = true)
73        : AllowInvalidDecl(AllowInvalid), WantClassName(WantClass),
74          AllowTemplates(AllowTemplates), AllowNonTemplates(AllowNonTemplates) {
75      WantExpressionKeywords = false;
76      WantCXXNamedCasts = false;
77      WantRemainingKeywords = false;
78   }
79 
80   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
81     if (NamedDecl *ND = candidate.getCorrectionDecl()) {
82       if (!AllowInvalidDecl && ND->isInvalidDecl())
83         return false;
84 
85       if (getAsTypeTemplateDecl(ND))
86         return AllowTemplates;
87 
88       bool IsType = isa<TypeDecl>(ND) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(ND);
89       if (!IsType)
90         return false;
91 
92       if (AllowNonTemplates)
93         return true;
94 
95       // An injected-class-name of a class template (specialization) is valid
96       // as a template or as a non-template.
97       if (AllowTemplates) {
98         auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ND);
99         if (!RD || !RD->isInjectedClassName())
100           return false;
101         RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD->getDeclContext());
102         return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate() ||
103                isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(RD);
104       }
105 
106       return false;
107     }
108 
109     return !WantClassName && candidate.isKeyword();
110   }
111 
112   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
113     return std::make_unique<TypeNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
114   }
115 
116  private:
117   bool AllowInvalidDecl;
118   bool WantClassName;
119   bool AllowTemplates;
120   bool AllowNonTemplates;
121 };
122 
123 } // end anonymous namespace
124 
125 /// Determine whether the token kind starts a simple-type-specifier.
126 bool Sema::isSimpleTypeSpecifier(tok::TokenKind Kind) const {
127   switch (Kind) {
128   // FIXME: Take into account the current language when deciding whether a
129   // token kind is a valid type specifier
130   case tok::kw_short:
131   case tok::kw_long:
132   case tok::kw___int64:
133   case tok::kw___int128:
134   case tok::kw_signed:
135   case tok::kw_unsigned:
136   case tok::kw_void:
137   case tok::kw_char:
138   case tok::kw_int:
139   case tok::kw_half:
140   case tok::kw_float:
141   case tok::kw_double:
142   case tok::kw___bf16:
143   case tok::kw__Float16:
144   case tok::kw___float128:
145   case tok::kw___ibm128:
146   case tok::kw_wchar_t:
147   case tok::kw_bool:
148   case tok::kw___underlying_type:
149   case tok::kw___auto_type:
150     return true;
151 
152   case tok::annot_typename:
153   case tok::kw_char16_t:
154   case tok::kw_char32_t:
155   case tok::kw_typeof:
156   case tok::annot_decltype:
157   case tok::kw_decltype:
158     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
159 
160   case tok::kw_char8_t:
161     return getLangOpts().Char8;
162 
163   default:
164     break;
165   }
166 
167   return false;
168 }
169 
170 namespace {
171 enum class UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult {
172   NotFound,
173   FoundNonType,
174   FoundType
175 };
176 } // end anonymous namespace
177 
178 /// Tries to perform unqualified lookup of the type decls in bases for
179 /// dependent class.
180 /// \return \a NotFound if no any decls is found, \a FoundNotType if found not a
181 /// type decl, \a FoundType if only type decls are found.
182 static UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult
183 lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(Sema &S, const IdentifierInfo &II,
184                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
185                                 const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
186   if (!RD->hasDefinition())
187     return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
188   // Look for type decls in base classes.
189   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
190       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
191   for (const auto &Base : RD->bases()) {
192     const CXXRecordDecl *BaseRD = nullptr;
193     if (auto *BaseTT = Base.getType()->getAs<TagType>())
194       BaseRD = BaseTT->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
195     else if (auto *TST = Base.getType()->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
196       // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
197       // templates.
198       if (!TST || !TST->isDependentType())
199         continue;
200       auto *TD = TST->getTemplateName().getAsTemplateDecl();
201       if (!TD)
202         continue;
203       if (auto *BasePrimaryTemplate =
204           dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
205         if (BasePrimaryTemplate->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
206           BaseRD = BasePrimaryTemplate;
207         else if (auto *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD)) {
208           if (const ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl *PS =
209                   CTD->findPartialSpecialization(Base.getType()))
210             if (PS->getCanonicalDecl() != RD->getCanonicalDecl())
211               BaseRD = PS;
212         }
213       }
214     }
215     if (BaseRD) {
216       for (NamedDecl *ND : BaseRD->lookup(&II)) {
217         if (!isa<TypeDecl>(ND))
218           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
219         FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
220       }
221       if (FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound) {
222         switch (lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, BaseRD)) {
223         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType:
224           return UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundNonType;
225         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType:
226           FoundTypeDecl = UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType;
227           break;
228         case UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound:
229           break;
230         }
231       }
232     }
233   }
234 
235   return FoundTypeDecl;
236 }
237 
238 static ParsedType recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(Sema &S,
239                                                       const IdentifierInfo &II,
240                                                       SourceLocation NameLoc) {
241   // Lookup in the parent class template context, if any.
242   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr;
243   UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult FoundTypeDecl =
244       UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
245   for (DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext;
246        DC && FoundTypeDecl == UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::NotFound;
247        DC = DC->getParent()) {
248     // Look for type decls in dependent base classes that have known primary
249     // templates.
250     RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
251     if (RD && RD->getDescribedClassTemplate())
252       FoundTypeDecl = lookupUnqualifiedTypeNameInBase(S, II, NameLoc, RD);
253   }
254   if (FoundTypeDecl != UnqualifiedTypeNameLookupResult::FoundType)
255     return nullptr;
256 
257   // We found some types in dependent base classes.  Recover as if the user
258   // wrote 'typename MyClass::II' instead of 'II'.  We'll fully resolve the
259   // lookup during template instantiation.
260   S.Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_found_in_dependent_base) << &II;
261 
262   ASTContext &Context = S.Context;
263   auto *NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, false,
264                                           cast<Type>(Context.getRecordType(RD)));
265   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_Typename, NNS, &II);
266 
267   CXXScopeSpec SS;
268   SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
269 
270   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
271   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
272   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
273   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
274   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
275   return S.CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
276 }
277 
278 /// If the identifier refers to a type name within this scope,
279 /// return the declaration of that type.
280 ///
281 /// This routine performs ordinary name lookup of the identifier II
282 /// within the given scope, with optional C++ scope specifier SS, to
283 /// determine whether the name refers to a type. If so, returns an
284 /// opaque pointer (actually a QualType) corresponding to that
285 /// type. Otherwise, returns NULL.
286 ParsedType Sema::getTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II, SourceLocation NameLoc,
287                              Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec *SS,
288                              bool isClassName, bool HasTrailingDot,
289                              ParsedType ObjectTypePtr,
290                              bool IsCtorOrDtorName,
291                              bool WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
292                              bool IsClassTemplateDeductionContext,
293                              IdentifierInfo **CorrectedII) {
294   // FIXME: Consider allowing this outside C++1z mode as an extension.
295   bool AllowDeducedTemplate = IsClassTemplateDeductionContext &&
296                               getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
297                               !isClassName && !HasTrailingDot;
298 
299   // Determine where we will perform name lookup.
300   DeclContext *LookupCtx = nullptr;
301   if (ObjectTypePtr) {
302     QualType ObjectType = ObjectTypePtr.get();
303     if (ObjectType->isRecordType())
304       LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(ObjectType);
305   } else if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty()) {
306     LookupCtx = computeDeclContext(*SS, false);
307 
308     if (!LookupCtx) {
309       if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
310         // C++ [temp.res]p3:
311         //   A qualified-id that refers to a type and in which the
312         //   nested-name-specifier depends on a template-parameter (14.6.2)
313         //   shall be prefixed by the keyword typename to indicate that the
314         //   qualified-id denotes a type, forming an
315         //   elaborated-type-specifier (7.1.5.3).
316         //
317         // We therefore do not perform any name lookup if the result would
318         // refer to a member of an unknown specialization.
319         if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName)
320           return nullptr;
321 
322         // We know from the grammar that this name refers to a type,
323         // so build a dependent node to describe the type.
324         if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo)
325           return ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, II, NameLoc).get();
326 
327         NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = SS->getWithLocInContext(Context);
328         QualType T = CheckTypenameType(ETK_None, SourceLocation(), QualifierLoc,
329                                        II, NameLoc);
330         return ParsedType::make(T);
331       }
332 
333       return nullptr;
334     }
335 
336     if (!LookupCtx->isDependentContext() &&
337         RequireCompleteDeclContext(*SS, LookupCtx))
338       return nullptr;
339   }
340 
341   // FIXME: LookupNestedNameSpecifierName isn't the right kind of
342   // lookup for class-names.
343   LookupNameKind Kind = isClassName ? LookupNestedNameSpecifierName :
344                                       LookupOrdinaryName;
345   LookupResult Result(*this, &II, NameLoc, Kind);
346   if (LookupCtx) {
347     // Perform "qualified" name lookup into the declaration context we
348     // computed, which is either the type of the base of a member access
349     // expression or the declaration context associated with a prior
350     // nested-name-specifier.
351     LookupQualifiedName(Result, LookupCtx);
352 
353     if (ObjectTypePtr && Result.empty()) {
354       // C++ [basic.lookup.classref]p3:
355       //   If the unqualified-id is ~type-name, the type-name is looked up
356       //   in the context of the entire postfix-expression. If the type T of
357       //   the object expression is of a class type C, the type-name is also
358       //   looked up in the scope of class C. At least one of the lookups shall
359       //   find a name that refers to (possibly cv-qualified) T.
360       LookupName(Result, S);
361     }
362   } else {
363     // Perform unqualified name lookup.
364     LookupName(Result, S);
365 
366     // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
367     // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
368     if (Result.empty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && (!SS || SS->isEmpty())) {
369       if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
370               recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, II, NameLoc))
371         return TypeInBase;
372     }
373   }
374 
375   NamedDecl *IIDecl = nullptr;
376   UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
377   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
378   case LookupResult::NotFound:
379   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
380     if (CorrectedII) {
381       TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/true, isClassName,
382                                AllowDeducedTemplate);
383       TypoCorrection Correction = CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Kind,
384                                               S, SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery);
385       IdentifierInfo *NewII = Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
386       TemplateTy Template;
387       bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
388       UnqualifiedId TemplateName;
389       TemplateName.setIdentifier(NewII, NameLoc);
390       NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = Correction.getCorrectionSpecifier();
391       CXXScopeSpec NewSS, *NewSSPtr = SS;
392       if (SS && NNS) {
393         NewSS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
394         NewSSPtr = &NewSS;
395       }
396       if (Correction && (NNS || NewII != &II) &&
397           // Ignore a correction to a template type as the to-be-corrected
398           // identifier is not a template (typo correction for template names
399           // is handled elsewhere).
400           !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewSSPtr &&
401             isTemplateName(S, *NewSSPtr, false, TemplateName, nullptr, false,
402                            Template, MemberOfUnknownSpecialization))) {
403         ParsedType Ty = getTypeName(*NewII, NameLoc, S, NewSSPtr,
404                                     isClassName, HasTrailingDot, ObjectTypePtr,
405                                     IsCtorOrDtorName,
406                                     WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo,
407                                     IsClassTemplateDeductionContext);
408         if (Ty) {
409           diagnoseTypo(Correction,
410                        PDiag(diag::err_unknown_type_or_class_name_suggest)
411                          << Result.getLookupName() << isClassName);
412           if (SS && NNS)
413             SS->MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
414           *CorrectedII = NewII;
415           return Ty;
416         }
417       }
418     }
419     // If typo correction failed or was not performed, fall through
420     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
421   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
422   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
423     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
424     return nullptr;
425 
426   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
427     // Recover from type-hiding ambiguities by hiding the type.  We'll
428     // do the lookup again when looking for an object, and we can
429     // diagnose the error then.  If we don't do this, then the error
430     // about hiding the type will be immediately followed by an error
431     // that only makes sense if the identifier was treated like a type.
432     if (Result.getAmbiguityKind() == LookupResult::AmbiguousTagHiding) {
433       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
434       return nullptr;
435     }
436 
437     // Look to see if we have a type anywhere in the list of results.
438     for (LookupResult::iterator Res = Result.begin(), ResEnd = Result.end();
439          Res != ResEnd; ++Res) {
440       NamedDecl *RealRes = (*Res)->getUnderlyingDecl();
441       if (isa<TypeDecl, ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(
442               RealRes) ||
443           (AllowDeducedTemplate && getAsTypeTemplateDecl(RealRes))) {
444         if (!IIDecl ||
445             // Make the selection of the recovery decl deterministic.
446             RealRes->getLocation() < IIDecl->getLocation()) {
447           IIDecl = RealRes;
448           FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Res);
449         }
450       }
451     }
452 
453     if (!IIDecl) {
454       // None of the entities we found is a type, so there is no way
455       // to even assume that the result is a type. In this case, don't
456       // complain about the ambiguity. The parser will either try to
457       // perform this lookup again (e.g., as an object name), which
458       // will produce the ambiguity, or will complain that it expected
459       // a type name.
460       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
461       return nullptr;
462     }
463 
464     // We found a type within the ambiguous lookup; diagnose the
465     // ambiguity and then return that type. This might be the right
466     // answer, or it might not be, but it suppresses any attempt to
467     // perform the name lookup again.
468     break;
469 
470   case LookupResult::Found:
471     IIDecl = Result.getFoundDecl();
472     FoundUsingShadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin());
473     break;
474   }
475 
476   assert(IIDecl && "Didn't find decl");
477 
478   QualType T;
479   if (TypeDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(IIDecl)) {
480     // C++ [class.qual]p2: A lookup that would find the injected-class-name
481     // instead names the constructors of the class, except when naming a class.
482     // This is ill-formed when we're not actually forming a ctor or dtor name.
483     auto *LookupRD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(LookupCtx);
484     auto *FoundRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TD);
485     if (!isClassName && !IsCtorOrDtorName && LookupRD && FoundRD &&
486         FoundRD->isInjectedClassName() &&
487         declaresSameEntity(LookupRD, cast<Decl>(FoundRD->getParent())))
488       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_out_of_line_qualified_id_type_names_constructor)
489           << &II << /*Type*/1;
490 
491     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IIDecl, NameLoc);
492 
493     T = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD);
494     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(TD->getLocation(), TD, /*OdrUse=*/false);
495   } else if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IIDecl)) {
496     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IDecl, NameLoc);
497     if (!HasTrailingDot)
498       T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(IDecl);
499     FoundUsingShadow = nullptr; // FIXME: Target must be a TypeDecl.
500   } else if (auto *UD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
501     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(UD, NameLoc);
502     // Recover with 'int'
503     T = Context.IntTy;
504     FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
505   } else if (AllowDeducedTemplate) {
506     if (auto *TD = getAsTypeTemplateDecl(IIDecl)) {
507       assert(!FoundUsingShadow || FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl() == TD);
508       TemplateName Template =
509           FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD);
510       T = Context.getDeducedTemplateSpecializationType(Template, QualType(),
511                                                        false);
512       // Don't wrap in a further UsingType.
513       FoundUsingShadow = nullptr;
514     }
515   }
516 
517   if (T.isNull()) {
518     // If it's not plausibly a type, suppress diagnostics.
519     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
520     return nullptr;
521   }
522 
523   if (FoundUsingShadow)
524     T = Context.getUsingType(FoundUsingShadow, T);
525 
526   // NOTE: avoid constructing an ElaboratedType(Loc) if this is a
527   // constructor or destructor name (in such a case, the scope specifier
528   // will be attached to the enclosing Expr or Decl node).
529   if (SS && SS->isNotEmpty() && !IsCtorOrDtorName &&
530       !isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl, UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(IIDecl)) {
531     if (WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo) {
532       // Construct a type with type-source information.
533       TypeLocBuilder Builder;
534       Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
535 
536       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
537       ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
538       ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
539       ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS->getWithLocInContext(Context));
540       return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
541     } else {
542       T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, *SS, T);
543     }
544   }
545 
546   return ParsedType::make(T);
547 }
548 
549 // Builds a fake NNS for the given decl context.
550 static NestedNameSpecifier *
551 synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(ASTContext &Context, DeclContext *DC) {
552   for (;; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
553     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
554     auto *ND = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
555     if (ND && !ND->isInline() && !ND->isAnonymousNamespace())
556       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, ND);
557     else if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
558       return NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
559                                          RD->getTypeForDecl());
560     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
561       return NestedNameSpecifier::GlobalSpecifier(Context);
562   }
563   llvm_unreachable("something isn't in TU scope?");
564 }
565 
566 /// Find the parent class with dependent bases of the innermost enclosing method
567 /// context. Do not look for enclosing CXXRecordDecls directly, or we will end
568 /// up allowing unqualified dependent type names at class-level, which MSVC
569 /// correctly rejects.
570 static const CXXRecordDecl *
571 findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(const DeclContext *DC) {
572   for (; DC && DC->isDependentContext(); DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
573     DC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
574     if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC))
575       if (MD->getParent()->hasAnyDependentBases())
576         return MD->getParent();
577   }
578   return nullptr;
579 }
580 
581 ParsedType Sema::ActOnMSVCUnknownTypeName(const IdentifierInfo &II,
582                                           SourceLocation NameLoc,
583                                           bool IsTemplateTypeArg) {
584   assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && "shouldn't be called in non-MSVC mode");
585 
586   NestedNameSpecifier *NNS = nullptr;
587   if (IsTemplateTypeArg && getCurScope()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
588     // If we weren't able to parse a default template argument, delay lookup
589     // until instantiation time by making a non-dependent DependentTypeName. We
590     // pretend we saw a NestedNameSpecifier referring to the current scope, and
591     // lookup is retried.
592     // FIXME: This hurts our diagnostic quality, since we get errors like "no
593     // type named 'Foo' in 'current_namespace'" when the user didn't write any
594     // name specifiers.
595     NNS = synthesizeCurrentNestedNameSpecifier(Context, CurContext);
596     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_ms_delayed_template_argument) << &II;
597   } else if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD =
598                  findRecordWithDependentBasesOfEnclosingMethod(CurContext)) {
599     // Build a DependentNameType that will perform lookup into RD at
600     // instantiation time.
601     NNS = NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, RD->isTemplateDecl(),
602                                       RD->getTypeForDecl());
603 
604     // Diagnose that this identifier was undeclared, and retry the lookup during
605     // template instantiation.
606     Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base) << &II
607                                                                       << RD;
608   } else {
609     // This is not a situation that we should recover from.
610     return ParsedType();
611   }
612 
613   QualType T = Context.getDependentNameType(ETK_None, NNS, &II);
614 
615   // Build type location information.  We synthesized the qualifier, so we have
616   // to build a fake NestedNameSpecifierLoc.
617   NestedNameSpecifierLocBuilder NNSLocBuilder;
618   NNSLocBuilder.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(NameLoc));
619   NestedNameSpecifierLoc QualifierLoc = NNSLocBuilder.getWithLocInContext(Context);
620 
621   TypeLocBuilder Builder;
622   DependentNameTypeLoc DepTL = Builder.push<DependentNameTypeLoc>(T);
623   DepTL.setNameLoc(NameLoc);
624   DepTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
625   DepTL.setQualifierLoc(QualifierLoc);
626   return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
627 }
628 
629 /// isTagName() - This method is called *for error recovery purposes only*
630 /// to determine if the specified name is a valid tag name ("struct foo").  If
631 /// so, this returns the TST for the tag corresponding to it (TST_enum,
632 /// TST_union, TST_struct, TST_interface, TST_class).  This is used to diagnose
633 /// cases in C where the user forgot to specify the tag.
634 DeclSpec::TST Sema::isTagName(IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
635   // Do a tag name lookup in this scope.
636   LookupResult R(*this, &II, SourceLocation(), LookupTagName);
637   LookupName(R, S, false);
638   R.suppressDiagnostics();
639   if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found)
640     if (const TagDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
641       switch (TD->getTagKind()) {
642       case TTK_Struct: return DeclSpec::TST_struct;
643       case TTK_Interface: return DeclSpec::TST_interface;
644       case TTK_Union:  return DeclSpec::TST_union;
645       case TTK_Class:  return DeclSpec::TST_class;
646       case TTK_Enum:   return DeclSpec::TST_enum;
647       }
648     }
649 
650   return DeclSpec::TST_unspecified;
651 }
652 
653 /// isMicrosoftMissingTypename - In Microsoft mode, within class scope,
654 /// if a CXXScopeSpec's type is equal to the type of one of the base classes
655 /// then downgrade the missing typename error to a warning.
656 /// This is needed for MSVC compatibility; Example:
657 /// @code
658 /// template<class T> class A {
659 /// public:
660 ///   typedef int TYPE;
661 /// };
662 /// template<class T> class B : public A<T> {
663 /// public:
664 ///   A<T>::TYPE a; // no typename required because A<T> is a base class.
665 /// };
666 /// @endcode
667 bool Sema::isMicrosoftMissingTypename(const CXXScopeSpec *SS, Scope *S) {
668   if (CurContext->isRecord()) {
669     if (SS->getScopeRep()->getKind() == NestedNameSpecifier::Super)
670       return true;
671 
672     const Type *Ty = SS->getScopeRep()->getAsType();
673 
674     CXXRecordDecl *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
675     for (const auto &Base : RD->bases())
676       if (Ty && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(QualType(Ty, 1), Base.getType()))
677         return true;
678     return S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
679   }
680   return CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() || S->isFunctionPrototypeScope();
681 }
682 
683 void Sema::DiagnoseUnknownTypeName(IdentifierInfo *&II,
684                                    SourceLocation IILoc,
685                                    Scope *S,
686                                    CXXScopeSpec *SS,
687                                    ParsedType &SuggestedType,
688                                    bool IsTemplateName) {
689   // Don't report typename errors for editor placeholders.
690   if (II->isEditorPlaceholder())
691     return;
692   // We don't have anything to suggest (yet).
693   SuggestedType = nullptr;
694 
695   // There may have been a typo in the name of the type. Look up typo
696   // results, in case we have something that we can suggest.
697   TypeNameValidatorCCC CCC(/*AllowInvalid=*/false, /*WantClass=*/false,
698                            /*AllowTemplates=*/IsTemplateName,
699                            /*AllowNonTemplates=*/!IsTemplateName);
700   if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
701           CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(II, IILoc), LookupOrdinaryName, S, SS,
702                       CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
703     // FIXME: Support error recovery for the template-name case.
704     bool CanRecover = !IsTemplateName;
705     if (Corrected.isKeyword()) {
706       // We corrected to a keyword.
707       diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
708                    PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
709                                         : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
710                        << II);
711       II = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
712     } else {
713       // We found a similarly-named type or interface; suggest that.
714       if (!SS || !SS->isSet()) {
715         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
716                      PDiag(IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template_suggest
717                                           : diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest)
718                          << II, CanRecover);
719       } else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false)) {
720         std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
721         bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
722                                 II->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
723         diagnoseTypo(Corrected,
724                      PDiag(IsTemplateName
725                                ? diag::err_no_member_template_suggest
726                                : diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest)
727                          << II << DC << DroppedSpecifier << SS->getRange(),
728                      CanRecover);
729       } else {
730         llvm_unreachable("could not have corrected a typo here");
731       }
732 
733       if (!CanRecover)
734         return;
735 
736       CXXScopeSpec tmpSS;
737       if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier())
738         tmpSS.MakeTrivial(Context, Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier(),
739                           SourceRange(IILoc));
740       // FIXME: Support class template argument deduction here.
741       SuggestedType =
742           getTypeName(*Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(), IILoc, S,
743                       tmpSS.isSet() ? &tmpSS : SS, false, false, nullptr,
744                       /*IsCtorOrDtorName=*/false,
745                       /*WantNontrivialTypeSourceInfo=*/true);
746     }
747     return;
748   }
749 
750   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !IsTemplateName) {
751     // See if II is a class template that the user forgot to pass arguments to.
752     UnqualifiedId Name;
753     Name.setIdentifier(II, IILoc);
754     CXXScopeSpec EmptySS;
755     TemplateTy TemplateResult;
756     bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
757     if (isTemplateName(S, SS ? *SS : EmptySS, /*hasTemplateKeyword=*/false,
758                        Name, nullptr, true, TemplateResult,
759                        MemberOfUnknownSpecialization) == TNK_Type_template) {
760       diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateResult.get(), IILoc);
761       return;
762     }
763   }
764 
765   // FIXME: Should we move the logic that tries to recover from a missing tag
766   // (struct, union, enum) from Parser::ParseImplicitInt here, instead?
767 
768   if (!SS || (!SS->isSet() && !SS->isInvalid()))
769     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_template
770                                : diag::err_unknown_typename)
771         << II;
772   else if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(*SS, false))
773     Diag(IILoc, IsTemplateName ? diag::err_no_member_template
774                                : diag::err_typename_nested_not_found)
775         << II << DC << SS->getRange();
776   else if (SS->isValid() && SS->getScopeRep()->containsErrors()) {
777     SuggestedType =
778         ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(), *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
779   } else if (isDependentScopeSpecifier(*SS)) {
780     unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing;
781     if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isMicrosoftMissingTypename(SS, S))
782       DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing;
783 
784     Diag(SS->getRange().getBegin(), DiagID)
785       << SS->getScopeRep() << II->getName()
786       << SourceRange(SS->getRange().getBegin(), IILoc)
787       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SS->getRange().getBegin(), "typename ");
788     SuggestedType = ActOnTypenameType(S, SourceLocation(),
789                                       *SS, *II, IILoc).get();
790   } else {
791     assert(SS && SS->isInvalid() &&
792            "Invalid scope specifier has already been diagnosed");
793   }
794 }
795 
796 /// Determine whether the given result set contains either a type name
797 /// or
798 static bool isResultTypeOrTemplate(LookupResult &R, const Token &NextToken) {
799   bool CheckTemplate = R.getSema().getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
800                        NextToken.is(tok::less);
801 
802   for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), IEnd = R.end(); I != IEnd; ++I) {
803     if (isa<TypeDecl>(*I) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*I))
804       return true;
805 
806     if (CheckTemplate && isa<TemplateDecl>(*I))
807       return true;
808   }
809 
810   return false;
811 }
812 
813 static bool isTagTypeWithMissingTag(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Result,
814                                     Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
815                                     IdentifierInfo *&Name,
816                                     SourceLocation NameLoc) {
817   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupTagName);
818   SemaRef.LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS);
819   if (TagDecl *Tag = R.getAsSingle<TagDecl>()) {
820     StringRef FixItTagName;
821     switch (Tag->getTagKind()) {
822       case TTK_Class:
823         FixItTagName = "class ";
824         break;
825 
826       case TTK_Enum:
827         FixItTagName = "enum ";
828         break;
829 
830       case TTK_Struct:
831         FixItTagName = "struct ";
832         break;
833 
834       case TTK_Interface:
835         FixItTagName = "__interface ";
836         break;
837 
838       case TTK_Union:
839         FixItTagName = "union ";
840         break;
841     }
842 
843     StringRef TagName = FixItTagName.drop_back();
844     SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_use_of_tag_name_without_tag)
845       << Name << TagName << SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
846       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, FixItTagName);
847 
848     for (LookupResult::iterator I = Result.begin(), IEnd = Result.end();
849          I != IEnd; ++I)
850       SemaRef.Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_decl_hiding_tag_type)
851         << Name << TagName;
852 
853     // Replace lookup results with just the tag decl.
854     Result.clear(Sema::LookupTagName);
855     SemaRef.LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS);
856     return true;
857   }
858 
859   return false;
860 }
861 
862 Sema::NameClassification Sema::ClassifyName(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
863                                             IdentifierInfo *&Name,
864                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
865                                             const Token &NextToken,
866                                             CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC) {
867   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
868   ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
869 
870   assert(NextToken.isNot(tok::coloncolon) &&
871          "parse nested name specifiers before calling ClassifyName");
872   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && SS.isSet() &&
873       isCurrentClassName(*Name, S, &SS)) {
874     // Per [class.qual]p2, this names the constructors of SS, not the
875     // injected-class-name. We don't have a classification for that.
876     // There's not much point caching this result, since the parser
877     // will reject it later.
878     return NameClassification::Unknown();
879   }
880 
881   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
882   LookupParsedName(Result, S, &SS, !CurMethod);
883 
884   if (SS.isInvalid())
885     return NameClassification::Error();
886 
887   // For unqualified lookup in a class template in MSVC mode, look into
888   // dependent base classes where the primary class template is known.
889   if (Result.empty() && SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) {
890     if (ParsedType TypeInBase =
891             recoverFromTypeInKnownDependentBase(*this, *Name, NameLoc))
892       return TypeInBase;
893   }
894 
895   // Perform lookup for Objective-C instance variables (including automatically
896   // synthesized instance variables), if we're in an Objective-C method.
897   // FIXME: This lookup really, really needs to be folded in to the normal
898   // unqualified lookup mechanism.
899   if (SS.isEmpty() && CurMethod && !isResultTypeOrTemplate(Result, NextToken)) {
900     DeclResult Ivar = LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Name);
901     if (Ivar.isInvalid())
902       return NameClassification::Error();
903     if (Ivar.isUsable())
904       return NameClassification::NonType(cast<NamedDecl>(Ivar.get()));
905 
906     // We defer builtin creation until after ivar lookup inside ObjC methods.
907     if (Result.empty())
908       LookupBuiltin(Result);
909   }
910 
911   bool SecondTry = false;
912   bool IsFilteredTemplateName = false;
913 
914 Corrected:
915   switch (Result.getResultKind()) {
916   case LookupResult::NotFound:
917     // If an unqualified-id is followed by a '(', then we have a function
918     // call.
919     if (SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::l_paren)) {
920       // In C++, this is an ADL-only call.
921       // FIXME: Reference?
922       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
923         return NameClassification::UndeclaredNonType();
924 
925       // C90 6.3.2.2:
926       //   If the expression that precedes the parenthesized argument list in a
927       //   function call consists solely of an identifier, and if no
928       //   declaration is visible for this identifier, the identifier is
929       //   implicitly declared exactly as if, in the innermost block containing
930       //   the function call, the declaration
931       //
932       //     extern int identifier ();
933       //
934       //   appeared.
935       //
936       // We also allow this in C99 as an extension. However, this is not
937       // allowed in all language modes as functions without prototypes may not
938       // be supported.
939       if (getLangOpts().implicitFunctionsAllowed()) {
940         if (NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *Name, S))
941           return NameClassification::NonType(D);
942       }
943     }
944 
945     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 && SS.isEmpty() && NextToken.is(tok::less)) {
946       // In C++20 onwards, this could be an ADL-only call to a function
947       // template, and we're required to assume that this is a template name.
948       //
949       // FIXME: Find a way to still do typo correction in this case.
950       TemplateName Template =
951           Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
952       return NameClassification::UndeclaredTemplate(Template);
953     }
954 
955     // In C, we first see whether there is a tag type by the same name, in
956     // which case it's likely that the user just forgot to write "enum",
957     // "struct", or "union".
958     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !SecondTry &&
959         isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
960       break;
961     }
962 
963     // Perform typo correction to determine if there is another name that is
964     // close to this name.
965     if (!SecondTry && CCC) {
966       SecondTry = true;
967       if (TypoCorrection Corrected =
968               CorrectTypo(Result.getLookupNameInfo(), Result.getLookupKind(), S,
969                           &SS, *CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
970         unsigned UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
971         unsigned QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_suggest;
972 
973         NamedDecl *FirstDecl = Corrected.getFoundDecl();
974         NamedDecl *UnderlyingFirstDecl = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl();
975         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
976             UnderlyingFirstDecl && isa<TemplateDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl)) {
977           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_template_suggest;
978           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_no_member_template_suggest;
979         } else if (UnderlyingFirstDecl &&
980                    (isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
981                     isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl) ||
982                     isa<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(UnderlyingFirstDecl))) {
983           UnqualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_typename_suggest;
984           QualifiedDiag = diag::err_unknown_nested_typename_suggest;
985         }
986 
987         if (SS.isEmpty()) {
988           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(UnqualifiedDiag) << Name);
989         } else {// FIXME: is this even reachable? Test it.
990           std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts()));
991           bool DroppedSpecifier = Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() &&
992                                   Name->getName().equals(CorrectedStr);
993           diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(QualifiedDiag)
994                                     << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
995                                     << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange());
996         }
997 
998         // Update the name, so that the caller has the new name.
999         Name = Corrected.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo();
1000 
1001         // Typo correction corrected to a keyword.
1002         if (Corrected.isKeyword())
1003           return Name;
1004 
1005         // Also update the LookupResult...
1006         // FIXME: This should probably go away at some point
1007         Result.clear();
1008         Result.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection());
1009         if (FirstDecl)
1010           Result.addDecl(FirstDecl);
1011 
1012         // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1013         // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
1014         // reference the ivar.
1015         // FIXME: This is a gross hack.
1016         if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = Result.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1017           DeclResult R =
1018               LookupIvarInObjCMethod(Result, S, Ivar->getIdentifier());
1019           if (R.isInvalid())
1020             return NameClassification::Error();
1021           if (R.isUsable())
1022             return NameClassification::NonType(Ivar);
1023         }
1024 
1025         goto Corrected;
1026       }
1027     }
1028 
1029     // We failed to correct; just fall through and let the parser deal with it.
1030     Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1031     return NameClassification::Unknown();
1032 
1033   case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation: {
1034     // We performed name lookup into the current instantiation, and there were
1035     // dependent bases, so we treat this result the same way as any other
1036     // dependent nested-name-specifier.
1037 
1038     // C++ [temp.res]p2:
1039     //   A name used in a template declaration or definition and that is
1040     //   dependent on a template-parameter is assumed not to name a type
1041     //   unless the applicable name lookup finds a type name or the name is
1042     //   qualified by the keyword typename.
1043     //
1044     // FIXME: If the next token is '<', we might want to ask the parser to
1045     // perform some heroics to see if we actually have a
1046     // template-argument-list, which would indicate a missing 'template'
1047     // keyword here.
1048     return NameClassification::DependentNonType();
1049   }
1050 
1051   case LookupResult::Found:
1052   case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
1053   case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
1054     break;
1055 
1056   case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
1057     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1058         hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1059                                       /*AllowDependent=*/false)) {
1060       // C++ [temp.local]p3:
1061       //   A lookup that finds an injected-class-name (10.2) can result in an
1062       //   ambiguity in certain cases (for example, if it is found in more than
1063       //   one base class). If all of the injected-class-names that are found
1064       //   refer to specializations of the same class template, and if the name
1065       //   is followed by a template-argument-list, the reference refers to the
1066       //   class template itself and not a specialization thereof, and is not
1067       //   ambiguous.
1068       //
1069       // This filtering can make an ambiguous result into an unambiguous one,
1070       // so try again after filtering out template names.
1071       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1072       if (!Result.isAmbiguous()) {
1073         IsFilteredTemplateName = true;
1074         break;
1075       }
1076     }
1077 
1078     // Diagnose the ambiguity and return an error.
1079     return NameClassification::Error();
1080   }
1081 
1082   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NextToken.is(tok::less) &&
1083       (IsFilteredTemplateName ||
1084        hasAnyAcceptableTemplateNames(
1085            Result, /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1086            /*AllowDependent=*/false,
1087            /*AllowNonTemplateFunctions*/ SS.isEmpty() &&
1088                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20))) {
1089     // C++ [temp.names]p3:
1090     //   After name lookup (3.4) finds that a name is a template-name or that
1091     //   an operator-function-id or a literal- operator-id refers to a set of
1092     //   overloaded functions any member of which is a function template if
1093     //   this is followed by a <, the < is always taken as the delimiter of a
1094     //   template-argument-list and never as the less-than operator.
1095     // C++2a [temp.names]p2:
1096     //   A name is also considered to refer to a template if it is an
1097     //   unqualified-id followed by a < and name lookup finds either one
1098     //   or more functions or finds nothing.
1099     if (!IsFilteredTemplateName)
1100       FilterAcceptableTemplateNames(Result);
1101 
1102     bool IsFunctionTemplate;
1103     bool IsVarTemplate;
1104     TemplateName Template;
1105     if (Result.end() - Result.begin() > 1) {
1106       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1107       Template = Context.getOverloadedTemplateName(Result.begin(),
1108                                                    Result.end());
1109     } else if (!Result.empty()) {
1110       auto *TD = cast<TemplateDecl>(getAsTemplateNameDecl(
1111           *Result.begin(), /*AllowFunctionTemplates=*/true,
1112           /*AllowDependent=*/false));
1113       IsFunctionTemplate = isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD);
1114       IsVarTemplate = isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD);
1115 
1116       UsingShadowDecl *FoundUsingShadow =
1117           dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*Result.begin());
1118       assert(!FoundUsingShadow ||
1119              TD == cast<TemplateDecl>(FoundUsingShadow->getTargetDecl()));
1120       Template =
1121           FoundUsingShadow ? TemplateName(FoundUsingShadow) : TemplateName(TD);
1122       if (SS.isNotEmpty())
1123         Template = Context.getQualifiedTemplateName(SS.getScopeRep(),
1124                                                     /*TemplateKeyword=*/false,
1125                                                     Template);
1126     } else {
1127       // All results were non-template functions. This is a function template
1128       // name.
1129       IsFunctionTemplate = true;
1130       Template = Context.getAssumedTemplateName(NameInfo.getName());
1131     }
1132 
1133     if (IsFunctionTemplate) {
1134       // Function templates always go through overload resolution, at which
1135       // point we'll perform the various checks (e.g., accessibility) we need
1136       // to based on which function we selected.
1137       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1138 
1139       return NameClassification::FunctionTemplate(Template);
1140     }
1141 
1142     return IsVarTemplate ? NameClassification::VarTemplate(Template)
1143                          : NameClassification::TypeTemplate(Template);
1144   }
1145 
1146   auto BuildTypeFor = [&](TypeDecl *Type, NamedDecl *Found) {
1147     QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(Type);
1148     if (const auto *USD = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Found))
1149       T = Context.getUsingType(USD, T);
1150 
1151     if (SS.isEmpty()) // No elaborated type, trivial location info
1152       return ParsedType::make(T);
1153 
1154     TypeLocBuilder Builder;
1155     Builder.pushTypeSpec(T).setNameLoc(NameLoc);
1156     T = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, T);
1157     ElaboratedTypeLoc ElabTL = Builder.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(T);
1158     ElabTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation());
1159     ElabTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
1160     return CreateParsedType(T, Builder.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, T));
1161   };
1162 
1163   NamedDecl *FirstDecl = (*Result.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl();
1164   if (TypeDecl *Type = dyn_cast<TypeDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1165     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1166     MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Type->getLocation(), Type, /*OdrUse=*/false);
1167     return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin());
1168   }
1169 
1170   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Class = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(FirstDecl);
1171   if (!Class) {
1172     // FIXME: It's unfortunate that we don't have a Type node for handling this.
1173     if (ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl *Alias =
1174             dyn_cast<ObjCCompatibleAliasDecl>(FirstDecl))
1175       Class = Alias->getClassInterface();
1176   }
1177 
1178   if (Class) {
1179     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Class, NameLoc);
1180 
1181     if (NextToken.is(tok::period)) {
1182       // Interface. <something> is parsed as a property reference expression.
1183       // Just return "unknown" as a fall-through for now.
1184       Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1185       return NameClassification::Unknown();
1186     }
1187 
1188     QualType T = Context.getObjCInterfaceType(Class);
1189     return ParsedType::make(T);
1190   }
1191 
1192   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(FirstDecl))
1193     return NameClassification::Concept(
1194         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1195 
1196   if (auto *EmptyD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingIfExistsDecl>(FirstDecl)) {
1197     (void)DiagnoseUseOfDecl(EmptyD, NameLoc);
1198     return NameClassification::Error();
1199   }
1200 
1201   // We can have a type template here if we're classifying a template argument.
1202   if (isa<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl) &&
1203       !isa<VarTemplateDecl>(FirstDecl))
1204     return NameClassification::TypeTemplate(
1205         TemplateName(cast<TemplateDecl>(FirstDecl)));
1206 
1207   // Check for a tag type hidden by a non-type decl in a few cases where it
1208   // seems likely a type is wanted instead of the non-type that was found.
1209   bool NextIsOp = NextToken.isOneOf(tok::amp, tok::star);
1210   if ((NextToken.is(tok::identifier) ||
1211        (NextIsOp &&
1212         FirstDecl->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate())) &&
1213       isTagTypeWithMissingTag(*this, Result, S, SS, Name, NameLoc)) {
1214     TypeDecl *Type = Result.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
1215     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Type, NameLoc);
1216     return BuildTypeFor(Type, *Result.begin());
1217   }
1218 
1219   // If we already know which single declaration is referenced, just annotate
1220   // that declaration directly. Defer resolving even non-overloaded class
1221   // member accesses, as we need to defer certain access checks until we know
1222   // the context.
1223   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1224   if (Result.isSingleResult() && !ADL && !FirstDecl->isCXXClassMember())
1225     return NameClassification::NonType(Result.getRepresentativeDecl());
1226 
1227   // Otherwise, this is an overload set that we will need to resolve later.
1228   Result.suppressDiagnostics();
1229   return NameClassification::OverloadSet(UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(
1230       Context, Result.getNamingClass(), SS.getWithLocInContext(Context),
1231       Result.getLookupNameInfo(), ADL, Result.isOverloadedResult(),
1232       Result.begin(), Result.end()));
1233 }
1234 
1235 ExprResult
1236 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsUndeclaredNonType(IdentifierInfo *Name,
1237                                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1238   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL-only call in C?");
1239   CXXScopeSpec SS;
1240   LookupResult Result(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1241   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, /*ADL=*/true);
1242 }
1243 
1244 ExprResult
1245 Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsDependentNonType(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1246                                             IdentifierInfo *Name,
1247                                             SourceLocation NameLoc,
1248                                             bool IsAddressOfOperand) {
1249   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(Name, NameLoc);
1250   return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
1251                                     NameInfo, IsAddressOfOperand,
1252                                     /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr);
1253 }
1254 
1255 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsNonType(Scope *S, const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1256                                               NamedDecl *Found,
1257                                               SourceLocation NameLoc,
1258                                               const Token &NextToken) {
1259   if (getCurMethodDecl() && SS.isEmpty())
1260     if (auto *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()))
1261       return BuildIvarRefExpr(S, NameLoc, Ivar);
1262 
1263   // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1264   LookupResult Result(*this, Found->getDeclName(), NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
1265   Result.addDecl(Found);
1266   Result.resolveKind();
1267 
1268   bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, Result, NextToken.is(tok::l_paren));
1269   return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, Result, ADL);
1270 }
1271 
1272 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNameClassifiedAsOverloadSet(Scope *S, Expr *E) {
1273   // For an implicit class member access, transform the result into a member
1274   // access expression if necessary.
1275   auto *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E);
1276   if ((*ULE->decls_begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
1277     CXXScopeSpec SS;
1278     SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
1279 
1280     // Reconstruct the lookup result.
1281     LookupResult Result(*this, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
1282                         LookupOrdinaryName);
1283     Result.setNamingClass(ULE->getNamingClass());
1284     for (auto I = ULE->decls_begin(), E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
1285       Result.addDecl(*I, I.getAccess());
1286     Result.resolveKind();
1287     return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, SourceLocation(), Result,
1288                                            nullptr, S);
1289   }
1290 
1291   // Otherwise, this is already in the form we needed, and no further checks
1292   // are necessary.
1293   return ULE;
1294 }
1295 
1296 Sema::TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics
1297 Sema::getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TemplateName Name) {
1298   auto *TD = Name.getAsTemplateDecl();
1299   if (!TD)
1300     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1301   if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(TD))
1302     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::ClassTemplate;
1303   if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(TD))
1304     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::FunctionTemplate;
1305   if (isa<VarTemplateDecl>(TD))
1306     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::VarTemplate;
1307   if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(TD))
1308     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::AliasTemplate;
1309   if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(TD))
1310     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::TemplateTemplateParam;
1311   if (isa<ConceptDecl>(TD))
1312     return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::Concept;
1313   return TemplateNameKindForDiagnostics::DependentTemplate;
1314 }
1315 
1316 void Sema::PushDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1317   assert(DC->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
1318       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1319   CurContext = DC;
1320   S->setEntity(DC);
1321 }
1322 
1323 void Sema::PopDeclContext() {
1324   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1325 
1326   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1327   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1328 }
1329 
1330 Sema::SkippedDefinitionContext Sema::ActOnTagStartSkippedDefinition(Scope *S,
1331                                                                     Decl *D) {
1332   // Unlike PushDeclContext, the context to which we return is not necessarily
1333   // the containing DC of TD, because the new context will be some pre-existing
1334   // TagDecl definition instead of a fresh one.
1335   auto Result = static_cast<SkippedDefinitionContext>(CurContext);
1336   CurContext = cast<TagDecl>(D)->getDefinition();
1337   assert(CurContext && "skipping definition of undefined tag");
1338   // Start lookups from the parent of the current context; we don't want to look
1339   // into the pre-existing complete definition.
1340   S->setEntity(CurContext->getLookupParent());
1341   return Result;
1342 }
1343 
1344 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishSkippedDefinition(SkippedDefinitionContext Context) {
1345   CurContext = static_cast<decltype(CurContext)>(Context);
1346 }
1347 
1348 /// EnterDeclaratorContext - Used when we must lookup names in the context
1349 /// of a declarator's nested name specifier.
1350 ///
1351 void Sema::EnterDeclaratorContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1352   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p13:
1353   //   A name used in the definition of a static data member of class
1354   //   X (after the qualified-id of the static member) is looked up as
1355   //   if the name was used in a member function of X.
1356   // C++0x [basic.lookup.unqual]p14:
1357   //   If a variable member of a namespace is defined outside of the
1358   //   scope of its namespace then any name used in the definition of
1359   //   the variable member (after the declarator-id) is looked up as
1360   //   if the definition of the variable member occurred in its
1361   //   namespace.
1362   // Both of these imply that we should push a scope whose context
1363   // is the semantic context of the declaration.  We can't use
1364   // PushDeclContext here because that context is not necessarily
1365   // lexically contained in the current context.  Fortunately,
1366   // the containing scope should have the appropriate information.
1367 
1368   assert(!S->getEntity() && "scope already has entity");
1369 
1370 #ifndef NDEBUG
1371   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1372   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1373   assert(Ancestor->getEntity() == CurContext && "ancestor context mismatch");
1374 #endif
1375 
1376   CurContext = DC;
1377   S->setEntity(DC);
1378 
1379   if (S->getParent()->isTemplateParamScope()) {
1380     // Also set the corresponding entities for all immediately-enclosing
1381     // template parameter scopes.
1382     EnterTemplatedContext(S->getParent(), DC);
1383   }
1384 }
1385 
1386 void Sema::ExitDeclaratorContext(Scope *S) {
1387   assert(S->getEntity() == CurContext && "Context imbalance!");
1388 
1389   // Switch back to the lexical context.  The safety of this is
1390   // enforced by an assert in EnterDeclaratorContext.
1391   Scope *Ancestor = S->getParent();
1392   while (!Ancestor->getEntity()) Ancestor = Ancestor->getParent();
1393   CurContext = Ancestor->getEntity();
1394 
1395   // We don't need to do anything with the scope, which is going to
1396   // disappear.
1397 }
1398 
1399 void Sema::EnterTemplatedContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1400   assert(S->isTemplateParamScope() &&
1401          "expected to be initializing a template parameter scope");
1402 
1403   // C++20 [temp.local]p7:
1404   //   In the definition of a member of a class template that appears outside
1405   //   of the class template definition, the name of a member of the class
1406   //   template hides the name of a template-parameter of any enclosing class
1407   //   templates (but not a template-parameter of the member if the member is a
1408   //   class or function template).
1409   // C++20 [temp.local]p9:
1410   //   In the definition of a class template or in the definition of a member
1411   //   of such a template that appears outside of the template definition, for
1412   //   each non-dependent base class (13.8.2.1), if the name of the base class
1413   //   or the name of a member of the base class is the same as the name of a
1414   //   template-parameter, the base class name or member name hides the
1415   //   template-parameter name (6.4.10).
1416   //
1417   // This means that a template parameter scope should be searched immediately
1418   // after searching the DeclContext for which it is a template parameter
1419   // scope. For example, for
1420   //   template<typename T> template<typename U> template<typename V>
1421   //     void N::A<T>::B<U>::f(...)
1422   // we search V then B<U> (and base classes) then U then A<T> (and base
1423   // classes) then T then N then ::.
1424   unsigned ScopeDepth = getTemplateDepth(S);
1425   for (; S && S->isTemplateParamScope(); S = S->getParent(), --ScopeDepth) {
1426     DeclContext *SearchDCAfterScope = DC;
1427     for (; DC; DC = DC->getLookupParent()) {
1428       if (const TemplateParameterList *TPL =
1429               cast<Decl>(DC)->getDescribedTemplateParams()) {
1430         unsigned DCDepth = TPL->getDepth() + 1;
1431         if (DCDepth > ScopeDepth)
1432           continue;
1433         if (ScopeDepth == DCDepth)
1434           SearchDCAfterScope = DC = DC->getLookupParent();
1435         break;
1436       }
1437     }
1438     S->setLookupEntity(SearchDCAfterScope);
1439   }
1440 }
1441 
1442 void Sema::ActOnReenterFunctionContext(Scope* S, Decl *D) {
1443   // We assume that the caller has already called
1444   // ActOnReenterTemplateScope so getTemplatedDecl() works.
1445   FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction();
1446   if (!FD)
1447     return;
1448 
1449   // Same implementation as PushDeclContext, but enters the context
1450   // from the lexical parent, rather than the top-level class.
1451   assert(CurContext == FD->getLexicalParent() &&
1452     "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
1453   CurContext = FD;
1454   S->setEntity(CurContext);
1455 
1456   for (unsigned P = 0, NumParams = FD->getNumParams(); P < NumParams; ++P) {
1457     ParmVarDecl *Param = FD->getParamDecl(P);
1458     // If the parameter has an identifier, then add it to the scope
1459     if (Param->getIdentifier()) {
1460       S->AddDecl(Param);
1461       IdResolver.AddDecl(Param);
1462     }
1463   }
1464 }
1465 
1466 void Sema::ActOnExitFunctionContext() {
1467   // Same implementation as PopDeclContext, but returns to the lexical parent,
1468   // rather than the top-level class.
1469   assert(CurContext && "DeclContext imbalance!");
1470   CurContext = CurContext->getLexicalParent();
1471   assert(CurContext && "Popped translation unit!");
1472 }
1473 
1474 /// Determine whether overloading is allowed for a new function
1475 /// declaration considering prior declarations of the same name.
1476 ///
1477 /// This routine determines whether overloading is possible, not
1478 /// whether a new declaration actually overloads a previous one.
1479 /// It will return true in C++ (where overloads are alway permitted)
1480 /// or, as a C extension, when either the new declaration or a
1481 /// previous one is declared with the 'overloadable' attribute.
1482 static bool AllowOverloadingOfFunction(const LookupResult &Previous,
1483                                        ASTContext &Context,
1484                                        const FunctionDecl *New) {
1485   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
1486     return true;
1487 
1488   // Multiversion function declarations are not overloads in the
1489   // usual sense of that term, but lookup will report that an
1490   // overload set was found if more than one multiversion function
1491   // declaration is present for the same name. It is therefore
1492   // inadequate to assume that some prior declaration(s) had
1493   // the overloadable attribute; checking is required. Since one
1494   // declaration is permitted to omit the attribute, it is necessary
1495   // to check at least two; hence the 'any_of' check below. Note that
1496   // the overloadable attribute is implicitly added to declarations
1497   // that were required to have it but did not.
1498   if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) {
1499     return llvm::any_of(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
1500       return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
1501     });
1502   } else if (Previous.getResultKind() == LookupResult::Found)
1503     return Previous.getFoundDecl()->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
1504 
1505   return false;
1506 }
1507 
1508 /// Add this decl to the scope shadowed decl chains.
1509 void Sema::PushOnScopeChains(NamedDecl *D, Scope *S, bool AddToContext) {
1510   // Move up the scope chain until we find the nearest enclosing
1511   // non-transparent context. The declaration will be introduced into this
1512   // scope.
1513   while (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext())
1514     S = S->getParent();
1515 
1516   // Add scoped declarations into their context, so that they can be
1517   // found later. Declarations without a context won't be inserted
1518   // into any context.
1519   if (AddToContext)
1520     CurContext->addDecl(D);
1521 
1522   // Out-of-line definitions shouldn't be pushed into scope in C++, unless they
1523   // are function-local declarations.
1524   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D->isOutOfLine() && !S->getFnParent())
1525     return;
1526 
1527   // Template instantiations should also not be pushed into scope.
1528   if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
1529       cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
1530     return;
1531 
1532   // If this replaces anything in the current scope,
1533   IdentifierResolver::iterator I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()),
1534                                IEnd = IdResolver.end();
1535   for (; I != IEnd; ++I) {
1536     if (S->isDeclScope(*I) && D->declarationReplaces(*I)) {
1537       S->RemoveDecl(*I);
1538       IdResolver.RemoveDecl(*I);
1539 
1540       // Should only need to replace one decl.
1541       break;
1542     }
1543   }
1544 
1545   S->AddDecl(D);
1546 
1547   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D) && !cast<LabelDecl>(D)->isGnuLocal()) {
1548     // Implicitly-generated labels may end up getting generated in an order that
1549     // isn't strictly lexical, which breaks name lookup. Be careful to insert
1550     // the label at the appropriate place in the identifier chain.
1551     for (I = IdResolver.begin(D->getDeclName()); I != IEnd; ++I) {
1552       DeclContext *IDC = (*I)->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
1553       if (IDC == CurContext) {
1554         if (!S->isDeclScope(*I))
1555           continue;
1556       } else if (IDC->Encloses(CurContext))
1557         break;
1558     }
1559 
1560     IdResolver.InsertDeclAfter(I, D);
1561   } else {
1562     IdResolver.AddDecl(D);
1563   }
1564   warnOnReservedIdentifier(D);
1565 }
1566 
1567 bool Sema::isDeclInScope(NamedDecl *D, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1568                          bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1569   return IdResolver.isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace);
1570 }
1571 
1572 Scope *Sema::getScopeForDeclContext(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC) {
1573   DeclContext *TargetDC = DC->getPrimaryContext();
1574   do {
1575     if (DeclContext *ScopeDC = S->getEntity())
1576       if (ScopeDC->getPrimaryContext() == TargetDC)
1577         return S;
1578   } while ((S = S->getParent()));
1579 
1580   return nullptr;
1581 }
1582 
1583 static bool isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *,
1584                                             DeclContext*,
1585                                             ASTContext&);
1586 
1587 /// Filters out lookup results that don't fall within the given scope
1588 /// as determined by isDeclInScope.
1589 void Sema::FilterLookupForScope(LookupResult &R, DeclContext *Ctx, Scope *S,
1590                                 bool ConsiderLinkage,
1591                                 bool AllowInlineNamespace) {
1592   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1593   while (F.hasNext()) {
1594     NamedDecl *D = F.next();
1595 
1596     if (isDeclInScope(D, Ctx, S, AllowInlineNamespace))
1597       continue;
1598 
1599     if (ConsiderLinkage && isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(D, Ctx, Context))
1600       continue;
1601 
1602     F.erase();
1603   }
1604 
1605   F.done();
1606 }
1607 
1608 /// We've determined that \p New is a redeclaration of \p Old. Check that they
1609 /// have compatible owning modules.
1610 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1611   // [module.interface]p7:
1612   // A declaration is attached to a module as follows:
1613   // - If the declaration is a non-dependent friend declaration that nominates a
1614   // function with a declarator-id that is a qualified-id or template-id or that
1615   // nominates a class other than with an elaborated-type-specifier with neither
1616   // a nested-name-specifier nor a simple-template-id, it is attached to the
1617   // module to which the friend is attached ([basic.link]).
1618   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() &&
1619       Old->getOwningModuleForLinkage() != New->getOwningModuleForLinkage()) {
1620     New->setLocalOwningModule(Old->getOwningModule());
1621     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(New);
1622     return false;
1623   }
1624 
1625   Module *NewM = New->getOwningModule();
1626   Module *OldM = Old->getOwningModule();
1627 
1628   if (NewM && NewM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1629     NewM = NewM->Parent;
1630   if (OldM && OldM->Kind == Module::PrivateModuleFragment)
1631     OldM = OldM->Parent;
1632 
1633   // If we have a decl in a module partition, it is part of the containing
1634   // module (which is the only thing that can be importing it).
1635   if (NewM && OldM &&
1636       (OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionInterface ||
1637        OldM->Kind == Module::ModulePartitionImplementation)) {
1638     return false;
1639   }
1640 
1641   if (NewM == OldM)
1642     return false;
1643 
1644   bool NewIsModuleInterface = NewM && NewM->isModulePurview();
1645   bool OldIsModuleInterface = OldM && OldM->isModulePurview();
1646   if (NewIsModuleInterface || OldIsModuleInterface) {
1647     // C++ Modules TS [basic.def.odr] 6.2/6.7 [sic]:
1648     //   if a declaration of D [...] appears in the purview of a module, all
1649     //   other such declarations shall appear in the purview of the same module
1650     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_mismatched_owning_module)
1651       << New
1652       << NewIsModuleInterface
1653       << (NewIsModuleInterface ? NewM->getFullModuleName() : "")
1654       << OldIsModuleInterface
1655       << (OldIsModuleInterface ? OldM->getFullModuleName() : "");
1656     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1657     New->setInvalidDecl();
1658     return true;
1659   }
1660 
1661   return false;
1662 }
1663 
1664 // [module.interface]p6:
1665 // A redeclaration of an entity X is implicitly exported if X was introduced by
1666 // an exported declaration; otherwise it shall not be exported.
1667 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationExported(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1668   // [module.interface]p1:
1669   // An export-declaration shall inhabit a namespace scope.
1670   //
1671   // So it is meaningless to talk about redeclaration which is not at namespace
1672   // scope.
1673   if (!New->getLexicalDeclContext()
1674            ->getNonTransparentContext()
1675            ->isFileContext() ||
1676       !Old->getLexicalDeclContext()
1677            ->getNonTransparentContext()
1678            ->isFileContext())
1679     return false;
1680 
1681   bool IsNewExported = New->isInExportDeclContext();
1682   bool IsOldExported = Old->isInExportDeclContext();
1683 
1684   // It should be irrevelant if both of them are not exported.
1685   if (!IsNewExported && !IsOldExported)
1686     return false;
1687 
1688   if (IsOldExported)
1689     return false;
1690 
1691   assert(IsNewExported);
1692 
1693   auto Lk = Old->getFormalLinkage();
1694   int S = 0;
1695   if (Lk == Linkage::InternalLinkage)
1696     S = 1;
1697   else if (Lk == Linkage::ModuleLinkage)
1698     S = 2;
1699   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redeclaration_non_exported) << New << S;
1700   Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1701   return true;
1702 }
1703 
1704 // A wrapper function for checking the semantic restrictions of
1705 // a redeclaration within a module.
1706 bool Sema::CheckRedeclarationInModule(NamedDecl *New, NamedDecl *Old) {
1707   if (CheckRedeclarationModuleOwnership(New, Old))
1708     return true;
1709 
1710   if (CheckRedeclarationExported(New, Old))
1711     return true;
1712 
1713   return false;
1714 }
1715 
1716 static bool isUsingDecl(NamedDecl *D) {
1717   return isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D) ||
1718          isa<UnresolvedUsingTypenameDecl>(D) ||
1719          isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(D);
1720 }
1721 
1722 /// Removes using shadow declarations from the lookup results.
1723 static void RemoveUsingDecls(LookupResult &R) {
1724   LookupResult::Filter F = R.makeFilter();
1725   while (F.hasNext())
1726     if (isUsingDecl(F.next()))
1727       F.erase();
1728 
1729   F.done();
1730 }
1731 
1732 /// Check for this common pattern:
1733 /// @code
1734 /// class S {
1735 ///   S(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1736 ///   void operator=(const S&); // DO NOT IMPLEMENT
1737 /// };
1738 /// @endcode
1739 static bool IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(const CXXMethodDecl *D) {
1740   // FIXME: Should check for private access too but access is set after we get
1741   // the decl here.
1742   if (D->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody())
1743     return false;
1744 
1745   if (const CXXConstructorDecl *CD = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D))
1746     return CD->isCopyConstructor();
1747   return D->isCopyAssignmentOperator();
1748 }
1749 
1750 // We need this to handle
1751 //
1752 // typedef struct {
1753 //   void *foo() { return 0; }
1754 // } A;
1755 //
1756 // When we see foo we don't know if after the typedef we will get 'A' or '*A'
1757 // for example. If 'A', foo will have external linkage. If we have '*A',
1758 // foo will have no linkage. Since we can't know until we get to the end
1759 // of the typedef, this function finds out if D might have non-external linkage.
1760 // Callers should verify at the end of the TU if it D has external linkage or
1761 // not.
1762 bool Sema::mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1763   const DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext();
1764   while (!DC->isTranslationUnit()) {
1765     if (const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(DC)){
1766       if (!RD->hasNameForLinkage())
1767         return true;
1768     }
1769     DC = DC->getParent();
1770   }
1771 
1772   return !D->isExternallyVisible();
1773 }
1774 
1775 // FIXME: This needs to be refactored; some other isInMainFile users want
1776 // these semantics.
1777 static bool isMainFileLoc(const Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
1778   if (S.TUKind != TU_Complete)
1779     return false;
1780   return S.SourceMgr.isInMainFile(Loc);
1781 }
1782 
1783 bool Sema::ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) const {
1784   assert(D);
1785 
1786   if (D->isInvalidDecl() || D->isUsed() || D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1787     return false;
1788 
1789   // Ignore all entities declared within templates, and out-of-line definitions
1790   // of members of class templates.
1791   if (D->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext() ||
1792       D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
1793     return false;
1794 
1795   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1796     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1797       return false;
1798     // A non-out-of-line declaration of a member specialization was implicitly
1799     // instantiated; it's the out-of-line declaration that we're interested in.
1800     if (FD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1801         FD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
1802       return false;
1803 
1804     if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
1805       if (MD->isVirtual() || IsDisallowedCopyOrAssign(MD))
1806         return false;
1807     } else {
1808       // 'static inline' functions are defined in headers; don't warn.
1809       if (FD->isInlined() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, FD->getLocation()))
1810         return false;
1811     }
1812 
1813     if (FD->doesThisDeclarationHaveABody() &&
1814         Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(FD))
1815       return false;
1816   } else if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1817     // Constants and utility variables are defined in headers with internal
1818     // linkage; don't warn.  (Unlike functions, there isn't a convenient marker
1819     // like "inline".)
1820     if (!isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1821       return false;
1822 
1823     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(VD))
1824       return false;
1825 
1826     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1827         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
1828       return false;
1829     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() &&
1830         VD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
1831         VD->getMemberSpecializationInfo() && !VD->isOutOfLine())
1832       return false;
1833 
1834     if (VD->isInline() && !isMainFileLoc(*this, VD->getLocation()))
1835       return false;
1836   } else {
1837     return false;
1838   }
1839 
1840   // Only warn for unused decls internal to the translation unit.
1841   // FIXME: This seems like a bogus check; it suppresses -Wunused-function
1842   // for inline functions defined in the main source file, for instance.
1843   return mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(D);
1844 }
1845 
1846 void Sema::MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(const DeclaratorDecl *D) {
1847   if (!D)
1848     return;
1849 
1850   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1851     const FunctionDecl *First = FD->getFirstDecl();
1852     if (FD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1853       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1854   }
1855 
1856   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1857     const VarDecl *First = VD->getFirstDecl();
1858     if (VD != First && ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(First))
1859       return; // First should already be in the vector.
1860   }
1861 
1862   if (ShouldWarnIfUnusedFileScopedDecl(D))
1863     UnusedFileScopedDecls.push_back(D);
1864 }
1865 
1866 static bool ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
1867   if (D->isInvalidDecl())
1868     return false;
1869 
1870   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D)) {
1871     // For a decomposition declaration, warn if none of the bindings are
1872     // referenced, instead of if the variable itself is referenced (which
1873     // it is, by the bindings' expressions).
1874     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
1875       if (BD->isReferenced())
1876         return false;
1877   } else if (!D->getDeclName()) {
1878     return false;
1879   } else if (D->isReferenced() || D->isUsed()) {
1880     return false;
1881   }
1882 
1883   if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() || D->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>())
1884     return false;
1885 
1886   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
1887     return true;
1888 
1889   // Except for labels, we only care about unused decls that are local to
1890   // functions.
1891   bool WithinFunction = D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod();
1892   if (const auto *R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext()))
1893     // For dependent types, the diagnostic is deferred.
1894     WithinFunction =
1895         WithinFunction || (R->isLocalClass() && !R->isDependentType());
1896   if (!WithinFunction)
1897     return false;
1898 
1899   if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D))
1900     return true;
1901 
1902   // White-list anything that isn't a local variable.
1903   if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) || isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) || isa<ImplicitParamDecl>(D))
1904     return false;
1905 
1906   // Types of valid local variables should be complete, so this should succeed.
1907   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
1908 
1909     const Expr *Init = VD->getInit();
1910     if (const auto *Cleanups = dyn_cast_or_null<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
1911       Init = Cleanups->getSubExpr();
1912 
1913     const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr();
1914 
1915     // Only look at the outermost level of typedef.
1916     if (const TypedefType *TT = Ty->getAs<TypedefType>()) {
1917       // Allow anything marked with __attribute__((unused)).
1918       if (TT->getDecl()->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1919         return false;
1920     }
1921 
1922     // Warn for reference variables whose initializtion performs lifetime
1923     // extension.
1924     if (const auto *MTE = dyn_cast_or_null<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Init)) {
1925       if (MTE->getExtendingDecl()) {
1926         Ty = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType().getTypePtr();
1927         Init = MTE->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImplicitAsWritten();
1928       }
1929     }
1930 
1931     // If we failed to complete the type for some reason, or if the type is
1932     // dependent, don't diagnose the variable.
1933     if (Ty->isIncompleteType() || Ty->isDependentType())
1934       return false;
1935 
1936     // Look at the element type to ensure that the warning behaviour is
1937     // consistent for both scalars and arrays.
1938     Ty = Ty->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
1939 
1940     if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
1941       const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
1942       if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
1943         return false;
1944 
1945       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
1946         if (!RD->hasTrivialDestructor() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
1947           return false;
1948 
1949         if (Init) {
1950           const CXXConstructExpr *Construct =
1951             dyn_cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Init);
1952           if (Construct && !Construct->isElidable()) {
1953             CXXConstructorDecl *CD = Construct->getConstructor();
1954             if (!CD->isTrivial() && !RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>() &&
1955                 (VD->getInit()->isValueDependent() || !VD->evaluateValue()))
1956               return false;
1957           }
1958 
1959           // Suppress the warning if we don't know how this is constructed, and
1960           // it could possibly be non-trivial constructor.
1961           if (Init->isTypeDependent()) {
1962             for (const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor : RD->ctors())
1963               if (!Ctor->isTrivial())
1964                 return false;
1965           }
1966 
1967           // Suppress the warning if the constructor is unresolved because
1968           // its arguments are dependent.
1969           if (isa<CXXUnresolvedConstructExpr>(Init))
1970             return false;
1971         }
1972       }
1973     }
1974 
1975     // TODO: __attribute__((unused)) templates?
1976   }
1977 
1978   return true;
1979 }
1980 
1981 static void GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D, ASTContext &Ctx,
1982                                      FixItHint &Hint) {
1983   if (isa<LabelDecl>(D)) {
1984     SourceLocation AfterColon = Lexer::findLocationAfterToken(
1985         D->getEndLoc(), tok::colon, Ctx.getSourceManager(), Ctx.getLangOpts(),
1986         true);
1987     if (AfterColon.isInvalid())
1988       return;
1989     Hint = FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
1990         CharSourceRange::getCharRange(D->getBeginLoc(), AfterColon));
1991   }
1992 }
1993 
1994 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(const RecordDecl *D) {
1995   if (D->getTypeForDecl()->isDependentType())
1996     return;
1997 
1998   for (auto *TmpD : D->decls()) {
1999     if (const auto *T = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(TmpD))
2000       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(T);
2001     else if(const auto *R = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(TmpD))
2002       DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(R);
2003   }
2004 }
2005 
2006 /// DiagnoseUnusedDecl - Emit warnings about declarations that are not used
2007 /// unless they are marked attr(unused).
2008 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedDecl(const NamedDecl *D) {
2009   if (!ShouldDiagnoseUnusedDecl(D))
2010     return;
2011 
2012   if (auto *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) {
2013     // typedefs can be referenced later on, so the diagnostics are emitted
2014     // at end-of-translation-unit.
2015     UnusedLocalTypedefNameCandidates.insert(TD);
2016     return;
2017   }
2018 
2019   FixItHint Hint;
2020   GenerateFixForUnusedDecl(D, Context, Hint);
2021 
2022   unsigned DiagID;
2023   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && cast<VarDecl>(D)->isExceptionVariable())
2024     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_exception_param;
2025   else if (isa<LabelDecl>(D))
2026     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_label;
2027   else
2028     DiagID = diag::warn_unused_variable;
2029 
2030   Diag(D->getLocation(), DiagID) << D << Hint;
2031 }
2032 
2033 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(const VarDecl *VD) {
2034   // If it's not referenced, it can't be set. If it has the Cleanup attribute,
2035   // it's not really unused.
2036   if (!VD->isReferenced() || !VD->getDeclName() || VD->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>() ||
2037       VD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>())
2038     return;
2039 
2040   const auto *Ty = VD->getType().getTypePtr()->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe();
2041 
2042   if (Ty->isReferenceType() || Ty->isDependentType())
2043     return;
2044 
2045   if (const TagType *TT = Ty->getAs<TagType>()) {
2046     const TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
2047     if (Tag->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
2048       return;
2049     // In C++, don't warn for record types that don't have WarnUnusedAttr, to
2050     // mimic gcc's behavior.
2051     if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
2052       if (!RD->hasAttr<WarnUnusedAttr>())
2053         return;
2054     }
2055   }
2056 
2057   // Don't warn about __block Objective-C pointer variables, as they might
2058   // be assigned in the block but not used elsewhere for the purpose of lifetime
2059   // extension.
2060   if (VD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2061     return;
2062 
2063   // Don't warn about Objective-C pointer variables with precise lifetime
2064   // semantics; they can be used to ensure ARC releases the object at a known
2065   // time, which may mean assignment but no other references.
2066   if (VD->hasAttr<ObjCPreciseLifetimeAttr>() && Ty->isObjCObjectPointerType())
2067     return;
2068 
2069   auto iter = RefsMinusAssignments.find(VD);
2070   if (iter == RefsMinusAssignments.end())
2071     return;
2072 
2073   assert(iter->getSecond() >= 0 &&
2074          "Found a negative number of references to a VarDecl");
2075   if (iter->getSecond() != 0)
2076     return;
2077   unsigned DiagID = isa<ParmVarDecl>(VD) ? diag::warn_unused_but_set_parameter
2078                                          : diag::warn_unused_but_set_variable;
2079   Diag(VD->getLocation(), DiagID) << VD;
2080 }
2081 
2082 static void CheckPoppedLabel(LabelDecl *L, Sema &S) {
2083   // Verify that we have no forward references left.  If so, there was a goto
2084   // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.  Label fwd
2085   // definitions are indicated with a null substmt which is also not a resolved
2086   // MS inline assembly label name.
2087   bool Diagnose = false;
2088   if (L->isMSAsmLabel())
2089     Diagnose = !L->isResolvedMSAsmLabel();
2090   else
2091     Diagnose = L->getStmt() == nullptr;
2092   if (Diagnose)
2093     S.Diag(L->getLocation(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L;
2094 }
2095 
2096 void Sema::ActOnPopScope(SourceLocation Loc, Scope *S) {
2097   S->mergeNRVOIntoParent();
2098 
2099   if (S->decl_empty()) return;
2100   assert((S->getFlags() & (Scope::DeclScope | Scope::TemplateParamScope)) &&
2101          "Scope shouldn't contain decls!");
2102 
2103   for (auto *TmpD : S->decls()) {
2104     assert(TmpD && "This decl didn't get pushed??");
2105 
2106     assert(isa<NamedDecl>(TmpD) && "Decl isn't NamedDecl?");
2107     NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(TmpD);
2108 
2109     // Diagnose unused variables in this scope.
2110     if (!S->hasUnrecoverableErrorOccurred()) {
2111       DiagnoseUnusedDecl(D);
2112       if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(D))
2113         DiagnoseUnusedNestedTypedefs(RD);
2114       if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2115         DiagnoseUnusedButSetDecl(VD);
2116         RefsMinusAssignments.erase(VD);
2117       }
2118     }
2119 
2120     if (!D->getDeclName()) continue;
2121 
2122     // If this was a forward reference to a label, verify it was defined.
2123     if (LabelDecl *LD = dyn_cast<LabelDecl>(D))
2124       CheckPoppedLabel(LD, *this);
2125 
2126     // Remove this name from our lexical scope, and warn on it if we haven't
2127     // already.
2128     IdResolver.RemoveDecl(D);
2129     auto ShadowI = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
2130     if (ShadowI != ShadowingDecls.end()) {
2131       if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowI->second)) {
2132         Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_ctor_parm_shadows_field)
2133             << D << FD << FD->getParent();
2134         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2135       }
2136       ShadowingDecls.erase(ShadowI);
2137     }
2138   }
2139 }
2140 
2141 /// Look for an Objective-C class in the translation unit.
2142 ///
2143 /// \param Id The name of the Objective-C class we're looking for. If
2144 /// typo-correction fixes this name, the Id will be updated
2145 /// to the fixed name.
2146 ///
2147 /// \param IdLoc The location of the name in the translation unit.
2148 ///
2149 /// \param DoTypoCorrection If true, this routine will attempt typo correction
2150 /// if there is no class with the given name.
2151 ///
2152 /// \returns The declaration of the named Objective-C class, or NULL if the
2153 /// class could not be found.
2154 ObjCInterfaceDecl *Sema::getObjCInterfaceDecl(IdentifierInfo *&Id,
2155                                               SourceLocation IdLoc,
2156                                               bool DoTypoCorrection) {
2157   // The third "scope" argument is 0 since we aren't enabling lazy built-in
2158   // creation from this context.
2159   NamedDecl *IDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
2160 
2161   if (!IDecl && DoTypoCorrection) {
2162     // Perform typo correction at the given location, but only if we
2163     // find an Objective-C class name.
2164     DeclFilterCCC<ObjCInterfaceDecl> CCC{};
2165     if (TypoCorrection C =
2166             CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc), LookupOrdinaryName,
2167                         TUScope, nullptr, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery)) {
2168       diagnoseTypo(C, PDiag(diag::err_undef_interface_suggest) << Id);
2169       IDecl = C.getCorrectionDeclAs<ObjCInterfaceDecl>();
2170       Id = IDecl->getIdentifier();
2171     }
2172   }
2173   ObjCInterfaceDecl *Def = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(IDecl);
2174   // This routine must always return a class definition, if any.
2175   if (Def && Def->getDefinition())
2176       Def = Def->getDefinition();
2177   return Def;
2178 }
2179 
2180 /// getNonFieldDeclScope - Retrieves the innermost scope, starting
2181 /// from S, where a non-field would be declared. This routine copes
2182 /// with the difference between C and C++ scoping rules in structs and
2183 /// unions. For example, the following code is well-formed in C but
2184 /// ill-formed in C++:
2185 /// @code
2186 /// struct S6 {
2187 ///   enum { BAR } e;
2188 /// };
2189 ///
2190 /// void test_S6() {
2191 ///   struct S6 a;
2192 ///   a.e = BAR;
2193 /// }
2194 /// @endcode
2195 /// For the declaration of BAR, this routine will return a different
2196 /// scope. The scope S will be the scope of the unnamed enumeration
2197 /// within S6. In C++, this routine will return the scope associated
2198 /// with S6, because the enumeration's scope is a transparent
2199 /// context but structures can contain non-field names. In C, this
2200 /// routine will return the translation unit scope, since the
2201 /// enumeration's scope is a transparent context and structures cannot
2202 /// contain non-field names.
2203 Scope *Sema::getNonFieldDeclScope(Scope *S) {
2204   while (((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
2205          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()) ||
2206          (S->isClassScope() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus))
2207     S = S->getParent();
2208   return S;
2209 }
2210 
2211 static StringRef getHeaderName(Builtin::Context &BuiltinInfo, unsigned ID,
2212                                ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error) {
2213   switch (Error) {
2214   case ASTContext::GE_None:
2215     return "";
2216   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_type:
2217     return BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID);
2218   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_stdio:
2219     return "stdio.h";
2220   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp:
2221     return "setjmp.h";
2222   case ASTContext::GE_Missing_ucontext:
2223     return "ucontext.h";
2224   }
2225   llvm_unreachable("unhandled error kind");
2226 }
2227 
2228 FunctionDecl *Sema::CreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, QualType Type,
2229                                   unsigned ID, SourceLocation Loc) {
2230   DeclContext *Parent = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
2231 
2232   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2233     LinkageSpecDecl *CLinkageDecl = LinkageSpecDecl::Create(
2234         Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c, false);
2235     CLinkageDecl->setImplicit();
2236     Parent->addDecl(CLinkageDecl);
2237     Parent = CLinkageDecl;
2238   }
2239 
2240   FunctionDecl *New = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, Loc, Loc, II, Type,
2241                                            /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_Extern,
2242                                            getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
2243                                            false, Type->isFunctionProtoType());
2244   New->setImplicit();
2245   New->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ID));
2246 
2247   // Create Decl objects for each parameter, adding them to the
2248   // FunctionDecl.
2249   if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Type)) {
2250     SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params;
2251     for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
2252       ParmVarDecl *parm = ParmVarDecl::Create(
2253           Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr,
2254           FT->getParamType(i), /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
2255       parm->setScopeInfo(0, i);
2256       Params.push_back(parm);
2257     }
2258     New->setParams(Params);
2259   }
2260 
2261   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(New);
2262   return New;
2263 }
2264 
2265 /// LazilyCreateBuiltin - The specified Builtin-ID was first used at
2266 /// file scope.  lazily create a decl for it. ForRedeclaration is true
2267 /// if we're creating this built-in in anticipation of redeclaring the
2268 /// built-in.
2269 NamedDecl *Sema::LazilyCreateBuiltin(IdentifierInfo *II, unsigned ID,
2270                                      Scope *S, bool ForRedeclaration,
2271                                      SourceLocation Loc) {
2272   LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, ID);
2273 
2274   ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
2275   QualType R = Context.GetBuiltinType(ID, Error);
2276   if (Error) {
2277     if (!ForRedeclaration)
2278       return nullptr;
2279 
2280     // If we have a builtin without an associated type we should not emit a
2281     // warning when we were not able to find a type for it.
2282     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_type ||
2283         Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(ID))
2284       return nullptr;
2285 
2286     // If we could not find a type for setjmp it is because the jmp_buf type was
2287     // not defined prior to the setjmp declaration.
2288     if (Error == ASTContext::GE_Missing_setjmp) {
2289       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_no_jmp_buf)
2290           << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2291       return nullptr;
2292     }
2293 
2294     // Generally, we emit a warning that the declaration requires the
2295     // appropriate header.
2296     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_implicit_decl_requires_sysheader)
2297         << getHeaderName(Context.BuiltinInfo, ID, Error)
2298         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2299     return nullptr;
2300   }
2301 
2302   if (!ForRedeclaration &&
2303       (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(ID) ||
2304        Context.BuiltinInfo.isHeaderDependentFunction(ID))) {
2305     Diag(Loc, LangOpts.C99 ? diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl_c99
2306                            : diag::ext_implicit_lib_function_decl)
2307         << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID) << R;
2308     if (const char *Header = Context.BuiltinInfo.getHeaderName(ID))
2309       Diag(Loc, diag::note_include_header_or_declare)
2310           << Header << Context.BuiltinInfo.getName(ID);
2311   }
2312 
2313   if (R.isNull())
2314     return nullptr;
2315 
2316   FunctionDecl *New = CreateBuiltin(II, R, ID, Loc);
2317   RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(New, S);
2318 
2319   // TUScope is the translation-unit scope to insert this function into.
2320   // FIXME: This is hideous. We need to teach PushOnScopeChains to
2321   // relate Scopes to DeclContexts, and probably eliminate CurContext
2322   // entirely, but we're not there yet.
2323   DeclContext *SavedContext = CurContext;
2324   CurContext = New->getDeclContext();
2325   PushOnScopeChains(New, TUScope);
2326   CurContext = SavedContext;
2327   return New;
2328 }
2329 
2330 /// Typedef declarations don't have linkage, but they still denote the same
2331 /// entity if their types are the same.
2332 /// FIXME: This is notionally doing the same thing as ASTReaderDecl's
2333 /// isSameEntity.
2334 static void filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(Sema &S,
2335                                                      TypedefNameDecl *Decl,
2336                                                      LookupResult &Previous) {
2337   // This is only interesting when modules are enabled.
2338   if (!S.getLangOpts().Modules && !S.getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility)
2339     return;
2340 
2341   // Empty sets are uninteresting.
2342   if (Previous.empty())
2343     return;
2344 
2345   LookupResult::Filter Filter = Previous.makeFilter();
2346   while (Filter.hasNext()) {
2347     NamedDecl *Old = Filter.next();
2348 
2349     // Non-hidden declarations are never ignored.
2350     if (S.isVisible(Old))
2351       continue;
2352 
2353     // Declarations of the same entity are not ignored, even if they have
2354     // different linkages.
2355     if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2356       if (S.Context.hasSameType(OldTD->getUnderlyingType(),
2357                                 Decl->getUnderlyingType()))
2358         continue;
2359 
2360       // If both declarations give a tag declaration a typedef name for linkage
2361       // purposes, then they declare the same entity.
2362       if (OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true) &&
2363           Decl->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName())
2364         continue;
2365     }
2366 
2367     Filter.erase();
2368   }
2369 
2370   Filter.done();
2371 }
2372 
2373 bool Sema::isIncompatibleTypedef(TypeDecl *Old, TypedefNameDecl *New) {
2374   QualType OldType;
2375   if (TypedefNameDecl *OldTypedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2376     OldType = OldTypedef->getUnderlyingType();
2377   else
2378     OldType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Old);
2379   QualType NewType = New->getUnderlyingType();
2380 
2381   if (NewType->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2382     // Must not redefine a typedef with a variably-modified type.
2383     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2384     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_variably_modified_typedef)
2385       << Kind << NewType;
2386     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2387       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2388     New->setInvalidDecl();
2389     return true;
2390   }
2391 
2392   if (OldType != NewType &&
2393       !OldType->isDependentType() &&
2394       !NewType->isDependentType() &&
2395       !Context.hasSameType(OldType, NewType)) {
2396     int Kind = isa<TypeAliasDecl>(Old) ? 1 : 0;
2397     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_typedef)
2398       << Kind << NewType << OldType;
2399     if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
2400       notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2401     New->setInvalidDecl();
2402     return true;
2403   }
2404   return false;
2405 }
2406 
2407 /// MergeTypedefNameDecl - We just parsed a typedef 'New' which has the
2408 /// same name and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out
2409 /// how to resolve this situation, merging decls or emitting
2410 /// diagnostics as appropriate. If there was an error, set New to be invalid.
2411 ///
2412 void Sema::MergeTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *New,
2413                                 LookupResult &OldDecls) {
2414   // If the new decl is known invalid already, don't bother doing any
2415   // merging checks.
2416   if (New->isInvalidDecl()) return;
2417 
2418   // Allow multiple definitions for ObjC built-in typedefs.
2419   // FIXME: Verify the underlying types are equivalent!
2420   if (getLangOpts().ObjC) {
2421     const IdentifierInfo *TypeID = New->getIdentifier();
2422     switch (TypeID->getLength()) {
2423     default: break;
2424     case 2:
2425       {
2426         if (!TypeID->isStr("id"))
2427           break;
2428         QualType T = New->getUnderlyingType();
2429         if (!T->isPointerType())
2430           break;
2431         if (!T->isVoidPointerType()) {
2432           QualType PT = T->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2433           if (!PT->isStructureType())
2434             break;
2435         }
2436         Context.setObjCIdRedefinitionType(T);
2437         // Install the built-in type for 'id', ignoring the current definition.
2438         New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCIdType().getTypePtr());
2439         return;
2440       }
2441     case 5:
2442       if (!TypeID->isStr("Class"))
2443         break;
2444       Context.setObjCClassRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2445       // Install the built-in type for 'Class', ignoring the current definition.
2446       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCClassType().getTypePtr());
2447       return;
2448     case 3:
2449       if (!TypeID->isStr("SEL"))
2450         break;
2451       Context.setObjCSelRedefinitionType(New->getUnderlyingType());
2452       // Install the built-in type for 'SEL', ignoring the current definition.
2453       New->setTypeForDecl(Context.getObjCSelType().getTypePtr());
2454       return;
2455     }
2456     // Fall through - the typedef name was not a builtin type.
2457   }
2458 
2459   // Verify the old decl was also a type.
2460   TypeDecl *Old = OldDecls.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>();
2461   if (!Old) {
2462     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
2463       << New->getDeclName();
2464 
2465     NamedDecl *OldD = OldDecls.getRepresentativeDecl();
2466     if (OldD->getLocation().isValid())
2467       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
2468 
2469     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2470   }
2471 
2472   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
2473   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
2474     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2475 
2476   if (auto *OldTD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2477     auto *OldTag = OldTD->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName(/*AnyRedecl*/true);
2478     auto *NewTag = New->getAnonDeclWithTypedefName();
2479     NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
2480     if (OldTag && NewTag &&
2481         OldTag->getCanonicalDecl() != NewTag->getCanonicalDecl() &&
2482         !hasVisibleDefinition(OldTag, &Hidden)) {
2483       // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. Use it
2484       // instead of our tag.
2485       New->setTypeForDecl(OldTD->getTypeForDecl());
2486       if (OldTD->isModed())
2487         New->setModedTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo(),
2488                                     OldTD->getUnderlyingType());
2489       else
2490         New->setTypeSourceInfo(OldTD->getTypeSourceInfo());
2491 
2492       // Make the old tag definition visible.
2493       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
2494 
2495       // If this was an unscoped enumeration, yank all of its enumerators
2496       // out of the scope.
2497       if (isa<EnumDecl>(NewTag)) {
2498         Scope *EnumScope = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
2499         for (auto *D : NewTag->decls()) {
2500           auto *ED = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
2501           assert(EnumScope->isDeclScope(ED));
2502           EnumScope->RemoveDecl(ED);
2503           IdResolver.RemoveDecl(ED);
2504           ED->getLexicalDeclContext()->removeDecl(ED);
2505         }
2506       }
2507     }
2508   }
2509 
2510   // If the typedef types are not identical, reject them in all languages and
2511   // with any extensions enabled.
2512   if (isIncompatibleTypedef(Old, New))
2513     return;
2514 
2515   // The types match.  Link up the redeclaration chain and merge attributes if
2516   // the old declaration was a typedef.
2517   if (TypedefNameDecl *Typedef = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(Old)) {
2518     New->setPreviousDecl(Typedef);
2519     mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
2520   }
2521 
2522   if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
2523     return;
2524 
2525   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2526     // C++ [dcl.typedef]p2:
2527     //   In a given non-class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to
2528     //   redefine the name of any type declared in that scope to refer
2529     //   to the type to which it already refers.
2530     if (!isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))
2531       return;
2532 
2533     // C++0x [dcl.typedef]p4:
2534     //   In a given class scope, a typedef specifier can be used to redefine
2535     //   any class-name declared in that scope that is not also a typedef-name
2536     //   to refer to the type to which it already refers.
2537     //
2538     // This wording came in via DR424, which was a correction to the
2539     // wording in DR56, which accidentally banned code like:
2540     //
2541     //   struct S {
2542     //     typedef struct A { } A;
2543     //   };
2544     //
2545     // in the C++03 standard. We implement the C++0x semantics, which
2546     // allow the above but disallow
2547     //
2548     //   struct S {
2549     //     typedef int I;
2550     //     typedef int I;
2551     //   };
2552     //
2553     // since that was the intent of DR56.
2554     if (!isa<TypedefNameDecl>(Old))
2555       return;
2556 
2557     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition)
2558       << New->getDeclName();
2559     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2560     return New->setInvalidDecl();
2561   }
2562 
2563   // Modules always permit redefinition of typedefs, as does C11.
2564   if (getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().C11)
2565     return;
2566 
2567   // If we have a redefinition of a typedef in C, emit a warning.  This warning
2568   // is normally mapped to an error, but can be controlled with
2569   // -Wtypedef-redefinition.  If either the original or the redefinition is
2570   // in a system header, don't emit this for compatibility with GCC.
2571   if (getDiagnostics().getSuppressSystemWarnings() &&
2572       // Some standard types are defined implicitly in Clang (e.g. OpenCL).
2573       (Old->isImplicit() ||
2574        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Old->getLocation()) ||
2575        Context.getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(New->getLocation())))
2576     return;
2577 
2578   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_redefinition_of_typedef)
2579     << New->getDeclName();
2580   notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
2581 }
2582 
2583 /// DeclhasAttr - returns true if decl Declaration already has the target
2584 /// attribute.
2585 static bool DeclHasAttr(const Decl *D, const Attr *A) {
2586   const OwnershipAttr *OA = dyn_cast<OwnershipAttr>(A);
2587   const AnnotateAttr *Ann = dyn_cast<AnnotateAttr>(A);
2588   for (const auto *i : D->attrs())
2589     if (i->getKind() == A->getKind()) {
2590       if (Ann) {
2591         if (Ann->getAnnotation() == cast<AnnotateAttr>(i)->getAnnotation())
2592           return true;
2593         continue;
2594       }
2595       // FIXME: Don't hardcode this check
2596       if (OA && isa<OwnershipAttr>(i))
2597         return OA->getOwnKind() == cast<OwnershipAttr>(i)->getOwnKind();
2598       return true;
2599     }
2600 
2601   return false;
2602 }
2603 
2604 static bool isAttributeTargetADefinition(Decl *D) {
2605   if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
2606     return VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
2607   if (TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2608     return TD->isCompleteDefinition() || TD->isBeingDefined();
2609   return true;
2610 }
2611 
2612 /// Merge alignment attributes from \p Old to \p New, taking into account the
2613 /// special semantics of C11's _Alignas specifier and C++11's alignas attribute.
2614 ///
2615 /// \return \c true if any attributes were added to \p New.
2616 static bool mergeAlignedAttrs(Sema &S, NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old) {
2617   // Look for alignas attributes on Old, and pick out whichever attribute
2618   // specifies the strictest alignment requirement.
2619   AlignedAttr *OldAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2620   AlignedAttr *OldStrictestAlignAttr = nullptr;
2621   unsigned OldAlign = 0;
2622   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2623     // FIXME: We have no way of representing inherited dependent alignments
2624     // in a case like:
2625     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(A) X;
2626     //   template<int A, int B> struct alignas(B) X {};
2627     // For now, we just ignore any alignas attributes which are not on the
2628     // definition in such a case.
2629     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2630       return false;
2631 
2632     if (I->isAlignas())
2633       OldAlignasAttr = I;
2634 
2635     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2636     if (Align > OldAlign) {
2637       OldAlign = Align;
2638       OldStrictestAlignAttr = I;
2639     }
2640   }
2641 
2642   // Look for alignas attributes on New.
2643   AlignedAttr *NewAlignasAttr = nullptr;
2644   unsigned NewAlign = 0;
2645   for (auto *I : New->specific_attrs<AlignedAttr>()) {
2646     if (I->isAlignmentDependent())
2647       return false;
2648 
2649     if (I->isAlignas())
2650       NewAlignasAttr = I;
2651 
2652     unsigned Align = I->getAlignment(S.Context);
2653     if (Align > NewAlign)
2654       NewAlign = Align;
2655   }
2656 
2657   if (OldAlignasAttr && NewAlignasAttr && OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2658     // Both declarations have 'alignas' attributes. We require them to match.
2659     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6 and C11 6.7.5/7 both come close to saying this, but
2660     // fall short. (If two declarations both have alignas, they must both match
2661     // every definition, and so must match each other if there is a definition.)
2662 
2663     // If either declaration only contains 'alignas(0)' specifiers, then it
2664     // specifies the natural alignment for the type.
2665     if (OldAlign == 0 || NewAlign == 0) {
2666       QualType Ty;
2667       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(New))
2668         Ty = VD->getType();
2669       else
2670         Ty = S.Context.getTagDeclType(cast<TagDecl>(New));
2671 
2672       if (OldAlign == 0)
2673         OldAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2674       if (NewAlign == 0)
2675         NewAlign = S.Context.getTypeAlign(Ty);
2676     }
2677 
2678     if (OldAlign != NewAlign) {
2679       S.Diag(NewAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_mismatch)
2680         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(OldAlign).getQuantity()
2681         << (unsigned)S.Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(NewAlign).getQuantity();
2682       S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
2683     }
2684   }
2685 
2686   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr && isAttributeTargetADefinition(New)) {
2687     // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2688     //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2689     //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2690     //   equivalent alignment.
2691     // C11 6.7.5/7:
2692     //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2693     //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2694     //   have no alignment specifier.
2695     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2696       << OldAlignasAttr;
2697     S.Diag(OldAlignasAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2698       << OldAlignasAttr;
2699   }
2700 
2701   bool AnyAdded = false;
2702 
2703   // Ensure we have an attribute representing the strictest alignment.
2704   if (OldAlign > NewAlign) {
2705     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldStrictestAlignAttr->clone(S.Context);
2706     Clone->setInherited(true);
2707     New->addAttr(Clone);
2708     AnyAdded = true;
2709   }
2710 
2711   // Ensure we have an alignas attribute if the old declaration had one.
2712   if (OldAlignasAttr && !NewAlignasAttr &&
2713       !(AnyAdded && OldStrictestAlignAttr->isAlignas())) {
2714     AlignedAttr *Clone = OldAlignasAttr->clone(S.Context);
2715     Clone->setInherited(true);
2716     New->addAttr(Clone);
2717     AnyAdded = true;
2718   }
2719 
2720   return AnyAdded;
2721 }
2722 
2723 #define WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2724 #include "clang/Sema/AttrParsedAttrImpl.inc"
2725 #undef WANT_DECL_MERGE_LOGIC
2726 
2727 static bool mergeDeclAttribute(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D,
2728                                const InheritableAttr *Attr,
2729                                Sema::AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
2730   // Diagnose any mutual exclusions between the attribute that we want to add
2731   // and attributes that already exist on the declaration.
2732   if (!DiagnoseMutualExclusions(S, D, Attr))
2733     return false;
2734 
2735   // This function copies an attribute Attr from a previous declaration to the
2736   // new declaration D if the new declaration doesn't itself have that attribute
2737   // yet or if that attribute allows duplicates.
2738   // If you're adding a new attribute that requires logic different from
2739   // "use explicit attribute on decl if present, else use attribute from
2740   // previous decl", for example if the attribute needs to be consistent
2741   // between redeclarations, you need to call a custom merge function here.
2742   InheritableAttr *NewAttr = nullptr;
2743   if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AvailabilityAttr>(Attr))
2744     NewAttr = S.mergeAvailabilityAttr(
2745         D, *AA, AA->getPlatform(), AA->isImplicit(), AA->getIntroduced(),
2746         AA->getDeprecated(), AA->getObsoleted(), AA->getUnavailable(),
2747         AA->getMessage(), AA->getStrict(), AA->getReplacement(), AMK,
2748         AA->getPriority());
2749   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<VisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2750     NewAttr = S.mergeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2751   else if (const auto *VA = dyn_cast<TypeVisibilityAttr>(Attr))
2752     NewAttr = S.mergeTypeVisibilityAttr(D, *VA, VA->getVisibility());
2753   else if (const auto *ImportA = dyn_cast<DLLImportAttr>(Attr))
2754     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLImportAttr(D, *ImportA);
2755   else if (const auto *ExportA = dyn_cast<DLLExportAttr>(Attr))
2756     NewAttr = S.mergeDLLExportAttr(D, *ExportA);
2757   else if (const auto *EA = dyn_cast<ErrorAttr>(Attr))
2758     NewAttr = S.mergeErrorAttr(D, *EA, EA->getUserDiagnostic());
2759   else if (const auto *FA = dyn_cast<FormatAttr>(Attr))
2760     NewAttr = S.mergeFormatAttr(D, *FA, FA->getType(), FA->getFormatIdx(),
2761                                 FA->getFirstArg());
2762   else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<SectionAttr>(Attr))
2763     NewAttr = S.mergeSectionAttr(D, *SA, SA->getName());
2764   else if (const auto *CSA = dyn_cast<CodeSegAttr>(Attr))
2765     NewAttr = S.mergeCodeSegAttr(D, *CSA, CSA->getName());
2766   else if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast<MSInheritanceAttr>(Attr))
2767     NewAttr = S.mergeMSInheritanceAttr(D, *IA, IA->getBestCase(),
2768                                        IA->getInheritanceModel());
2769   else if (const auto *AA = dyn_cast<AlwaysInlineAttr>(Attr))
2770     NewAttr = S.mergeAlwaysInlineAttr(D, *AA,
2771                                       &S.Context.Idents.get(AA->getSpelling()));
2772   else if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
2773            (isa<CUDAHostAttr>(Attr) || isa<CUDADeviceAttr>(Attr) ||
2774             isa<CUDAGlobalAttr>(Attr))) {
2775     // CUDA target attributes are part of function signature for
2776     // overloading purposes and must not be merged.
2777     return false;
2778   } else if (const auto *MA = dyn_cast<MinSizeAttr>(Attr))
2779     NewAttr = S.mergeMinSizeAttr(D, *MA);
2780   else if (const auto *SNA = dyn_cast<SwiftNameAttr>(Attr))
2781     NewAttr = S.mergeSwiftNameAttr(D, *SNA, SNA->getName());
2782   else if (const auto *OA = dyn_cast<OptimizeNoneAttr>(Attr))
2783     NewAttr = S.mergeOptimizeNoneAttr(D, *OA);
2784   else if (const auto *InternalLinkageA = dyn_cast<InternalLinkageAttr>(Attr))
2785     NewAttr = S.mergeInternalLinkageAttr(D, *InternalLinkageA);
2786   else if (isa<AlignedAttr>(Attr))
2787     // AlignedAttrs are handled separately, because we need to handle all
2788     // such attributes on a declaration at the same time.
2789     NewAttr = nullptr;
2790   else if ((isa<DeprecatedAttr>(Attr) || isa<UnavailableAttr>(Attr)) &&
2791            (AMK == Sema::AMK_Override ||
2792             AMK == Sema::AMK_ProtocolImplementation ||
2793             AMK == Sema::AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation))
2794     NewAttr = nullptr;
2795   else if (const auto *UA = dyn_cast<UuidAttr>(Attr))
2796     NewAttr = S.mergeUuidAttr(D, *UA, UA->getGuid(), UA->getGuidDecl());
2797   else if (const auto *IMA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportModuleAttr>(Attr))
2798     NewAttr = S.mergeImportModuleAttr(D, *IMA);
2799   else if (const auto *INA = dyn_cast<WebAssemblyImportNameAttr>(Attr))
2800     NewAttr = S.mergeImportNameAttr(D, *INA);
2801   else if (const auto *TCBA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBAttr>(Attr))
2802     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBAttr(D, *TCBA);
2803   else if (const auto *TCBLA = dyn_cast<EnforceTCBLeafAttr>(Attr))
2804     NewAttr = S.mergeEnforceTCBLeafAttr(D, *TCBLA);
2805   else if (const auto *BTFA = dyn_cast<BTFDeclTagAttr>(Attr))
2806     NewAttr = S.mergeBTFDeclTagAttr(D, *BTFA);
2807   else if (const auto *NT = dyn_cast<HLSLNumThreadsAttr>(Attr))
2808     NewAttr =
2809         S.mergeHLSLNumThreadsAttr(D, *NT, NT->getX(), NT->getY(), NT->getZ());
2810   else if (const auto *SA = dyn_cast<HLSLShaderAttr>(Attr))
2811     NewAttr = S.mergeHLSLShaderAttr(D, *SA, SA->getType());
2812   else if (Attr->shouldInheritEvenIfAlreadyPresent() || !DeclHasAttr(D, Attr))
2813     NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(Attr->clone(S.Context));
2814 
2815   if (NewAttr) {
2816     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
2817     D->addAttr(NewAttr);
2818     if (isa<MSInheritanceAttr>(NewAttr))
2819       S.Consumer.AssignInheritanceModel(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D));
2820     return true;
2821   }
2822 
2823   return false;
2824 }
2825 
2826 static const NamedDecl *getDefinition(const Decl *D) {
2827   if (const TagDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(D))
2828     return TD->getDefinition();
2829   if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
2830     const VarDecl *Def = VD->getDefinition();
2831     if (Def)
2832       return Def;
2833     return VD->getActingDefinition();
2834   }
2835   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2836     const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr;
2837     if (FD->isDefined(Def, true))
2838       return Def;
2839   }
2840   return nullptr;
2841 }
2842 
2843 static bool hasAttribute(const Decl *D, attr::Kind Kind) {
2844   for (const auto *Attribute : D->attrs())
2845     if (Attribute->getKind() == Kind)
2846       return true;
2847   return false;
2848 }
2849 
2850 /// checkNewAttributesAfterDef - If we already have a definition, check that
2851 /// there are no new attributes in this declaration.
2852 static void checkNewAttributesAfterDef(Sema &S, Decl *New, const Decl *Old) {
2853   if (!New->hasAttrs())
2854     return;
2855 
2856   const NamedDecl *Def = getDefinition(Old);
2857   if (!Def || Def == New)
2858     return;
2859 
2860   AttrVec &NewAttributes = New->getAttrs();
2861   for (unsigned I = 0, E = NewAttributes.size(); I != E;) {
2862     const Attr *NewAttribute = NewAttributes[I];
2863 
2864     if (isa<AliasAttr>(NewAttribute) || isa<IFuncAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2865       if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(New)) {
2866         Sema::SkipBodyInfo SkipBody;
2867         S.CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, cast<FunctionDecl>(Def), &SkipBody);
2868 
2869         // If we're skipping this definition, drop the "alias" attribute.
2870         if (SkipBody.ShouldSkip) {
2871           NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2872           --E;
2873           continue;
2874         }
2875       } else {
2876         VarDecl *VD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
2877         unsigned Diag = cast<VarDecl>(Def)->isThisDeclarationADefinition() ==
2878                                 VarDecl::TentativeDefinition
2879                             ? diag::err_alias_after_tentative
2880                             : diag::err_redefinition;
2881         S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), Diag) << VD->getDeclName();
2882         if (Diag == diag::err_redefinition)
2883           S.notePreviousDefinition(Def, VD->getLocation());
2884         else
2885           S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2886         VD->setInvalidDecl();
2887       }
2888       ++I;
2889       continue;
2890     }
2891 
2892     if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Def)) {
2893       // Tentative definitions are only interesting for the alias check above.
2894       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() != VarDecl::Definition) {
2895         ++I;
2896         continue;
2897       }
2898     }
2899 
2900     if (hasAttribute(Def, NewAttribute->getKind())) {
2901       ++I;
2902       continue; // regular attr merging will take care of validating this.
2903     }
2904 
2905     if (isa<C11NoReturnAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2906       // C's _Noreturn is allowed to be added to a function after it is defined.
2907       ++I;
2908       continue;
2909     } else if (isa<UuidAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2910       // msvc will allow a subsequent definition to add an uuid to a class
2911       ++I;
2912       continue;
2913     } else if (const AlignedAttr *AA = dyn_cast<AlignedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2914       if (AA->isAlignas()) {
2915         // C++11 [dcl.align]p6:
2916         //   if any declaration of an entity has an alignment-specifier,
2917         //   every defining declaration of that entity shall specify an
2918         //   equivalent alignment.
2919         // C11 6.7.5/7:
2920         //   If the definition of an object does not have an alignment
2921         //   specifier, any other declaration of that object shall also
2922         //   have no alignment specifier.
2923         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::err_alignas_missing_on_definition)
2924           << AA;
2925         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(), diag::note_alignas_on_declaration)
2926           << AA;
2927         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2928         --E;
2929         continue;
2930       }
2931     } else if (isa<LoaderUninitializedAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2932       // If there is a C definition followed by a redeclaration with this
2933       // attribute then there are two different definitions. In C++, prefer the
2934       // standard diagnostics.
2935       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
2936         S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2937                diag::err_loader_uninitialized_redeclaration);
2938         S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2939         NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2940         --E;
2941         continue;
2942       }
2943     } else if (isa<SelectAnyAttr>(NewAttribute) &&
2944                cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInline() &&
2945                !cast<VarDecl>(New)->isInlineSpecified()) {
2946       // Don't warn about applying selectany to implicitly inline variables.
2947       // Older compilers and language modes would require the use of selectany
2948       // to make such variables inline, and it would have no effect if we
2949       // honored it.
2950       ++I;
2951       continue;
2952     } else if (isa<OMPDeclareVariantAttr>(NewAttribute)) {
2953       // We allow to add OMP[Begin]DeclareVariantAttr to be added to
2954       // declarations after defintions.
2955       ++I;
2956       continue;
2957     }
2958 
2959     S.Diag(NewAttribute->getLocation(),
2960            diag::warn_attribute_precede_definition);
2961     S.Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
2962     NewAttributes.erase(NewAttributes.begin() + I);
2963     --E;
2964   }
2965 }
2966 
2967 static void diagnoseMissingConstinit(Sema &S, const VarDecl *InitDecl,
2968                                      const ConstInitAttr *CIAttr,
2969                                      bool AttrBeforeInit) {
2970   SourceLocation InsertLoc = InitDecl->getInnerLocStart();
2971 
2972   // Figure out a good way to write this specifier on the old declaration.
2973   // FIXME: We should just use the spelling of CIAttr, but we don't preserve
2974   // enough of the attribute list spelling information to extract that without
2975   // heroics.
2976   std::string SuitableSpelling;
2977   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2978     SuitableSpelling = std::string(
2979         S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(InsertLoc, {tok::kw_constinit}));
2980   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2981     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2982         InsertLoc, {tok::l_square, tok::l_square,
2983                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("clang"), tok::coloncolon,
2984                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2985                     tok::r_square, tok::r_square}));
2986   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2987     SuitableSpelling = std::string(S.PP.getLastMacroWithSpelling(
2988         InsertLoc, {tok::kw___attribute, tok::l_paren, tok::r_paren,
2989                     S.PP.getIdentifierInfo("require_constant_initialization"),
2990                     tok::r_paren, tok::r_paren}));
2991   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
2992     SuitableSpelling = "constinit";
2993   if (SuitableSpelling.empty() && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
2994     SuitableSpelling = "[[clang::require_constant_initialization]]";
2995   if (SuitableSpelling.empty())
2996     SuitableSpelling = "__attribute__((require_constant_initialization))";
2997   SuitableSpelling += " ";
2998 
2999   if (AttrBeforeInit) {
3000     // extern constinit int a;
3001     // int a = 0; // error (missing 'constinit'), accepted as extension
3002     assert(CIAttr->isConstinit() && "should not diagnose this for attribute");
3003     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_constinit_missing)
3004         << InitDecl << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
3005     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_specified_here);
3006   } else {
3007     // int a = 0;
3008     // constinit extern int a; // error (missing 'constinit')
3009     S.Diag(CIAttr->getLocation(),
3010            CIAttr->isConstinit() ? diag::err_constinit_added_too_late
3011                                  : diag::warn_require_const_init_added_too_late)
3012         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SourceRange(CIAttr->getLocation()));
3013     S.Diag(InitDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_constinit_missing_here)
3014         << CIAttr->isConstinit()
3015         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, SuitableSpelling);
3016   }
3017 }
3018 
3019 /// mergeDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the Old decl to the New one.
3020 void Sema::mergeDeclAttributes(NamedDecl *New, Decl *Old,
3021                                AvailabilityMergeKind AMK) {
3022   if (UsedAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
3023     UsedAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
3024     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
3025     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
3026   }
3027   if (RetainAttr *OldAttr = Old->getMostRecentDecl()->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
3028     RetainAttr *NewAttr = OldAttr->clone(Context);
3029     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
3030     New->addAttr(NewAttr);
3031   }
3032 
3033   if (!Old->hasAttrs() && !New->hasAttrs())
3034     return;
3035 
3036   // [dcl.constinit]p1:
3037   //   If the [constinit] specifier is applied to any declaration of a
3038   //   variable, it shall be applied to the initializing declaration.
3039   const auto *OldConstInit = Old->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3040   const auto *NewConstInit = New->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3041   if (bool(OldConstInit) != bool(NewConstInit)) {
3042     const auto *OldVD = cast<VarDecl>(Old);
3043     auto *NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(New);
3044 
3045     // Find the initializing declaration. Note that we might not have linked
3046     // the new declaration into the redeclaration chain yet.
3047     const VarDecl *InitDecl = OldVD->getInitializingDeclaration();
3048     if (!InitDecl &&
3049         (NewVD->hasInit() || NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()))
3050       InitDecl = NewVD;
3051 
3052     if (InitDecl == NewVD) {
3053       // This is the initializing declaration. If it would inherit 'constinit',
3054       // that's ill-formed. (Note that we do not apply this to the attribute
3055       // form).
3056       if (OldConstInit && OldConstInit->isConstinit())
3057         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, NewVD, OldConstInit,
3058                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/true);
3059     } else if (NewConstInit) {
3060       // This is the first time we've been told that this declaration should
3061       // have a constant initializer. If we already saw the initializing
3062       // declaration, this is too late.
3063       if (InitDecl && InitDecl != NewVD) {
3064         diagnoseMissingConstinit(*this, InitDecl, NewConstInit,
3065                                  /*AttrBeforeInit=*/false);
3066         NewVD->dropAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
3067       }
3068     }
3069   }
3070 
3071   // Attributes declared post-definition are currently ignored.
3072   checkNewAttributesAfterDef(*this, New, Old);
3073 
3074   if (AsmLabelAttr *NewA = New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
3075     if (AsmLabelAttr *OldA = Old->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()) {
3076       if (!OldA->isEquivalent(NewA)) {
3077         // This redeclaration changes __asm__ label.
3078         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_asm_label);
3079         Diag(OldA->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3080       }
3081     } else if (Old->isUsed()) {
3082       // This redeclaration adds an __asm__ label to a declaration that has
3083       // already been ODR-used.
3084       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_late_asm_label_name)
3085         << isa<FunctionDecl>(Old) << New->getAttr<AsmLabelAttr>()->getRange();
3086     }
3087   }
3088 
3089   // Re-declaration cannot add abi_tag's.
3090   if (const auto *NewAbiTagAttr = New->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
3091     if (const auto *OldAbiTagAttr = Old->getAttr<AbiTagAttr>()) {
3092       for (const auto &NewTag : NewAbiTagAttr->tags()) {
3093         if (!llvm::is_contained(OldAbiTagAttr->tags(), NewTag)) {
3094           Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(),
3095                diag::err_new_abi_tag_on_redeclaration)
3096               << NewTag;
3097           Diag(OldAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3098         }
3099       }
3100     } else {
3101       Diag(NewAbiTagAttr->getLocation(), diag::err_abi_tag_on_redeclaration);
3102       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3103     }
3104   }
3105 
3106   // This redeclaration adds a section attribute.
3107   if (New->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && !Old->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
3108     if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(New)) {
3109       if (VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly) {
3110         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_section_on_redeclaration);
3111         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3112       }
3113     }
3114   }
3115 
3116   // Redeclaration adds code-seg attribute.
3117   const auto *NewCSA = New->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>();
3118   if (NewCSA && !Old->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>() &&
3119       !NewCSA->isImplicit() && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New)) {
3120     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_section)
3121          << 0 /*codeseg*/;
3122     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3123   }
3124 
3125   if (!Old->hasAttrs())
3126     return;
3127 
3128   bool foundAny = New->hasAttrs();
3129 
3130   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is done before
3131   // we process them.
3132   if (!foundAny) New->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3133 
3134   for (auto *I : Old->specific_attrs<InheritableAttr>()) {
3135     // Ignore deprecated/unavailable/availability attributes if requested.
3136     AvailabilityMergeKind LocalAMK = AMK_None;
3137     if (isa<DeprecatedAttr>(I) ||
3138         isa<UnavailableAttr>(I) ||
3139         isa<AvailabilityAttr>(I)) {
3140       switch (AMK) {
3141       case AMK_None:
3142         continue;
3143 
3144       case AMK_Redeclaration:
3145       case AMK_Override:
3146       case AMK_ProtocolImplementation:
3147       case AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation:
3148         LocalAMK = AMK;
3149         break;
3150       }
3151     }
3152 
3153     // Already handled.
3154     if (isa<UsedAttr>(I) || isa<RetainAttr>(I))
3155       continue;
3156 
3157     if (mergeDeclAttribute(*this, New, I, LocalAMK))
3158       foundAny = true;
3159   }
3160 
3161   if (mergeAlignedAttrs(*this, New, Old))
3162     foundAny = true;
3163 
3164   if (!foundAny) New->dropAttrs();
3165 }
3166 
3167 /// mergeParamDeclAttributes - Copy attributes from the old parameter
3168 /// to the new one.
3169 static void mergeParamDeclAttributes(ParmVarDecl *newDecl,
3170                                      const ParmVarDecl *oldDecl,
3171                                      Sema &S) {
3172   // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3173   //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3174   //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3175   //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3176   const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = newDecl->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3177   if (CDA && !oldDecl->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3178     S.Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3179            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3180     // Find the first declaration of the parameter.
3181     // FIXME: Should we build redeclaration chains for function parameters?
3182     const FunctionDecl *FirstFD =
3183       cast<FunctionDecl>(oldDecl->getDeclContext())->getFirstDecl();
3184     const ParmVarDecl *FirstVD =
3185       FirstFD->getParamDecl(oldDecl->getFunctionScopeIndex());
3186     S.Diag(FirstVD->getLocation(),
3187            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 1/*Param*/;
3188   }
3189 
3190   if (!oldDecl->hasAttrs())
3191     return;
3192 
3193   bool foundAny = newDecl->hasAttrs();
3194 
3195   // Ensure that any moving of objects within the allocated map is
3196   // done before we process them.
3197   if (!foundAny) newDecl->setAttrs(AttrVec());
3198 
3199   for (const auto *I : oldDecl->specific_attrs<InheritableParamAttr>()) {
3200     if (!DeclHasAttr(newDecl, I)) {
3201       InheritableAttr *newAttr =
3202         cast<InheritableParamAttr>(I->clone(S.Context));
3203       newAttr->setInherited(true);
3204       newDecl->addAttr(newAttr);
3205       foundAny = true;
3206     }
3207   }
3208 
3209   if (!foundAny) newDecl->dropAttrs();
3210 }
3211 
3212 static void mergeParamDeclTypes(ParmVarDecl *NewParam,
3213                                 const ParmVarDecl *OldParam,
3214                                 Sema &S) {
3215   if (auto Oldnullability = OldParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3216     if (auto Newnullability = NewParam->getType()->getNullability(S.Context)) {
3217       if (*Oldnullability != *Newnullability) {
3218         S.Diag(NewParam->getLocation(), diag::warn_mismatched_nullability_attr)
3219           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3220                *Newnullability,
3221                ((NewParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3222                 != 0))
3223           << DiagNullabilityKind(
3224                *Oldnullability,
3225                ((OldParam->getObjCDeclQualifier() & Decl::OBJC_TQ_CSNullability)
3226                 != 0));
3227         S.Diag(OldParam->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3228       }
3229     } else {
3230       QualType NewT = NewParam->getType();
3231       NewT = S.Context.getAttributedType(
3232                          AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(*Oldnullability),
3233                          NewT, NewT);
3234       NewParam->setType(NewT);
3235     }
3236   }
3237 }
3238 
3239 namespace {
3240 
3241 /// Used in MergeFunctionDecl to keep track of function parameters in
3242 /// C.
3243 struct GNUCompatibleParamWarning {
3244   ParmVarDecl *OldParm;
3245   ParmVarDecl *NewParm;
3246   QualType PromotedType;
3247 };
3248 
3249 } // end anonymous namespace
3250 
3251 // Determine whether the previous declaration was a definition, implicit
3252 // declaration, or a declaration.
3253 template <typename T>
3254 static std::pair<diag::kind, SourceLocation>
3255 getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3256   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3257   SourceLocation OldLocation = Old->getLocation();
3258   if (Old->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3259     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_definition;
3260   else if (Old->isImplicit()) {
3261     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_implicit_declaration;
3262     if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Old)) {
3263       if (FD->getBuiltinID())
3264         PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration;
3265     }
3266     if (OldLocation.isInvalid())
3267       OldLocation = New->getLocation();
3268   } else
3269     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_declaration;
3270   return std::make_pair(PrevDiag, OldLocation);
3271 }
3272 
3273 /// canRedefineFunction - checks if a function can be redefined. Currently,
3274 /// only extern inline functions can be redefined, and even then only in
3275 /// GNU89 mode.
3276 static bool canRedefineFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
3277                                 const LangOptions& LangOpts) {
3278   return ((FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() || LangOpts.GNUInline) &&
3279           !LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
3280           FD->isInlineSpecified() &&
3281           FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern);
3282 }
3283 
3284 const AttributedType *Sema::getCallingConvAttributedType(QualType T) const {
3285   const AttributedType *AT = T->getAs<AttributedType>();
3286   while (AT && !AT->isCallingConv())
3287     AT = AT->getModifiedType()->getAs<AttributedType>();
3288   return AT;
3289 }
3290 
3291 template <typename T>
3292 static bool haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(const T *Old, const T *New) {
3293   const DeclContext *DC = Old->getDeclContext();
3294   if (DC->isRecord())
3295     return false;
3296 
3297   LanguageLinkage OldLinkage = Old->getLanguageLinkage();
3298   if (OldLinkage == CXXLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCContext())
3299     return true;
3300   if (OldLinkage == CLanguageLinkage && New->isInExternCXXContext())
3301     return true;
3302   return false;
3303 }
3304 
3305 template<typename T> static bool isExternC(T *D) { return D->isExternC(); }
3306 static bool isExternC(VarTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3307 static bool isExternC(FunctionTemplateDecl *) { return false; }
3308 
3309 /// Check whether a redeclaration of an entity introduced by a
3310 /// using-declaration is valid, given that we know it's not an overload
3311 /// (nor a hidden tag declaration).
3312 template<typename ExpectedDecl>
3313 static bool checkUsingShadowRedecl(Sema &S, UsingShadowDecl *OldS,
3314                                    ExpectedDecl *New) {
3315   // C++11 [basic.scope.declarative]p4:
3316   //   Given a set of declarations in a single declarative region, each of
3317   //   which specifies the same unqualified name,
3318   //   -- they shall all refer to the same entity, or all refer to functions
3319   //      and function templates; or
3320   //   -- exactly one declaration shall declare a class name or enumeration
3321   //      name that is not a typedef name and the other declarations shall all
3322   //      refer to the same variable or enumerator, or all refer to functions
3323   //      and function templates; in this case the class name or enumeration
3324   //      name is hidden (3.3.10).
3325 
3326   // C++11 [namespace.udecl]p14:
3327   //   If a function declaration in namespace scope or block scope has the
3328   //   same name and the same parameter-type-list as a function introduced
3329   //   by a using-declaration, and the declarations do not declare the same
3330   //   function, the program is ill-formed.
3331 
3332   auto *Old = dyn_cast<ExpectedDecl>(OldS->getTargetDecl());
3333   if (Old &&
3334       !Old->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
3335           New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) &&
3336       !(isExternC(Old) && isExternC(New)))
3337     Old = nullptr;
3338 
3339   if (!Old) {
3340     S.Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
3341     S.Diag(OldS->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl_target);
3342     S.Diag(OldS->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl) << 0;
3343     return true;
3344   }
3345   return false;
3346 }
3347 
3348 static bool hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(const FunctionDecl *A,
3349                                             const FunctionDecl *B) {
3350   assert(A->getNumParams() == B->getNumParams());
3351 
3352   auto AttrEq = [](const ParmVarDecl *A, const ParmVarDecl *B) {
3353     const auto *AttrA = A->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3354     const auto *AttrB = B->getAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
3355     if (AttrA == AttrB)
3356       return true;
3357     return AttrA && AttrB && AttrA->getType() == AttrB->getType() &&
3358            AttrA->isDynamic() == AttrB->isDynamic();
3359   };
3360 
3361   return std::equal(A->param_begin(), A->param_end(), B->param_begin(), AttrEq);
3362 }
3363 
3364 /// If necessary, adjust the semantic declaration context for a qualified
3365 /// declaration to name the correct inline namespace within the qualifier.
3366 static void adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(DeclaratorDecl *NewD,
3367                                                DeclaratorDecl *OldD) {
3368   // The only case where we need to update the DeclContext is when
3369   // redeclaration lookup for a qualified name finds a declaration
3370   // in an inline namespace within the context named by the qualifier:
3371   //
3372   //   inline namespace N { int f(); }
3373   //   int ::f(); // Sema DC needs adjusting from :: to N::.
3374   //
3375   // For unqualified declarations, the semantic context *can* change
3376   // along the redeclaration chain (for local extern declarations,
3377   // extern "C" declarations, and friend declarations in particular).
3378   if (!NewD->getQualifier())
3379     return;
3380 
3381   // NewD is probably already in the right context.
3382   auto *NamedDC = NewD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3383   auto *SemaDC = OldD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
3384   if (NamedDC->Equals(SemaDC))
3385     return;
3386 
3387   assert((NamedDC->InEnclosingNamespaceSetOf(SemaDC) ||
3388           NewD->isInvalidDecl() || OldD->isInvalidDecl()) &&
3389          "unexpected context for redeclaration");
3390 
3391   auto *LexDC = NewD->getLexicalDeclContext();
3392   auto FixSemaDC = [=](NamedDecl *D) {
3393     if (!D)
3394       return;
3395     D->setDeclContext(SemaDC);
3396     D->setLexicalDeclContext(LexDC);
3397   };
3398 
3399   FixSemaDC(NewD);
3400   if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewD))
3401     FixSemaDC(FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate());
3402   else if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewD))
3403     FixSemaDC(VD->getDescribedVarTemplate());
3404 }
3405 
3406 /// MergeFunctionDecl - We just parsed a function 'New' from
3407 /// declarator D which has the same name and scope as a previous
3408 /// declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this situation,
3409 /// merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
3410 ///
3411 /// In C++, New and Old must be declarations that are not
3412 /// overloaded. Use IsOverload to determine whether New and Old are
3413 /// overloaded, and to select the Old declaration that New should be
3414 /// merged with.
3415 ///
3416 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
3417 bool Sema::MergeFunctionDecl(FunctionDecl *New, NamedDecl *&OldD, Scope *S,
3418                              bool MergeTypeWithOld, bool NewDeclIsDefn) {
3419   // Verify the old decl was also a function.
3420   FunctionDecl *Old = OldD->getAsFunction();
3421   if (!Old) {
3422     if (UsingShadowDecl *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
3423       if (New->getFriendObjectKind()) {
3424         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_using_decl_friend);
3425         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
3426              diag::note_using_decl_target);
3427         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
3428             << 0;
3429         return true;
3430       }
3431 
3432       // Check whether the two declarations might declare the same function or
3433       // function template.
3434       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate =
3435               New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
3436         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow,
3437                                                          NewTemplate))
3438           return true;
3439         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl())
3440                          ->getAsFunction();
3441       } else {
3442         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<FunctionDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
3443           return true;
3444         OldD = Old = cast<FunctionDecl>(Shadow->getTargetDecl());
3445       }
3446     } else {
3447       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
3448         << New->getDeclName();
3449       notePreviousDefinition(OldD, New->getLocation());
3450       return true;
3451     }
3452   }
3453 
3454   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
3455   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
3456   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
3457 
3458   // If the old declaration is invalid, just give up here.
3459   if (Old->isInvalidDecl())
3460     return true;
3461 
3462   // Disallow redeclaration of some builtins.
3463   if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(Old)) {
3464     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_redeclare) << Old->getDeclName();
3465     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
3466         << Old << Old->getType();
3467     return true;
3468   }
3469 
3470   diag::kind PrevDiag;
3471   SourceLocation OldLocation;
3472   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
3473       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
3474 
3475   // Don't complain about this if we're in GNU89 mode and the old function
3476   // is an extern inline function.
3477   // Don't complain about specializations. They are not supposed to have
3478   // storage classes.
3479   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(New) && !isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Old) &&
3480       New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
3481       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage() &&
3482       !New->getTemplateSpecializationInfo() &&
3483       !canRedefineFunction(Old, getLangOpts())) {
3484     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
3485       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static) << New;
3486       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3487     } else {
3488       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static) << New;
3489       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3490       return true;
3491     }
3492   }
3493 
3494   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
3495     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
3496       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3497           << ILA;
3498       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3499       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
3500     }
3501 
3502   if (auto *EA = New->getAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3503     if (!Old->hasAttr<ErrorAttr>()) {
3504       Diag(EA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl) << EA;
3505       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3506       New->dropAttr<ErrorAttr>();
3507     }
3508   }
3509 
3510   if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old))
3511     return true;
3512 
3513   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3514     bool OldOvl = Old->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3515     if (OldOvl != New->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() && !Old->isImplicit()) {
3516       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_overloadable_mismatch)
3517         << New << OldOvl;
3518 
3519       // Try our best to find a decl that actually has the overloadable
3520       // attribute for the note. In most cases (e.g. programs with only one
3521       // broken declaration/definition), this won't matter.
3522       //
3523       // FIXME: We could do this if we juggled some extra state in
3524       // OverloadableAttr, rather than just removing it.
3525       const Decl *DiagOld = Old;
3526       if (OldOvl) {
3527         auto OldIter = llvm::find_if(Old->redecls(), [](const Decl *D) {
3528           const auto *A = D->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3529           return A && !A->isImplicit();
3530         });
3531         // If we've implicitly added *all* of the overloadable attrs to this
3532         // chain, emitting a "previous redecl" note is pointless.
3533         DiagOld = OldIter == Old->redecls_end() ? nullptr : *OldIter;
3534       }
3535 
3536       if (DiagOld)
3537         Diag(DiagOld->getLocation(),
3538              diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
3539           << OldOvl;
3540 
3541       if (OldOvl)
3542         New->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
3543       else
3544         New->dropAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
3545     }
3546   }
3547 
3548   // If a function is first declared with a calling convention, but is later
3549   // declared or defined without one, all following decls assume the calling
3550   // convention of the first.
3551   //
3552   // It's OK if a function is first declared without a calling convention,
3553   // but is later declared or defined with the default calling convention.
3554   //
3555   // To test if either decl has an explicit calling convention, we look for
3556   // AttributedType sugar nodes on the type as written.  If they are missing or
3557   // were canonicalized away, we assume the calling convention was implicit.
3558   //
3559   // Note also that we DO NOT return at this point, because we still have
3560   // other tests to run.
3561   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3562   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3563   const FunctionType *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
3564   const FunctionType *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
3565   FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
3566   FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
3567   bool RequiresAdjustment = false;
3568 
3569   if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC()) {
3570     FunctionDecl *First = Old->getFirstDecl();
3571     const FunctionType *FT =
3572         First->getType().getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3573     FunctionType::ExtInfo FI = FT->getExtInfo();
3574     bool NewCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(New->getType());
3575     if (!NewCCExplicit) {
3576       // Inherit the CC from the previous declaration if it was specified
3577       // there but not here.
3578       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3579       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3580     } else if (Old->getBuiltinID()) {
3581       // Builtin attribute isn't propagated to the new one yet at this point,
3582       // so we check if the old one is a builtin.
3583 
3584       // Calling Conventions on a Builtin aren't really useful and setting a
3585       // default calling convention and cdecl'ing some builtin redeclarations is
3586       // common, so warn and ignore the calling convention on the redeclaration.
3587       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_cconv_unsupported)
3588           << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3589           << (int)CallingConventionIgnoredReason::BuiltinFunction;
3590       NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withCallingConv(OldTypeInfo.getCC());
3591       RequiresAdjustment = true;
3592     } else {
3593       // Calling conventions aren't compatible, so complain.
3594       bool FirstCCExplicit = getCallingConvAttributedType(First->getType());
3595       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_cconv_change)
3596         << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(NewTypeInfo.getCC())
3597         << !FirstCCExplicit
3598         << (!FirstCCExplicit ? "" :
3599             FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(FI.getCC()));
3600 
3601       // Put the note on the first decl, since it is the one that matters.
3602       Diag(First->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3603       return true;
3604     }
3605   }
3606 
3607   // FIXME: diagnose the other way around?
3608   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && !NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3609     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true);
3610     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3611   }
3612 
3613   // Merge regparm attribute.
3614   if (OldTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm() ||
3615       OldTypeInfo.getRegParm() != NewTypeInfo.getRegParm()) {
3616     if (NewTypeInfo.getHasRegParm()) {
3617       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_regparm_mismatch)
3618         << NewType->getRegParmType()
3619         << OldType->getRegParmType();
3620       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3621       return true;
3622     }
3623 
3624     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withRegParm(OldTypeInfo.getRegParm());
3625     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3626   }
3627 
3628   // Merge ns_returns_retained attribute.
3629   if (OldTypeInfo.getProducesResult() != NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3630     if (NewTypeInfo.getProducesResult()) {
3631       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch)
3632           << "'ns_returns_retained'";
3633       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3634       return true;
3635     }
3636 
3637     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withProducesResult(true);
3638     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3639   }
3640 
3641   if (OldTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs() !=
3642       NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3643     if (NewTypeInfo.getNoCallerSavedRegs()) {
3644       AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr *Attr =
3645         New->getAttr<AnyX86NoCallerSavedRegistersAttr>();
3646       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_function_attribute_mismatch) << Attr;
3647       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_declaration);
3648       return true;
3649     }
3650 
3651     NewTypeInfo = NewTypeInfo.withNoCallerSavedRegs(true);
3652     RequiresAdjustment = true;
3653   }
3654 
3655   if (RequiresAdjustment) {
3656     const FunctionType *AdjustedType = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3657     AdjustedType = Context.adjustFunctionType(AdjustedType, NewTypeInfo);
3658     New->setType(QualType(AdjustedType, 0));
3659     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3660   }
3661 
3662   // If this redeclaration makes the function inline, we may need to add it to
3663   // UndefinedButUsed.
3664   if (!Old->isInlined() && New->isInlined() &&
3665       !New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3666       !getLangOpts().GNUInline &&
3667       Old->isUsed(false) &&
3668       !Old->isDefined() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
3669     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
3670                                            SourceLocation()));
3671 
3672   // If this redeclaration makes it newly gnu_inline, we don't want to warn
3673   // about it.
3674   if (New->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>() &&
3675       Old->isInlined() && !Old->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) {
3676     UndefinedButUsed.erase(Old->getCanonicalDecl());
3677   }
3678 
3679   // If pass_object_size params don't match up perfectly, this isn't a valid
3680   // redeclaration.
3681   if (Old->getNumParams() > 0 && Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams() &&
3682       !hasIdenticalPassObjectSizeAttrs(Old, New)) {
3683     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_pass_object_size_params)
3684         << New->getDeclName();
3685     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3686     return true;
3687   }
3688 
3689   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3690     // C++1z [over.load]p2
3691     //   Certain function declarations cannot be overloaded:
3692     //     -- Function declarations that differ only in the return type,
3693     //        the exception specification, or both cannot be overloaded.
3694 
3695     // Check the exception specifications match. This may recompute the type of
3696     // both Old and New if it resolved exception specifications, so grab the
3697     // types again after this. Because this updates the type, we do this before
3698     // any of the other checks below, which may update the "de facto" NewQType
3699     // but do not necessarily update the type of New.
3700     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(Old, New))
3701       return true;
3702     OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
3703     NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
3704 
3705     // Go back to the type source info to compare the declared return types,
3706     // per C++1y [dcl.type.auto]p13:
3707     //   Redeclarations or specializations of a function or function template
3708     //   with a declared return type that uses a placeholder type shall also
3709     //   use that placeholder, not a deduced type.
3710     QualType OldDeclaredReturnType = Old->getDeclaredReturnType();
3711     QualType NewDeclaredReturnType = New->getDeclaredReturnType();
3712     if (!Context.hasSameType(OldDeclaredReturnType, NewDeclaredReturnType) &&
3713         canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewDeclaredReturnType,
3714                                        OldDeclaredReturnType)) {
3715       QualType ResQT;
3716       if (NewDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
3717           OldDeclaredReturnType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3718         // FIXME: This does the wrong thing for a deduced return type.
3719         ResQT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(NewQType, OldQType);
3720       if (ResQT.isNull()) {
3721         if (New->isCXXClassMember() && New->isOutOfLine())
3722           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_def_does_not_match_ret_type)
3723               << New << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3724         else
3725           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_diff_return_type)
3726               << New->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3727         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType()
3728                                     << Old->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
3729         return true;
3730       }
3731       else
3732         NewQType = ResQT;
3733     }
3734 
3735     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
3736     QualType NewReturnType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType)->getReturnType();
3737     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType) {
3738       // If this function has a deduced return type and has already been
3739       // defined, copy the deduced value from the old declaration.
3740       AutoType *OldAT = Old->getReturnType()->getContainedAutoType();
3741       if (OldAT && OldAT->isDeduced()) {
3742         QualType DT = OldAT->getDeducedType();
3743         if (DT.isNull()) {
3744           New->setType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(New->getType()));
3745           NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoTypeDependent(NewQType));
3746         } else {
3747           New->setType(SubstAutoType(New->getType(), DT));
3748           NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(SubstAutoType(NewQType, DT));
3749         }
3750       }
3751     }
3752 
3753     const CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
3754     CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
3755     if (OldMethod && NewMethod) {
3756       // Preserve triviality.
3757       NewMethod->setTrivial(OldMethod->isTrivial());
3758 
3759       // MSVC allows explicit template specialization at class scope:
3760       // 2 CXXMethodDecls referring to the same function will be injected.
3761       // We don't want a redeclaration error.
3762       bool IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization =
3763                               OldMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
3764                               NewMethod->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
3765       bool isFriend = NewMethod->getFriendObjectKind();
3766 
3767       if (!isFriend && NewMethod->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
3768           !IsClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
3769         //    -- Member function declarations with the same name and the
3770         //       same parameter types cannot be overloaded if any of them
3771         //       is a static member function declaration.
3772         if (OldMethod->isStatic() != NewMethod->isStatic()) {
3773           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_ovl_static_nonstatic_member);
3774           Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3775           return true;
3776         }
3777 
3778         // C++ [class.mem]p1:
3779         //   [...] A member shall not be declared twice in the
3780         //   member-specification, except that a nested class or member
3781         //   class template can be declared and then later defined.
3782         if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
3783           unsigned NewDiag;
3784           if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(OldMethod))
3785             NewDiag = diag::err_constructor_redeclared;
3786           else if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewMethod))
3787             NewDiag = diag::err_destructor_redeclared;
3788           else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewMethod))
3789             NewDiag = diag::err_conv_function_redeclared;
3790           else
3791             NewDiag = diag::err_member_redeclared;
3792 
3793           Diag(New->getLocation(), NewDiag);
3794         } else {
3795           Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_member_redeclared_in_instantiation)
3796             << New << New->getType();
3797         }
3798         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3799         return true;
3800 
3801       // Complain if this is an explicit declaration of a special
3802       // member that was initially declared implicitly.
3803       //
3804       // As an exception, it's okay to befriend such methods in order
3805       // to permit the implicit constructor/destructor/operator calls.
3806       } else if (OldMethod->isImplicit()) {
3807         if (isFriend) {
3808           NewMethod->setImplicit();
3809         } else {
3810           Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3811                diag::err_definition_of_implicitly_declared_member)
3812             << New << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3813           return true;
3814         }
3815       } else if (OldMethod->getFirstDecl()->isExplicitlyDefaulted() && !isFriend) {
3816         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(),
3817              diag::err_definition_of_explicitly_defaulted_member)
3818           << getSpecialMember(OldMethod);
3819         return true;
3820       }
3821     }
3822 
3823     // C++11 [dcl.attr.noreturn]p1:
3824     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the noreturn
3825     //   attribute if any declaration of that function specifies the noreturn
3826     //   attribute.
3827     if (const auto *NRA = New->getAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>())
3828       if (!Old->hasAttr<CXX11NoReturnAttr>()) {
3829         Diag(NRA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
3830             << NRA;
3831         Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
3832       }
3833 
3834     // C++11 [dcl.attr.depend]p2:
3835     //   The first declaration of a function shall specify the
3836     //   carries_dependency attribute for its declarator-id if any declaration
3837     //   of the function specifies the carries_dependency attribute.
3838     const CarriesDependencyAttr *CDA = New->getAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>();
3839     if (CDA && !Old->hasAttr<CarriesDependencyAttr>()) {
3840       Diag(CDA->getLocation(),
3841            diag::err_carries_dependency_missing_on_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3842       Diag(Old->getFirstDecl()->getLocation(),
3843            diag::note_carries_dependency_missing_first_decl) << 0/*Function*/;
3844     }
3845 
3846     // (C++98 8.3.5p3):
3847     //   All declarations for a function shall agree exactly in both the
3848     //   return type and the parameter-type-list.
3849     // We also want to respect all the extended bits except noreturn.
3850 
3851     // noreturn should now match unless the old type info didn't have it.
3852     QualType OldQTypeForComparison = OldQType;
3853     if (!OldTypeInfo.getNoReturn() && NewTypeInfo.getNoReturn()) {
3854       auto *OldType = OldQType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3855       const FunctionType *OldTypeForComparison
3856         = Context.adjustFunctionType(OldType, OldTypeInfo.withNoReturn(true));
3857       OldQTypeForComparison = QualType(OldTypeForComparison, 0);
3858       assert(OldQTypeForComparison.isCanonical());
3859     }
3860 
3861     if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
3862       // As a special case, retain the language linkage from previous
3863       // declarations of a friend function as an extension.
3864       //
3865       // This liberal interpretation of C++ [class.friend]p3 matches GCC/MSVC
3866       // and is useful because there's otherwise no way to specify language
3867       // linkage within class scope.
3868       //
3869       // Check cautiously as the friend object kind isn't yet complete.
3870       if (New->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
3871         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_retained_language_linkage) << New;
3872         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3873       } else {
3874         Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
3875         Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
3876         return true;
3877       }
3878     }
3879 
3880     // If the function types are compatible, merge the declarations. Ignore the
3881     // exception specifier because it was already checked above in
3882     // CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec, and we don't want follow-on diagnostics
3883     // about incompatible types under -fms-compatibility.
3884     if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(OldQTypeForComparison,
3885                                                          NewQType))
3886       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
3887 
3888     // If the types are imprecise (due to dependent constructs in friends or
3889     // local extern declarations), it's OK if they differ. We'll check again
3890     // during instantiation.
3891     if (!canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(New, Old, NewQType, OldQType))
3892       return false;
3893 
3894     // Fall through for conflicting redeclarations and redefinitions.
3895   }
3896 
3897   // C: Function types need to be compatible, not identical. This handles
3898   // duplicate function decls like "void f(int); void f(enum X);" properly.
3899   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
3900     // C99 6.7.5.3p15: ...If one type has a parameter type list and the other
3901     // type is specified by a function definition that contains a (possibly
3902     // empty) identifier list, both shall agree in the number of parameters
3903     // and the type of each parameter shall be compatible with the type that
3904     // results from the application of default argument promotions to the
3905     // type of the corresponding identifier. ...
3906     // This cannot be handled by ASTContext::typesAreCompatible() because that
3907     // doesn't know whether the function type is for a definition or not when
3908     // eventually calling ASTContext::mergeFunctionTypes(). The only situation
3909     // we need to cover here is that the number of arguments agree as the
3910     // default argument promotion rules were already checked by
3911     // ASTContext::typesAreCompatible().
3912     if (Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasWrittenPrototype() && NewDeclIsDefn &&
3913         Old->getNumParams() != New->getNumParams()) {
3914       if (Old->hasInheritedPrototype())
3915         Old = Old->getCanonicalDecl();
3916       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New;
3917       Diag(Old->getLocation(), PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
3918       return true;
3919     }
3920 
3921     // If we are merging two functions where only one of them has a prototype,
3922     // we may have enough information to decide to issue a diagnostic that the
3923     // function without a protoype will change behavior in C2x. This handles
3924     // cases like:
3925     //   void i(); void i(int j);
3926     //   void i(int j); void i();
3927     //   void i(); void i(int j) {}
3928     // See ActOnFinishFunctionBody() for other cases of the behavior change
3929     // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function
3930     // type without a prototype.
3931     if (New->hasWrittenPrototype() != Old->hasWrittenPrototype() &&
3932         !New->isImplicit() && !Old->isImplicit()) {
3933       const FunctionDecl *WithProto, *WithoutProto;
3934       if (New->hasWrittenPrototype()) {
3935         WithProto = New;
3936         WithoutProto = Old;
3937       } else {
3938         WithProto = Old;
3939         WithoutProto = New;
3940       }
3941 
3942       if (WithProto->getNumParams() != 0) {
3943         if (WithoutProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithoutProto->isImplicit()) {
3944           // The one without the prototype will be changing behavior in C2x, so
3945           // warn about that one so long as it's a user-visible declaration.
3946           bool IsWithoutProtoADef = false, IsWithProtoADef = false;
3947           if (WithoutProto == New)
3948             IsWithoutProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn;
3949           else
3950             IsWithProtoADef = NewDeclIsDefn;
3951           Diag(WithoutProto->getLocation(),
3952                diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
3953               << IsWithoutProtoADef << (WithoutProto->getNumParams() ? 0 : 1)
3954               << (WithoutProto == Old) << IsWithProtoADef;
3955 
3956           // The reason the one without the prototype will be changing behavior
3957           // is because of the one with the prototype, so note that so long as
3958           // it's a user-visible declaration. There is one exception to this:
3959           // when the new declaration is a definition without a prototype, the
3960           // old declaration with a prototype is not the cause of the issue,
3961           // and that does not need to be noted because the one with a
3962           // prototype will not change behavior in C2x.
3963           if (WithProto->getBuiltinID() == 0 && !WithProto->isImplicit() &&
3964               !IsWithoutProtoADef)
3965             Diag(WithProto->getLocation(), diag::note_conflicting_prototype);
3966         }
3967       }
3968     }
3969 
3970     if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldQType, NewQType)) {
3971       const FunctionType *OldFuncType = OldQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3972       const FunctionType *NewFuncType = NewQType->getAs<FunctionType>();
3973       const FunctionProtoType *OldProto = nullptr;
3974       if (MergeTypeWithOld && isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewFuncType) &&
3975           (OldProto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldFuncType))) {
3976         // The old declaration provided a function prototype, but the
3977         // new declaration does not. Merge in the prototype.
3978         assert(!OldProto->hasExceptionSpec() && "Exception spec in C");
3979         SmallVector<QualType, 16> ParamTypes(OldProto->param_types());
3980         NewQType =
3981             Context.getFunctionType(NewFuncType->getReturnType(), ParamTypes,
3982                                     OldProto->getExtProtoInfo());
3983         New->setType(NewQType);
3984         New->setHasInheritedPrototype();
3985 
3986         // Synthesize parameters with the same types.
3987         SmallVector<ParmVarDecl *, 16> Params;
3988         for (const auto &ParamType : OldProto->param_types()) {
3989           ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(
3990               Context, New, SourceLocation(), SourceLocation(), nullptr,
3991               ParamType, /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr);
3992           Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
3993           Param->setImplicit();
3994           Params.push_back(Param);
3995         }
3996 
3997         New->setParams(Params);
3998       }
3999 
4000       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
4001     }
4002   }
4003 
4004   // Check if the function types are compatible when pointer size address
4005   // spaces are ignored.
4006   if (Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringPtrSizes(OldQType, NewQType))
4007     return false;
4008 
4009   // GNU C permits a K&R definition to follow a prototype declaration
4010   // if the declared types of the parameters in the K&R definition
4011   // match the types in the prototype declaration, even when the
4012   // promoted types of the parameters from the K&R definition differ
4013   // from the types in the prototype. GCC then keeps the types from
4014   // the prototype.
4015   //
4016   // If a variadic prototype is followed by a non-variadic K&R definition,
4017   // the K&R definition becomes variadic.  This is sort of an edge case, but
4018   // it's legal per the standard depending on how you read C99 6.7.5.3p15 and
4019   // C99 6.9.1p8.
4020   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
4021       Old->hasPrototype() && !New->hasPrototype() &&
4022       New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>() &&
4023       Old->getNumParams() == New->getNumParams()) {
4024     SmallVector<QualType, 16> ArgTypes;
4025     SmallVector<GNUCompatibleParamWarning, 16> Warnings;
4026     const FunctionProtoType *OldProto
4027       = Old->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4028     const FunctionProtoType *NewProto
4029       = New->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4030 
4031     // Determine whether this is the GNU C extension.
4032     QualType MergedReturn = Context.mergeTypes(OldProto->getReturnType(),
4033                                                NewProto->getReturnType());
4034     bool LooseCompatible = !MergedReturn.isNull();
4035     for (unsigned Idx = 0, End = Old->getNumParams();
4036          LooseCompatible && Idx != End; ++Idx) {
4037       ParmVarDecl *OldParm = Old->getParamDecl(Idx);
4038       ParmVarDecl *NewParm = New->getParamDecl(Idx);
4039       if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
4040                                      NewProto->getParamType(Idx))) {
4041         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
4042       } else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(OldParm->getType(),
4043                                             NewParm->getType(),
4044                                             /*CompareUnqualified=*/true)) {
4045         GNUCompatibleParamWarning Warn = { OldParm, NewParm,
4046                                            NewProto->getParamType(Idx) };
4047         Warnings.push_back(Warn);
4048         ArgTypes.push_back(NewParm->getType());
4049       } else
4050         LooseCompatible = false;
4051     }
4052 
4053     if (LooseCompatible) {
4054       for (unsigned Warn = 0; Warn < Warnings.size(); ++Warn) {
4055         Diag(Warnings[Warn].NewParm->getLocation(),
4056              diag::ext_param_promoted_not_compatible_with_prototype)
4057           << Warnings[Warn].PromotedType
4058           << Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getType();
4059         if (Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation().isValid())
4060           Diag(Warnings[Warn].OldParm->getLocation(),
4061                diag::note_previous_declaration);
4062       }
4063 
4064       if (MergeTypeWithOld)
4065         New->setType(Context.getFunctionType(MergedReturn, ArgTypes,
4066                                              OldProto->getExtProtoInfo()));
4067       return MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(New, Old, S, MergeTypeWithOld);
4068     }
4069 
4070     // Fall through to diagnose conflicting types.
4071   }
4072 
4073   // A function that has already been declared has been redeclared or
4074   // defined with a different type; show an appropriate diagnostic.
4075 
4076   // If the previous declaration was an implicitly-generated builtin
4077   // declaration, then at the very least we should use a specialized note.
4078   unsigned BuiltinID;
4079   if (Old->isImplicit() && (BuiltinID = Old->getBuiltinID())) {
4080     // If it's actually a library-defined builtin function like 'malloc'
4081     // or 'printf', just warn about the incompatible redeclaration.
4082     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID)) {
4083       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_redecl_library_builtin) << New;
4084       Diag(OldLocation, diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration)
4085         << Old << Old->getType();
4086       return false;
4087     }
4088 
4089     PrevDiag = diag::note_previous_builtin_declaration;
4090   }
4091 
4092   Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_conflicting_types) << New->getDeclName();
4093   Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag) << Old << Old->getType();
4094   return true;
4095 }
4096 
4097 /// Completes the merge of two function declarations that are
4098 /// known to be compatible.
4099 ///
4100 /// This routine handles the merging of attributes and other
4101 /// properties of function declarations from the old declaration to
4102 /// the new declaration, once we know that New is in fact a
4103 /// redeclaration of Old.
4104 ///
4105 /// \returns false
4106 bool Sema::MergeCompatibleFunctionDecls(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
4107                                         Scope *S, bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
4108   // Merge the attributes
4109   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
4110 
4111   // Merge "pure" flag.
4112   if (Old->isPure())
4113     New->setPure();
4114 
4115   // Merge "used" flag.
4116   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
4117     New->setIsUsed();
4118 
4119   // Merge attributes from the parameters.  These can mismatch with K&R
4120   // declarations.
4121   if (New->getNumParams() == Old->getNumParams())
4122       for (unsigned i = 0, e = New->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
4123         ParmVarDecl *NewParam = New->getParamDecl(i);
4124         ParmVarDecl *OldParam = Old->getParamDecl(i);
4125         mergeParamDeclAttributes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
4126         mergeParamDeclTypes(NewParam, OldParam, *this);
4127       }
4128 
4129   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4130     return MergeCXXFunctionDecl(New, Old, S);
4131 
4132   // Merge the function types so the we get the composite types for the return
4133   // and argument types. Per C11 6.2.7/4, only update the type if the old decl
4134   // was visible.
4135   QualType Merged = Context.mergeTypes(Old->getType(), New->getType());
4136   if (!Merged.isNull() && MergeTypeWithOld)
4137     New->setType(Merged);
4138 
4139   return false;
4140 }
4141 
4142 void Sema::mergeObjCMethodDecls(ObjCMethodDecl *newMethod,
4143                                 ObjCMethodDecl *oldMethod) {
4144   // Merge the attributes, including deprecated/unavailable
4145   AvailabilityMergeKind MergeKind =
4146       isa<ObjCProtocolDecl>(oldMethod->getDeclContext())
4147           ? (oldMethod->isOptional() ? AMK_OptionalProtocolImplementation
4148                                      : AMK_ProtocolImplementation)
4149           : isa<ObjCImplDecl>(newMethod->getDeclContext()) ? AMK_Redeclaration
4150                                                            : AMK_Override;
4151 
4152   mergeDeclAttributes(newMethod, oldMethod, MergeKind);
4153 
4154   // Merge attributes from the parameters.
4155   ObjCMethodDecl::param_const_iterator oi = oldMethod->param_begin(),
4156                                        oe = oldMethod->param_end();
4157   for (ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator
4158          ni = newMethod->param_begin(), ne = newMethod->param_end();
4159        ni != ne && oi != oe; ++ni, ++oi)
4160     mergeParamDeclAttributes(*ni, *oi, *this);
4161 
4162   CheckObjCMethodOverride(newMethod, oldMethod);
4163 }
4164 
4165 static void diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(Sema &S, VarDecl *New, VarDecl* Old) {
4166   assert(!S.Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType()));
4167 
4168   S.Diag(New->getLocation(), New->isThisDeclarationADefinition()
4169          ? diag::err_redefinition_different_type
4170          : diag::err_redeclaration_different_type)
4171     << New->getDeclName() << New->getType() << Old->getType();
4172 
4173   diag::kind PrevDiag;
4174   SourceLocation OldLocation;
4175   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation)
4176     = getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
4177   S.Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4178   New->setInvalidDecl();
4179 }
4180 
4181 /// MergeVarDeclTypes - We parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name and
4182 /// scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to merge their types,
4183 /// emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4184 ///
4185 /// Declarations using the auto type specifier (C++ [decl.spec.auto]) call back
4186 /// to here in AddInitializerToDecl. We can't check them before the initializer
4187 /// is attached.
4188 void Sema::MergeVarDeclTypes(VarDecl *New, VarDecl *Old,
4189                              bool MergeTypeWithOld) {
4190   if (New->isInvalidDecl() || Old->isInvalidDecl())
4191     return;
4192 
4193   QualType MergedT;
4194   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4195     if (New->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
4196       // We don't know what the new type is until the initializer is attached.
4197       return;
4198     } else if (Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), Old->getType())) {
4199       // These could still be something that needs exception specs checked.
4200       return MergeVarDeclExceptionSpecs(New, Old);
4201     }
4202     // C++ [basic.link]p10:
4203     //   [...] the types specified by all declarations referring to a given
4204     //   object or function shall be identical, except that declarations for an
4205     //   array object can specify array types that differ by the presence or
4206     //   absence of a major array bound (8.3.4).
4207     else if (Old->getType()->isArrayType() && New->getType()->isArrayType()) {
4208       const ArrayType *OldArray = Context.getAsArrayType(Old->getType());
4209       const ArrayType *NewArray = Context.getAsArrayType(New->getType());
4210 
4211       // We are merging a variable declaration New into Old. If it has an array
4212       // bound, and that bound differs from Old's bound, we should diagnose the
4213       // mismatch.
4214       if (!NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && !NewArray->isDependentType()) {
4215         for (VarDecl *PrevVD = Old->getMostRecentDecl(); PrevVD;
4216              PrevVD = PrevVD->getPreviousDecl()) {
4217           QualType PrevVDTy = PrevVD->getType();
4218           if (PrevVDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() || PrevVDTy->isDependentType())
4219             continue;
4220 
4221           if (!Context.hasSameType(New->getType(), PrevVDTy))
4222             return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, PrevVD);
4223         }
4224       }
4225 
4226       if (OldArray->isIncompleteArrayType() && NewArray->isArrayType()) {
4227         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4228                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4229           MergedT = New->getType();
4230       }
4231       // FIXME: Check visibility. New is hidden but has a complete type. If New
4232       // has no array bound, it should not inherit one from Old, if Old is not
4233       // visible.
4234       else if (OldArray->isArrayType() && NewArray->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
4235         if (Context.hasSameType(OldArray->getElementType(),
4236                                 NewArray->getElementType()))
4237           MergedT = Old->getType();
4238       }
4239     }
4240     else if (New->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
4241                Old->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4242       MergedT = Context.mergeObjCGCQualifiers(New->getType(),
4243                                               Old->getType());
4244     }
4245   } else {
4246     // C 6.2.7p2:
4247     //   All declarations that refer to the same object or function shall have
4248     //   compatible type.
4249     MergedT = Context.mergeTypes(New->getType(), Old->getType());
4250   }
4251   if (MergedT.isNull()) {
4252     // It's OK if we couldn't merge types if either type is dependent, for a
4253     // block-scope variable. In other cases (static data members of class
4254     // templates, variable templates, ...), we require the types to be
4255     // equivalent.
4256     // FIXME: The C++ standard doesn't say anything about this.
4257     if ((New->getType()->isDependentType() ||
4258          Old->getType()->isDependentType()) && New->isLocalVarDecl()) {
4259       // If the old type was dependent, we can't merge with it, so the new type
4260       // becomes dependent for now. We'll reproduce the original type when we
4261       // instantiate the TypeSourceInfo for the variable.
4262       if (!New->getType()->isDependentType() && MergeTypeWithOld)
4263         New->setType(Context.DependentTy);
4264       return;
4265     }
4266     return diagnoseVarDeclTypeMismatch(*this, New, Old);
4267   }
4268 
4269   // Don't actually update the type on the new declaration if the old
4270   // declaration was an extern declaration in a different scope.
4271   if (MergeTypeWithOld)
4272     New->setType(MergedT);
4273 }
4274 
4275 static bool mergeTypeWithPrevious(Sema &S, VarDecl *NewVD, VarDecl *OldVD,
4276                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
4277   // C11 6.2.7p4:
4278   //   For an identifier with internal or external linkage declared
4279   //   in a scope in which a prior declaration of that identifier is
4280   //   visible, if the prior declaration specifies internal or
4281   //   external linkage, the type of the identifier at the later
4282   //   declaration becomes the composite type.
4283   //
4284   // If the variable isn't visible, we do not merge with its type.
4285   if (Previous.isShadowed())
4286     return false;
4287 
4288   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4289     // C++11 [dcl.array]p3:
4290     //   If there is a preceding declaration of the entity in the same
4291     //   scope in which the bound was specified, an omitted array bound
4292     //   is taken to be the same as in that earlier declaration.
4293     return NewVD->isPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope() ||
4294            (!OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
4295             !NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
4296   } else {
4297     // If the old declaration was function-local, don't merge with its
4298     // type unless we're in the same function.
4299     return !OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
4300            OldVD->getLexicalDeclContext() == NewVD->getLexicalDeclContext();
4301   }
4302 }
4303 
4304 /// MergeVarDecl - We just parsed a variable 'New' which has the same name
4305 /// and scope as a previous declaration 'Old'.  Figure out how to resolve this
4306 /// situation, merging decls or emitting diagnostics as appropriate.
4307 ///
4308 /// Tentative definition rules (C99 6.9.2p2) are checked by
4309 /// FinalizeDeclaratorGroup. Unfortunately, we can't analyze tentative
4310 /// definitions here, since the initializer hasn't been attached.
4311 ///
4312 void Sema::MergeVarDecl(VarDecl *New, LookupResult &Previous) {
4313   // If the new decl is already invalid, don't do any other checking.
4314   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4315     return;
4316 
4317   if (!shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Previous, New))
4318     return;
4319 
4320   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedVarTemplate();
4321 
4322   // Verify the old decl was also a variable or variable template.
4323   VarDecl *Old = nullptr;
4324   VarTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = nullptr;
4325   if (Previous.isSingleResult()) {
4326     if (NewTemplate) {
4327       OldTemplate = dyn_cast<VarTemplateDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4328       Old = OldTemplate ? OldTemplate->getTemplatedDecl() : nullptr;
4329 
4330       if (auto *Shadow =
4331               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4332         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarTemplateDecl>(*this, Shadow, NewTemplate))
4333           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4334     } else {
4335       Old = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
4336 
4337       if (auto *Shadow =
4338               dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl()))
4339         if (checkUsingShadowRedecl<VarDecl>(*this, Shadow, New))
4340           return New->setInvalidDecl();
4341     }
4342   }
4343   if (!Old) {
4344     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_different_kind)
4345         << New->getDeclName();
4346     notePreviousDefinition(Previous.getRepresentativeDecl(),
4347                            New->getLocation());
4348     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4349   }
4350 
4351   // If the old declaration was found in an inline namespace and the new
4352   // declaration was qualified, update the DeclContext to match.
4353   adjustDeclContextForDeclaratorDecl(New, Old);
4354 
4355   // Ensure the template parameters are compatible.
4356   if (NewTemplate &&
4357       !TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4358                                       OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
4359                                       /*Complain=*/true, TPL_TemplateMatch))
4360     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4361 
4362   // C++ [class.mem]p1:
4363   //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification [...]
4364   //
4365   // Here, we need only consider static data members.
4366   if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && !New->isOutOfLine()) {
4367     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_duplicate_member)
4368       << New->getIdentifier();
4369     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4370     New->setInvalidDecl();
4371   }
4372 
4373   mergeDeclAttributes(New, Old);
4374   // Warn if an already-declared variable is made a weak_import in a subsequent
4375   // declaration
4376   if (New->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>() &&
4377       Old->getStorageClass() == SC_None &&
4378       !Old->hasAttr<WeakImportAttr>()) {
4379     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::warn_weak_import) << New->getDeclName();
4380     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4381     // Remove weak_import attribute on new declaration.
4382     New->dropAttr<WeakImportAttr>();
4383   }
4384 
4385   if (const auto *ILA = New->getAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>())
4386     if (!Old->hasAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>()) {
4387       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_missing_on_first_decl)
4388           << ILA;
4389       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
4390       New->dropAttr<InternalLinkageAttr>();
4391     }
4392 
4393   // Merge the types.
4394   VarDecl *MostRecent = Old->getMostRecentDecl();
4395   if (MostRecent != Old) {
4396     MergeVarDeclTypes(New, MostRecent,
4397                       mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, MostRecent, Previous));
4398     if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4399       return;
4400   }
4401 
4402   MergeVarDeclTypes(New, Old, mergeTypeWithPrevious(*this, New, Old, Previous));
4403   if (New->isInvalidDecl())
4404     return;
4405 
4406   diag::kind PrevDiag;
4407   SourceLocation OldLocation;
4408   std::tie(PrevDiag, OldLocation) =
4409       getNoteDiagForInvalidRedeclaration(Old, New);
4410 
4411   // [dcl.stc]p8: Check if we have a non-static decl followed by a static.
4412   if (New->getStorageClass() == SC_Static &&
4413       !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4414       Old->hasExternalFormalLinkage()) {
4415     if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4416       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::ext_static_non_static)
4417           << New->getDeclName();
4418       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4419     } else {
4420       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_static_non_static)
4421           << New->getDeclName();
4422       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4423       return New->setInvalidDecl();
4424     }
4425   }
4426   // C99 6.2.2p4:
4427   //   For an identifier declared with the storage-class specifier
4428   //   extern in a scope in which a prior declaration of that
4429   //   identifier is visible,23) if the prior declaration specifies
4430   //   internal or external linkage, the linkage of the identifier at
4431   //   the later declaration is the same as the linkage specified at
4432   //   the prior declaration. If no prior declaration is visible, or
4433   //   if the prior declaration specifies no linkage, then the
4434   //   identifier has external linkage.
4435   if (New->hasExternalStorage() && Old->hasLinkage())
4436     /* Okay */;
4437   else if (New->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() != SC_Static &&
4438            !New->isStaticDataMember() &&
4439            Old->getCanonicalDecl()->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
4440     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_static_static) << New->getDeclName();
4441     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4442     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4443   }
4444 
4445   // Check if extern is followed by non-extern and vice-versa.
4446   if (New->hasExternalStorage() &&
4447       !Old->hasLinkage() && Old->isLocalVarDeclOrParm()) {
4448     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_non_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4449     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4450     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4451   }
4452   if (Old->hasLinkage() && New->isLocalVarDeclOrParm() &&
4453       !New->hasExternalStorage()) {
4454     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_extern_extern) << New->getDeclName();
4455     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4456     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4457   }
4458 
4459   if (CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, Old))
4460     return;
4461 
4462   // Variables with external linkage are analyzed in FinalizeDeclaratorGroup.
4463 
4464   // FIXME: The test for external storage here seems wrong? We still
4465   // need to check for mismatches.
4466   if (!New->hasExternalStorage() && !New->isFileVarDecl() &&
4467       // Don't complain about out-of-line definitions of static members.
4468       !(Old->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
4469         !New->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord())) {
4470     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New->getDeclName();
4471     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4472     return New->setInvalidDecl();
4473   }
4474 
4475   if (New->isInline() && !Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isInline()) {
4476     if (VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition()) {
4477       // C++1z [dcl.fcn.spec]p4:
4478       //   If the definition of a variable appears in a translation unit before
4479       //   its first declaration as inline, the program is ill-formed.
4480       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_inline_decl_follows_def) << New;
4481       Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4482     }
4483   }
4484 
4485   // If this redeclaration makes the variable inline, we may need to add it to
4486   // UndefinedButUsed.
4487   if (!Old->isInline() && New->isInline() && Old->isUsed(false) &&
4488       !Old->getDefinition() && !New->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
4489     UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Old->getCanonicalDecl(),
4490                                            SourceLocation()));
4491 
4492   if (New->getTLSKind() != Old->getTLSKind()) {
4493     if (!Old->getTLSKind()) {
4494       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_non_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4495       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4496     } else if (!New->getTLSKind()) {
4497       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_non_thread_thread) << New->getDeclName();
4498       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4499     } else {
4500       // Do not allow redeclaration to change the variable between requiring
4501       // static and dynamic initialization.
4502       // FIXME: GCC allows this, but uses the TLS keyword on the first
4503       // declaration to determine the kind. Do we need to be compatible here?
4504       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_thread_different_kind)
4505         << New->getDeclName() << (New->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Dynamic);
4506       Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4507     }
4508   }
4509 
4510   // C++ doesn't have tentative definitions, so go right ahead and check here.
4511   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
4512     if (Old->isStaticDataMember() && Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isInline() &&
4513         Old->getCanonicalDecl()->isConstexpr()) {
4514       // This definition won't be a definition any more once it's been merged.
4515       Diag(New->getLocation(),
4516            diag::warn_deprecated_redundant_constexpr_static_def);
4517     } else if (New->isThisDeclarationADefinition() == VarDecl::Definition) {
4518       VarDecl *Def = Old->getDefinition();
4519       if (Def && checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, New))
4520         return;
4521     }
4522   }
4523 
4524   if (haveIncompatibleLanguageLinkages(Old, New)) {
4525     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_different_language_linkage) << New;
4526     Diag(OldLocation, PrevDiag);
4527     New->setInvalidDecl();
4528     return;
4529   }
4530 
4531   // Merge "used" flag.
4532   if (Old->getMostRecentDecl()->isUsed(false))
4533     New->setIsUsed();
4534 
4535   // Keep a chain of previous declarations.
4536   New->setPreviousDecl(Old);
4537   if (NewTemplate)
4538     NewTemplate->setPreviousDecl(OldTemplate);
4539 
4540   // Inherit access appropriately.
4541   New->setAccess(Old->getAccess());
4542   if (NewTemplate)
4543     NewTemplate->setAccess(New->getAccess());
4544 
4545   if (Old->isInline())
4546     New->setImplicitlyInline();
4547 }
4548 
4549 void Sema::notePreviousDefinition(const NamedDecl *Old, SourceLocation New) {
4550   SourceManager &SrcMgr = getSourceManager();
4551   auto FNewDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(New);
4552   auto FOldDecLoc = SrcMgr.getDecomposedLoc(Old->getLocation());
4553   auto *FNew = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FNewDecLoc.first);
4554   auto *FOld = SrcMgr.getFileEntryForID(FOldDecLoc.first);
4555   auto &HSI = PP.getHeaderSearchInfo();
4556   StringRef HdrFilename =
4557       SrcMgr.getFilename(SrcMgr.getSpellingLoc(Old->getLocation()));
4558 
4559   auto noteFromModuleOrInclude = [&](Module *Mod,
4560                                      SourceLocation IncLoc) -> bool {
4561     // Redefinition errors with modules are common with non modular mapped
4562     // headers, example: a non-modular header H in module A that also gets
4563     // included directly in a TU. Pointing twice to the same header/definition
4564     // is confusing, try to get better diagnostics when modules is on.
4565     if (IncLoc.isValid()) {
4566       if (Mod) {
4567         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_modules_same_file)
4568             << HdrFilename.str() << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4569         if (!Mod->DefinitionLoc.isInvalid())
4570           Diag(Mod->DefinitionLoc, diag::note_defined_here)
4571               << Mod->getFullModuleName();
4572       } else {
4573         Diag(IncLoc, diag::note_redefinition_include_same_file)
4574             << HdrFilename.str();
4575       }
4576       return true;
4577     }
4578 
4579     return false;
4580   };
4581 
4582   // Is it the same file and same offset? Provide more information on why
4583   // this leads to a redefinition error.
4584   if (FNew == FOld && FNewDecLoc.second == FOldDecLoc.second) {
4585     SourceLocation OldIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FOldDecLoc.first);
4586     SourceLocation NewIncLoc = SrcMgr.getIncludeLoc(FNewDecLoc.first);
4587     bool EmittedDiag =
4588         noteFromModuleOrInclude(Old->getOwningModule(), OldIncLoc);
4589     EmittedDiag |= noteFromModuleOrInclude(getCurrentModule(), NewIncLoc);
4590 
4591     // If the header has no guards, emit a note suggesting one.
4592     if (FOld && !HSI.isFileMultipleIncludeGuarded(FOld))
4593       Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_use_ifdef_guards);
4594 
4595     if (EmittedDiag)
4596       return;
4597   }
4598 
4599   // Redefinition coming from different files or couldn't do better above.
4600   if (Old->getLocation().isValid())
4601     Diag(Old->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
4602 }
4603 
4604 /// We've just determined that \p Old and \p New both appear to be definitions
4605 /// of the same variable. Either diagnose or fix the problem.
4606 bool Sema::checkVarDeclRedefinition(VarDecl *Old, VarDecl *New) {
4607   if (!hasVisibleDefinition(Old) &&
4608       (New->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
4609        New->isInline() ||
4610        New->getDescribedVarTemplate() ||
4611        New->getNumTemplateParameterLists() ||
4612        New->getDeclContext()->isDependentContext())) {
4613     // The previous definition is hidden, and multiple definitions are
4614     // permitted (in separate TUs). Demote this to a declaration.
4615     New->demoteThisDefinitionToDeclaration();
4616 
4617     // Make the canonical definition visible.
4618     if (auto *OldTD = Old->getDescribedVarTemplate())
4619       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(OldTD);
4620     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Old);
4621     return false;
4622   } else {
4623     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << New;
4624     notePreviousDefinition(Old, New->getLocation());
4625     New->setInvalidDecl();
4626     return true;
4627   }
4628 }
4629 
4630 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4631 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed.
4632 Decl *
4633 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS,
4634                                  RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4635   return ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(S, AS, DS, MultiTemplateParamsArg(), false,
4636                                     AnonRecord);
4637 }
4638 
4639 // The MS ABI changed between VS2013 and VS2015 with regard to numbers used to
4640 // disambiguate entities defined in different scopes.
4641 // While the VS2015 ABI fixes potential miscompiles, it is also breaks
4642 // compatibility.
4643 // We will pick our mangling number depending on which version of MSVC is being
4644 // targeted.
4645 static unsigned getMSManglingNumber(const LangOptions &LO, Scope *S) {
4646   return LO.isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015)
4647              ? S->getMSCurManglingNumber()
4648              : S->getMSLastManglingNumber();
4649 }
4650 
4651 void Sema::handleTagNumbering(const TagDecl *Tag, Scope *TagScope) {
4652   if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4653     return;
4654 
4655   if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag->getParent())) {
4656     // If this tag is the direct child of a class, number it if
4657     // it is anonymous.
4658     if (!Tag->getName().empty() || Tag->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl())
4659       return;
4660     MangleNumberingContext &MCtx =
4661         Context.getManglingNumberContext(Tag->getParent());
4662     Context.setManglingNumber(
4663         Tag, MCtx.getManglingNumber(
4664                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4665     return;
4666   }
4667 
4668   // If this tag isn't a direct child of a class, number it if it is local.
4669   MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
4670   Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
4671   std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
4672       getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Tag->getDeclContext());
4673   if (MCtx) {
4674     Context.setManglingNumber(
4675         Tag, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
4676                  Tag, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), TagScope)));
4677   }
4678 }
4679 
4680 namespace {
4681 struct NonCLikeKind {
4682   enum {
4683     None,
4684     BaseClass,
4685     DefaultMemberInit,
4686     Lambda,
4687     Friend,
4688     OtherMember,
4689     Invalid,
4690   } Kind = None;
4691   SourceRange Range;
4692 
4693   explicit operator bool() { return Kind != None; }
4694 };
4695 }
4696 
4697 /// Determine whether a class is C-like, according to the rules of C++
4698 /// [dcl.typedef] for anonymous classes with typedef names for linkage.
4699 static NonCLikeKind getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(const CXXRecordDecl *RD) {
4700   if (RD->isInvalidDecl())
4701     return {NonCLikeKind::Invalid, {}};
4702 
4703   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1]
4704   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall not
4705   //
4706   //    -- have any base classes
4707   if (RD->getNumBases())
4708     return {NonCLikeKind::BaseClass,
4709             SourceRange(RD->bases_begin()->getBeginLoc(),
4710                         RD->bases_end()[-1].getEndLoc())};
4711   bool Invalid = false;
4712   for (Decl *D : RD->decls()) {
4713     // Don't complain about things we already diagnosed.
4714     if (D->isInvalidDecl()) {
4715       Invalid = true;
4716       continue;
4717     }
4718 
4719     //  -- have any [...] default member initializers
4720     if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D)) {
4721       if (FD->hasInClassInitializer()) {
4722         auto *Init = FD->getInClassInitializer();
4723         return {NonCLikeKind::DefaultMemberInit,
4724                 Init ? Init->getSourceRange() : D->getSourceRange()};
4725       }
4726       continue;
4727     }
4728 
4729     // FIXME: We don't allow friend declarations. This violates the wording of
4730     // P1766, but not the intent.
4731     if (isa<FriendDecl>(D))
4732       return {NonCLikeKind::Friend, D->getSourceRange()};
4733 
4734     //  -- declare any members other than non-static data members, member
4735     //     enumerations, or member classes,
4736     if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D) ||
4737         isa<EnumDecl>(D))
4738       continue;
4739     auto *MemberRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D);
4740     if (!MemberRD) {
4741       if (D->isImplicit())
4742         continue;
4743       return {NonCLikeKind::OtherMember, D->getSourceRange()};
4744     }
4745 
4746     //  -- contain a lambda-expression,
4747     if (MemberRD->isLambda())
4748       return {NonCLikeKind::Lambda, MemberRD->getSourceRange()};
4749 
4750     //  and all member classes shall also satisfy these requirements
4751     //  (recursively).
4752     if (MemberRD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
4753       if (auto Kind = getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(MemberRD))
4754         return Kind;
4755     }
4756   }
4757 
4758   return {Invalid ? NonCLikeKind::Invalid : NonCLikeKind::None, {}};
4759 }
4760 
4761 void Sema::setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(TagDecl *TagFromDeclSpec,
4762                                         TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
4763   if (TagFromDeclSpec->isInvalidDecl())
4764     return;
4765 
4766   // Do nothing if the tag already has a name for linkage purposes.
4767   if (TagFromDeclSpec->hasNameForLinkage())
4768     return;
4769 
4770   // A well-formed anonymous tag must always be a TUK_Definition.
4771   assert(TagFromDeclSpec->isThisDeclarationADefinition());
4772 
4773   // The type must match the tag exactly;  no qualifiers allowed.
4774   if (!Context.hasSameType(NewTD->getUnderlyingType(),
4775                            Context.getTagDeclType(TagFromDeclSpec))) {
4776     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
4777       Context.addTypedefNameForUnnamedTagDecl(TagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
4778     return;
4779   }
4780 
4781   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p9: [P1766R1, applied as DR]
4782   //   An unnamed class with a typedef name for linkage purposes shall [be
4783   //   C-like].
4784   //
4785   // FIXME: Also diagnose if we've already computed the linkage. That ideally
4786   // shouldn't happen, but there are constructs that the language rule doesn't
4787   // disallow for which we can't reasonably avoid computing linkage early.
4788   const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagFromDeclSpec);
4789   NonCLikeKind NonCLike = RD ? getNonCLikeKindForAnonymousStruct(RD)
4790                              : NonCLikeKind();
4791   bool ChangesLinkage = TagFromDeclSpec->hasLinkageBeenComputed();
4792   if (NonCLike || ChangesLinkage) {
4793     if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::Invalid)
4794       return;
4795 
4796     unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4797     if (ChangesLinkage) {
4798       // If the linkage changes, we can't accept this as an extension.
4799       if (NonCLike.Kind == NonCLikeKind::None)
4800         DiagID = diag::err_typedef_changes_linkage;
4801       else
4802         DiagID = diag::err_non_c_like_anon_struct_in_typedef;
4803     }
4804 
4805     SourceLocation FixitLoc =
4806         getLocForEndOfToken(TagFromDeclSpec->getInnerLocStart());
4807     llvm::SmallString<40> TextToInsert;
4808     TextToInsert += ' ';
4809     TextToInsert += NewTD->getIdentifier()->getName();
4810 
4811     Diag(FixitLoc, DiagID)
4812       << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD)
4813       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FixitLoc, TextToInsert);
4814     if (NonCLike.Kind != NonCLikeKind::None) {
4815       Diag(NonCLike.Range.getBegin(), diag::note_non_c_like_anon_struct)
4816         << NonCLike.Kind - 1 << NonCLike.Range;
4817     }
4818     Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::note_typedef_for_linkage_here)
4819       << NewTD << isa<TypeAliasDecl>(NewTD);
4820 
4821     if (ChangesLinkage)
4822       return;
4823   }
4824 
4825   // Otherwise, set this as the anon-decl typedef for the tag.
4826   TagFromDeclSpec->setTypedefNameForAnonDecl(NewTD);
4827 }
4828 
4829 static unsigned GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DeclSpec::TST T) {
4830   switch (T) {
4831   case DeclSpec::TST_class:
4832     return 0;
4833   case DeclSpec::TST_struct:
4834     return 1;
4835   case DeclSpec::TST_interface:
4836     return 2;
4837   case DeclSpec::TST_union:
4838     return 3;
4839   case DeclSpec::TST_enum:
4840     return 4;
4841   default:
4842     llvm_unreachable("unexpected type specifier");
4843   }
4844 }
4845 
4846 /// ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec - This method is invoked when a declspec with
4847 /// no declarator (e.g. "struct foo;") is parsed. It also accepts template
4848 /// parameters to cope with template friend declarations.
4849 Decl *
4850 Sema::ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec(Scope *S, AccessSpecifier AS, DeclSpec &DS,
4851                                  MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParams,
4852                                  bool IsExplicitInstantiation,
4853                                  RecordDecl *&AnonRecord) {
4854   Decl *TagD = nullptr;
4855   TagDecl *Tag = nullptr;
4856   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
4857       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
4858       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
4859       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
4860       DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
4861     TagD = DS.getRepAsDecl();
4862 
4863     if (!TagD) // We probably had an error
4864       return nullptr;
4865 
4866     // Note that the above type specs guarantee that the
4867     // type rep is a Decl, whereas in many of the others
4868     // it's a Type.
4869     if (isa<TagDecl>(TagD))
4870       Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
4871     else if (ClassTemplateDecl *CTD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateDecl>(TagD))
4872       Tag = CTD->getTemplatedDecl();
4873   }
4874 
4875   if (Tag) {
4876     handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
4877     Tag->setFreeStanding();
4878     if (Tag->isInvalidDecl())
4879       return Tag;
4880   }
4881 
4882   if (unsigned TypeQuals = DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
4883     // Enforce C99 6.7.3p2: "Types other than pointer types derived from object
4884     // or incomplete types shall not be restrict-qualified."
4885     if (TypeQuals & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
4886       Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
4887            diag::err_typecheck_invalid_restrict_not_pointer_noarg)
4888            << DS.getSourceRange();
4889   }
4890 
4891   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
4892     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
4893         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
4894 
4895   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier()) {
4896     // C++0x [dcl.constexpr]p1: constexpr can only be applied to declarations
4897     // and definitions of functions and variables.
4898     // C++2a [dcl.constexpr]p1: The consteval specifier shall be applied only to
4899     // the declaration of a function or function template
4900     if (Tag)
4901       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_tag)
4902           << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType())
4903           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4904     else
4905       Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
4906           << static_cast<int>(DS.getConstexprSpecifier());
4907     // Don't emit warnings after this error.
4908     return TagD;
4909   }
4910 
4911   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
4912 
4913   if (DS.isFriendSpecified()) {
4914     // If we're dealing with a decl but not a TagDecl, assume that
4915     // whatever routines created it handled the friendship aspect.
4916     if (TagD && !Tag)
4917       return nullptr;
4918     return ActOnFriendTypeDecl(S, DS, TemplateParams);
4919   }
4920 
4921   const CXXScopeSpec &SS = DS.getTypeSpecScope();
4922   bool IsExplicitSpecialization =
4923     !TemplateParams.empty() && TemplateParams.back()->size() == 0;
4924   if (Tag && SS.isNotEmpty() && !Tag->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4925       !IsExplicitInstantiation && !IsExplicitSpecialization &&
4926       !isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Tag)) {
4927     // Per C++ [dcl.type.elab]p1, a class declaration cannot have a
4928     // nested-name-specifier unless it is an explicit instantiation
4929     // or an explicit specialization.
4930     //
4931     // FIXME: We allow class template partial specializations here too, per the
4932     // obvious intent of DR1819.
4933     //
4934     // Per C++ [dcl.enum]p1, an opaque-enum-declaration can't either.
4935     Diag(SS.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_standalone_class_nested_name_specifier)
4936         << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(DS.getTypeSpecType()) << SS.getRange();
4937     return nullptr;
4938   }
4939 
4940   // Track whether this decl-specifier declares anything.
4941   bool DeclaresAnything = true;
4942 
4943   // Handle anonymous struct definitions.
4944   if (RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(Tag)) {
4945     if (!Record->getDeclName() && Record->isCompleteDefinition() &&
4946         DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
4947       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
4948           Record->getDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
4949         // If CurContext is a DeclContext that can contain statements,
4950         // RecursiveASTVisitor won't visit the decls that
4951         // BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion() will put into CurContext.
4952         // Also store them here so that they can be part of the
4953         // DeclStmt that gets created in this case.
4954         // FIXME: Also return the IndirectFieldDecls created by
4955         // BuildAnonymousStructOr union, for the same reason?
4956         if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
4957           AnonRecord = Record;
4958         return BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(S, DS, AS, Record,
4959                                            Context.getPrintingPolicy());
4960       }
4961 
4962       DeclaresAnything = false;
4963     }
4964   }
4965 
4966   // C11 6.7.2.1p2:
4967   //   A struct-declaration that does not declare an anonymous structure or
4968   //   anonymous union shall contain a struct-declarator-list.
4969   //
4970   // This rule also existed in C89 and C99; the grammar for struct-declaration
4971   // did not permit a struct-declaration without a struct-declarator-list.
4972   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && CurContext->isRecord() &&
4973       DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
4974     // Check for Microsoft C extension: anonymous struct/union member.
4975     // Handle 2 kinds of anonymous struct/union:
4976     //   struct STRUCT;
4977     //   union UNION;
4978     // and
4979     //   STRUCT_TYPE;  <- where STRUCT_TYPE is a typedef struct.
4980     //   UNION_TYPE;   <- where UNION_TYPE is a typedef union.
4981     if ((Tag && Tag->getDeclName()) ||
4982         DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_typename) {
4983       RecordDecl *Record = nullptr;
4984       if (Tag)
4985         Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag);
4986       else if (const RecordType *RT =
4987                    DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsStructureType())
4988         Record = RT->getDecl();
4989       else if (const RecordType *UT = DS.getRepAsType().get()->getAsUnionType())
4990         Record = UT->getDecl();
4991 
4992       if (Record && getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt) {
4993         Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_ms_anonymous_record)
4994             << Record->isUnion() << DS.getSourceRange();
4995         return BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(S, DS, Record);
4996       }
4997 
4998       DeclaresAnything = false;
4999     }
5000   }
5001 
5002   // Skip all the checks below if we have a type error.
5003   if (DS.getTypeSpecType() == DeclSpec::TST_error ||
5004       (TagD && TagD->isInvalidDecl()))
5005     return TagD;
5006 
5007   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
5008       DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5009     if (EnumDecl *Enum = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(Tag))
5010       if (Enum->enumerator_begin() == Enum->enumerator_end() &&
5011           !Enum->getIdentifier() && !Enum->isInvalidDecl())
5012         DeclaresAnything = false;
5013 
5014   if (!DS.isMissingDeclaratorOk()) {
5015     // Customize diagnostic for a typedef missing a name.
5016     if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5017       Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typedef_without_a_name)
5018           << DS.getSourceRange();
5019     else
5020       DeclaresAnything = false;
5021   }
5022 
5023   if (DS.isModulePrivateSpecified() &&
5024       Tag && Tag->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
5025     Diag(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc(), diag::err_module_private_local_class)
5026       << Tag->getTagKind()
5027       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
5028 
5029   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
5030 
5031   // C 6.7/2:
5032   //   A declaration [...] shall declare at least a declarator [...], a tag,
5033   //   or the members of an enumeration.
5034   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
5035   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
5036   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
5037   //   names into the program, or shall redeclare a name introduced by a
5038   //   previous declaration.
5039   if (!DeclaresAnything) {
5040     // In C, we allow this as a (popular) extension / bug. Don't bother
5041     // producing further diagnostics for redundant qualifiers after this.
5042     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), (IsExplicitInstantiation || !TemplateParams.empty())
5043                                ? diag::err_no_declarators
5044                                : diag::ext_no_declarators)
5045         << DS.getSourceRange();
5046     return TagD;
5047   }
5048 
5049   // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
5050   //   If a storage-class-specifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, [...] the
5051   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
5052   // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p1:
5053   //   If a cv-qualifier appears in a decl-specifier-seq, the
5054   //   init-declarator-list of the declaration shall not be empty.
5055   //
5056   // Spurious qualifiers here appear to be valid in C.
5057   unsigned DiagID = diag::warn_standalone_specifier;
5058   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5059     DiagID = diag::ext_standalone_specifier;
5060 
5061   // Note that a linkage-specification sets a storage class, but
5062   // 'extern "C" struct foo;' is actually valid and not theoretically
5063   // useless.
5064   if (DeclSpec::SCS SCS = DS.getStorageClassSpec()) {
5065     if (SCS == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable)
5066       // Since mutable is not a viable storage class specifier in C, there is
5067       // no reason to treat it as an extension. Instead, diagnose as an error.
5068       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
5069     else if (!DS.isExternInLinkageSpec() && SCS != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
5070       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
5071         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(SCS);
5072   }
5073 
5074   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
5075     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), DiagID)
5076       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
5077   if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
5078     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
5079       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "const";
5080     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
5081       Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "volatile";
5082     // Restrict is covered above.
5083     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
5084       Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "_Atomic";
5085     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
5086       Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(), DiagID) << "__unaligned";
5087   }
5088 
5089   // Warn about ignored type attributes, for example:
5090   // __attribute__((aligned)) struct A;
5091   // Attributes should be placed after tag to apply to type declaration.
5092   if (!DS.getAttributes().empty()) {
5093     DeclSpec::TST TypeSpecType = DS.getTypeSpecType();
5094     if (TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_class ||
5095         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_struct ||
5096         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_interface ||
5097         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_union ||
5098         TypeSpecType == DeclSpec::TST_enum) {
5099       for (const ParsedAttr &AL : DS.getAttributes())
5100         Diag(AL.getLoc(), diag::warn_declspec_attribute_ignored)
5101             << AL << GetDiagnosticTypeSpecifierID(TypeSpecType);
5102     }
5103   }
5104 
5105   return TagD;
5106 }
5107 
5108 /// We are trying to inject an anonymous member into the given scope;
5109 /// check if there's an existing declaration that can't be overloaded.
5110 ///
5111 /// \return true if this is a forbidden redeclaration
5112 static bool CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(Sema &SemaRef,
5113                                          Scope *S,
5114                                          DeclContext *Owner,
5115                                          DeclarationName Name,
5116                                          SourceLocation NameLoc,
5117                                          bool IsUnion) {
5118   LookupResult R(SemaRef, Name, NameLoc, Sema::LookupMemberName,
5119                  Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
5120   if (!SemaRef.LookupName(R, S)) return false;
5121 
5122   // Pick a representative declaration.
5123   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getRepresentativeDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5124   assert(PrevDecl && "Expected a non-null Decl");
5125 
5126   if (!SemaRef.isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Owner, S))
5127     return false;
5128 
5129   SemaRef.Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_anonymous_record_member_redecl)
5130     << IsUnion << Name;
5131   SemaRef.Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
5132 
5133   return true;
5134 }
5135 
5136 /// InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers - Inject the members of the
5137 /// anonymous struct or union AnonRecord into the owning context Owner
5138 /// and scope S. This routine will be invoked just after we realize
5139 /// that an unnamed union or struct is actually an anonymous union or
5140 /// struct, e.g.,
5141 ///
5142 /// @code
5143 /// union {
5144 ///   int i;
5145 ///   float f;
5146 /// }; // InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers called here to inject i and
5147 ///    // f into the surrounding scope.x
5148 /// @endcode
5149 ///
5150 /// This routine is recursive, injecting the names of nested anonymous
5151 /// structs/unions into the owning context and scope as well.
5152 static bool
5153 InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, DeclContext *Owner,
5154                                     RecordDecl *AnonRecord, AccessSpecifier AS,
5155                                     SmallVectorImpl<NamedDecl *> &Chaining) {
5156   bool Invalid = false;
5157 
5158   // Look every FieldDecl and IndirectFieldDecl with a name.
5159   for (auto *D : AnonRecord->decls()) {
5160     if ((isa<FieldDecl>(D) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) &&
5161         cast<NamedDecl>(D)->getDeclName()) {
5162       ValueDecl *VD = cast<ValueDecl>(D);
5163       if (CheckAnonMemberRedeclaration(SemaRef, S, Owner, VD->getDeclName(),
5164                                        VD->getLocation(),
5165                                        AnonRecord->isUnion())) {
5166         // C++ [class.union]p2:
5167         //   The names of the members of an anonymous union shall be
5168         //   distinct from the names of any other entity in the
5169         //   scope in which the anonymous union is declared.
5170         Invalid = true;
5171       } else {
5172         // C++ [class.union]p2:
5173         //   For the purpose of name lookup, after the anonymous union
5174         //   definition, the members of the anonymous union are
5175         //   considered to have been defined in the scope in which the
5176         //   anonymous union is declared.
5177         unsigned OldChainingSize = Chaining.size();
5178         if (IndirectFieldDecl *IF = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD))
5179           Chaining.append(IF->chain_begin(), IF->chain_end());
5180         else
5181           Chaining.push_back(VD);
5182 
5183         assert(Chaining.size() >= 2);
5184         NamedDecl **NamedChain =
5185           new (SemaRef.Context)NamedDecl*[Chaining.size()];
5186         for (unsigned i = 0; i < Chaining.size(); i++)
5187           NamedChain[i] = Chaining[i];
5188 
5189         IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectField = IndirectFieldDecl::Create(
5190             SemaRef.Context, Owner, VD->getLocation(), VD->getIdentifier(),
5191             VD->getType(), {NamedChain, Chaining.size()});
5192 
5193         for (const auto *Attr : VD->attrs())
5194           IndirectField->addAttr(Attr->clone(SemaRef.Context));
5195 
5196         IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
5197         IndirectField->setImplicit();
5198         SemaRef.PushOnScopeChains(IndirectField, S);
5199 
5200         // That includes picking up the appropriate access specifier.
5201         if (AS != AS_none) IndirectField->setAccess(AS);
5202 
5203         Chaining.resize(OldChainingSize);
5204       }
5205     }
5206   }
5207 
5208   return Invalid;
5209 }
5210 
5211 /// StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass - Maps a DeclSpec::SCS to
5212 /// a VarDecl::StorageClass. Any error reporting is up to the caller:
5213 /// illegal input values are mapped to SC_None.
5214 static StorageClass
5215 StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(const DeclSpec &DS) {
5216   DeclSpec::SCS StorageClassSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5217   assert(StorageClassSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
5218          "Parser allowed 'typedef' as storage class VarDecl.");
5219   switch (StorageClassSpec) {
5220   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified:    return SC_None;
5221   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
5222     if (DS.isExternInLinkageSpec())
5223       return SC_None;
5224     return SC_Extern;
5225   case DeclSpec::SCS_static:         return SC_Static;
5226   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:           return SC_Auto;
5227   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:       return SC_Register;
5228   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
5229     // Illegal SCSs map to None: error reporting is up to the caller.
5230   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:        // Fall through.
5231   case DeclSpec::SCS_typedef:        return SC_None;
5232   }
5233   llvm_unreachable("unknown storage class specifier");
5234 }
5235 
5236 static SourceLocation findDefaultInitializer(const CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
5237   assert(Record->hasInClassInitializer());
5238 
5239   for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
5240     const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(I);
5241     if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
5242       FD = IFD->getAnonField();
5243     if (FD && FD->hasInClassInitializer())
5244       return FD->getLocation();
5245   }
5246 
5247   llvm_unreachable("couldn't find in-class initializer");
5248 }
5249 
5250 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5251                                       SourceLocation DefaultInitLoc) {
5252   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5253     return;
5254 
5255   S.Diag(DefaultInitLoc, diag::err_multiple_mem_union_initialization);
5256   S.Diag(findDefaultInitializer(Parent), diag::note_previous_initializer) << 0;
5257 }
5258 
5259 static void checkDuplicateDefaultInit(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Parent,
5260                                       CXXRecordDecl *AnonUnion) {
5261   if (!Parent->isUnion() || !Parent->hasInClassInitializer())
5262     return;
5263 
5264   checkDuplicateDefaultInit(S, Parent, findDefaultInitializer(AnonUnion));
5265 }
5266 
5267 /// BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion - Handle the declaration of an
5268 /// anonymous structure or union. Anonymous unions are a C++ feature
5269 /// (C++ [class.union]) and a C11 feature; anonymous structures
5270 /// are a C11 feature and GNU C++ extension.
5271 Decl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructOrUnion(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5272                                         AccessSpecifier AS,
5273                                         RecordDecl *Record,
5274                                         const PrintingPolicy &Policy) {
5275   DeclContext *Owner = Record->getDeclContext();
5276 
5277   // Diagnose whether this anonymous struct/union is an extension.
5278   if (Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().C11)
5279     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_union);
5280   else if (!Record->isUnion() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5281     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_gnu_anonymous_struct);
5282   else if (!Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().C11)
5283     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::ext_c11_anonymous_struct);
5284 
5285   // C and C++ require different kinds of checks for anonymous
5286   // structs/unions.
5287   bool Invalid = false;
5288   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5289     const char *PrevSpec = nullptr;
5290     if (Record->isUnion()) {
5291       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5292       // C++17 [class.union.anon]p2:
5293       //   Anonymous unions declared in a named namespace or in the
5294       //   global namespace shall be declared static.
5295       unsigned DiagID;
5296       DeclContext *OwnerScope = Owner->getRedeclContext();
5297       if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static &&
5298           (OwnerScope->isTranslationUnit() ||
5299            (OwnerScope->isNamespace() &&
5300             !cast<NamespaceDecl>(OwnerScope)->isAnonymousNamespace()))) {
5301         Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_union_not_static)
5302           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Record->getLocation(), "static ");
5303 
5304         // Recover by adding 'static'.
5305         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_static, SourceLocation(),
5306                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Policy);
5307       }
5308       // C++ [class.union]p6:
5309       //   A storage class is not allowed in a declaration of an
5310       //   anonymous union in a class scope.
5311       else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified &&
5312                isa<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5313         Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
5314              diag::err_anonymous_union_with_storage_spec)
5315           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
5316 
5317         // Recover by removing the storage specifier.
5318         DS.SetStorageClassSpec(*this, DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified,
5319                                SourceLocation(),
5320                                PrevSpec, DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
5321       }
5322     }
5323 
5324     // Ignore const/volatile/restrict qualifiers.
5325     if (DS.getTypeQualifiers()) {
5326       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_const)
5327         Diag(DS.getConstSpecLoc(), diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5328           << Record->isUnion() << "const"
5329           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstSpecLoc());
5330       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_volatile)
5331         Diag(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc(),
5332              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5333           << Record->isUnion() << "volatile"
5334           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getVolatileSpecLoc());
5335       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_restrict)
5336         Diag(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc(),
5337              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5338           << Record->isUnion() << "restrict"
5339           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getRestrictSpecLoc());
5340       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_atomic)
5341         Diag(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc(),
5342              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5343           << Record->isUnion() << "_Atomic"
5344           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getAtomicSpecLoc());
5345       if (DS.getTypeQualifiers() & DeclSpec::TQ_unaligned)
5346         Diag(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc(),
5347              diag::ext_anonymous_struct_union_qualified)
5348           << Record->isUnion() << "__unaligned"
5349           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getUnalignedSpecLoc());
5350 
5351       DS.ClearTypeQualifiers();
5352     }
5353 
5354     // C++ [class.union]p2:
5355     //   The member-specification of an anonymous union shall only
5356     //   define non-static data members. [Note: nested types and
5357     //   functions cannot be declared within an anonymous union. ]
5358     for (auto *Mem : Record->decls()) {
5359       // Ignore invalid declarations; we already diagnosed them.
5360       if (Mem->isInvalidDecl())
5361         continue;
5362 
5363       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Mem)) {
5364         // C++ [class.union]p3:
5365         //   An anonymous union shall not have private or protected
5366         //   members (clause 11).
5367         assert(FD->getAccess() != AS_none);
5368         if (FD->getAccess() != AS_public) {
5369           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_nonpublic_member)
5370             << Record->isUnion() << (FD->getAccess() == AS_protected);
5371           Invalid = true;
5372         }
5373 
5374         // C++ [class.union]p1
5375         //   An object of a class with a non-trivial constructor, a non-trivial
5376         //   copy constructor, a non-trivial destructor, or a non-trivial copy
5377         //   assignment operator cannot be a member of a union, nor can an
5378         //   array of such objects.
5379         if (CheckNontrivialField(FD))
5380           Invalid = true;
5381       } else if (Mem->isImplicit()) {
5382         // Any implicit members are fine.
5383       } else if (isa<TagDecl>(Mem) && Mem->getDeclContext() != Record) {
5384         // This is a type that showed up in an
5385         // elaborated-type-specifier inside the anonymous struct or
5386         // union, but which actually declares a type outside of the
5387         // anonymous struct or union. It's okay.
5388       } else if (auto *MemRecord = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Mem)) {
5389         if (!MemRecord->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
5390             MemRecord->getDeclName()) {
5391           // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5392           if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
5393             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5394               << Record->isUnion();
5395           else {
5396             // This is a nested type declaration.
5397             Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5398               << Record->isUnion();
5399             Invalid = true;
5400           }
5401         } else {
5402           // This is an anonymous type definition within another anonymous type.
5403           // This is a popular extension, provided by Plan9, MSVC and GCC, but
5404           // not part of standard C++.
5405           Diag(MemRecord->getLocation(),
5406                diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_anonymous_type)
5407             << Record->isUnion();
5408         }
5409       } else if (isa<AccessSpecDecl>(Mem)) {
5410         // Any access specifier is fine.
5411       } else if (isa<StaticAssertDecl>(Mem)) {
5412         // In C++1z, static_assert declarations are also fine.
5413       } else {
5414         // We have something that isn't a non-static data
5415         // member. Complain about it.
5416         unsigned DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_bad_member;
5417         if (isa<TypeDecl>(Mem))
5418           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type;
5419         else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Mem))
5420           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_function;
5421         else if (isa<VarDecl>(Mem))
5422           DK = diag::err_anonymous_record_with_static;
5423 
5424         // Visual C++ allows type definition in anonymous struct or union.
5425         if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt &&
5426             DK == diag::err_anonymous_record_with_type)
5427           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), diag::ext_anonymous_record_with_type)
5428             << Record->isUnion();
5429         else {
5430           Diag(Mem->getLocation(), DK) << Record->isUnion();
5431           Invalid = true;
5432         }
5433       }
5434     }
5435 
5436     // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
5437     //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
5438     //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
5439     if (cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record)->hasInClassInitializer() &&
5440         Owner->isRecord())
5441       checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Owner),
5442                                 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record));
5443   }
5444 
5445   if (!Record->isUnion() && !Owner->isRecord()) {
5446     Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_anonymous_struct_not_member)
5447       << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
5448     Invalid = true;
5449   }
5450 
5451   // C++ [dcl.dcl]p3:
5452   //   [If there are no declarators], and except for the declaration of an
5453   //   unnamed bit-field, the decl-specifier-seq shall introduce one or more
5454   //   names into the program
5455   // C++ [class.mem]p2:
5456   //   each such member-declaration shall either declare at least one member
5457   //   name of the class or declare at least one unnamed bit-field
5458   //
5459   // For C this is an error even for a named struct, and is diagnosed elsewhere.
5460   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Record->field_empty())
5461     Diag(DS.getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_no_declarators) << DS.getSourceRange();
5462 
5463   // Mock up a declarator.
5464   Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Member);
5465   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5466   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct/union");
5467 
5468   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct/union.
5469   NamedDecl *Anon = nullptr;
5470   if (RecordDecl *OwningClass = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Owner)) {
5471     Anon = FieldDecl::Create(
5472         Context, OwningClass, DS.getBeginLoc(), Record->getLocation(),
5473         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo,
5474         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5475         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5476     Anon->setAccess(AS);
5477     ProcessDeclAttributes(S, Anon, Dc);
5478 
5479     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
5480       FieldCollector->Add(cast<FieldDecl>(Anon));
5481   } else {
5482     DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = DS.getStorageClassSpec();
5483     StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(DS);
5484     if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
5485       // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
5486       // an error here
5487       Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
5488       Invalid = true;
5489       SC = SC_None;
5490     }
5491 
5492     assert(DS.getAttributes().empty() && "No attribute expected");
5493     Anon = VarDecl::Create(Context, Owner, DS.getBeginLoc(),
5494                            Record->getLocation(), /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr,
5495                            Context.getTypeDeclType(Record), TInfo, SC);
5496 
5497     // Default-initialize the implicit variable. This initialization will be
5498     // trivial in almost all cases, except if a union member has an in-class
5499     // initializer:
5500     //   union { int n = 0; };
5501     ActOnUninitializedDecl(Anon);
5502   }
5503   Anon->setImplicit();
5504 
5505   // Mark this as an anonymous struct/union type.
5506   Record->setAnonymousStructOrUnion(true);
5507 
5508   // Add the anonymous struct/union object to the current
5509   // context. We'll be referencing this object when we refer to one of
5510   // its members.
5511   Owner->addDecl(Anon);
5512 
5513   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct/union into the owning
5514   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5515   // purposes.
5516   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5517   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5518 
5519   if (InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, Owner, Record, AS, Chain))
5520     Invalid = true;
5521 
5522   if (VarDecl *NewVD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Anon)) {
5523     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
5524       MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
5525       Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
5526       std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
5527           getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
5528       if (MCtx) {
5529         Context.setManglingNumber(
5530             NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
5531                        NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
5532         Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
5533       }
5534     }
5535   }
5536 
5537   if (Invalid)
5538     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5539 
5540   return Anon;
5541 }
5542 
5543 /// BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct - Handle the declaration of an
5544 /// Microsoft C anonymous structure.
5545 /// Ref: http://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/z2cx9y4f.aspx
5546 /// Example:
5547 ///
5548 /// struct A { int a; };
5549 /// struct B { struct A; int b; };
5550 ///
5551 /// void foo() {
5552 ///   B var;
5553 ///   var.a = 3;
5554 /// }
5555 ///
5556 Decl *Sema::BuildMicrosoftCAnonymousStruct(Scope *S, DeclSpec &DS,
5557                                            RecordDecl *Record) {
5558   assert(Record && "expected a record!");
5559 
5560   // Mock up a declarator.
5561   Declarator Dc(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::TypeName);
5562   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(Dc, S);
5563   assert(TInfo && "couldn't build declarator info for anonymous struct");
5564 
5565   auto *ParentDecl = cast<RecordDecl>(CurContext);
5566   QualType RecTy = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
5567 
5568   // Create a declaration for this anonymous struct.
5569   NamedDecl *Anon =
5570       FieldDecl::Create(Context, ParentDecl, DS.getBeginLoc(), DS.getBeginLoc(),
5571                         /*IdentifierInfo=*/nullptr, RecTy, TInfo,
5572                         /*BitWidth=*/nullptr, /*Mutable=*/false,
5573                         /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit);
5574   Anon->setImplicit();
5575 
5576   // Add the anonymous struct object to the current context.
5577   CurContext->addDecl(Anon);
5578 
5579   // Inject the members of the anonymous struct into the current
5580   // context and into the identifier resolver chain for name lookup
5581   // purposes.
5582   SmallVector<NamedDecl*, 2> Chain;
5583   Chain.push_back(Anon);
5584 
5585   RecordDecl *RecordDef = Record->getDefinition();
5586   if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Anon->getLocation(), RecTy,
5587                                diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless) ||
5588       InjectAnonymousStructOrUnionMembers(*this, S, CurContext, RecordDef,
5589                                           AS_none, Chain)) {
5590     Anon->setInvalidDecl();
5591     ParentDecl->setInvalidDecl();
5592   }
5593 
5594   return Anon;
5595 }
5596 
5597 /// GetNameForDeclarator - Determine the full declaration name for the
5598 /// given Declarator.
5599 DeclarationNameInfo Sema::GetNameForDeclarator(Declarator &D) {
5600   return GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(D.getName());
5601 }
5602 
5603 /// Retrieves the declaration name from a parsed unqualified-id.
5604 DeclarationNameInfo
5605 Sema::GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Name) {
5606   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
5607   NameInfo.setLoc(Name.StartLocation);
5608 
5609   switch (Name.getKind()) {
5610 
5611   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
5612   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
5613     NameInfo.setName(Name.Identifier);
5614     return NameInfo;
5615 
5616   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName: {
5617     // C++ [temp.deduct.guide]p3:
5618     //   The simple-template-id shall name a class template specialization.
5619     //   The template-name shall be the same identifier as the template-name
5620     //   of the simple-template-id.
5621     // These together intend to imply that the template-name shall name a
5622     // class template.
5623     // FIXME: template<typename T> struct X {};
5624     //        template<typename T> using Y = X<T>;
5625     //        Y(int) -> Y<int>;
5626     //   satisfies these rules but does not name a class template.
5627     TemplateName TN = Name.TemplateName.get().get();
5628     auto *Template = TN.getAsTemplateDecl();
5629     if (!Template || !isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(Template)) {
5630       Diag(Name.StartLocation,
5631            diag::err_deduction_guide_name_not_class_template)
5632         << (int)getTemplateNameKindForDiagnostics(TN) << TN;
5633       if (Template)
5634         Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
5635       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5636     }
5637 
5638     NameInfo.setName(
5639         Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDeductionGuideName(Template));
5640     return NameInfo;
5641   }
5642 
5643   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
5644     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(
5645                                            Name.OperatorFunctionId.Operator));
5646     NameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(
5647         Name.OperatorFunctionId.SymbolLocations[0], Name.EndLocation));
5648     return NameInfo;
5649 
5650   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
5651     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(
5652                                                            Name.Identifier));
5653     NameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(Name.EndLocation);
5654     return NameInfo;
5655 
5656   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId: {
5657     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5658     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConversionFunctionId, &TInfo);
5659     if (Ty.isNull())
5660       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5661     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConversionFunctionName(
5662                                                Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5663     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5664     return NameInfo;
5665   }
5666 
5667   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName: {
5668     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5669     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.ConstructorName, &TInfo);
5670     if (Ty.isNull())
5671       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5672     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5673                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5674     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5675     return NameInfo;
5676   }
5677 
5678   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId: {
5679     // In well-formed code, we can only have a constructor
5680     // template-id that refers to the current context, so go there
5681     // to find the actual type being constructed.
5682     CXXRecordDecl *CurClass = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext);
5683     if (!CurClass || CurClass->getIdentifier() != Name.TemplateId->Name)
5684       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5685 
5686     // Determine the type of the class being constructed.
5687     QualType CurClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(CurClass);
5688 
5689     // FIXME: Check two things: that the template-id names the same type as
5690     // CurClassType, and that the template-id does not occur when the name
5691     // was qualified.
5692 
5693     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXConstructorName(
5694                                     Context.getCanonicalType(CurClassType)));
5695     // FIXME: should we retrieve TypeSourceInfo?
5696     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(nullptr);
5697     return NameInfo;
5698   }
5699 
5700   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName: {
5701     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
5702     QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Name.DestructorName, &TInfo);
5703     if (Ty.isNull())
5704       return DeclarationNameInfo();
5705     NameInfo.setName(Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
5706                                               Context.getCanonicalType(Ty)));
5707     NameInfo.setNamedTypeInfo(TInfo);
5708     return NameInfo;
5709   }
5710 
5711   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId: {
5712     TemplateName TName = Name.TemplateId->Template.get();
5713     SourceLocation TNameLoc = Name.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
5714     return Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
5715   }
5716 
5717   } // switch (Name.getKind())
5718 
5719   llvm_unreachable("Unknown name kind");
5720 }
5721 
5722 static QualType getCoreType(QualType Ty) {
5723   do {
5724     if (Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isReferenceType())
5725       Ty = Ty->getPointeeType();
5726     else if (Ty->isArrayType())
5727       Ty = Ty->castAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType();
5728     else
5729       return Ty.withoutLocalFastQualifiers();
5730   } while (true);
5731 }
5732 
5733 /// hasSimilarParameters - Determine whether the C++ functions Declaration
5734 /// and Definition have "nearly" matching parameters. This heuristic is
5735 /// used to improve diagnostics in the case where an out-of-line function
5736 /// definition doesn't match any declaration within the class or namespace.
5737 /// Also sets Params to the list of indices to the parameters that differ
5738 /// between the declaration and the definition. If hasSimilarParameters
5739 /// returns true and Params is empty, then all of the parameters match.
5740 static bool hasSimilarParameters(ASTContext &Context,
5741                                      FunctionDecl *Declaration,
5742                                      FunctionDecl *Definition,
5743                                      SmallVectorImpl<unsigned> &Params) {
5744   Params.clear();
5745   if (Declaration->param_size() != Definition->param_size())
5746     return false;
5747   for (unsigned Idx = 0; Idx < Declaration->param_size(); ++Idx) {
5748     QualType DeclParamTy = Declaration->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5749     QualType DefParamTy = Definition->getParamDecl(Idx)->getType();
5750 
5751     // The parameter types are identical
5752     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DefParamTy, DeclParamTy))
5753       continue;
5754 
5755     QualType DeclParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DeclParamTy);
5756     QualType DefParamBaseTy = getCoreType(DefParamTy);
5757     const IdentifierInfo *DeclTyName = DeclParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5758     const IdentifierInfo *DefTyName = DefParamBaseTy.getBaseTypeIdentifier();
5759 
5760     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DeclParamBaseTy, DefParamBaseTy) ||
5761         (DeclTyName && DeclTyName == DefTyName))
5762       Params.push_back(Idx);
5763     else  // The two parameters aren't even close
5764       return false;
5765   }
5766 
5767   return true;
5768 }
5769 
5770 /// RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation - Checks whether the given
5771 /// declarator needs to be rebuilt in the current instantiation.
5772 /// Any bits of declarator which appear before the name are valid for
5773 /// consideration here.  That's specifically the type in the decl spec
5774 /// and the base type in any member-pointer chunks.
5775 static bool RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(Sema &S, Declarator &D,
5776                                                     DeclarationName Name) {
5777   // The types we specifically need to rebuild are:
5778   //   - typenames, typeofs, and decltypes
5779   //   - types which will become injected class names
5780   // Of course, we also need to rebuild any type referencing such a
5781   // type.  It's safest to just say "dependent", but we call out a
5782   // few cases here.
5783 
5784   DeclSpec &DS = D.getMutableDeclSpec();
5785   switch (DS.getTypeSpecType()) {
5786   case DeclSpec::TST_typename:
5787   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofType:
5788   case DeclSpec::TST_underlyingType:
5789   case DeclSpec::TST_atomic: {
5790     // Grab the type from the parser.
5791     TypeSourceInfo *TSI = nullptr;
5792     QualType T = S.GetTypeFromParser(DS.getRepAsType(), &TSI);
5793     if (T.isNull() || !T->isInstantiationDependentType()) break;
5794 
5795     // Make sure there's a type source info.  This isn't really much
5796     // of a waste; most dependent types should have type source info
5797     // attached already.
5798     if (!TSI)
5799       TSI = S.Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, DS.getTypeSpecTypeLoc());
5800 
5801     // Rebuild the type in the current instantiation.
5802     TSI = S.RebuildTypeInCurrentInstantiation(TSI, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name);
5803     if (!TSI) return true;
5804 
5805     // Store the new type back in the decl spec.
5806     ParsedType LocType = S.CreateParsedType(TSI->getType(), TSI);
5807     DS.UpdateTypeRep(LocType);
5808     break;
5809   }
5810 
5811   case DeclSpec::TST_decltype:
5812   case DeclSpec::TST_typeofExpr: {
5813     Expr *E = DS.getRepAsExpr();
5814     ExprResult Result = S.RebuildExprInCurrentInstantiation(E);
5815     if (Result.isInvalid()) return true;
5816     DS.UpdateExprRep(Result.get());
5817     break;
5818   }
5819 
5820   default:
5821     // Nothing to do for these decl specs.
5822     break;
5823   }
5824 
5825   // It doesn't matter what order we do this in.
5826   for (unsigned I = 0, E = D.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
5827     DeclaratorChunk &Chunk = D.getTypeObject(I);
5828 
5829     // The only type information in the declarator which can come
5830     // before the declaration name is the base type of a member
5831     // pointer.
5832     if (Chunk.Kind != DeclaratorChunk::MemberPointer)
5833       continue;
5834 
5835     // Rebuild the scope specifier in-place.
5836     CXXScopeSpec &SS = Chunk.Mem.Scope();
5837     if (S.RebuildNestedNameSpecifierInCurrentInstantiation(SS))
5838       return true;
5839   }
5840 
5841   return false;
5842 }
5843 
5844 /// Returns true if the declaration is declared in a system header or from a
5845 /// system macro.
5846 static bool isFromSystemHeader(SourceManager &SM, const Decl *D) {
5847   return SM.isInSystemHeader(D->getLocation()) ||
5848          SM.isInSystemMacro(D->getLocation());
5849 }
5850 
5851 void Sema::warnOnReservedIdentifier(const NamedDecl *D) {
5852   // Avoid warning twice on the same identifier, and don't warn on redeclaration
5853   // of system decl.
5854   if (D->getPreviousDecl() || D->isImplicit())
5855     return;
5856   ReservedIdentifierStatus Status = D->isReserved(getLangOpts());
5857   if (Status != ReservedIdentifierStatus::NotReserved &&
5858       !isFromSystemHeader(Context.getSourceManager(), D)) {
5859     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_reserved_extern_symbol)
5860         << D << static_cast<int>(Status);
5861   }
5862 }
5863 
5864 Decl *Sema::ActOnDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
5865   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration);
5866   Decl *Dcl = HandleDeclarator(S, D, MultiTemplateParamsArg());
5867 
5868   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer() &&
5869       Dcl && Dcl->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
5870     Dcl->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
5871 
5872   return Dcl;
5873 }
5874 
5875 /// DiagnoseClassNameShadow - Implement C++ [class.mem]p13:
5876 ///   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
5877 ///   name different from T:
5878 ///     - every static data member of class T;
5879 ///     - every member function of class T
5880 ///     - every member of class T that is itself a type;
5881 /// \returns true if the declaration name violates these rules.
5882 bool Sema::DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DeclContext *DC,
5883                                    DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo) {
5884   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
5885 
5886   CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
5887   while (Record && Record->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
5888     Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getParent());
5889   if (Record && Record->getIdentifier() && Record->getDeclName() == Name) {
5890     Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_member_name_of_class) << Name;
5891     return true;
5892   }
5893 
5894   return false;
5895 }
5896 
5897 /// Diagnose a declaration whose declarator-id has the given
5898 /// nested-name-specifier.
5899 ///
5900 /// \param SS The nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
5901 ///
5902 /// \param DC The declaration context to which the nested-name-specifier
5903 /// resolves.
5904 ///
5905 /// \param Name The name of the entity being declared.
5906 ///
5907 /// \param Loc The location of the name of the entity being declared.
5908 ///
5909 /// \param IsTemplateId Whether the name is a (simple-)template-id, and thus
5910 /// we're declaring an explicit / partial specialization / instantiation.
5911 ///
5912 /// \returns true if we cannot safely recover from this error, false otherwise.
5913 bool Sema::diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(CXXScopeSpec &SS, DeclContext *DC,
5914                                         DeclarationName Name,
5915                                         SourceLocation Loc, bool IsTemplateId) {
5916   DeclContext *Cur = CurContext;
5917   while (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(Cur) || isa<CapturedDecl>(Cur))
5918     Cur = Cur->getParent();
5919 
5920   // If the user provided a superfluous scope specifier that refers back to the
5921   // class in which the entity is already declared, diagnose and ignore it.
5922   //
5923   // class X {
5924   //   void X::f();
5925   // };
5926   //
5927   // Note, it was once ill-formed to give redundant qualification in all
5928   // contexts, but that rule was removed by DR482.
5929   if (Cur->Equals(DC)) {
5930     if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5931       Diag(Loc, LangOpts.MicrosoftExt ? diag::warn_member_extra_qualification
5932                                       : diag::err_member_extra_qualification)
5933         << Name << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(SS.getRange());
5934       SS.clear();
5935     } else {
5936       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_namespace_member_extra_qualification) << Name;
5937     }
5938     return false;
5939   }
5940 
5941   // Check whether the qualifying scope encloses the scope of the original
5942   // declaration. For a template-id, we perform the checks in
5943   // CheckTemplateSpecializationScope.
5944   if (!Cur->Encloses(DC) && !IsTemplateId) {
5945     if (Cur->isRecord())
5946       Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5947         << Name << SS.getRange();
5948     else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(DC))
5949       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_global_scope)
5950         << Name << SS.getRange();
5951     else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(Cur))
5952       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_function)
5953         << Name << SS.getRange();
5954     else if (isa<BlockDecl>(Cur))
5955       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_in_block)
5956         << Name << SS.getRange();
5957     else if (isa<ExportDecl>(Cur)) {
5958       if (!isa<NamespaceDecl>(DC))
5959         Diag(Loc, diag::err_export_non_namespace_scope_name)
5960             << Name << SS.getRange();
5961       else
5962         // The cases that DC is not NamespaceDecl should be handled in
5963         // CheckRedeclarationExported.
5964         return false;
5965     } else
5966       Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_declarator_scope)
5967       << Name << cast<NamedDecl>(Cur) << cast<NamedDecl>(DC) << SS.getRange();
5968 
5969     return true;
5970   }
5971 
5972   if (Cur->isRecord()) {
5973     // Cannot qualify members within a class.
5974     Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_qualification)
5975       << Name << SS.getRange();
5976     SS.clear();
5977 
5978     // C++ constructors and destructors with incorrect scopes can break
5979     // our AST invariants by having the wrong underlying types. If
5980     // that's the case, then drop this declaration entirely.
5981     if ((Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName ||
5982          Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) &&
5983         !Context.hasSameType(Name.getCXXNameType(),
5984                              Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cur))))
5985       return true;
5986 
5987     return false;
5988   }
5989 
5990   // C++11 [dcl.meaning]p1:
5991   //   [...] "The nested-name-specifier of the qualified declarator-id shall
5992   //   not begin with a decltype-specifer"
5993   NestedNameSpecifierLoc SpecLoc(SS.getScopeRep(), SS.location_data());
5994   while (SpecLoc.getPrefix())
5995     SpecLoc = SpecLoc.getPrefix();
5996   if (isa_and_nonnull<DecltypeType>(
5997           SpecLoc.getNestedNameSpecifier()->getAsType()))
5998     Diag(Loc, diag::err_decltype_in_declarator)
5999       << SpecLoc.getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
6000 
6001   return false;
6002 }
6003 
6004 NamedDecl *Sema::HandleDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
6005                                   MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists) {
6006   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
6007   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
6008   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
6009 
6010   // All of these full declarators require an identifier.  If it doesn't have
6011   // one, the ParsedFreeStandingDeclSpec action should be used.
6012   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
6013     return ActOnDecompositionDeclarator(S, D, TemplateParamLists);
6014   } else if (!Name) {
6015     if (!D.isInvalidType())  // Reject this if we think it is valid.
6016       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), diag::err_declarator_need_ident)
6017           << D.getDeclSpec().getSourceRange() << D.getSourceRange();
6018     return nullptr;
6019   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(NameInfo, UPPC_DeclarationType))
6020     return nullptr;
6021 
6022   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
6023   // we find one that is.
6024   while ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0 ||
6025          (S->getFlags() & Scope::TemplateParamScope) != 0)
6026     S = S->getParent();
6027 
6028   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
6029   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isInvalid())
6030     D.setInvalidType();
6031   else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6032     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
6033                                         UPPC_DeclarationQualifier))
6034       return nullptr;
6035 
6036     bool EnteringContext = !D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
6037     DC = computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), EnteringContext);
6038     if (!DC || isa<EnumDecl>(DC)) {
6039       // If we could not compute the declaration context, it's because the
6040       // declaration context is dependent but does not refer to a class,
6041       // class template, or class template partial specialization. Complain
6042       // and return early, to avoid the coming semantic disaster.
6043       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6044            diag::err_template_qualified_declarator_no_match)
6045         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()
6046         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6047       return nullptr;
6048     }
6049     bool IsDependentContext = DC->isDependentContext();
6050 
6051     if (!IsDependentContext &&
6052         RequireCompleteDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC))
6053       return nullptr;
6054 
6055     // If a class is incomplete, do not parse entities inside it.
6056     if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC) && !cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->hasDefinition()) {
6057       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6058            diag::err_member_def_undefined_record)
6059         << Name << DC << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6060       return nullptr;
6061     }
6062     if (!D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) {
6063       if (diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(
6064               D.getCXXScopeSpec(), DC, Name, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6065               D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId)) {
6066         if (DC->isRecord())
6067           return nullptr;
6068 
6069         D.setInvalidType();
6070       }
6071     }
6072 
6073     // Check whether we need to rebuild the type of the given
6074     // declaration in the current instantiation.
6075     if (EnteringContext && IsDependentContext &&
6076         TemplateParamLists.size() != 0) {
6077       ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
6078       if (RebuildDeclaratorInCurrentInstantiation(*this, D, Name))
6079         D.setInvalidType();
6080     }
6081   }
6082 
6083   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
6084   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
6085 
6086   if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
6087                                       UPPC_DeclarationType))
6088     D.setInvalidType();
6089 
6090   LookupResult Previous(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName,
6091                         forRedeclarationInCurContext());
6092 
6093   // See if this is a redefinition of a variable in the same scope.
6094   if (!D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6095     bool IsLinkageLookup = false;
6096     bool CreateBuiltins = false;
6097 
6098     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be a function
6099     // or object with linkage, then look for another declaration with
6100     // linkage (C99 6.2.2p4-5 and C++ [basic.link]p6).
6101     //
6102     // If the declaration we're planning to build will be declared with
6103     // external linkage in the translation unit, create any builtin with
6104     // the same name.
6105     if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef)
6106       /* Do nothing*/;
6107     else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod() &&
6108              (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_extern ||
6109               R->isFunctionType())) {
6110       IsLinkageLookup = true;
6111       CreateBuiltins =
6112           CurContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext()->isTranslationUnit();
6113     } else if (CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
6114                D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_static)
6115       CreateBuiltins = true;
6116 
6117     if (IsLinkageLookup) {
6118       Previous.clear(LookupRedeclarationWithLinkage);
6119       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(ForExternalRedeclaration);
6120     }
6121 
6122     LookupName(Previous, S, CreateBuiltins);
6123   } else { // Something like "int foo::x;"
6124     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
6125 
6126     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
6127     //   When the declarator-id is qualified, the declaration shall refer to a
6128     //  previously declared member of the class or namespace to which the
6129     //  qualifier refers (or, in the case of a namespace, of an element of the
6130     //  inline namespace set of that namespace (7.3.1)) or to a specialization
6131     //  thereof; [...]
6132     //
6133     // Note that we already checked the context above, and that we do not have
6134     // enough information to make sure that Previous contains the declaration
6135     // we want to match. For example, given:
6136     //
6137     //   class X {
6138     //     void f();
6139     //     void f(float);
6140     //   };
6141     //
6142     //   void X::f(int) { } // ill-formed
6143     //
6144     // In this case, Previous will point to the overload set
6145     // containing the two f's declared in X, but neither of them
6146     // matches.
6147 
6148     // C++ [dcl.meaning]p1:
6149     //   [...] the member shall not merely have been introduced by a
6150     //   using-declaration in the scope of the class or namespace nominated by
6151     //   the nested-name-specifier of the declarator-id.
6152     RemoveUsingDecls(Previous);
6153   }
6154 
6155   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
6156       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
6157     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
6158     if (!D.isInvalidType())
6159       DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
6160                                       Previous.getFoundDecl());
6161 
6162     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
6163     Previous.clear();
6164   }
6165 
6166   if (!R->isFunctionType() && DiagnoseClassNameShadow(DC, NameInfo))
6167     // Forget that the previous declaration is the injected-class-name.
6168     Previous.clear();
6169 
6170   // In C++, the previous declaration we find might be a tag type
6171   // (class or enum). In this case, the new declaration will hide the
6172   // tag type. Note that this applies to functions, function templates, and
6173   // variables, but not to typedefs (C++ [dcl.typedef]p4) or variable templates.
6174   if (Previous.isSingleTagDecl() &&
6175       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_typedef &&
6176       (TemplateParamLists.size() == 0 || R->isFunctionType()))
6177     Previous.clear();
6178 
6179   // Check that there are no default arguments other than in the parameters
6180   // of a function declaration (C++ only).
6181   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
6182     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
6183 
6184   NamedDecl *New;
6185 
6186   bool AddToScope = true;
6187   if (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_typedef) {
6188     if (TemplateParamLists.size()) {
6189       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_typedef);
6190       return nullptr;
6191     }
6192 
6193     New = ActOnTypedefDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous);
6194   } else if (R->isFunctionType()) {
6195     New = ActOnFunctionDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous,
6196                                   TemplateParamLists,
6197                                   AddToScope);
6198   } else {
6199     New = ActOnVariableDeclarator(S, D, DC, TInfo, Previous, TemplateParamLists,
6200                                   AddToScope);
6201   }
6202 
6203   if (!New)
6204     return nullptr;
6205 
6206   // If this has an identifier and is not a function template specialization,
6207   // add it to the scope stack.
6208   if (New->getDeclName() && AddToScope)
6209     PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
6210 
6211   if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext())
6212     checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(nullptr, New);
6213 
6214   return New;
6215 }
6216 
6217 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
6218 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6219 /// GCC compatibility).
6220 static QualType TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(QualType T,
6221                                                     ASTContext &Context,
6222                                                     bool &SizeIsNegative,
6223                                                     llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6224   // This method tries to turn a variable array into a constant
6225   // array even when the size isn't an ICE.  This is necessary
6226   // for compatibility with code that depends on gcc's buggy
6227   // constant expression folding, like struct {char x[(int)(char*)2];}
6228   SizeIsNegative = false;
6229   Oversized = 0;
6230 
6231   if (T->isDependentType())
6232     return QualType();
6233 
6234   QualifierCollector Qs;
6235   const Type *Ty = Qs.strip(T);
6236 
6237   if (const PointerType* PTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Ty)) {
6238     QualType Pointee = PTy->getPointeeType();
6239     QualType FixedType =
6240         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Pointee, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6241                                             Oversized);
6242     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6243     FixedType = Context.getPointerType(FixedType);
6244     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6245   }
6246   if (const ParenType* PTy = dyn_cast<ParenType>(Ty)) {
6247     QualType Inner = PTy->getInnerType();
6248     QualType FixedType =
6249         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(Inner, Context, SizeIsNegative,
6250                                             Oversized);
6251     if (FixedType.isNull()) return FixedType;
6252     FixedType = Context.getParenType(FixedType);
6253     return Qs.apply(Context, FixedType);
6254   }
6255 
6256   const VariableArrayType* VLATy = dyn_cast<VariableArrayType>(T);
6257   if (!VLATy)
6258     return QualType();
6259 
6260   QualType ElemTy = VLATy->getElementType();
6261   if (ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6262     ElemTy = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(ElemTy, Context,
6263                                                  SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6264     if (ElemTy.isNull())
6265       return QualType();
6266   }
6267 
6268   Expr::EvalResult Result;
6269   if (!VLATy->getSizeExpr() ||
6270       !VLATy->getSizeExpr()->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context))
6271     return QualType();
6272 
6273   llvm::APSInt Res = Result.Val.getInt();
6274 
6275   // Check whether the array size is negative.
6276   if (Res.isSigned() && Res.isNegative()) {
6277     SizeIsNegative = true;
6278     return QualType();
6279   }
6280 
6281   // Check whether the array is too large to be addressed.
6282   unsigned ActiveSizeBits =
6283       (!ElemTy->isDependentType() && !ElemTy->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
6284        !ElemTy->isIncompleteType() && !ElemTy->isUndeducedType())
6285           ? ConstantArrayType::getNumAddressingBits(Context, ElemTy, Res)
6286           : Res.getActiveBits();
6287   if (ActiveSizeBits > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
6288     Oversized = Res;
6289     return QualType();
6290   }
6291 
6292   QualType FoldedArrayType = Context.getConstantArrayType(
6293       ElemTy, Res, VLATy->getSizeExpr(), ArrayType::Normal, 0);
6294   return Qs.apply(Context, FoldedArrayType);
6295 }
6296 
6297 static void
6298 FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TypeLoc SrcTL, TypeLoc DstTL) {
6299   SrcTL = SrcTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6300   DstTL = DstTL.getUnqualifiedLoc();
6301   if (PointerTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<PointerTypeLoc>()) {
6302     PointerTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<PointerTypeLoc>();
6303     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getPointeeLoc(),
6304                                       DstPTL.getPointeeLoc());
6305     DstPTL.setStarLoc(SrcPTL.getStarLoc());
6306     return;
6307   }
6308   if (ParenTypeLoc SrcPTL = SrcTL.getAs<ParenTypeLoc>()) {
6309     ParenTypeLoc DstPTL = DstTL.castAs<ParenTypeLoc>();
6310     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcPTL.getInnerLoc(),
6311                                       DstPTL.getInnerLoc());
6312     DstPTL.setLParenLoc(SrcPTL.getLParenLoc());
6313     DstPTL.setRParenLoc(SrcPTL.getRParenLoc());
6314     return;
6315   }
6316   ArrayTypeLoc SrcATL = SrcTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6317   ArrayTypeLoc DstATL = DstTL.castAs<ArrayTypeLoc>();
6318   TypeLoc SrcElemTL = SrcATL.getElementLoc();
6319   TypeLoc DstElemTL = DstATL.getElementLoc();
6320   if (VariableArrayTypeLoc SrcElemATL =
6321           SrcElemTL.getAs<VariableArrayTypeLoc>()) {
6322     ConstantArrayTypeLoc DstElemATL = DstElemTL.castAs<ConstantArrayTypeLoc>();
6323     FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(SrcElemATL, DstElemATL);
6324   } else {
6325     DstElemTL.initializeFullCopy(SrcElemTL);
6326   }
6327   DstATL.setLBracketLoc(SrcATL.getLBracketLoc());
6328   DstATL.setSizeExpr(SrcATL.getSizeExpr());
6329   DstATL.setRBracketLoc(SrcATL.getRBracketLoc());
6330 }
6331 
6332 /// Helper method to turn variable array types into constant array
6333 /// types in certain situations which would otherwise be errors (for
6334 /// GCC compatibility).
6335 static TypeSourceInfo*
6336 TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
6337                                               ASTContext &Context,
6338                                               bool &SizeIsNegative,
6339                                               llvm::APSInt &Oversized) {
6340   QualType FixedTy
6341     = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(TInfo->getType(), Context,
6342                                           SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6343   if (FixedTy.isNull())
6344     return nullptr;
6345   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(FixedTy);
6346   FixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeLoc(TInfo->getTypeLoc(),
6347                                     FixedTInfo->getTypeLoc());
6348   return FixedTInfo;
6349 }
6350 
6351 /// Attempt to fold a variable-sized type to a constant-sized type, returning
6352 /// true if we were successful.
6353 bool Sema::tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TypeSourceInfo *&TInfo,
6354                                            QualType &T, SourceLocation Loc,
6355                                            unsigned FailedFoldDiagID) {
6356   bool SizeIsNegative;
6357   llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6358   TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
6359       TInfo, Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
6360   if (FixedTInfo) {
6361     Diag(Loc, diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6362     TInfo = FixedTInfo;
6363     T = FixedTInfo->getType();
6364     return true;
6365   }
6366 
6367   if (SizeIsNegative)
6368     Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6369   else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6370     Diag(Loc, diag::err_array_too_large) << toString(Oversized, 10);
6371   else if (FailedFoldDiagID)
6372     Diag(Loc, FailedFoldDiagID);
6373   return false;
6374 }
6375 
6376 /// Register the given locally-scoped extern "C" declaration so
6377 /// that it can be found later for redeclarations. We include any extern "C"
6378 /// declaration that is not visible in the translation unit here, not just
6379 /// function-scope declarations.
6380 void
6381 Sema::RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S) {
6382   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
6383       ND->getLexicalDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
6384     // Don't need to track declarations in the TU in C.
6385     return;
6386 
6387   // Note that we have a locally-scoped external with this name.
6388   Context.getExternCContextDecl()->makeDeclVisibleInContext(ND);
6389 }
6390 
6391 NamedDecl *Sema::findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(DeclarationName Name) {
6392   // FIXME: We can have multiple results via __attribute__((overloadable)).
6393   auto Result = Context.getExternCContextDecl()->lookup(Name);
6394   return Result.empty() ? nullptr : *Result.begin();
6395 }
6396 
6397 /// Diagnose function specifiers on a declaration of an identifier that
6398 /// does not identify a function.
6399 void Sema::DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(const DeclSpec &DS) {
6400   // FIXME: We should probably indicate the identifier in question to avoid
6401   // confusion for constructs like "virtual int a(), b;"
6402   if (DS.isVirtualSpecified())
6403     Diag(DS.getVirtualSpecLoc(),
6404          diag::err_virtual_non_function);
6405 
6406   if (DS.hasExplicitSpecifier())
6407     Diag(DS.getExplicitSpecLoc(),
6408          diag::err_explicit_non_function);
6409 
6410   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified())
6411     Diag(DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
6412          diag::err_noreturn_non_function);
6413 }
6414 
6415 NamedDecl*
6416 Sema::ActOnTypedefDeclarator(Scope* S, Declarator& D, DeclContext* DC,
6417                              TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous) {
6418   // Typedef declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
6419   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
6420     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_typedef_declarator)
6421       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
6422     D.setInvalidType();
6423     // Pretend we didn't see the scope specifier.
6424     DC = CurContext;
6425     Previous.clear();
6426   }
6427 
6428   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
6429 
6430   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
6431     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
6432         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
6433   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
6434     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
6435         << 1 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
6436 
6437   if (D.getName().Kind != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier) {
6438     if (D.getName().Kind == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName)
6439       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation,
6440            diag::err_deduction_guide_invalid_specifier)
6441           << "typedef";
6442     else
6443       Diag(D.getName().StartLocation, diag::err_typedef_not_identifier)
6444           << D.getName().getSourceRange();
6445     return nullptr;
6446   }
6447 
6448   TypedefDecl *NewTD = ParseTypedefDecl(S, D, TInfo->getType(), TInfo);
6449   if (!NewTD) return nullptr;
6450 
6451   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
6452   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewTD, D);
6453 
6454   CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(S, NewTD);
6455 
6456   bool Redeclaration = D.isRedeclaration();
6457   NamedDecl *ND = ActOnTypedefNameDecl(S, DC, NewTD, Previous, Redeclaration);
6458   D.setRedeclaration(Redeclaration);
6459   return ND;
6460 }
6461 
6462 void
6463 Sema::CheckTypedefForVariablyModifiedType(Scope *S, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD) {
6464   // C99 6.7.7p2: If a typedef name specifies a variably modified type
6465   // then it shall have block scope.
6466   // Note that variably modified types must be fixed before merging the decl so
6467   // that redeclarations will match.
6468   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = NewTD->getTypeSourceInfo();
6469   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
6470   if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
6471     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
6472 
6473     if (S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
6474       bool SizeIsNegative;
6475       llvm::APSInt Oversized;
6476       TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo =
6477         TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(TInfo, Context,
6478                                                       SizeIsNegative,
6479                                                       Oversized);
6480       if (FixedTInfo) {
6481         Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
6482         NewTD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
6483       } else {
6484         if (SizeIsNegative)
6485           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_negative_array_size);
6486         else if (T->isVariableArrayType())
6487           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope);
6488         else if (Oversized.getBoolValue())
6489           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_array_too_large)
6490             << toString(Oversized, 10);
6491         else
6492           Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
6493         NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
6494       }
6495     }
6496   }
6497 }
6498 
6499 /// ActOnTypedefNameDecl - Perform semantic checking for a declaration which
6500 /// declares a typedef-name, either using the 'typedef' type specifier or via
6501 /// a C++0x [dcl.typedef]p2 alias-declaration: 'using T = A;'.
6502 NamedDecl*
6503 Sema::ActOnTypedefNameDecl(Scope *S, DeclContext *DC, TypedefNameDecl *NewTD,
6504                            LookupResult &Previous, bool &Redeclaration) {
6505 
6506   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
6507   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(NewTD, Previous);
6508 
6509   // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate. If the decl is
6510   // in an outer scope, it isn't the same thing.
6511   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, DC, S, /*ConsiderLinkage*/false,
6512                        /*AllowInlineNamespace*/false);
6513   filterNonConflictingPreviousTypedefDecls(*this, NewTD, Previous);
6514   if (!Previous.empty()) {
6515     Redeclaration = true;
6516     MergeTypedefNameDecl(S, NewTD, Previous);
6517   } else {
6518     inferGslPointerAttribute(NewTD);
6519   }
6520 
6521   if (ShadowedDecl && !Redeclaration)
6522     CheckShadow(NewTD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
6523 
6524   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
6525   if (IdentifierInfo *II = NewTD->getIdentifier())
6526     if (!NewTD->isInvalidDecl() &&
6527         NewTD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
6528       if (II->isStr("FILE"))
6529         Context.setFILEDecl(NewTD);
6530       else if (II->isStr("jmp_buf"))
6531         Context.setjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6532       else if (II->isStr("sigjmp_buf"))
6533         Context.setsigjmp_bufDecl(NewTD);
6534       else if (II->isStr("ucontext_t"))
6535         Context.setucontext_tDecl(NewTD);
6536     }
6537 
6538   return NewTD;
6539 }
6540 
6541 /// Determines whether the given declaration is an out-of-scope
6542 /// previous declaration.
6543 ///
6544 /// This routine should be invoked when name lookup has found a
6545 /// previous declaration (PrevDecl) that is not in the scope where a
6546 /// new declaration by the same name is being introduced. If the new
6547 /// declaration occurs in a local scope, previous declarations with
6548 /// linkage may still be considered previous declarations (C99
6549 /// 6.2.2p4-5, C++ [basic.link]p6).
6550 ///
6551 /// \param PrevDecl the previous declaration found by name
6552 /// lookup
6553 ///
6554 /// \param DC the context in which the new declaration is being
6555 /// declared.
6556 ///
6557 /// \returns true if PrevDecl is an out-of-scope previous declaration
6558 /// for a new delcaration with the same name.
6559 static bool
6560 isOutOfScopePreviousDeclaration(NamedDecl *PrevDecl, DeclContext *DC,
6561                                 ASTContext &Context) {
6562   if (!PrevDecl)
6563     return false;
6564 
6565   if (!PrevDecl->hasLinkage())
6566     return false;
6567 
6568   if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6569     // C++ [basic.link]p6:
6570     //   If there is a visible declaration of an entity with linkage
6571     //   having the same name and type, ignoring entities declared
6572     //   outside the innermost enclosing namespace scope, the block
6573     //   scope declaration declares that same entity and receives the
6574     //   linkage of the previous declaration.
6575     DeclContext *OuterContext = DC->getRedeclContext();
6576     if (!OuterContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
6577       // This rule only applies to block-scope declarations.
6578       return false;
6579 
6580     DeclContext *PrevOuterContext = PrevDecl->getDeclContext();
6581     if (PrevOuterContext->isRecord())
6582       // We found a member function: ignore it.
6583       return false;
6584 
6585     // Find the innermost enclosing namespace for the new and
6586     // previous declarations.
6587     OuterContext = OuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6588     PrevOuterContext = PrevOuterContext->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
6589 
6590     // The previous declaration is in a different namespace, so it
6591     // isn't the same function.
6592     if (!OuterContext->Equals(PrevOuterContext))
6593       return false;
6594   }
6595 
6596   return true;
6597 }
6598 
6599 static void SetNestedNameSpecifier(Sema &S, DeclaratorDecl *DD, Declarator &D) {
6600   CXXScopeSpec &SS = D.getCXXScopeSpec();
6601   if (!SS.isSet()) return;
6602   DD->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(S.Context));
6603 }
6604 
6605 bool Sema::inferObjCARCLifetime(ValueDecl *decl) {
6606   QualType type = decl->getType();
6607   Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime = type.getObjCLifetime();
6608   if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) {
6609     // Various kinds of declaration aren't allowed to be __autoreleasing.
6610     unsigned kind = -1U;
6611     if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6612       if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
6613         kind = 0; // __block
6614       else if (!var->hasLocalStorage())
6615         kind = 1; // global
6616     } else if (isa<ObjCIvarDecl>(decl)) {
6617       kind = 3; // ivar
6618     } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(decl)) {
6619       kind = 2; // field
6620     }
6621 
6622     if (kind != -1U) {
6623       Diag(decl->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_var)
6624         << kind;
6625     }
6626   } else if (lifetime == Qualifiers::OCL_None) {
6627     // Try to infer lifetime.
6628     if (!type->isObjCLifetimeType())
6629       return false;
6630 
6631     lifetime = type->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
6632     type = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(type, lifetime);
6633     decl->setType(type);
6634   }
6635 
6636   if (VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(decl)) {
6637     // Thread-local variables cannot have lifetime.
6638     if (lifetime && lifetime != Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone &&
6639         var->getTLSKind()) {
6640       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_arc_thread_ownership)
6641         << var->getType();
6642       return true;
6643     }
6644   }
6645 
6646   return false;
6647 }
6648 
6649 void Sema::deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(ValueDecl *Decl) {
6650   if (Decl->getType().hasAddressSpace())
6651     return;
6652   if (Decl->getType()->isDependentType())
6653     return;
6654   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
6655     QualType Type = Var->getType();
6656     if (Type->isSamplerT() || Type->isVoidType())
6657       return;
6658     LangAS ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_private;
6659     // OpenCL C v3.0 s6.7.8 - For OpenCL C 2.0 or with the
6660     // __opencl_c_program_scope_global_variables feature, the address space
6661     // for a variable at program scope or a static or extern variable inside
6662     // a function are inferred to be __global.
6663     if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()) &&
6664         Var->hasGlobalStorage())
6665       ImplAS = LangAS::opencl_global;
6666     // If the original type from a decayed type is an array type and that array
6667     // type has no address space yet, deduce it now.
6668     if (auto DT = dyn_cast<DecayedType>(Type)) {
6669       auto OrigTy = DT->getOriginalType();
6670       if (!OrigTy.hasAddressSpace() && OrigTy->isArrayType()) {
6671         // Add the address space to the original array type and then propagate
6672         // that to the element type through `getAsArrayType`.
6673         OrigTy = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(OrigTy, ImplAS);
6674         OrigTy = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy), 0);
6675         // Re-generate the decayed type.
6676         Type = Context.getDecayedType(OrigTy);
6677       }
6678     }
6679     Type = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(Type, ImplAS);
6680     // Apply any qualifiers (including address space) from the array type to
6681     // the element type. This implements C99 6.7.3p8: "If the specification of
6682     // an array type includes any type qualifiers, the element type is so
6683     // qualified, not the array type."
6684     if (Type->isArrayType())
6685       Type = QualType(Context.getAsArrayType(Type), 0);
6686     Decl->setType(Type);
6687   }
6688 }
6689 
6690 static void checkAttributesAfterMerging(Sema &S, NamedDecl &ND) {
6691   // Ensure that an auto decl is deduced otherwise the checks below might cache
6692   // the wrong linkage.
6693   assert(S.ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(&ND) == 0);
6694 
6695   // 'weak' only applies to declarations with external linkage.
6696   if (WeakAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakAttr>()) {
6697     if (!ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6698       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weak_static);
6699       ND.dropAttr<WeakAttr>();
6700     }
6701   }
6702   if (WeakRefAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<WeakRefAttr>()) {
6703     if (ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6704       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_weakref_not_static);
6705       ND.dropAttr<WeakRefAttr>();
6706       ND.dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6707     }
6708   }
6709 
6710   if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND)) {
6711     if (VD->hasInit()) {
6712       if (const auto *Attr = VD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
6713         assert(VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
6714                !VD->isExternallyVisible() && "Broken AliasAttr handled late!");
6715         S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << VD << 0;
6716         VD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
6717       }
6718     }
6719   }
6720 
6721   // 'selectany' only applies to externally visible variable declarations.
6722   // It does not apply to functions.
6723   if (SelectAnyAttr *Attr = ND.getAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) {
6724     if (isa<FunctionDecl>(ND) || !ND.isExternallyVisible()) {
6725       S.Diag(Attr->getLocation(),
6726              diag::err_attribute_selectany_non_extern_data);
6727       ND.dropAttr<SelectAnyAttr>();
6728     }
6729   }
6730 
6731   if (const InheritableAttr *Attr = getDLLAttr(&ND)) {
6732     auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(&ND);
6733     bool IsAnonymousNS = false;
6734     bool IsMicrosoft = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft();
6735     if (VD) {
6736       const NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(VD->getDeclContext());
6737       while (NS && !IsAnonymousNS) {
6738         IsAnonymousNS = NS->isAnonymousNamespace();
6739         NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(NS->getParent());
6740       }
6741     }
6742     // dll attributes require external linkage. Static locals may have external
6743     // linkage but still cannot be explicitly imported or exported.
6744     // In Microsoft mode, a variable defined in anonymous namespace must have
6745     // external linkage in order to be exported.
6746     bool AnonNSInMicrosoftMode = IsAnonymousNS && IsMicrosoft;
6747     if ((ND.isExternallyVisible() && AnonNSInMicrosoftMode) ||
6748         (!AnonNSInMicrosoftMode &&
6749          (!ND.isExternallyVisible() || (VD && VD->isStaticLocal())))) {
6750       S.Diag(ND.getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_not_extern)
6751         << &ND << Attr;
6752       ND.setInvalidDecl();
6753     }
6754   }
6755 
6756   // Check the attributes on the function type, if any.
6757   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(&ND)) {
6758     // Don't declare this variable in the second operand of the for-statement;
6759     // GCC miscompiles that by ending its lifetime before evaluating the
6760     // third operand. See gcc.gnu.org/PR86769.
6761     AttributedTypeLoc ATL;
6762     for (TypeLoc TL = FD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc();
6763          (ATL = TL.getAsAdjusted<AttributedTypeLoc>());
6764          TL = ATL.getModifiedLoc()) {
6765       // The [[lifetimebound]] attribute can be applied to the implicit object
6766       // parameter of a non-static member function (other than a ctor or dtor)
6767       // by applying it to the function type.
6768       if (const auto *A = ATL.getAttrAs<LifetimeBoundAttr>()) {
6769         const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
6770         if (!MD || MD->isStatic()) {
6771           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_no_object_param)
6772               << !MD << A->getRange();
6773         } else if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) || isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) {
6774           S.Diag(A->getLocation(), diag::err_lifetimebound_ctor_dtor)
6775               << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) << A->getRange();
6776         }
6777       }
6778     }
6779   }
6780 }
6781 
6782 static void checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(Sema &S, NamedDecl *OldDecl,
6783                                            NamedDecl *NewDecl,
6784                                            bool IsSpecialization,
6785                                            bool IsDefinition) {
6786   if (OldDecl->isInvalidDecl() || NewDecl->isInvalidDecl())
6787     return;
6788 
6789   bool IsTemplate = false;
6790   if (TemplateDecl *OldTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
6791     OldDecl = OldTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6792     IsTemplate = true;
6793     if (!IsSpecialization)
6794       IsDefinition = false;
6795   }
6796   if (TemplateDecl *NewTD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6797     NewDecl = NewTD->getTemplatedDecl();
6798     IsTemplate = true;
6799   }
6800 
6801   if (!OldDecl || !NewDecl)
6802     return;
6803 
6804   const DLLImportAttr *OldImportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6805   const DLLExportAttr *OldExportAttr = OldDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6806   const DLLImportAttr *NewImportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6807   const DLLExportAttr *NewExportAttr = NewDecl->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>();
6808 
6809   // dllimport and dllexport are inheritable attributes so we have to exclude
6810   // inherited attribute instances.
6811   bool HasNewAttr = (NewImportAttr && !NewImportAttr->isInherited()) ||
6812                     (NewExportAttr && !NewExportAttr->isInherited());
6813 
6814   // A redeclaration is not allowed to add a dllimport or dllexport attribute,
6815   // the only exception being explicit specializations.
6816   // Implicitly generated declarations are also excluded for now because there
6817   // is no other way to switch these to use dllimport or dllexport.
6818   bool AddsAttr = !(OldImportAttr || OldExportAttr) && HasNewAttr;
6819 
6820   if (AddsAttr && !IsSpecialization && !OldDecl->isImplicit()) {
6821     // Allow with a warning for free functions and global variables.
6822     bool JustWarn = false;
6823     if (!OldDecl->isCXXClassMember()) {
6824       auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(OldDecl);
6825       if (VD && !VD->getDescribedVarTemplate())
6826         JustWarn = true;
6827       auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
6828       if (FD && FD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_NonTemplate)
6829         JustWarn = true;
6830     }
6831 
6832     // We cannot change a declaration that's been used because IR has already
6833     // been emitted. Dllimported functions will still work though (modulo
6834     // address equality) as they can use the thunk.
6835     if (OldDecl->isUsed())
6836       if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl) || !NewImportAttr)
6837         JustWarn = false;
6838 
6839     unsigned DiagID = JustWarn ? diag::warn_attribute_dll_redeclaration
6840                                : diag::err_attribute_dll_redeclaration;
6841     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(), DiagID)
6842         << NewDecl
6843         << (NewImportAttr ? (const Attr *)NewImportAttr : NewExportAttr);
6844     S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6845     if (!JustWarn) {
6846       NewDecl->setInvalidDecl();
6847       return;
6848     }
6849   }
6850 
6851   // A redeclaration is not allowed to drop a dllimport attribute, the only
6852   // exceptions being inline function definitions (except for function
6853   // templates), local extern declarations, qualified friend declarations or
6854   // special MSVC extension: in the last case, the declaration is treated as if
6855   // it were marked dllexport.
6856   bool IsInline = false, IsStaticDataMember = false, IsQualifiedFriend = false;
6857   bool IsMicrosoftABI  = S.Context.getTargetInfo().shouldDLLImportComdatSymbols();
6858   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6859     // Ignore static data because out-of-line definitions are diagnosed
6860     // separately.
6861     IsStaticDataMember = VD->isStaticDataMember();
6862     IsDefinition = VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition(S.Context) !=
6863                    VarDecl::DeclarationOnly;
6864   } else if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6865     IsInline = FD->isInlined();
6866     IsQualifiedFriend = FD->getQualifier() &&
6867                         FD->getFriendObjectKind() == Decl::FOK_Declared;
6868   }
6869 
6870   if (OldImportAttr && !HasNewAttr &&
6871       (!IsInline || (IsMicrosoftABI && IsTemplate)) && !IsStaticDataMember &&
6872       !NewDecl->isLocalExternDecl() && !IsQualifiedFriend) {
6873     if (IsMicrosoftABI && IsDefinition) {
6874       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6875              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_import_attribute)
6876           << NewDecl;
6877       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6878       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6879       NewDecl->addAttr(
6880           DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(S.Context, NewImportAttr->getRange()));
6881     } else {
6882       S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6883              diag::warn_redeclaration_without_attribute_prev_attribute_ignored)
6884           << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6885       S.Diag(OldDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
6886       S.Diag(OldImportAttr->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_attribute);
6887       OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6888       NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6889     }
6890   } else if (IsInline && OldImportAttr && !IsMicrosoftABI) {
6891     // In MinGW, seeing a function declared inline drops the dllimport
6892     // attribute.
6893     OldDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6894     NewDecl->dropAttr<DLLImportAttr>();
6895     S.Diag(NewDecl->getLocation(),
6896            diag::warn_dllimport_dropped_from_inline_function)
6897         << NewDecl << OldImportAttr;
6898   }
6899 
6900   // A specialization of a class template member function is processed here
6901   // since it's a redeclaration. If the parent class is dllexport, the
6902   // specialization inherits that attribute. This doesn't happen automatically
6903   // since the parent class isn't instantiated until later.
6904   if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDecl)) {
6905     if (MD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_MemberSpecialization &&
6906         !NewImportAttr && !NewExportAttr) {
6907       if (const DLLExportAttr *ParentExportAttr =
6908               MD->getParent()->getAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) {
6909         DLLExportAttr *NewAttr = ParentExportAttr->clone(S.Context);
6910         NewAttr->setInherited(true);
6911         NewDecl->addAttr(NewAttr);
6912       }
6913     }
6914   }
6915 }
6916 
6917 /// Given that we are within the definition of the given function,
6918 /// will that definition behave like C99's 'inline', where the
6919 /// definition is discarded except for optimization purposes?
6920 static bool isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) {
6921   // Try to avoid calling GetGVALinkageForFunction.
6922 
6923   // All cases of this require the 'inline' keyword.
6924   if (!FD->isInlined()) return false;
6925 
6926   // This is only possible in C++ with the gnu_inline attribute.
6927   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>())
6928     return false;
6929 
6930   // Okay, go ahead and call the relatively-more-expensive function.
6931   return S.Context.GetGVALinkageForFunction(FD) == GVA_AvailableExternally;
6932 }
6933 
6934 /// Determine whether a variable is extern "C" prior to attaching
6935 /// an initializer. We can't just call isExternC() here, because that
6936 /// will also compute and cache whether the declaration is externally
6937 /// visible, which might change when we attach the initializer.
6938 ///
6939 /// This can only be used if the declaration is known to not be a
6940 /// redeclaration of an internal linkage declaration.
6941 ///
6942 /// For instance:
6943 ///
6944 ///   auto x = []{};
6945 ///
6946 /// Attaching the initializer here makes this declaration not externally
6947 /// visible, because its type has internal linkage.
6948 ///
6949 /// FIXME: This is a hack.
6950 template<typename T>
6951 static bool isIncompleteDeclExternC(Sema &S, const T *D) {
6952   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6953     // In C++, the overloadable attribute negates the effects of extern "C".
6954     if (!D->isInExternCContext() || D->template hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>())
6955       return false;
6956 
6957     // So do CUDA's host/device attributes.
6958     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && (D->template hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
6959                                  D->template hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()))
6960       return false;
6961   }
6962   return D->isExternC();
6963 }
6964 
6965 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const VarDecl *VD) {
6966   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6967   if (DC->isFunctionOrMethod() || isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) ||
6968       isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6969     return VD->hasExternalStorage();
6970   if (DC->isFileContext())
6971     return true;
6972   if (DC->isRecord())
6973     return false;
6974   if (isa<RequiresExprBodyDecl>(DC))
6975     return false;
6976   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6977 }
6978 
6979 static bool shouldConsiderLinkage(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
6980   const DeclContext *DC = FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
6981   if (DC->isFileContext() || DC->isFunctionOrMethod() ||
6982       isa<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(DC) || isa<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(DC))
6983     return true;
6984   if (DC->isRecord())
6985     return false;
6986   llvm_unreachable("Unexpected context");
6987 }
6988 
6989 static bool hasParsedAttr(Scope *S, const Declarator &PD,
6990                           ParsedAttr::Kind Kind) {
6991   // Check decl attributes on the DeclSpec.
6992   if (PD.getDeclSpec().getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind))
6993     return true;
6994 
6995   // Walk the declarator structure, checking decl attributes that were in a type
6996   // position to the decl itself.
6997   for (unsigned I = 0, E = PD.getNumTypeObjects(); I != E; ++I) {
6998     if (PD.getTypeObject(I).getAttrs().hasAttribute(Kind))
6999       return true;
7000   }
7001 
7002   // Finally, check attributes on the decl itself.
7003   return PD.getAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind) ||
7004          PD.getDeclarationAttributes().hasAttribute(Kind);
7005 }
7006 
7007 /// Adjust the \c DeclContext for a function or variable that might be a
7008 /// function-local external declaration.
7009 bool Sema::adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DeclContext *&DC) {
7010   if (!DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
7011     return false;
7012 
7013   // If this is a local extern function or variable declared within a function
7014   // template, don't add it into the enclosing namespace scope until it is
7015   // instantiated; it might have a dependent type right now.
7016   if (DC->isDependentContext())
7017     return true;
7018 
7019   // C++11 [basic.link]p7:
7020   //   When a block scope declaration of an entity with linkage is not found to
7021   //   refer to some other declaration, then that entity is a member of the
7022   //   innermost enclosing namespace.
7023   //
7024   // Per C++11 [namespace.def]p6, the innermost enclosing namespace is a
7025   // semantically-enclosing namespace, not a lexically-enclosing one.
7026   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(DC))
7027     DC = DC->getParent();
7028   return true;
7029 }
7030 
7031 /// Returns true if given declaration has external C language linkage.
7032 static bool isDeclExternC(const Decl *D) {
7033   if (const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D))
7034     return FD->isExternC();
7035   if (const auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D))
7036     return VD->isExternC();
7037 
7038   llvm_unreachable("Unknown type of decl!");
7039 }
7040 
7041 /// Returns true if there hasn't been any invalid type diagnosed.
7042 static bool diagnoseOpenCLTypes(Sema &Se, VarDecl *NewVD) {
7043   DeclContext *DC = NewVD->getDeclContext();
7044   QualType R = NewVD->getType();
7045 
7046   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.b - Image type can only be used as a function argument.
7047   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.13.16.1 - Pipe type can only be used as a function
7048   // argument.
7049   if (R->isImageType() || R->isPipeType()) {
7050     Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
7051             diag::err_opencl_type_can_only_be_used_as_function_parameter)
7052         << R;
7053     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7054     return false;
7055   }
7056 
7057   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
7058   // The event type cannot be used to declare a program scope variable.
7059   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.q:
7060   // The clk_event_t and reserve_id_t types cannot be declared in program
7061   // scope.
7062   if (NewVD->hasGlobalStorage() && !NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
7063     if (R->isReserveIDT() || R->isClkEventT() || R->isEventT()) {
7064       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(),
7065               diag::err_invalid_type_for_program_scope_var)
7066           << R;
7067       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7068       return false;
7069     }
7070   }
7071 
7072   // OpenCL v1.0 s6.8.a.3: Pointers to functions are not allowed.
7073   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("__cl_clang_function_pointers",
7074                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
7075     QualType NR = R.getCanonicalType();
7076     while (NR->isPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
7077            NR->isReferenceType()) {
7078       if (NR->isFunctionPointerType() || NR->isMemberFunctionPointerType() ||
7079           NR->isFunctionReferenceType()) {
7080         Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_pointer)
7081             << NR->isReferenceType();
7082         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7083         return false;
7084       }
7085       NR = NR->getPointeeType();
7086     }
7087   }
7088 
7089   if (!Se.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16",
7090                                                Se.getLangOpts())) {
7091     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1: reject declaring variables of the half and
7092     // half array type (unless the cl_khr_fp16 extension is enabled).
7093     if (Se.Context.getBaseElementType(R)->isHalfType()) {
7094       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_half_declaration) << R;
7095       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7096       return false;
7097     }
7098   }
7099 
7100   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.r:
7101   // The event type cannot be used with the __local, __constant and __global
7102   // address space qualifiers.
7103   if (R->isEventT()) {
7104     if (R.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private) {
7105       Se.Diag(NewVD->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_event_t_addr_space_qual);
7106       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7107       return false;
7108     }
7109   }
7110 
7111   if (R->isSamplerT()) {
7112     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.b p4:
7113     // The sampler type cannot be used with the __local and __global address
7114     // space qualifiers.
7115     if (R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local ||
7116         R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
7117       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_wrong_sampler_addressspace);
7118       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7119     }
7120 
7121     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.12.14.1:
7122     // A global sampler must be declared with either the constant address
7123     // space qualifier or with the const qualifier.
7124     if (DC->isTranslationUnit() &&
7125         !(R.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
7126           R.isConstQualified())) {
7127       Se.Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_nonconst_global_sampler);
7128       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7129     }
7130     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7131       return false;
7132   }
7133 
7134   return true;
7135 }
7136 
7137 template <typename AttrTy>
7138 static void copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl(Sema &S, Decl *D, const TypedefType *TT) {
7139   const TypedefNameDecl *TND = TT->getDecl();
7140   if (const auto *Attribute = TND->getAttr<AttrTy>()) {
7141     AttrTy *Clone = Attribute->clone(S.Context);
7142     Clone->setInherited(true);
7143     D->addAttr(Clone);
7144   }
7145 }
7146 
7147 NamedDecl *Sema::ActOnVariableDeclarator(
7148     Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7149     LookupResult &Previous, MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists,
7150     bool &AddToScope, ArrayRef<BindingDecl *> Bindings) {
7151   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
7152   DeclarationName Name = GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
7153 
7154   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
7155 
7156   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
7157     // Take the name of the first declarator as our name for diagnostic
7158     // purposes.
7159     auto &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
7160     if (!Decomp.bindings().empty()) {
7161       II = Decomp.bindings()[0].Name;
7162       Name = II;
7163     }
7164   } else if (!II) {
7165     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_variable_name) << Name;
7166     return nullptr;
7167   }
7168 
7169 
7170   DeclSpec::SCS SCSpec = D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec();
7171   StorageClass SC = StorageClassSpecToVarDeclStorageClass(D.getDeclSpec());
7172 
7173   // dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as extern. We
7174   // have to change the storage class this early to get the right DeclContext.
7175   if (SC == SC_None && !DC->isRecord() &&
7176       hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLImport) &&
7177       !hasParsedAttr(S, D, ParsedAttr::AT_DLLExport))
7178     SC = SC_Extern;
7179 
7180   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
7181   bool IsLocalExternDecl = SC == SC_Extern &&
7182                            adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
7183 
7184   if (SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable) {
7185     // mutable can only appear on non-static class members, so it's always
7186     // an error here
7187     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_mutable_nonmember);
7188     D.setInvalidType();
7189     SC = SC_None;
7190   }
7191 
7192   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && SCSpec == DeclSpec::SCS_register &&
7193       !D.getAsmLabel() && !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(
7194                               D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc())) {
7195     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
7196     // Suppress the warning in system macros, it's used in macros in some
7197     // popular C system headers, such as in glibc's htonl() macro.
7198     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7199          getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
7200                                    : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
7201       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7202   }
7203 
7204   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
7205 
7206   if (!DC->isRecord() && S->getFnParent() == nullptr) {
7207     // C99 6.9p2: The storage-class specifiers auto and register shall not
7208     // appear in the declaration specifiers in an external declaration.
7209     // Global Register+Asm is a GNU extension we support.
7210     if (SC == SC_Auto || (SC == SC_Register && !D.getAsmLabel())) {
7211       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_sclass_fscope);
7212       D.setInvalidType();
7213     }
7214   }
7215 
7216   // If this variable has a VLA type and an initializer, try to
7217   // fold to a constant-sized type. This is otherwise invalid.
7218   if (D.hasInitializer() && R->isVariableArrayType())
7219     tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(TInfo, R, D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7220                                     /*DiagID=*/0);
7221 
7222   bool IsMemberSpecialization = false;
7223   bool IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = false;
7224   bool IsPartialSpecialization = false;
7225   bool IsVariableTemplate = false;
7226   VarDecl *NewVD = nullptr;
7227   VarTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = nullptr;
7228   TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams = nullptr;
7229   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7230     NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7231                             II, R, TInfo, SC);
7232 
7233     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7234       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7235 
7236     if (D.isInvalidType())
7237       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7238 
7239     if (NewVD->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() &&
7240         NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7241       checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewVD->getType(), NewVD->getLocation(),
7242                             NTCUC_AutoVar, NTCUK_Destruct);
7243   } else {
7244     bool Invalid = false;
7245 
7246     if (DC->isRecord() && !CurContext->isRecord()) {
7247       // This is an out-of-line definition of a static data member.
7248       switch (SC) {
7249       case SC_None:
7250         break;
7251       case SC_Static:
7252         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7253              diag::err_static_out_of_line)
7254           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7255         break;
7256       case SC_Auto:
7257       case SC_Register:
7258       case SC_Extern:
7259         // [dcl.stc] p2: The auto or register specifiers shall be applied only
7260         // to names of variables declared in a block or to function parameters.
7261         // [dcl.stc] p6: The extern specifier cannot be used in the declaration
7262         // of class members
7263 
7264         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7265              diag::err_storage_class_for_static_member)
7266           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
7267         break;
7268       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7269         llvm_unreachable("C storage class in c++!");
7270       }
7271     }
7272 
7273     if (SC == SC_Static && CurContext->isRecord()) {
7274       if (const CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
7275         // Walk up the enclosing DeclContexts to check for any that are
7276         // incompatible with static data members.
7277         const DeclContext *FunctionOrMethod = nullptr;
7278         const CXXRecordDecl *AnonStruct = nullptr;
7279         for (DeclContext *Ctxt = DC; Ctxt; Ctxt = Ctxt->getParent()) {
7280           if (Ctxt->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7281             FunctionOrMethod = Ctxt;
7282             break;
7283           }
7284           const CXXRecordDecl *ParentDecl = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Ctxt);
7285           if (ParentDecl && !ParentDecl->getDeclName()) {
7286             AnonStruct = ParentDecl;
7287             break;
7288           }
7289         }
7290         if (FunctionOrMethod) {
7291           // C++ [class.static.data]p5: A local class shall not have static data
7292           // members.
7293           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7294                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_local_class)
7295             << Name << RD->getDeclName() << RD->getTagKind();
7296         } else if (AnonStruct) {
7297           // C++ [class.static.data]p4: Unnamed classes and classes contained
7298           // directly or indirectly within unnamed classes shall not contain
7299           // static data members.
7300           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7301                diag::err_static_data_member_not_allowed_in_anon_struct)
7302             << Name << AnonStruct->getTagKind();
7303           Invalid = true;
7304         } else if (RD->isUnion()) {
7305           // C++98 [class.union]p1: If a union contains a static data member,
7306           // the program is ill-formed. C++11 drops this restriction.
7307           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7308                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11
7309                  ? diag::warn_cxx98_compat_static_data_member_in_union
7310                  : diag::ext_static_data_member_in_union) << Name;
7311         }
7312       }
7313     }
7314 
7315     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
7316     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
7317     bool InvalidScope = false;
7318     TemplateParams = MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
7319         D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7320         D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
7321         D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
7322             ? D.getName().TemplateId
7323             : nullptr,
7324         TemplateParamLists,
7325         /*never a friend*/ false, IsMemberSpecialization, InvalidScope);
7326     Invalid |= InvalidScope;
7327 
7328     if (TemplateParams) {
7329       if (!TemplateParams->size() &&
7330           D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7331         // There is an extraneous 'template<>' for this variable. Complain
7332         // about it, but allow the declaration of the variable.
7333         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7334              diag::err_template_variable_noparams)
7335           << II
7336           << SourceRange(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(),
7337                          TemplateParams->getRAngleLoc());
7338         TemplateParams = nullptr;
7339       } else {
7340         // Check that we can declare a template here.
7341         if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
7342           return nullptr;
7343 
7344         if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
7345           // This is an explicit specialization or a partial specialization.
7346           IsVariableTemplateSpecialization = true;
7347           IsPartialSpecialization = TemplateParams->size() > 0;
7348         } else { // if (TemplateParams->size() > 0)
7349           // This is a template declaration.
7350           IsVariableTemplate = true;
7351 
7352           // Only C++1y supports variable templates (N3651).
7353           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
7354                getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14
7355                    ? diag::warn_cxx11_compat_variable_template
7356                    : diag::ext_variable_template);
7357         }
7358       }
7359     } else {
7360       // Check that we can declare a member specialization here.
7361       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && IsMemberSpecialization &&
7362           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
7363         return nullptr;
7364       assert((Invalid ||
7365               D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) &&
7366              "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
7367     }
7368 
7369     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization) {
7370       SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc =
7371           TemplateParamLists.size() > 0
7372               ? TemplateParamLists[0]->getTemplateLoc()
7373               : SourceLocation();
7374       DeclResult Res = ActOnVarTemplateSpecialization(
7375           S, D, TInfo, TemplateKWLoc, TemplateParams, SC,
7376           IsPartialSpecialization);
7377       if (Res.isInvalid())
7378         return nullptr;
7379       NewVD = cast<VarDecl>(Res.get());
7380       AddToScope = false;
7381     } else if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
7382       NewVD = DecompositionDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7383                                         D.getIdentifierLoc(), R, TInfo, SC,
7384                                         Bindings);
7385     } else
7386       NewVD = VarDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
7387                               D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, R, TInfo, SC);
7388 
7389     // If this is supposed to be a variable template, create it as such.
7390     if (IsVariableTemplate) {
7391       NewTemplate =
7392           VarTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC, D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name,
7393                                   TemplateParams, NewVD);
7394       NewVD->setDescribedVarTemplate(NewTemplate);
7395     }
7396 
7397     // If this decl has an auto type in need of deduction, make a note of the
7398     // Decl so we can diagnose uses of it in its own initializer.
7399     if (R->getContainedDeducedType())
7400       ParsingInitForAutoVars.insert(NewVD);
7401 
7402     if (D.isInvalidType() || Invalid) {
7403       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7404       if (NewTemplate)
7405         NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7406     }
7407 
7408     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewVD, D);
7409 
7410     // If we have any template parameter lists that don't directly belong to
7411     // the variable (matching the scope specifier), store them.
7412     unsigned VDTemplateParamLists = TemplateParams ? 1 : 0;
7413     if (TemplateParamLists.size() > VDTemplateParamLists)
7414       NewVD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(
7415           Context, TemplateParamLists.drop_back(VDTemplateParamLists));
7416   }
7417 
7418   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified()) {
7419     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7420       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
7421           << 0;
7422     } else if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
7423       // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope variable declaration.
7424       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7425            diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
7426         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
7427     } else {
7428       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
7429            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::warn_cxx14_compat_inline_variable
7430                                      : diag::ext_inline_variable);
7431       NewVD->setInlineSpecified();
7432     }
7433   }
7434 
7435   // Set the lexical context. If the declarator has a C++ scope specifier, the
7436   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
7437   NewVD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7438   if (NewTemplate)
7439     NewTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
7440 
7441   if (IsLocalExternDecl) {
7442     if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator())
7443       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7444         B->setLocalExternDecl();
7445     else
7446       NewVD->setLocalExternDecl();
7447   }
7448 
7449   bool EmitTLSUnsupportedError = false;
7450   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec()) {
7451     // C++11 [dcl.stc]p4:
7452     //   When thread_local is applied to a variable of block scope the
7453     //   storage-class-specifier static is implied if it does not appear
7454     //   explicitly.
7455     // Core issue: 'static' is not implied if the variable is declared
7456     //   'extern'.
7457     if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
7458         (SCSpec != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified ||
7459          TSCS != DeclSpec::TSCS_thread_local ||
7460          !DC->isFunctionOrMethod()))
7461       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7462            diag::err_thread_non_global)
7463         << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
7464     else if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isTLSSupported()) {
7465       if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7466           getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7467         // Postpone error emission until we've collected attributes required to
7468         // figure out whether it's a host or device variable and whether the
7469         // error should be ignored.
7470         EmitTLSUnsupportedError = true;
7471         // We still need to mark the variable as TLS so it shows up in AST with
7472         // proper storage class for other tools to use even if we're not going
7473         // to emit any code for it.
7474         NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7475       } else
7476         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7477              diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7478     } else
7479       NewVD->setTSCSpec(TSCS);
7480   }
7481 
7482   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier()) {
7483   case ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified:
7484     break;
7485 
7486   case ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval:
7487     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7488          diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
7489         << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
7490     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
7491 
7492   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr:
7493     NewVD->setConstexpr(true);
7494     // C++1z [dcl.spec.constexpr]p1:
7495     //   A static data member declared with the constexpr specifier is
7496     //   implicitly an inline variable.
7497     if (NewVD->isStaticDataMember() &&
7498         (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ||
7499          Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()))
7500       NewVD->setImplicitlyInline();
7501     break;
7502 
7503   case ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit:
7504     if (!NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())
7505       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7506            diag::err_constinit_local_variable);
7507     else
7508       NewVD->addAttr(ConstInitAttr::Create(
7509           Context, D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
7510           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword, ConstInitAttr::Keyword_constinit));
7511     break;
7512   }
7513 
7514   // C99 6.7.4p3
7515   //   An inline definition of a function with external linkage shall
7516   //   not contain a definition of a modifiable object with static or
7517   //   thread storage duration...
7518   // We only apply this when the function is required to be defined
7519   // elsewhere, i.e. when the function is not 'extern inline'.  Note
7520   // that a local variable with thread storage duration still has to
7521   // be marked 'static'.  Also note that it's possible to get these
7522   // semantics in C++ using __attribute__((gnu_inline)).
7523   if (SC == SC_Static && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7524       !NewVD->getType().isConstQualified()) {
7525     FunctionDecl *CurFD = getCurFunctionDecl();
7526     if (CurFD && isFunctionDefinitionDiscarded(*this, CurFD)) {
7527       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7528            diag::warn_static_local_in_extern_inline);
7529       MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(CurFD);
7530     }
7531   }
7532 
7533   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
7534     if (IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7535       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7536           << (IsPartialSpecialization ? 1 : 0)
7537           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7538                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7539     else if (IsMemberSpecialization)
7540       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
7541         << 2
7542         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7543     else if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage())
7544       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
7545           << 0 << NewVD
7546           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
7547           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
7548                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
7549     else {
7550       NewVD->setModulePrivate();
7551       if (NewTemplate)
7552         NewTemplate->setModulePrivate();
7553       for (auto *B : Bindings)
7554         B->setModulePrivate();
7555     }
7556   }
7557 
7558   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
7559     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(NewVD);
7560 
7561     DeclSpec::TSCS TSC = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec();
7562     if (TSC != TSCS_unspecified) {
7563       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7564            diag::err_opencl_unknown_type_specifier)
7565           << getLangOpts().getOpenCLVersionString()
7566           << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSC) << 1;
7567       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7568     }
7569   }
7570 
7571   // Handle attributes prior to checking for duplicates in MergeVarDecl
7572   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewVD, D);
7573 
7574   // FIXME: This is probably the wrong location to be doing this and we should
7575   // probably be doing this for more attributes (especially for function
7576   // pointer attributes such as format, warn_unused_result, etc.). Ideally
7577   // the code to copy attributes would be generated by TableGen.
7578   if (R->isFunctionPointerType())
7579     if (const auto *TT = R->getAs<TypedefType>())
7580       copyAttrFromTypedefToDecl<AllocSizeAttr>(*this, NewVD, TT);
7581 
7582   if (getLangOpts().CUDA || getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice ||
7583       getLangOpts().SYCLIsDevice) {
7584     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7585         ((getLangOpts().CUDA && DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) ||
7586          (getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice &&
7587           OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::isDeclareTargetDeclaration(NewVD))))
7588       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
7589            diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7590 
7591     if (EmitTLSUnsupportedError &&
7592         (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice || (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice)))
7593       targetDiag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_thread_unsupported);
7594     // CUDA B.2.5: "__shared__ and __constant__ variables have implied static
7595     // storage [duration]."
7596     if (SC == SC_None && S->getFnParent() != nullptr &&
7597         (NewVD->hasAttr<CUDASharedAttr>() ||
7598          NewVD->hasAttr<CUDAConstantAttr>())) {
7599       NewVD->setStorageClass(SC_Static);
7600     }
7601   }
7602 
7603   // Ensure that dllimport globals without explicit storage class are treated as
7604   // extern. The storage class is set above using parsed attributes. Now we can
7605   // check the VarDecl itself.
7606   assert(!NewVD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() ||
7607          NewVD->getAttr<DLLImportAttr>()->isInherited() ||
7608          NewVD->isStaticDataMember() || NewVD->getStorageClass() != SC_None);
7609 
7610   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for variables of
7611   // retainable type.
7612   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewVD))
7613     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7614 
7615   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
7616   if (Expr *E = (Expr*)D.getAsmLabel()) {
7617     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
7618     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
7619     StringRef Label = SE->getString();
7620     if (S->getFnParent() != nullptr) {
7621       switch (SC) {
7622       case SC_None:
7623       case SC_Auto:
7624         Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_asm_label_on_auto_decl) << Label;
7625         break;
7626       case SC_Register:
7627         // Local Named register
7628         if (!Context.getTargetInfo().isValidGCCRegisterName(Label) &&
7629             DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), getCurFunctionDecl()))
7630           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7631         break;
7632       case SC_Static:
7633       case SC_Extern:
7634       case SC_PrivateExtern:
7635         break;
7636       }
7637     } else if (SC == SC_Register) {
7638       // Global Named register
7639       if (DeclAttrsMatchCUDAMode(getLangOpts(), NewVD)) {
7640         const auto &TI = Context.getTargetInfo();
7641         bool HasSizeMismatch;
7642 
7643         if (!TI.isValidGCCRegisterName(Label))
7644           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_unknown_register_name) << Label;
7645         else if (!TI.validateGlobalRegisterVariable(Label,
7646                                                     Context.getTypeSize(R),
7647                                                     HasSizeMismatch))
7648           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_invalid_global_var_reg) << Label;
7649         else if (HasSizeMismatch)
7650           Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_asm_register_size_mismatch) << Label;
7651       }
7652 
7653       if (!R->isIntegralType(Context) && !R->isPointerType()) {
7654         Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_asm_bad_register_type);
7655         NewVD->setInvalidDecl(true);
7656       }
7657     }
7658 
7659     NewVD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, Label,
7660                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
7661                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
7662   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
7663     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
7664       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewVD->getIdentifier());
7665     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
7666       if (isDeclExternC(NewVD)) {
7667         NewVD->addAttr(I->second);
7668         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
7669       } else
7670         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
7671             << /*Variable*/1 << NewVD;
7672     }
7673   }
7674 
7675   // Find the shadowed declaration before filtering for scope.
7676   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = D.getCXXScopeSpec().isEmpty()
7677                                 ? getShadowedDeclaration(NewVD, Previous)
7678                                 : nullptr;
7679 
7680   // Don't consider existing declarations that are in a different
7681   // scope and are out-of-semantic-context declarations (if the new
7682   // declaration has linkage).
7683   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewVD),
7684                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
7685                        IsMemberSpecialization ||
7686                        IsVariableTemplateSpecialization);
7687 
7688   // Check whether the previous declaration is in the same block scope. This
7689   // affects whether we merge types with it, per C++11 [dcl.array]p3.
7690   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
7691       NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() && NewVD->hasExternalStorage())
7692     NewVD->setPreviousDeclInSameBlockScope(
7693         Previous.isSingleResult() && !Previous.isShadowed() &&
7694         isDeclInScope(Previous.getFoundDecl(), OriginalDC, S, false));
7695 
7696   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
7697     D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7698   } else {
7699     // If this is an explicit specialization of a static data member, check it.
7700     if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7701         CheckMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous))
7702       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7703 
7704     // Merge the decl with the existing one if appropriate.
7705     if (!Previous.empty()) {
7706       if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
7707           isa<FieldDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl()) &&
7708           D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7709         // The user tried to define a non-static data member
7710         // out-of-line (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
7711         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_nonstatic_member_out_of_line)
7712           << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7713         Previous.clear();
7714         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7715       }
7716     } else if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
7717       // No previous declaration in the qualifying scope.
7718       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
7719         << Name << computeDeclContext(D.getCXXScopeSpec(), true)
7720         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
7721       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7722     }
7723 
7724     if (!IsVariableTemplateSpecialization)
7725       D.setRedeclaration(CheckVariableDeclaration(NewVD, Previous));
7726 
7727     if (NewTemplate) {
7728       VarTemplateDecl *PrevVarTemplate =
7729           NewVD->getPreviousDecl()
7730               ? NewVD->getPreviousDecl()->getDescribedVarTemplate()
7731               : nullptr;
7732 
7733       // Check the template parameter list of this declaration, possibly
7734       // merging in the template parameter list from the previous variable
7735       // template declaration.
7736       if (CheckTemplateParameterList(
7737               TemplateParams,
7738               PrevVarTemplate ? PrevVarTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
7739                               : nullptr,
7740               (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() && DC && DC->isRecord() &&
7741                DC->isDependentContext())
7742                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
7743                   : TPC_VarTemplate))
7744         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
7745 
7746       // If we are providing an explicit specialization of a static variable
7747       // template, make a note of that.
7748       if (PrevVarTemplate &&
7749           PrevVarTemplate->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate())
7750         PrevVarTemplate->setMemberSpecialization();
7751     }
7752   }
7753 
7754   // Diagnose shadowed variables iff this isn't a redeclaration.
7755   if (ShadowedDecl && !D.isRedeclaration())
7756     CheckShadow(NewVD, ShadowedDecl, Previous);
7757 
7758   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewVD);
7759 
7760   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
7761   // the map of such variables.
7762   if (NewVD->isFirstDecl() && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl() &&
7763       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewVD))
7764     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewVD, S);
7765 
7766   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
7767     MangleNumberingContext *MCtx;
7768     Decl *ManglingContextDecl;
7769     std::tie(MCtx, ManglingContextDecl) =
7770         getCurrentMangleNumberContext(NewVD->getDeclContext());
7771     if (MCtx) {
7772       Context.setManglingNumber(
7773           NewVD, MCtx->getManglingNumber(
7774                      NewVD, getMSManglingNumber(getLangOpts(), S)));
7775       Context.setStaticLocalNumber(NewVD, MCtx->getStaticLocalNumber(NewVD));
7776     }
7777   }
7778 
7779   // Special handling of variable named 'main'.
7780   if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() && Name.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("main") &&
7781       NewVD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
7782       !getLangOpts().Freestanding && !NewVD->getDescribedVarTemplate()) {
7783 
7784     // C++ [basic.start.main]p3
7785     // A program that declares a variable main at global scope is ill-formed.
7786     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
7787       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::err_main_global_variable);
7788 
7789     // In C, and external-linkage variable named main results in undefined
7790     // behavior.
7791     else if (NewVD->hasExternalFormalLinkage())
7792       Diag(D.getBeginLoc(), diag::warn_main_redefined);
7793   }
7794 
7795   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
7796     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
7797     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewVD, IsMemberSpecialization,
7798                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
7799   }
7800 
7801   if (NewTemplate) {
7802     if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7803       NewTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
7804     ActOnDocumentableDecl(NewTemplate);
7805     return NewTemplate;
7806   }
7807 
7808   if (IsMemberSpecialization && !NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
7809     CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewVD, Previous);
7810 
7811   return NewVD;
7812 }
7813 
7814 /// Enum describing the %select options in diag::warn_decl_shadow.
7815 enum ShadowedDeclKind {
7816   SDK_Local,
7817   SDK_Global,
7818   SDK_StaticMember,
7819   SDK_Field,
7820   SDK_Typedef,
7821   SDK_Using,
7822   SDK_StructuredBinding
7823 };
7824 
7825 /// Determine what kind of declaration we're shadowing.
7826 static ShadowedDeclKind computeShadowedDeclKind(const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7827                                                 const DeclContext *OldDC) {
7828   if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7829     return SDK_Using;
7830   else if (isa<TypedefDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7831     return SDK_Typedef;
7832   else if (isa<BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7833     return SDK_StructuredBinding;
7834   else if (isa<RecordDecl>(OldDC))
7835     return isa<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? SDK_Field : SDK_StaticMember;
7836 
7837   return OldDC->isFileContext() ? SDK_Global : SDK_Local;
7838 }
7839 
7840 /// Return the location of the capture if the given lambda captures the given
7841 /// variable \p VD, or an invalid source location otherwise.
7842 static SourceLocation getCaptureLocation(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI,
7843                                          const VarDecl *VD) {
7844   for (const Capture &Capture : LSI->Captures) {
7845     if (Capture.isVariableCapture() && Capture.getVariable() == VD)
7846       return Capture.getLocation();
7847   }
7848   return SourceLocation();
7849 }
7850 
7851 static bool shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(const DiagnosticsEngine &Diags,
7852                                      const LookupResult &R) {
7853   // Only diagnose if we're shadowing an unambiguous field or variable.
7854   if (R.getResultKind() != LookupResult::Found)
7855     return false;
7856 
7857   // Return false if warning is ignored.
7858   return !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, R.getNameLoc());
7859 }
7860 
7861 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7862 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7863 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const VarDecl *D,
7864                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7865   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7866     return nullptr;
7867 
7868   // Don't diagnose declarations at file scope.
7869   if (D->hasGlobalStorage())
7870     return nullptr;
7871 
7872   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7873   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7874                                                             : nullptr;
7875 }
7876 
7877 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given typedef \p D, or null
7878 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7879 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const TypedefNameDecl *D,
7880                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7881   // Don't warn if typedef declaration is part of a class
7882   if (D->getDeclContext()->isRecord())
7883     return nullptr;
7884 
7885   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7886     return nullptr;
7887 
7888   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7889   return isa<TypedefNameDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl : nullptr;
7890 }
7891 
7892 /// Return the declaration shadowed by the given variable \p D, or null
7893 /// if it doesn't shadow any declaration or shadowing warnings are disabled.
7894 NamedDecl *Sema::getShadowedDeclaration(const BindingDecl *D,
7895                                         const LookupResult &R) {
7896   if (!shouldWarnIfShadowedDecl(Diags, R))
7897     return nullptr;
7898 
7899   NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
7900   return isa<VarDecl, FieldDecl, BindingDecl>(ShadowedDecl) ? ShadowedDecl
7901                                                             : nullptr;
7902 }
7903 
7904 /// Diagnose variable or built-in function shadowing.  Implements
7905 /// -Wshadow.
7906 ///
7907 /// This method is called whenever a VarDecl is added to a "useful"
7908 /// scope.
7909 ///
7910 /// \param ShadowedDecl the declaration that is shadowed by the given variable
7911 /// \param R the lookup of the name
7912 ///
7913 void Sema::CheckShadow(NamedDecl *D, NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl,
7914                        const LookupResult &R) {
7915   DeclContext *NewDC = D->getDeclContext();
7916 
7917   if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ShadowedDecl)) {
7918     // Fields are not shadowed by variables in C++ static methods.
7919     if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC))
7920       if (MD->isStatic())
7921         return;
7922 
7923     // Fields shadowed by constructor parameters are a special case. Usually
7924     // the constructor initializes the field with the parameter.
7925     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewDC))
7926       if (const auto PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D)) {
7927         // Remember that this was shadowed so we can either warn about its
7928         // modification or its existence depending on warning settings.
7929         ShadowingDecls.insert({PVD->getCanonicalDecl(), FD});
7930         return;
7931       }
7932   }
7933 
7934   if (VarDecl *shadowedVar = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl))
7935     if (shadowedVar->isExternC()) {
7936       // For shadowing external vars, make sure that we point to the global
7937       // declaration, not a locally scoped extern declaration.
7938       for (auto I : shadowedVar->redecls())
7939         if (I->isFileVarDecl()) {
7940           ShadowedDecl = I;
7941           break;
7942         }
7943     }
7944 
7945   DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
7946 
7947   unsigned WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow;
7948   SourceLocation CaptureLoc;
7949   if (isa<VarDecl>(D) && isa<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl) && NewDC &&
7950       isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewDC)) {
7951     if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewDC->getParent())) {
7952       if (RD->isLambda() && OldDC->Encloses(NewDC->getLexicalParent())) {
7953         if (RD->getLambdaCaptureDefault() == LCD_None) {
7954           // Try to avoid warnings for lambdas with an explicit capture list.
7955           const auto *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction());
7956           // Warn only when the lambda captures the shadowed decl explicitly.
7957           CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl));
7958           if (CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
7959             WarningDiag = diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local;
7960         } else {
7961           // Remember that this was shadowed so we can avoid the warning if the
7962           // shadowed decl isn't captured and the warning settings allow it.
7963           cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(getCurFunction())
7964               ->ShadowingDecls.push_back(
7965                   {cast<VarDecl>(D), cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)});
7966           return;
7967         }
7968       }
7969 
7970       if (cast<VarDecl>(ShadowedDecl)->hasLocalStorage()) {
7971         // A variable can't shadow a local variable in an enclosing scope, if
7972         // they are separated by a non-capturing declaration context.
7973         for (DeclContext *ParentDC = NewDC;
7974              ParentDC && !ParentDC->Equals(OldDC);
7975              ParentDC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(ParentDC)) {
7976           // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions
7977           // can capture; other scopes don't.
7978           if (!isa<BlockDecl>(ParentDC) && !isa<CapturedDecl>(ParentDC) &&
7979               !isLambdaCallOperator(ParentDC)) {
7980             return;
7981           }
7982         }
7983       }
7984     }
7985   }
7986 
7987   // Only warn about certain kinds of shadowing for class members.
7988   if (NewDC && NewDC->isRecord()) {
7989     // In particular, don't warn about shadowing non-class members.
7990     if (!OldDC->isRecord())
7991       return;
7992 
7993     // TODO: should we warn about static data members shadowing
7994     // static data members from base classes?
7995 
7996     // TODO: don't diagnose for inaccessible shadowed members.
7997     // This is hard to do perfectly because we might friend the
7998     // shadowing context, but that's just a false negative.
7999   }
8000 
8001 
8002   DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
8003 
8004   // Emit warning and note.
8005   ShadowedDeclKind Kind = computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC);
8006   Diag(R.getNameLoc(), WarningDiag) << Name << Kind << OldDC;
8007   if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
8008     Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
8009         << Name << /*explicitly*/ 1;
8010   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8011 }
8012 
8013 /// Diagnose shadowing for variables shadowed in the lambda record \p LambdaRD
8014 /// when these variables are captured by the lambda.
8015 void Sema::DiagnoseShadowingLambdaDecls(const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI) {
8016   for (const auto &Shadow : LSI->ShadowingDecls) {
8017     const VarDecl *ShadowedDecl = Shadow.ShadowedDecl;
8018     // Try to avoid the warning when the shadowed decl isn't captured.
8019     SourceLocation CaptureLoc = getCaptureLocation(LSI, ShadowedDecl);
8020     const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
8021     Diag(Shadow.VD->getLocation(), CaptureLoc.isInvalid()
8022                                        ? diag::warn_decl_shadow_uncaptured_local
8023                                        : diag::warn_decl_shadow)
8024         << Shadow.VD->getDeclName()
8025         << computeShadowedDeclKind(ShadowedDecl, OldDC) << OldDC;
8026     if (!CaptureLoc.isInvalid())
8027       Diag(CaptureLoc, diag::note_var_explicitly_captured_here)
8028           << Shadow.VD->getDeclName() << /*explicitly*/ 0;
8029     Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8030   }
8031 }
8032 
8033 /// Check -Wshadow without the advantage of a previous lookup.
8034 void Sema::CheckShadow(Scope *S, VarDecl *D) {
8035   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_decl_shadow, D->getLocation()))
8036     return;
8037 
8038   LookupResult R(*this, D->getDeclName(), D->getLocation(),
8039                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
8040   LookupName(R, S);
8041   if (NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = getShadowedDeclaration(D, R))
8042     CheckShadow(D, ShadowedDecl, R);
8043 }
8044 
8045 /// Check if 'E', which is an expression that is about to be modified, refers
8046 /// to a constructor parameter that shadows a field.
8047 void Sema::CheckShadowingDeclModification(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8048   // Quickly ignore expressions that can't be shadowing ctor parameters.
8049   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || ShadowingDecls.empty())
8050     return;
8051   E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
8052   auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E);
8053   if (!DRE)
8054     return;
8055   const NamedDecl *D = cast<NamedDecl>(DRE->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl());
8056   auto I = ShadowingDecls.find(D);
8057   if (I == ShadowingDecls.end())
8058     return;
8059   const NamedDecl *ShadowedDecl = I->second;
8060   const DeclContext *OldDC = ShadowedDecl->getDeclContext();
8061   Diag(Loc, diag::warn_modifying_shadowing_decl) << D << OldDC;
8062   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_var_declared_here) << D;
8063   Diag(ShadowedDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
8064 
8065   // Avoid issuing multiple warnings about the same decl.
8066   ShadowingDecls.erase(I);
8067 }
8068 
8069 /// Check for conflict between this global or extern "C" declaration and
8070 /// previous global or extern "C" declarations. This is only used in C++.
8071 template<typename T>
8072 static bool checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(
8073     Sema &S, const T *ND, bool IsGlobal, LookupResult &Previous) {
8074   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "only C++ has extern \"C\"");
8075   NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName());
8076 
8077   if (!Prev && IsGlobal && !isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
8078     // The common case: this global doesn't conflict with any extern "C"
8079     // declaration.
8080     return false;
8081   }
8082 
8083   if (Prev) {
8084     if (!IsGlobal || isIncompleteDeclExternC(S, ND)) {
8085       // Both the old and new declarations have C language linkage. This is a
8086       // redeclaration.
8087       Previous.clear();
8088       Previous.addDecl(Prev);
8089       return true;
8090     }
8091 
8092     // This is a global, non-extern "C" declaration, and there is a previous
8093     // non-global extern "C" declaration. Diagnose if this is a variable
8094     // declaration.
8095     if (!isa<VarDecl>(ND))
8096       return false;
8097   } else {
8098     // The declaration is extern "C". Check for any declaration in the
8099     // translation unit which might conflict.
8100     if (IsGlobal) {
8101       // We have already performed the lookup into the translation unit.
8102       IsGlobal = false;
8103       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
8104            I != E; ++I) {
8105         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
8106           Prev = *I;
8107           break;
8108         }
8109       }
8110     } else {
8111       DeclContext::lookup_result R =
8112           S.Context.getTranslationUnitDecl()->lookup(ND->getDeclName());
8113       for (DeclContext::lookup_result::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end();
8114            I != E; ++I) {
8115         if (isa<VarDecl>(*I)) {
8116           Prev = *I;
8117           break;
8118         }
8119         // FIXME: If we have any other entity with this name in global scope,
8120         // the declaration is ill-formed, but that is a defect: it breaks the
8121         // 'stat' hack, for instance. Only variables can have mangled name
8122         // clashes with extern "C" declarations, so only they deserve a
8123         // diagnostic.
8124       }
8125     }
8126 
8127     if (!Prev)
8128       return false;
8129   }
8130 
8131   // Use the first declaration's location to ensure we point at something which
8132   // is lexically inside an extern "C" linkage-spec.
8133   assert(Prev && "should have found a previous declaration to diagnose");
8134   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Prev))
8135     Prev = FD->getFirstDecl();
8136   else
8137     Prev = cast<VarDecl>(Prev)->getFirstDecl();
8138 
8139   S.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::err_extern_c_global_conflict)
8140     << IsGlobal << ND;
8141   S.Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_extern_c_global_conflict)
8142     << IsGlobal;
8143   return false;
8144 }
8145 
8146 /// Apply special rules for handling extern "C" declarations. Returns \c true
8147 /// if we have found that this is a redeclaration of some prior entity.
8148 ///
8149 /// Per C++ [dcl.link]p6:
8150 ///   Two declarations [for a function or variable] with C language linkage
8151 ///   with the same name that appear in different scopes refer to the same
8152 ///   [entity]. An entity with C language linkage shall not be declared with
8153 ///   the same name as an entity in global scope.
8154 template<typename T>
8155 static bool checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(Sema &S, const T *ND,
8156                                                   LookupResult &Previous) {
8157   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8158     // In C, when declaring a global variable, look for a corresponding 'extern'
8159     // variable declared in function scope. We don't need this in C++, because
8160     // we find local extern decls in the surrounding file-scope DeclContext.
8161     if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
8162       if (NamedDecl *Prev = S.findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(ND->getDeclName())) {
8163         Previous.clear();
8164         Previous.addDecl(Prev);
8165         return true;
8166       }
8167     }
8168     return false;
8169   }
8170 
8171   // A declaration in the translation unit can conflict with an extern "C"
8172   // declaration.
8173   if (ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit())
8174     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/true, Previous);
8175 
8176   // An extern "C" declaration can conflict with a declaration in the
8177   // translation unit or can be a redeclaration of an extern "C" declaration
8178   // in another scope.
8179   if (isIncompleteDeclExternC(S,ND))
8180     return checkGlobalOrExternCConflict(S, ND, /*IsGlobal*/false, Previous);
8181 
8182   // Neither global nor extern "C": nothing to do.
8183   return false;
8184 }
8185 
8186 void Sema::CheckVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *NewVD) {
8187   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
8188   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
8189     return;
8190 
8191   QualType T = NewVD->getType();
8192 
8193   // Defer checking an 'auto' type until its initializer is attached.
8194   if (T->isUndeducedType())
8195     return;
8196 
8197   if (NewVD->hasAttrs())
8198     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewVD);
8199 
8200   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
8201     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
8202       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NewVD->getLocation(), "*");
8203     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
8204     NewVD->setType(T);
8205   }
8206 
8207   // Emit an error if an address space was applied to decl with local storage.
8208   // This includes arrays of objects with address space qualifiers, but not
8209   // automatic variables that point to other address spaces.
8210   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S5.1.2
8211   if (!getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewVD->hasLocalStorage() &&
8212       T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
8213     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 0;
8214     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8215     return;
8216   }
8217 
8218   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 - The static qualifier is valid only in program
8219   // scope.
8220   if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion == 120 &&
8221       !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_clang_storage_class_specifiers",
8222                                             getLangOpts()) &&
8223       NewVD->isStaticLocal()) {
8224     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_static_function_scope);
8225     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8226     return;
8227   }
8228 
8229   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
8230     if (!diagnoseOpenCLTypes(*this, NewVD))
8231       return;
8232 
8233     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The __block storage type is not supported.
8234     if (NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8235       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_block_storage_type);
8236       return;
8237     }
8238 
8239     if (T->isBlockPointerType()) {
8240       // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Any block declaration must be const qualified and
8241       // can't use 'extern' storage class.
8242       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
8243         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
8244             << 0 /*const*/;
8245         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8246         return;
8247       }
8248       if (NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8249         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_extern_block_declaration);
8250         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8251         return;
8252       }
8253     }
8254 
8255     // FIXME: Adding local AS in C++ for OpenCL might make sense.
8256     if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl() || NewVD->isStaticLocal() ||
8257         NewVD->hasExternalStorage()) {
8258       if (!T->isSamplerT() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8259           !(T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8260             (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global &&
8261              getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(
8262                  getLangOpts())))) {
8263         int Scope = NewVD->isStaticLocal() | NewVD->hasExternalStorage() << 1;
8264         if (getOpenCLOptions().areProgramScopeVariablesSupported(getLangOpts()))
8265           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8266               << Scope << "global or constant";
8267         else
8268           Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_global_invalid_addr_space)
8269               << Scope << "constant";
8270         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8271         return;
8272       }
8273     } else {
8274       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_global) {
8275         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8276             << 1 /*is any function*/ << "global";
8277         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8278         return;
8279       }
8280       if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant ||
8281           T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
8282         FunctionDecl *FD = getCurFunctionDecl();
8283         // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: no local or constant variables
8284         // in functions.
8285         if (FD && !FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8286           if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8287             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8288                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "constant";
8289           else
8290             Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_function_variable)
8291                 << 0 /*non-kernel only*/ << "local";
8292           NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8293           return;
8294         }
8295         // OpenCL v2.0 s6.5.2 and s6.5.3: local and constant variables must be
8296         // in the outermost scope of a kernel function.
8297         if (FD && FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
8298           if (!getCurScope()->isFunctionScope()) {
8299             if (T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant)
8300               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8301                   << "constant";
8302             else
8303               Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_addrspace_scope)
8304                   << "local";
8305             NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8306             return;
8307           }
8308         }
8309       } else if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private &&
8310                  // If we are parsing a template we didn't deduce an addr
8311                  // space yet.
8312                  T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) {
8313         // Do not allow other address spaces on automatic variable.
8314         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_as_qualified_auto_decl) << 1;
8315         NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8316         return;
8317       }
8318     }
8319   }
8320 
8321   if (NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T.isObjCGCWeak()
8322       && !NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8323     if (getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC)
8324       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_gc_attribute_weak_on_local);
8325     else {
8326       assert(!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
8327       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_local);
8328     }
8329   }
8330 
8331   bool isVM = T->isVariablyModifiedType();
8332   if (isVM || NewVD->hasAttr<CleanupAttr>() ||
8333       NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
8334     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
8335 
8336   if ((isVM && NewVD->hasLinkage()) ||
8337       (T->isVariableArrayType() && NewVD->hasGlobalStorage())) {
8338     bool SizeIsNegative;
8339     llvm::APSInt Oversized;
8340     TypeSourceInfo *FixedTInfo = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedTypeSourceInfo(
8341         NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Context, SizeIsNegative, Oversized);
8342     QualType FixedT;
8343     if (FixedTInfo &&  T == NewVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType())
8344       FixedT = FixedTInfo->getType();
8345     else if (FixedTInfo) {
8346       // Type and type-as-written are canonically different. We need to fix up
8347       // both types separately.
8348       FixedT = TryToFixInvalidVariablyModifiedType(T, Context, SizeIsNegative,
8349                                                    Oversized);
8350     }
8351     if ((!FixedTInfo || FixedT.isNull()) && T->isVariableArrayType()) {
8352       const VariableArrayType *VAT = Context.getAsVariableArrayType(T);
8353       // FIXME: This won't give the correct result for
8354       // int a[10][n];
8355       SourceRange SizeRange = VAT->getSizeExpr()->getSourceRange();
8356 
8357       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8358         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_in_file_scope)
8359         << SizeRange;
8360       else if (NewVD->isStaticLocal())
8361         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_static_storage)
8362         << SizeRange;
8363       else
8364         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vla_decl_has_extern_linkage)
8365         << SizeRange;
8366       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8367       return;
8368     }
8369 
8370     if (!FixedTInfo) {
8371       if (NewVD->isFileVarDecl())
8372         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_in_file_scope);
8373       else
8374         Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_decl_has_extern_linkage);
8375       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8376       return;
8377     }
8378 
8379     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::ext_vla_folded_to_constant);
8380     NewVD->setType(FixedT);
8381     NewVD->setTypeSourceInfo(FixedTInfo);
8382   }
8383 
8384   if (T->isVoidType()) {
8385     // C++98 [dcl.stc]p5: The extern specifier can be applied only to the names
8386     //                    of objects and functions.
8387     if (NewVD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8388       Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
8389         << T;
8390       NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8391       return;
8392     }
8393   }
8394 
8395   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8396     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
8397     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8398     return;
8399   }
8400 
8401   if (!NewVD->hasLocalStorage() && T->isSizelessType()) {
8402     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_sizeless_nonlocal) << T;
8403     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8404     return;
8405   }
8406 
8407   if (isVM && NewVD->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
8408     Diag(NewVD->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_vm);
8409     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8410     return;
8411   }
8412 
8413   if (NewVD->isConstexpr() && !T->isDependentType() &&
8414       RequireLiteralType(NewVD->getLocation(), T,
8415                          diag::err_constexpr_var_non_literal)) {
8416     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8417     return;
8418   }
8419 
8420   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as non-local variable types.
8421   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
8422       !NewVD->isLocalVarDecl() &&
8423       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewVD->getLocation())) {
8424     NewVD->setInvalidDecl();
8425     return;
8426   }
8427 }
8428 
8429 /// Perform semantic checking on a newly-created variable
8430 /// declaration.
8431 ///
8432 /// This routine performs all of the type-checking required for a
8433 /// variable declaration once it has been built. It is used both to
8434 /// check variables after they have been parsed and their declarators
8435 /// have been translated into a declaration, and to check variables
8436 /// that have been instantiated from a template.
8437 ///
8438 /// Sets NewVD->isInvalidDecl() if an error was encountered.
8439 ///
8440 /// Returns true if the variable declaration is a redeclaration.
8441 bool Sema::CheckVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *NewVD, LookupResult &Previous) {
8442   CheckVariableDeclarationType(NewVD);
8443 
8444   // If the decl is already known invalid, don't check it.
8445   if (NewVD->isInvalidDecl())
8446     return false;
8447 
8448   // If we did not find anything by this name, look for a non-visible
8449   // extern "C" declaration with the same name.
8450   if (Previous.empty() &&
8451       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewVD, Previous))
8452     Previous.setShadowed();
8453 
8454   if (!Previous.empty()) {
8455     MergeVarDecl(NewVD, Previous);
8456     return true;
8457   }
8458   return false;
8459 }
8460 
8461 /// AddOverriddenMethods - See if a method overrides any in the base classes,
8462 /// and if so, check that it's a valid override and remember it.
8463 bool Sema::AddOverriddenMethods(CXXRecordDecl *DC, CXXMethodDecl *MD) {
8464   llvm::SmallPtrSet<const CXXMethodDecl*, 4> Overridden;
8465 
8466   // Look for methods in base classes that this method might override.
8467   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/false,
8468                      /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
8469   auto VisitBase = [&] (const CXXBaseSpecifier *Specifier, CXXBasePath &Path) {
8470     CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = Specifier->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
8471     DeclarationName Name = MD->getDeclName();
8472 
8473     if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8474       // We really want to find the base class destructor here.
8475       QualType T = Context.getTypeDeclType(BaseRecord);
8476       CanQualType CT = Context.getCanonicalType(T);
8477       Name = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(CT);
8478     }
8479 
8480     for (NamedDecl *BaseND : BaseRecord->lookup(Name)) {
8481       CXXMethodDecl *BaseMD =
8482           dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(BaseND->getCanonicalDecl());
8483       if (!BaseMD || !BaseMD->isVirtual() ||
8484           IsOverload(MD, BaseMD, /*UseMemberUsingDeclRules=*/false,
8485                      /*ConsiderCudaAttrs=*/true,
8486                      // C++2a [class.virtual]p2 does not consider requires
8487                      // clauses when overriding.
8488                      /*ConsiderRequiresClauses=*/false))
8489         continue;
8490 
8491       if (Overridden.insert(BaseMD).second) {
8492         MD->addOverriddenMethod(BaseMD);
8493         CheckOverridingFunctionReturnType(MD, BaseMD);
8494         CheckOverridingFunctionAttributes(MD, BaseMD);
8495         CheckOverridingFunctionExceptionSpec(MD, BaseMD);
8496         CheckIfOverriddenFunctionIsMarkedFinal(MD, BaseMD);
8497       }
8498 
8499       // A method can only override one function from each base class. We
8500       // don't track indirectly overridden methods from bases of bases.
8501       return true;
8502     }
8503 
8504     return false;
8505   };
8506 
8507   DC->lookupInBases(VisitBase, Paths);
8508   return !Overridden.empty();
8509 }
8510 
8511 namespace {
8512   // Struct for holding all of the extra arguments needed by
8513   // DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration to call Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator.
8514   struct ActOnFDArgs {
8515     Scope *S;
8516     Declarator &D;
8517     MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamLists;
8518     bool AddToScope;
8519   };
8520 } // end anonymous namespace
8521 
8522 namespace {
8523 
8524 // Callback to only accept typo corrections that have a non-zero edit distance.
8525 // Also only accept corrections that have the same parent decl.
8526 class DifferentNameValidatorCCC final : public CorrectionCandidateCallback {
8527  public:
8528   DifferentNameValidatorCCC(ASTContext &Context, FunctionDecl *TypoFD,
8529                             CXXRecordDecl *Parent)
8530       : Context(Context), OriginalFD(TypoFD),
8531         ExpectedParent(Parent ? Parent->getCanonicalDecl() : nullptr) {}
8532 
8533   bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override {
8534     if (candidate.getEditDistance() == 0)
8535       return false;
8536 
8537     SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8538     for (TypoCorrection::const_decl_iterator CDecl = candidate.begin(),
8539                                           CDeclEnd = candidate.end();
8540          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8541       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8542 
8543       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8544           hasSimilarParameters(Context, FD, OriginalFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8545         if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
8546           CXXRecordDecl *Parent = MD->getParent();
8547           if (Parent && Parent->getCanonicalDecl() == ExpectedParent)
8548             return true;
8549         } else if (!ExpectedParent) {
8550           return true;
8551         }
8552       }
8553     }
8554 
8555     return false;
8556   }
8557 
8558   std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override {
8559     return std::make_unique<DifferentNameValidatorCCC>(*this);
8560   }
8561 
8562  private:
8563   ASTContext &Context;
8564   FunctionDecl *OriginalFD;
8565   CXXRecordDecl *ExpectedParent;
8566 };
8567 
8568 } // end anonymous namespace
8569 
8570 void Sema::MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(const NamedDecl *F) {
8571   TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.insert(F);
8572 }
8573 
8574 /// Generate diagnostics for an invalid function redeclaration.
8575 ///
8576 /// This routine handles generating the diagnostic messages for an invalid
8577 /// function redeclaration, including finding possible similar declarations
8578 /// or performing typo correction if there are no previous declarations with
8579 /// the same name.
8580 ///
8581 /// Returns a NamedDecl iff typo correction was performed and substituting in
8582 /// the new declaration name does not cause new errors.
8583 static NamedDecl *DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
8584     Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &Previous, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
8585     ActOnFDArgs &ExtraArgs, bool IsLocalFriend, Scope *S) {
8586   DeclarationName Name = NewFD->getDeclName();
8587   DeclContext *NewDC = NewFD->getDeclContext();
8588   SmallVector<unsigned, 1> MismatchedParams;
8589   SmallVector<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned>, 1> NearMatches;
8590   TypoCorrection Correction;
8591   bool IsDefinition = ExtraArgs.D.isFunctionDefinition();
8592   unsigned DiagMsg =
8593     IsLocalFriend ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend :
8594     NewFD->getFriendObjectKind() ? diag::err_qualified_friend_no_match :
8595     diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match;
8596   LookupResult Prev(SemaRef, Name, NewFD->getLocation(),
8597                     IsLocalFriend ? Sema::LookupLocalFriendName
8598                                   : Sema::LookupOrdinaryName,
8599                     Sema::ForVisibleRedeclaration);
8600 
8601   NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8602   if (IsLocalFriend)
8603     SemaRef.LookupName(Prev, S);
8604   else
8605     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(Prev, NewDC);
8606   assert(!Prev.isAmbiguous() &&
8607          "Cannot have an ambiguity in previous-declaration lookup");
8608   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
8609   DifferentNameValidatorCCC CCC(SemaRef.Context, NewFD,
8610                                 MD ? MD->getParent() : nullptr);
8611   if (!Prev.empty()) {
8612     for (LookupResult::iterator Func = Prev.begin(), FuncEnd = Prev.end();
8613          Func != FuncEnd; ++Func) {
8614       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*Func);
8615       if (FD &&
8616           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8617         // Add 1 to the index so that 0 can mean the mismatch didn't
8618         // involve a parameter
8619         unsigned ParamNum =
8620             MismatchedParams.empty() ? 0 : MismatchedParams.front() + 1;
8621         NearMatches.push_back(std::make_pair(FD, ParamNum));
8622       }
8623     }
8624   // If the qualified name lookup yielded nothing, try typo correction
8625   } else if ((Correction = SemaRef.CorrectTypo(
8626                   Prev.getLookupNameInfo(), Prev.getLookupKind(), S,
8627                   &ExtraArgs.D.getCXXScopeSpec(), CCC, Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery,
8628                   IsLocalFriend ? nullptr : NewDC))) {
8629     // Set up everything for the call to ActOnFunctionDeclarator
8630     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Correction.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(),
8631                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8632     Previous.clear();
8633     Previous.setLookupName(Correction.getCorrection());
8634     for (TypoCorrection::decl_iterator CDecl = Correction.begin(),
8635                                     CDeclEnd = Correction.end();
8636          CDecl != CDeclEnd; ++CDecl) {
8637       FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*CDecl);
8638       if (FD && !FD->hasBody() &&
8639           hasSimilarParameters(SemaRef.Context, FD, NewFD, MismatchedParams)) {
8640         Previous.addDecl(FD);
8641       }
8642     }
8643     bool wasRedeclaration = ExtraArgs.D.isRedeclaration();
8644 
8645     NamedDecl *Result;
8646     // Retry building the function declaration with the new previous
8647     // declarations, and with errors suppressed.
8648     {
8649       // Trap errors.
8650       Sema::SFINAETrap Trap(SemaRef);
8651 
8652       // TODO: Refactor ActOnFunctionDeclarator so that we can call only the
8653       // pieces need to verify the typo-corrected C++ declaration and hopefully
8654       // eliminate the need for the parameter pack ExtraArgs.
8655       Result = SemaRef.ActOnFunctionDeclarator(
8656           ExtraArgs.S, ExtraArgs.D,
8657           Correction.getCorrectionDecl()->getDeclContext(),
8658           NewFD->getTypeSourceInfo(), Previous, ExtraArgs.TemplateParamLists,
8659           ExtraArgs.AddToScope);
8660 
8661       if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
8662         Result = nullptr;
8663     }
8664 
8665     if (Result) {
8666       // Determine which correction we picked.
8667       Decl *Canonical = Result->getCanonicalDecl();
8668       for (LookupResult::iterator I = Previous.begin(), E = Previous.end();
8669            I != E; ++I)
8670         if ((*I)->getCanonicalDecl() == Canonical)
8671           Correction.setCorrectionDecl(*I);
8672 
8673       // Let Sema know about the correction.
8674       SemaRef.MarkTypoCorrectedFunctionDefinition(Result);
8675       SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(
8676           Correction,
8677           SemaRef.PDiag(IsLocalFriend
8678                           ? diag::err_no_matching_local_friend_suggest
8679                           : diag::err_member_decl_does_not_match_suggest)
8680             << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition);
8681       return Result;
8682     }
8683 
8684     // Pretend the typo correction never occurred
8685     ExtraArgs.D.SetIdentifier(Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(),
8686                               ExtraArgs.D.getIdentifierLoc());
8687     ExtraArgs.D.setRedeclaration(wasRedeclaration);
8688     Previous.clear();
8689     Previous.setLookupName(Name);
8690   }
8691 
8692   SemaRef.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagMsg)
8693       << Name << NewDC << IsDefinition << NewFD->getLocation();
8694 
8695   bool NewFDisConst = false;
8696   if (CXXMethodDecl *NewMD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD))
8697     NewFDisConst = NewMD->isConst();
8698 
8699   for (SmallVectorImpl<std::pair<FunctionDecl *, unsigned> >::iterator
8700        NearMatch = NearMatches.begin(), NearMatchEnd = NearMatches.end();
8701        NearMatch != NearMatchEnd; ++NearMatch) {
8702     FunctionDecl *FD = NearMatch->first;
8703     CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
8704     bool FDisConst = MD && MD->isConst();
8705     bool IsMember = MD || !IsLocalFriend;
8706 
8707     // FIXME: These notes are poorly worded for the local friend case.
8708     if (unsigned Idx = NearMatch->second) {
8709       ParmVarDecl *FDParam = FD->getParamDecl(Idx-1);
8710       SourceLocation Loc = FDParam->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
8711       if (Loc.isInvalid()) Loc = FD->getLocation();
8712       SemaRef.Diag(Loc, IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_param_match
8713                                  : diag::note_local_decl_close_param_match)
8714         << Idx << FDParam->getType()
8715         << NewFD->getParamDecl(Idx - 1)->getType();
8716     } else if (FDisConst != NewFDisConst) {
8717       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_member_def_close_const_match)
8718           << NewFDisConst << FD->getSourceRange().getEnd()
8719           << (NewFDisConst
8720                   ? FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo()
8721                                                  .getConstQualifierLoc())
8722                   : FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ExtraArgs.D.getFunctionTypeInfo()
8723                                                    .getRParenLoc()
8724                                                    .getLocWithOffset(1),
8725                                                " const"));
8726     } else
8727       SemaRef.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
8728                    IsMember ? diag::note_member_def_close_match
8729                             : diag::note_local_decl_close_match);
8730   }
8731   return nullptr;
8732 }
8733 
8734 static StorageClass getFunctionStorageClass(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D) {
8735   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec()) {
8736   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown storage class!");
8737   case DeclSpec::SCS_auto:
8738   case DeclSpec::SCS_register:
8739   case DeclSpec::SCS_mutable:
8740     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8741                  diag::err_typecheck_sclass_func);
8742     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
8743     D.setInvalidType();
8744     break;
8745   case DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified: break;
8746   case DeclSpec::SCS_extern:
8747     if (D.getDeclSpec().isExternInLinkageSpec())
8748       return SC_None;
8749     return SC_Extern;
8750   case DeclSpec::SCS_static: {
8751     if (SemaRef.CurContext->getRedeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
8752       // C99 6.7.1p5:
8753       //   The declaration of an identifier for a function that has
8754       //   block scope shall have no explicit storage-class specifier
8755       //   other than extern
8756       // See also (C++ [dcl.stc]p4).
8757       SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
8758                    diag::err_static_block_func);
8759       break;
8760     } else
8761       return SC_Static;
8762   }
8763   case DeclSpec::SCS_private_extern: return SC_PrivateExtern;
8764   }
8765 
8766   // No explicit storage class has already been returned
8767   return SC_None;
8768 }
8769 
8770 static FunctionDecl *CreateNewFunctionDecl(Sema &SemaRef, Declarator &D,
8771                                            DeclContext *DC, QualType &R,
8772                                            TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
8773                                            StorageClass SC,
8774                                            bool &IsVirtualOkay) {
8775   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameForDeclarator(D);
8776   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
8777 
8778   FunctionDecl *NewFD = nullptr;
8779   bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
8780 
8781   if (!SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
8782     // Determine whether the function was written with a prototype. This is
8783     // true when:
8784     //   - there is a prototype in the declarator, or
8785     //   - the type R of the function is some kind of typedef or other non-
8786     //     attributed reference to a type name (which eventually refers to a
8787     //     function type). Note, we can't always look at the adjusted type to
8788     //     check this case because attributes may cause a non-function
8789     //     declarator to still have a function type. e.g.,
8790     //       typedef void func(int a);
8791     //       __attribute__((noreturn)) func other_func; // This has a prototype
8792     bool HasPrototype =
8793         (D.isFunctionDeclarator() && D.getFunctionTypeInfo().hasPrototype) ||
8794         (D.getDeclSpec().isTypeRep() &&
8795          D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsType().get()->isFunctionProtoType()) ||
8796         (!R->getAsAdjusted<FunctionType>() && R->isFunctionProtoType());
8797     assert(
8798         (HasPrototype || !SemaRef.getLangOpts().requiresStrictPrototypes()) &&
8799         "Strict prototypes are required");
8800 
8801     NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create(
8802         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8803         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline, HasPrototype,
8804         ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified,
8805         /*TrailingRequiresClause=*/nullptr);
8806     if (D.isInvalidType())
8807       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
8808 
8809     return NewFD;
8810   }
8811 
8812   ExplicitSpecifier ExplicitSpecifier = D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecifier();
8813 
8814   ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
8815   if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Constinit) {
8816     SemaRef.Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
8817                  diag::err_constexpr_wrong_decl_kind)
8818         << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
8819     ConstexprKind = ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified;
8820     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearConstexprSpec();
8821   }
8822   Expr *TrailingRequiresClause = D.getTrailingRequiresClause();
8823 
8824   // Check that the return type is not an abstract class type.
8825   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
8826   // the class has been completely parsed.
8827   if (!DC->isRecord() &&
8828       SemaRef.RequireNonAbstractType(
8829           D.getIdentifierLoc(), R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType(),
8830           diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl, SemaRef.AbstractReturnType))
8831     D.setInvalidType();
8832 
8833   if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConstructorName) {
8834     // This is a C++ constructor declaration.
8835     assert(DC->isRecord() &&
8836            "Constructors can only be declared in a member context");
8837 
8838     R = SemaRef.CheckConstructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8839     return CXXConstructorDecl::Create(
8840         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8841         TInfo, ExplicitSpecifier, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(),
8842         isInline, /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8843         InheritedConstructor(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8844 
8845   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
8846     // This is a C++ destructor declaration.
8847     if (DC->isRecord()) {
8848       R = SemaRef.CheckDestructorDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8849       CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC);
8850       CXXDestructorDecl *NewDD = CXXDestructorDecl::Create(
8851           SemaRef.Context, Record, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8852           SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8853           /*isImplicitlyDeclared=*/false, ConstexprKind,
8854           TrailingRequiresClause);
8855       // User defined destructors start as not selected if the class definition is still
8856       // not done.
8857       if (Record->isBeingDefined())
8858         NewDD->setIneligibleOrNotSelected(true);
8859 
8860       // If the destructor needs an implicit exception specification, set it
8861       // now. FIXME: It'd be nice to be able to create the right type to start
8862       // with, but the type needs to reference the destructor declaration.
8863       if (SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
8864         SemaRef.AdjustDestructorExceptionSpec(NewDD);
8865 
8866       IsVirtualOkay = true;
8867       return NewDD;
8868 
8869     } else {
8870       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_destructor_not_member);
8871       D.setInvalidType();
8872 
8873       // Create a FunctionDecl to satisfy the function definition parsing
8874       // code path.
8875       return FunctionDecl::Create(
8876           SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(), Name, R,
8877           TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8878           /*hasPrototype=*/true, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8879     }
8880 
8881   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
8882     if (!DC->isRecord()) {
8883       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(),
8884            diag::err_conv_function_not_member);
8885       return nullptr;
8886     }
8887 
8888     SemaRef.CheckConversionDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8889     if (D.isInvalidType())
8890       return nullptr;
8891 
8892     IsVirtualOkay = true;
8893     return CXXConversionDecl::Create(
8894         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8895         TInfo, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8896         ExplicitSpecifier, ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(),
8897         TrailingRequiresClause);
8898 
8899   } else if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDeductionGuideName) {
8900     if (TrailingRequiresClause)
8901       SemaRef.Diag(TrailingRequiresClause->getBeginLoc(),
8902                    diag::err_trailing_requires_clause_on_deduction_guide)
8903           << TrailingRequiresClause->getSourceRange();
8904     SemaRef.CheckDeductionGuideDeclarator(D, R, SC);
8905 
8906     return CXXDeductionGuideDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(),
8907                                          ExplicitSpecifier, NameInfo, R, TInfo,
8908                                          D.getEndLoc());
8909   } else if (DC->isRecord()) {
8910     // If the name of the function is the same as the name of the record,
8911     // then this must be an invalid constructor that has a return type.
8912     // (The parser checks for a return type and makes the declarator a
8913     // constructor if it has no return type).
8914     if (Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() &&
8915         Name.getAsIdentifierInfo() == cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getIdentifier()){
8916       SemaRef.Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_constructor_return_type)
8917         << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecTypeLoc())
8918         << SourceRange(D.getIdentifierLoc());
8919       return nullptr;
8920     }
8921 
8922     // This is a C++ method declaration.
8923     CXXMethodDecl *Ret = CXXMethodDecl::Create(
8924         SemaRef.Context, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC), D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R,
8925         TInfo, SC, SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8926         ConstexprKind, SourceLocation(), TrailingRequiresClause);
8927     IsVirtualOkay = !Ret->isStatic();
8928     return Ret;
8929   } else {
8930     bool isFriend =
8931         SemaRef.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
8932     if (!isFriend && SemaRef.CurContext->isRecord())
8933       return nullptr;
8934 
8935     // Determine whether the function was written with a
8936     // prototype. This true when:
8937     //   - we're in C++ (where every function has a prototype),
8938     return FunctionDecl::Create(
8939         SemaRef.Context, DC, D.getBeginLoc(), NameInfo, R, TInfo, SC,
8940         SemaRef.getCurFPFeatures().isFPConstrained(), isInline,
8941         true /*HasPrototype*/, ConstexprKind, TrailingRequiresClause);
8942   }
8943 }
8944 
8945 enum OpenCLParamType {
8946   ValidKernelParam,
8947   PtrPtrKernelParam,
8948   PtrKernelParam,
8949   InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam,
8950   InvalidKernelParam,
8951   RecordKernelParam
8952 };
8953 
8954 static bool isOpenCLSizeDependentType(ASTContext &C, QualType Ty) {
8955   // Size dependent types are just typedefs to normal integer types
8956   // (e.g. unsigned long), so we cannot distinguish them from other typedefs to
8957   // integers other than by their names.
8958   StringRef SizeTypeNames[] = {"size_t", "intptr_t", "uintptr_t", "ptrdiff_t"};
8959 
8960   // Remove typedefs one by one until we reach a typedef
8961   // for a size dependent type.
8962   QualType DesugaredTy = Ty;
8963   do {
8964     ArrayRef<StringRef> Names(SizeTypeNames);
8965     auto Match = llvm::find(Names, DesugaredTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString());
8966     if (Names.end() != Match)
8967       return true;
8968 
8969     Ty = DesugaredTy;
8970     DesugaredTy = Ty.getSingleStepDesugaredType(C);
8971   } while (DesugaredTy != Ty);
8972 
8973   return false;
8974 }
8975 
8976 static OpenCLParamType getOpenCLKernelParameterType(Sema &S, QualType PT) {
8977   if (PT->isDependentType())
8978     return InvalidKernelParam;
8979 
8980   if (PT->isPointerType() || PT->isReferenceType()) {
8981     QualType PointeeType = PT->getPointeeType();
8982     if (PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_generic ||
8983         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private ||
8984         PointeeType.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::Default)
8985       return InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam;
8986 
8987     if (PointeeType->isPointerType()) {
8988       // This is a pointer to pointer parameter.
8989       // Recursively check inner type.
8990       OpenCLParamType ParamKind = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PointeeType);
8991       if (ParamKind == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam ||
8992           ParamKind == InvalidKernelParam)
8993         return ParamKind;
8994 
8995       return PtrPtrKernelParam;
8996     }
8997 
8998     // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
8999     // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
9000     // Standard layout types for pointer parameters. The same applies to
9001     // reference if an implementation supports them in kernel parameters.
9002     if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
9003         !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
9004             "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9005         !PointeeType->isAtomicType() && !PointeeType->isVoidType() &&
9006         !PointeeType->isStandardLayoutType())
9007       return InvalidKernelParam;
9008 
9009     return PtrKernelParam;
9010   }
9011 
9012   // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
9013   // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
9014   // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
9015   // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be one
9016   // of these built-in scalar types.
9017   if (isOpenCLSizeDependentType(S.getASTContext(), PT))
9018     return InvalidKernelParam;
9019 
9020   if (PT->isImageType())
9021     return PtrKernelParam;
9022 
9023   if (PT->isBooleanType() || PT->isEventT() || PT->isReserveIDT())
9024     return InvalidKernelParam;
9025 
9026   // OpenCL extension spec v1.2 s9.5:
9027   // This extension adds support for half scalar and vector types as built-in
9028   // types that can be used for arithmetic operations, conversions etc.
9029   if (!S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption("cl_khr_fp16", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9030       PT->isHalfType())
9031     return InvalidKernelParam;
9032 
9033   // Look into an array argument to check if it has a forbidden type.
9034   if (PT->isArrayType()) {
9035     const Type *UnderlyingTy = PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
9036     // Call ourself to check an underlying type of an array. Since the
9037     // getPointeeOrArrayElementType returns an innermost type which is not an
9038     // array, this recursive call only happens once.
9039     return getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QualType(UnderlyingTy, 0));
9040   }
9041 
9042   // C++ for OpenCL v1.0 s2.4:
9043   // Moreover the types used in parameters of the kernel functions must be:
9044   // Trivial and standard-layout types C++17 [basic.types] (plain old data
9045   // types) for parameters passed by value;
9046   if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus &&
9047       !S.getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
9048           "__cl_clang_non_portable_kernel_param_types", S.getLangOpts()) &&
9049       !PT->isOpenCLSpecificType() && !PT.isPODType(S.Context))
9050     return InvalidKernelParam;
9051 
9052   if (PT->isRecordType())
9053     return RecordKernelParam;
9054 
9055   return ValidKernelParam;
9056 }
9057 
9058 static void checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(
9059   Sema &S,
9060   Declarator &D,
9061   ParmVarDecl *Param,
9062   llvm::SmallPtrSetImpl<const Type *> &ValidTypes) {
9063   QualType PT = Param->getType();
9064 
9065   // Cache the valid types we encounter to avoid rechecking structs that are
9066   // used again
9067   if (ValidTypes.count(PT.getTypePtr()))
9068     return;
9069 
9070   switch (getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, PT)) {
9071   case PtrPtrKernelParam:
9072     // OpenCL v3.0 s6.11.a:
9073     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared as a pointer to a pointer
9074     // type. [...] This restriction only applies to OpenCL C 1.2 or below.
9075     if (S.getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() <= 120) {
9076       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_ptrptr_kernel_param);
9077       D.setInvalidType();
9078       return;
9079     }
9080 
9081     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
9082     return;
9083 
9084   case InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam:
9085     // OpenCL v1.0 s6.5:
9086     // __kernel function arguments declared to be a pointer of a type can point
9087     // to one of the following address spaces only : __global, __local or
9088     // __constant.
9089     S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_kernel_arg_address_space);
9090     D.setInvalidType();
9091     return;
9092 
9093     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.k:
9094     // Arguments to kernel functions in a program cannot be declared with the
9095     // built-in scalar types bool, half, size_t, ptrdiff_t, intptr_t, and
9096     // uintptr_t or a struct and/or union that contain fields declared to be
9097     // one of these built-in scalar types.
9098 
9099   case InvalidKernelParam:
9100     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 n:
9101     // A kernel function argument cannot be declared
9102     // of event_t type.
9103     // Do not diagnose half type since it is diagnosed as invalid argument
9104     // type for any function elsewhere.
9105     if (!PT->isHalfType()) {
9106       S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
9107 
9108       // Explain what typedefs are involved.
9109       const TypedefType *Typedef = nullptr;
9110       while ((Typedef = PT->getAs<TypedefType>())) {
9111         SourceLocation Loc = Typedef->getDecl()->getLocation();
9112         // SourceLocation may be invalid for a built-in type.
9113         if (Loc.isValid())
9114           S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_entity_declared_at) << PT;
9115         PT = Typedef->desugar();
9116       }
9117     }
9118 
9119     D.setInvalidType();
9120     return;
9121 
9122   case PtrKernelParam:
9123   case ValidKernelParam:
9124     ValidTypes.insert(PT.getTypePtr());
9125     return;
9126 
9127   case RecordKernelParam:
9128     break;
9129   }
9130 
9131   // Track nested structs we will inspect
9132   SmallVector<const Decl *, 4> VisitStack;
9133 
9134   // Track where we are in the nested structs. Items will migrate from
9135   // VisitStack to HistoryStack as we do the DFS for bad field.
9136   SmallVector<const FieldDecl *, 4> HistoryStack;
9137   HistoryStack.push_back(nullptr);
9138 
9139   // At this point we already handled everything except of a RecordType or
9140   // an ArrayType of a RecordType.
9141   assert((PT->isArrayType() || PT->isRecordType()) && "Unexpected type.");
9142   const RecordType *RecTy =
9143       PT->getPointeeOrArrayElementType()->getAs<RecordType>();
9144   const RecordDecl *OrigRecDecl = RecTy->getDecl();
9145 
9146   VisitStack.push_back(RecTy->getDecl());
9147   assert(VisitStack.back() && "First decl null?");
9148 
9149   do {
9150     const Decl *Next = VisitStack.pop_back_val();
9151     if (!Next) {
9152       assert(!HistoryStack.empty());
9153       // Found a marker, we have gone up a level
9154       if (const FieldDecl *Hist = HistoryStack.pop_back_val())
9155         ValidTypes.insert(Hist->getType().getTypePtr());
9156 
9157       continue;
9158     }
9159 
9160     // Adds everything except the original parameter declaration (which is not a
9161     // field itself) to the history stack.
9162     const RecordDecl *RD;
9163     if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(Next)) {
9164       HistoryStack.push_back(Field);
9165 
9166       QualType FieldTy = Field->getType();
9167       // Other field types (known to be valid or invalid) are handled while we
9168       // walk around RecordDecl::fields().
9169       assert((FieldTy->isArrayType() || FieldTy->isRecordType()) &&
9170              "Unexpected type.");
9171       const Type *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getPointeeOrArrayElementType();
9172 
9173       RD = FieldRecTy->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
9174     } else {
9175       RD = cast<RecordDecl>(Next);
9176     }
9177 
9178     // Add a null marker so we know when we've gone back up a level
9179     VisitStack.push_back(nullptr);
9180 
9181     for (const auto *FD : RD->fields()) {
9182       QualType QT = FD->getType();
9183 
9184       if (ValidTypes.count(QT.getTypePtr()))
9185         continue;
9186 
9187       OpenCLParamType ParamType = getOpenCLKernelParameterType(S, QT);
9188       if (ParamType == ValidKernelParam)
9189         continue;
9190 
9191       if (ParamType == RecordKernelParam) {
9192         VisitStack.push_back(FD);
9193         continue;
9194       }
9195 
9196       // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.p:
9197       // Arguments to kernel functions that are declared to be a struct or union
9198       // do not allow OpenCL objects to be passed as elements of the struct or
9199       // union.
9200       if (ParamType == PtrKernelParam || ParamType == PtrPtrKernelParam ||
9201           ParamType == InvalidAddrSpacePtrKernelParam) {
9202         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(),
9203                diag::err_record_with_pointers_kernel_param)
9204           << PT->isUnionType()
9205           << PT;
9206       } else {
9207         S.Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_kernel_param_type) << PT;
9208       }
9209 
9210       S.Diag(OrigRecDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
9211           << OrigRecDecl->getDeclName();
9212 
9213       // We have an error, now let's go back up through history and show where
9214       // the offending field came from
9215       for (ArrayRef<const FieldDecl *>::const_iterator
9216                I = HistoryStack.begin() + 1,
9217                E = HistoryStack.end();
9218            I != E; ++I) {
9219         const FieldDecl *OuterField = *I;
9220         S.Diag(OuterField->getLocation(), diag::note_within_field_of_type)
9221           << OuterField->getType();
9222       }
9223 
9224       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_illegal_field_declared_here)
9225         << QT->isPointerType()
9226         << QT;
9227       D.setInvalidType();
9228       return;
9229     }
9230   } while (!VisitStack.empty());
9231 }
9232 
9233 /// Find the DeclContext in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
9234 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
9235 /// nothing.
9236 static DeclContext *getTagInjectionContext(DeclContext *DC) {
9237   while (!DC->isFileContext() && !DC->isFunctionOrMethod())
9238     DC = DC->getParent();
9239   return DC;
9240 }
9241 
9242 /// Find the Scope in which a tag is implicitly declared if we see an
9243 /// elaborated type specifier in the specified context, and lookup finds
9244 /// nothing.
9245 static Scope *getTagInjectionScope(Scope *S, const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
9246   while (S->isClassScope() ||
9247          (LangOpts.CPlusPlus &&
9248           S->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) ||
9249          ((S->getFlags() & Scope::DeclScope) == 0) ||
9250          (S->getEntity() && S->getEntity()->isTransparentContext()))
9251     S = S->getParent();
9252   return S;
9253 }
9254 
9255 /// Determine whether a declaration matches a known function in namespace std.
9256 static bool isStdBuiltin(ASTContext &Ctx, FunctionDecl *FD,
9257                          unsigned BuiltinID) {
9258   switch (BuiltinID) {
9259   case Builtin::BI__GetExceptionInfo:
9260     // No type checking whatsoever.
9261     return Ctx.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft();
9262 
9263   case Builtin::BIaddressof:
9264   case Builtin::BI__addressof:
9265   case Builtin::BIforward:
9266   case Builtin::BImove:
9267   case Builtin::BImove_if_noexcept:
9268   case Builtin::BIas_const: {
9269     // Ensure that we don't treat the algorithm
9270     //   OutputIt std::move(InputIt, InputIt, OutputIt)
9271     // as the builtin std::move.
9272     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9273     return FPT->getNumParams() == 1 && !FPT->isVariadic();
9274   }
9275 
9276   default:
9277     return false;
9278   }
9279 }
9280 
9281 NamedDecl*
9282 Sema::ActOnFunctionDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D, DeclContext *DC,
9283                               TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, LookupResult &Previous,
9284                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParamListsRef,
9285                               bool &AddToScope) {
9286   QualType R = TInfo->getType();
9287 
9288   assert(R->isFunctionType());
9289   if (R.getCanonicalType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCmseNSCallAttr())
9290     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_decl_cmse_ns_call);
9291 
9292   SmallVector<TemplateParameterList *, 4> TemplateParamLists;
9293   llvm::append_range(TemplateParamLists, TemplateParamListsRef);
9294   if (TemplateParameterList *Invented = D.getInventedTemplateParameterList()) {
9295     if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() &&
9296         Invented->getDepth() == TemplateParamLists.back()->getDepth())
9297       TemplateParamLists.back() = Invented;
9298     else
9299       TemplateParamLists.push_back(Invented);
9300   }
9301 
9302   // TODO: consider using NameInfo for diagnostic.
9303   DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo = GetNameForDeclarator(D);
9304   DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
9305   StorageClass SC = getFunctionStorageClass(*this, D);
9306 
9307   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
9308     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9309          diag::err_invalid_thread)
9310       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
9311 
9312   if (D.isFirstDeclarationOfMember())
9313     adjustMemberFunctionCC(R, D.isStaticMember(), D.isCtorOrDtor(),
9314                            D.getIdentifierLoc());
9315 
9316   bool isFriend = false;
9317   FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate = nullptr;
9318   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
9319   bool isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9320 
9321   bool isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = false;
9322   bool HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9323   TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgs;
9324 
9325   bool isVirtualOkay = false;
9326 
9327   DeclContext *OriginalDC = DC;
9328   bool IsLocalExternDecl = adjustContextForLocalExternDecl(DC);
9329 
9330   FunctionDecl *NewFD = CreateNewFunctionDecl(*this, D, DC, R, TInfo, SC,
9331                                               isVirtualOkay);
9332   if (!NewFD) return nullptr;
9333 
9334   if (OriginalLexicalContext && OriginalLexicalContext->isObjCContainer())
9335     NewFD->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
9336 
9337   // Set the lexical context. If this is a function-scope declaration, or has a
9338   // C++ scope specifier, or is the object of a friend declaration, the lexical
9339   // context will be different from the semantic context.
9340   NewFD->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9341 
9342   if (IsLocalExternDecl)
9343     NewFD->setLocalExternDecl();
9344 
9345   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9346     bool isInline = D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified();
9347     bool isVirtual = D.getDeclSpec().isVirtualSpecified();
9348     bool hasExplicit = D.getDeclSpec().hasExplicitSpecifier();
9349     isFriend = D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified();
9350     if (isFriend && !isInline && D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9351       // C++ [class.friend]p5
9352       //   A function can be defined in a friend declaration of a
9353       //   class . . . . Such a function is implicitly inline.
9354       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9355     }
9356 
9357     // If this is a method defined in an __interface, and is not a constructor
9358     // or an overloaded operator, then set the pure flag (isVirtual will already
9359     // return true).
9360     if (const CXXRecordDecl *Parent =
9361           dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext())) {
9362       if (Parent->isInterface() && cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)->isUserProvided())
9363         NewFD->setPure(true);
9364 
9365       // C++ [class.union]p2
9366       //   A union can have member functions, but not virtual functions.
9367       if (isVirtual && Parent->isUnion()) {
9368         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_virtual_in_union);
9369         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9370       }
9371       if ((Parent->isClass() || Parent->isStruct()) &&
9372           Parent->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>() &&
9373           NewFD->getKind() == Decl::Kind::CXXMethod && NewFD->getIdentifier() &&
9374           NewFD->getName() == "__init" && D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9375         if (auto *Def = Parent->getDefinition())
9376           Def->setInitMethod(true);
9377       }
9378     }
9379 
9380     SetNestedNameSpecifier(*this, NewFD, D);
9381     isMemberSpecialization = false;
9382     isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = false;
9383     if (D.isInvalidType())
9384       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9385 
9386     // Match up the template parameter lists with the scope specifier, then
9387     // determine whether we have a template or a template specialization.
9388     bool Invalid = false;
9389     TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
9390         MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
9391             D.getDeclSpec().getBeginLoc(), D.getIdentifierLoc(),
9392             D.getCXXScopeSpec(),
9393             D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId
9394                 ? D.getName().TemplateId
9395                 : nullptr,
9396             TemplateParamLists, isFriend, isMemberSpecialization,
9397             Invalid);
9398     if (TemplateParams) {
9399       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9400       if (CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParams))
9401         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9402 
9403       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
9404         // This is a function template
9405 
9406         // A destructor cannot be a template.
9407         if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
9408           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_template);
9409           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9410         }
9411 
9412         // If we're adding a template to a dependent context, we may need to
9413         // rebuilding some of the types used within the template parameter list,
9414         // now that we know what the current instantiation is.
9415         if (DC->isDependentContext()) {
9416           ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, DC);
9417           if (RebuildTemplateParamsInCurrentInstantiation(TemplateParams))
9418             Invalid = true;
9419         }
9420 
9421         FunctionTemplate = FunctionTemplateDecl::Create(Context, DC,
9422                                                         NewFD->getLocation(),
9423                                                         Name, TemplateParams,
9424                                                         NewFD);
9425         FunctionTemplate->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
9426         NewFD->setDescribedFunctionTemplate(FunctionTemplate);
9427 
9428         // For source fidelity, store the other template param lists.
9429         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 1) {
9430           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context,
9431               ArrayRef<TemplateParameterList *>(TemplateParamLists)
9432                   .drop_back(1));
9433         }
9434       } else {
9435         // This is a function template specialization.
9436         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9437         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9438         if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9439           NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9440 
9441         // C++0x [temp.expl.spec]p20 forbids "template<> friend void foo(int);".
9442         if (isFriend) {
9443           // We want to remove the "template<>", found here.
9444           SourceRange RemoveRange = TemplateParams->getSourceRange();
9445 
9446           // If we remove the template<> and the name is not a
9447           // template-id, we're actually silently creating a problem:
9448           // the friend declaration will refer to an untemplated decl,
9449           // and clearly the user wants a template specialization.  So
9450           // we need to insert '<>' after the name.
9451           SourceLocation InsertLoc;
9452           if (D.getName().getKind() != UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9453             InsertLoc = D.getName().getSourceRange().getEnd();
9454             InsertLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(InsertLoc);
9455           }
9456 
9457           Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_spec_decl_friend)
9458             << Name << RemoveRange
9459             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(RemoveRange)
9460             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(InsertLoc, "<>");
9461           Invalid = true;
9462         }
9463       }
9464     } else {
9465       // Check that we can declare a template here.
9466       if (!TemplateParamLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
9467           CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParamLists.back()))
9468         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9469 
9470       // All template param lists were matched against the scope specifier:
9471       // this is NOT (an explicit specialization of) a template.
9472       if (TemplateParamLists.size() > 0)
9473         // For source fidelity, store all the template param lists.
9474         NewFD->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParamLists);
9475     }
9476 
9477     if (Invalid) {
9478       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9479       if (FunctionTemplate)
9480         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
9481     }
9482 
9483     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p5:
9484     //   The virtual specifier shall only be used in declarations of
9485     //   nonstatic class member functions that appear within a
9486     //   member-specification of a class declaration; see 10.3.
9487     //
9488     if (isVirtual && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9489       if (!isVirtualOkay) {
9490         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9491              diag::err_virtual_non_function);
9492       } else if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9493         // 'virtual' was specified outside of the class.
9494         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9495              diag::err_virtual_out_of_class)
9496           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9497       } else if (NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
9498         // C++ [temp.mem]p3:
9499         //  A member function template shall not be virtual.
9500         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(),
9501              diag::err_virtual_member_function_template)
9502           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc());
9503       } else {
9504         // Okay: Add virtual to the method.
9505         NewFD->setVirtualAsWritten(true);
9506       }
9507 
9508       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9509           NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType())
9510         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getVirtualSpecLoc(), diag::err_auto_fn_virtual);
9511     }
9512 
9513     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
9514         (NewFD->isDependentContext() ||
9515          (isFriend && CurContext->isDependentContext())) &&
9516         NewFD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
9517       // If the function template is referenced directly (for instance, as a
9518       // member of the current instantiation), pretend it has a dependent type.
9519       // This is not really justified by the standard, but is the only sane
9520       // thing to do.
9521       // FIXME: For a friend function, we have not marked the function as being
9522       // a friend yet, so 'isDependentContext' on the FD doesn't work.
9523       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
9524           NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9525       QualType Result = SubstAutoTypeDependent(FPT->getReturnType());
9526       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(Result, FPT->getParamTypes(),
9527                                              FPT->getExtProtoInfo()));
9528     }
9529 
9530     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p3:
9531     //  The inline specifier shall not appear on a block scope function
9532     //  declaration.
9533     if (isInline && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9534       if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) {
9535         // 'inline' is not allowed on block scope function declaration.
9536         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9537              diag::err_inline_declaration_block_scope) << Name
9538           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc());
9539       }
9540     }
9541 
9542     // C++ [dcl.fct.spec]p6:
9543     //  The explicit specifier shall be used only in the declaration of a
9544     //  constructor or conversion function within its class definition;
9545     //  see 12.3.1 and 12.3.2.
9546     if (hasExplicit && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9547         !isa<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
9548       if (!CurContext->isRecord()) {
9549         // 'explicit' was specified outside of the class.
9550         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9551              diag::err_explicit_out_of_class)
9552             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9553       } else if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9554                  !isa<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD)) {
9555         // 'explicit' was specified on a function that wasn't a constructor
9556         // or conversion function.
9557         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecLoc(),
9558              diag::err_explicit_non_ctor_or_conv_function)
9559             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getExplicitSpecRange());
9560       }
9561     }
9562 
9563     ConstexprSpecKind ConstexprKind = D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier();
9564     if (ConstexprKind != ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified) {
9565       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p2: constexpr functions and constexpr constructors
9566       // are implicitly inline.
9567       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9568 
9569       // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p3: functions declared constexpr are required to
9570       // be either constructors or to return a literal type. Therefore,
9571       // destructors cannot be declared constexpr.
9572       if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD) &&
9573           (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20 ||
9574            ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval)) {
9575         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_dtor)
9576             << static_cast<int>(ConstexprKind);
9577         NewFD->setConstexprKind(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20
9578                                     ? ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified
9579                                     : ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9580       }
9581       // C++20 [dcl.constexpr]p2: An allocation function, or a
9582       // deallocation function shall not be declared with the consteval
9583       // specifier.
9584       if (ConstexprKind == ConstexprSpecKind::Consteval &&
9585           (NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_New ||
9586            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_New ||
9587            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9588            NewFD->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete)) {
9589         Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecLoc(),
9590              diag::err_invalid_consteval_decl_kind)
9591             << NewFD;
9592         NewFD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Constexpr);
9593       }
9594     }
9595 
9596     // If __module_private__ was specified, mark the function accordingly.
9597     if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
9598       if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9599         SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc
9600           = D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc();
9601         Diag(ModulePrivateLoc, diag::err_module_private_specialization)
9602           << 0
9603           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
9604       } else {
9605         NewFD->setModulePrivate();
9606         if (FunctionTemplate)
9607           FunctionTemplate->setModulePrivate();
9608       }
9609     }
9610 
9611     if (isFriend) {
9612       if (FunctionTemplate) {
9613         FunctionTemplate->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9614         FunctionTemplate->setAccess(AS_public);
9615       }
9616       NewFD->setObjectOfFriendDecl();
9617       NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
9618     }
9619 
9620     // If a function is defined as defaulted or deleted, mark it as such now.
9621     // We'll do the relevant checks on defaulted / deleted functions later.
9622     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
9623     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
9624     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
9625       break;
9626 
9627     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
9628       NewFD->setDefaulted();
9629       break;
9630 
9631     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
9632       NewFD->setDeletedAsWritten();
9633       break;
9634     }
9635 
9636     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && DC == CurContext &&
9637         D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9638       // C++ [class.mfct]p2:
9639       //   A member function may be defined (8.4) in its class definition, in
9640       //   which case it is an inline member function (7.1.2)
9641       NewFD->setImplicitlyInline();
9642     }
9643 
9644     if (SC == SC_Static && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) &&
9645         !CurContext->isRecord()) {
9646       // C++ [class.static]p1:
9647       //   A data or function member of a class may be declared static
9648       //   in a class definition, in which case it is a static member of
9649       //   the class.
9650 
9651       // Complain about the 'static' specifier if it's on an out-of-line
9652       // member function definition.
9653 
9654       // MSVC permits the use of a 'static' storage specifier on an out-of-line
9655       // member function template declaration and class member template
9656       // declaration (MSVC versions before 2015), warn about this.
9657       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
9658            ((!getLangOpts().isCompatibleWithMSVC(LangOptions::MSVC2015) &&
9659              cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getDescribedClassTemplate()) ||
9660            (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()))
9661            ? diag::ext_static_out_of_line : diag::err_static_out_of_line)
9662         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9663     }
9664 
9665     // C++11 [except.spec]p15:
9666     //   A deallocation function with no exception-specification is treated
9667     //   as if it were specified with noexcept(true).
9668     const FunctionProtoType *FPT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9669     if ((Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Delete ||
9670          Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator() == OO_Array_Delete) &&
9671         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && FPT && !FPT->hasExceptionSpec())
9672       NewFD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(
9673           FPT->getReturnType(), FPT->getParamTypes(),
9674           FPT->getExtProtoInfo().withExceptionSpec(EST_BasicNoexcept)));
9675   }
9676 
9677   // Filter out previous declarations that don't match the scope.
9678   FilterLookupForScope(Previous, OriginalDC, S, shouldConsiderLinkage(NewFD),
9679                        D.getCXXScopeSpec().isNotEmpty() ||
9680                        isMemberSpecialization ||
9681                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization);
9682 
9683   // Handle GNU asm-label extension (encoded as an attribute).
9684   if (Expr *E = (Expr*) D.getAsmLabel()) {
9685     // The parser guarantees this is a string.
9686     StringLiteral *SE = cast<StringLiteral>(E);
9687     NewFD->addAttr(AsmLabelAttr::Create(Context, SE->getString(),
9688                                         /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true,
9689                                         SE->getStrTokenLoc(0)));
9690   } else if (!ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.empty()) {
9691     llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*,AsmLabelAttr*>::iterator I =
9692       ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.find(NewFD->getIdentifier());
9693     if (I != ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.end()) {
9694       if (isDeclExternC(NewFD)) {
9695         NewFD->addAttr(I->second);
9696         ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.erase(I);
9697       } else
9698         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
9699             << /*Variable*/0 << NewFD;
9700     }
9701   }
9702 
9703   // Copy the parameter declarations from the declarator D to the function
9704   // declaration NewFD, if they are available.  First scavenge them into Params.
9705   SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params;
9706   unsigned FTIIdx;
9707   if (D.isFunctionDeclarator(FTIIdx)) {
9708     DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getTypeObject(FTIIdx).Fun;
9709 
9710     // Check for C99 6.7.5.3p10 - foo(void) is a non-varargs
9711     // function that takes no arguments, not a function that takes a
9712     // single void argument.
9713     // We let through "const void" here because Sema::GetTypeForDeclarator
9714     // already checks for that case.
9715     if (FTIHasNonVoidParameters(FTI) && FTI.Params[0].Param) {
9716       for (unsigned i = 0, e = FTI.NumParams; i != e; ++i) {
9717         ParmVarDecl *Param = cast<ParmVarDecl>(FTI.Params[i].Param);
9718         assert(Param->getDeclContext() != NewFD && "Was set before ?");
9719         Param->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9720         Params.push_back(Param);
9721 
9722         if (Param->isInvalidDecl())
9723           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9724       }
9725     }
9726 
9727     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9728       // In C, find all the tag declarations from the prototype and move them
9729       // into the function DeclContext. Remove them from the surrounding tag
9730       // injection context of the function, which is typically but not always
9731       // the TU.
9732       DeclContext *PrototypeTagContext =
9733           getTagInjectionContext(NewFD->getLexicalDeclContext());
9734       for (NamedDecl *NonParmDecl : FTI.getDeclsInPrototype()) {
9735         auto *TD = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(NonParmDecl);
9736 
9737         // We don't want to reparent enumerators. Look at their parent enum
9738         // instead.
9739         if (!TD) {
9740           if (auto *ECD = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(NonParmDecl))
9741             TD = cast<EnumDecl>(ECD->getDeclContext());
9742         }
9743         if (!TD)
9744           continue;
9745         DeclContext *TagDC = TD->getLexicalDeclContext();
9746         if (!TagDC->containsDecl(TD))
9747           continue;
9748         TagDC->removeDecl(TD);
9749         TD->setDeclContext(NewFD);
9750         NewFD->addDecl(TD);
9751 
9752         // Preserve the lexical DeclContext if it is not the surrounding tag
9753         // injection context of the FD. In this example, the semantic context of
9754         // E will be f and the lexical context will be S, while both the
9755         // semantic and lexical contexts of S will be f:
9756         //   void f(struct S { enum E { a } f; } s);
9757         if (TagDC != PrototypeTagContext)
9758           TD->setLexicalDeclContext(TagDC);
9759       }
9760     }
9761   } else if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = R->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
9762     // When we're declaring a function with a typedef, typeof, etc as in the
9763     // following example, we'll need to synthesize (unnamed)
9764     // parameters for use in the declaration.
9765     //
9766     // @code
9767     // typedef void fn(int);
9768     // fn f;
9769     // @endcode
9770 
9771     // Synthesize a parameter for each argument type.
9772     for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) {
9773       ParmVarDecl *Param =
9774           BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(NewFD, D.getIdentifierLoc(), AI);
9775       Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size());
9776       Params.push_back(Param);
9777     }
9778   } else {
9779     assert(R->isFunctionNoProtoType() && NewFD->getNumParams() == 0 &&
9780            "Should not need args for typedef of non-prototype fn");
9781   }
9782 
9783   // Finally, we know we have the right number of parameters, install them.
9784   NewFD->setParams(Params);
9785 
9786   if (D.getDeclSpec().isNoreturnSpecified())
9787     NewFD->addAttr(C11NoReturnAttr::Create(Context,
9788                                            D.getDeclSpec().getNoreturnSpecLoc(),
9789                                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword));
9790 
9791   // Functions returning a variably modified type violate C99 6.7.5.2p2
9792   // because all functions have linkage.
9793   if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9794       NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
9795     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_vm_func_decl);
9796     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9797   }
9798 
9799   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section text' is active
9800   if (PragmaClangTextSection.Valid && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9801       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>())
9802     NewFD->addAttr(PragmaClangTextSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9803         Context, PragmaClangTextSection.SectionName,
9804         PragmaClangTextSection.PragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
9805 
9806   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if #pragma code_seg is active.
9807   if (CodeSegStack.CurrentValue && D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
9808       !NewFD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
9809     NewFD->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
9810         Context, CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9811         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
9812         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
9813     if (UnifySection(CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
9814                      ASTContext::PSF_Implicit | ASTContext::PSF_Execute |
9815                          ASTContext::PSF_Read,
9816                      NewFD))
9817       NewFD->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
9818   }
9819 
9820   // Apply an implicit CodeSegAttr from class declspec or
9821   // apply an implicit SectionAttr from #pragma code_seg if active.
9822   if (!NewFD->hasAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
9823     if (Attr *SAttr = getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(NewFD,
9824                                                                  D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
9825       NewFD->addAttr(SAttr);
9826     }
9827   }
9828 
9829   // Handle attributes.
9830   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewFD, D);
9831 
9832   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
9833     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5: Using an address space qualifier in a function return
9834     // type declaration will generate a compilation error.
9835     LangAS AddressSpace = NewFD->getReturnType().getAddressSpace();
9836     if (AddressSpace != LangAS::Default) {
9837       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9838            diag::err_opencl_return_value_with_address_space);
9839       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9840     }
9841   }
9842 
9843   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
9844     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
9845     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
9846       CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
9847 
9848     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
9849       CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
9850 
9851     if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
9852       D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
9853                                                   isMemberSpecialization,
9854                                                   D.isFunctionDefinition()));
9855     else if (!Previous.empty())
9856       // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
9857       D.setRedeclaration(true);
9858     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
9859             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
9860            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
9861 
9862     // Diagnose no-prototype function declarations with calling conventions that
9863     // don't support variadic calls. Only do this in C and do it after merging
9864     // possibly prototyped redeclarations.
9865     const FunctionType *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
9866     if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT) && !D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
9867       CallingConv CC = FT->getExtInfo().getCC();
9868       if (!supportsVariadicCall(CC)) {
9869         // Windows system headers sometimes accidentally use stdcall without
9870         // (void) parameters, so we relax this to a warning.
9871         int DiagID =
9872             CC == CC_X86StdCall ? diag::warn_cconv_knr : diag::err_cconv_knr;
9873         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), DiagID)
9874             << FunctionType::getNameForCallConv(CC);
9875       }
9876     }
9877 
9878    if (NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
9879        NewFD->getReturnType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
9880      checkNonTrivialCUnion(NewFD->getReturnType(),
9881                            NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(),
9882                            NTCUC_FunctionReturn, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
9883   } else {
9884     // C++11 [replacement.functions]p3:
9885     //  The program's definitions shall not be specified as inline.
9886     //
9887     // N.B. We diagnose declarations instead of definitions per LWG issue 2340.
9888     //
9889     // Suppress the diagnostic if the function is __attribute__((used)), since
9890     // that forces an external definition to be emitted.
9891     if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified() &&
9892         NewFD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction() &&
9893         !NewFD->hasAttr<UsedAttr>())
9894       Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(),
9895            diag::ext_operator_new_delete_declared_inline)
9896         << NewFD->getDeclName();
9897 
9898     // If the declarator is a template-id, translate the parser's template
9899     // argument list into our AST format.
9900     if (D.getName().getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) {
9901       TemplateIdAnnotation *TemplateId = D.getName().TemplateId;
9902       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
9903       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9904       ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
9905                                          TemplateId->NumArgs);
9906       translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr,
9907                                  TemplateArgs);
9908 
9909       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9910 
9911       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
9912         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9913       } else if (FunctionTemplate) {
9914         // Function template with explicit template arguments.
9915         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_function_template_partial_spec)
9916           << SourceRange(TemplateId->LAngleLoc, TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
9917 
9918         HasExplicitTemplateArgs = false;
9919       } else {
9920         assert((isFunctionTemplateSpecialization ||
9921                 D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()) &&
9922                "should have a 'template<>' for this decl");
9923         // "friend void foo<>(int);" is an implicit specialization decl.
9924         isFunctionTemplateSpecialization = true;
9925       }
9926     } else if (isFriend && isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9927       // This combination is only possible in a recovery case;  the user
9928       // wrote something like:
9929       //   template <> friend void foo(int);
9930       // which we're recovering from as if the user had written:
9931       //   friend void foo<>(int);
9932       // Go ahead and fake up a template id.
9933       HasExplicitTemplateArgs = true;
9934       TemplateArgs.setLAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9935       TemplateArgs.setRAngleLoc(D.getIdentifierLoc());
9936     }
9937 
9938     // We do not add HD attributes to specializations here because
9939     // they may have different constexpr-ness compared to their
9940     // templates and, after maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs() is applied,
9941     // may end up with different effective targets. Instead, a
9942     // specialization inherits its target attributes from its template
9943     // in the CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization() call below.
9944     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization)
9945       maybeAddCUDAHostDeviceAttrs(NewFD, Previous);
9946 
9947     // If it's a friend (and only if it's a friend), it's possible
9948     // that either the specialized function type or the specialized
9949     // template is dependent, and therefore matching will fail.  In
9950     // this case, don't check the specialization yet.
9951     if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization && isFriend &&
9952         (NewFD->getType()->isDependentType() || DC->isDependentContext() ||
9953          TemplateSpecializationType::anyInstantiationDependentTemplateArguments(
9954              TemplateArgs.arguments()))) {
9955       assert(HasExplicitTemplateArgs &&
9956              "friend function specialization without template args");
9957       if (CheckDependentFunctionTemplateSpecialization(NewFD, TemplateArgs,
9958                                                        Previous))
9959         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9960     } else if (isFunctionTemplateSpecialization) {
9961       if (CurContext->isDependentContext() && CurContext->isRecord()
9962           && !isFriend) {
9963         isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization = true;
9964       } else if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
9965                  CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
9966                      NewFD, (HasExplicitTemplateArgs ? &TemplateArgs : nullptr),
9967                      Previous))
9968         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9969 
9970       // C++ [dcl.stc]p1:
9971       //   A storage-class-specifier shall not be specified in an explicit
9972       //   specialization (14.7.3)
9973       FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *Info =
9974           NewFD->getTemplateSpecializationInfo();
9975       if (Info && SC != SC_None) {
9976         if (SC != Info->getTemplate()->getTemplatedDecl()->getStorageClass())
9977           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9978                diag::err_explicit_specialization_inconsistent_storage_class)
9979             << SC
9980             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9981                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9982 
9983         else
9984           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
9985                diag::ext_explicit_specialization_storage_class)
9986             << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
9987                                       D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc());
9988       }
9989     } else if (isMemberSpecialization && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
9990       if (CheckMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous))
9991           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
9992     }
9993 
9994     // Perform semantic checking on the function declaration.
9995     if (!isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
9996       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMain())
9997         CheckMain(NewFD, D.getDeclSpec());
9998 
9999       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && NewFD->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
10000         CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(NewFD);
10001 
10002       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10003         D.setRedeclaration(CheckFunctionDeclaration(S, NewFD, Previous,
10004                                                     isMemberSpecialization,
10005                                                     D.isFunctionDefinition()));
10006       else if (!Previous.empty())
10007         // Recover gracefully from an invalid redeclaration.
10008         D.setRedeclaration(true);
10009     }
10010 
10011     assert((NewFD->isInvalidDecl() || !D.isRedeclaration() ||
10012             Previous.getResultKind() != LookupResult::FoundOverloaded) &&
10013            "previous declaration set still overloaded");
10014 
10015     NamedDecl *PrincipalDecl = (FunctionTemplate
10016                                 ? cast<NamedDecl>(FunctionTemplate)
10017                                 : NewFD);
10018 
10019     if (isFriend && NewFD->getPreviousDecl()) {
10020       AccessSpecifier Access = AS_public;
10021       if (!NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10022         Access = NewFD->getPreviousDecl()->getAccess();
10023 
10024       NewFD->setAccess(Access);
10025       if (FunctionTemplate) FunctionTemplate->setAccess(Access);
10026     }
10027 
10028     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() && !DC->isRecord() &&
10029         PrincipalDecl->isInIdentifierNamespace(Decl::IDNS_Ordinary))
10030       PrincipalDecl->setNonMemberOperator();
10031 
10032     // If we have a function template, check the template parameter
10033     // list. This will check and merge default template arguments.
10034     if (FunctionTemplate) {
10035       FunctionTemplateDecl *PrevTemplate =
10036                                      FunctionTemplate->getPreviousDecl();
10037       CheckTemplateParameterList(FunctionTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
10038                        PrevTemplate ? PrevTemplate->getTemplateParameters()
10039                                     : nullptr,
10040                             D.getDeclSpec().isFriendSpecified()
10041                               ? (D.isFunctionDefinition()
10042                                    ? TPC_FriendFunctionTemplateDefinition
10043                                    : TPC_FriendFunctionTemplate)
10044                               : (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet() &&
10045                                  DC && DC->isRecord() &&
10046                                  DC->isDependentContext())
10047                                   ? TPC_ClassTemplateMember
10048                                   : TPC_FunctionTemplate);
10049     }
10050 
10051     if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl()) {
10052       // Ignore all the rest of this.
10053     } else if (!D.isRedeclaration()) {
10054       struct ActOnFDArgs ExtraArgs = { S, D, TemplateParamLists,
10055                                        AddToScope };
10056       // Fake up an access specifier if it's supposed to be a class member.
10057       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(NewFD->getDeclContext()))
10058         NewFD->setAccess(AS_public);
10059 
10060       // Qualified decls generally require a previous declaration.
10061       if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
10062         // ...with the major exception of templated-scope or
10063         // dependent-scope friend declarations.
10064 
10065         // TODO: we currently also suppress this check in dependent
10066         // contexts because (1) the parameter depth will be off when
10067         // matching friend templates and (2) we might actually be
10068         // selecting a friend based on a dependent factor.  But there
10069         // are situations where these conditions don't apply and we
10070         // can actually do this check immediately.
10071         //
10072         // Unless the scope is dependent, it's always an error if qualified
10073         // redeclaration lookup found nothing at all. Diagnose that now;
10074         // nothing will diagnose that error later.
10075         if (isFriend &&
10076             (D.getCXXScopeSpec().getScopeRep()->isDependent() ||
10077              (!Previous.empty() && CurContext->isDependentContext()))) {
10078           // ignore these
10079         } else if (NewFD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
10080                    NewFD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()) {
10081           // ignore this, we allow the redeclaration behavior here to create new
10082           // versions of the function.
10083         } else {
10084           // The user tried to provide an out-of-line definition for a
10085           // function that is a member of a class or namespace, but there
10086           // was no such member function declared (C++ [class.mfct]p2,
10087           // C++ [namespace.memdef]p2). For example:
10088           //
10089           // class X {
10090           //   void f() const;
10091           // };
10092           //
10093           // void X::f() { } // ill-formed
10094           //
10095           // Complain about this problem, and attempt to suggest close
10096           // matches (e.g., those that differ only in cv-qualifiers and
10097           // whether the parameter types are references).
10098 
10099           if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
10100                   *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, false, nullptr)) {
10101             AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
10102             return Result;
10103           }
10104         }
10105 
10106         // Unqualified local friend declarations are required to resolve
10107         // to something.
10108       } else if (isFriend && cast<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext)->isLocalClass()) {
10109         if (NamedDecl *Result = DiagnoseInvalidRedeclaration(
10110                 *this, Previous, NewFD, ExtraArgs, true, S)) {
10111           AddToScope = ExtraArgs.AddToScope;
10112           return Result;
10113         }
10114       }
10115     } else if (!D.isFunctionDefinition() &&
10116                isa<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD) && NewFD->isOutOfLine() &&
10117                !isFriend && !isFunctionTemplateSpecialization &&
10118                !isMemberSpecialization) {
10119       // An out-of-line member function declaration must also be a
10120       // definition (C++ [class.mfct]p2).
10121       // Note that this is not the case for explicit specializations of
10122       // function templates or member functions of class templates, per
10123       // C++ [temp.expl.spec]p2. We also allow these declarations as an
10124       // extension for compatibility with old SWIG code which likes to
10125       // generate them.
10126       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::ext_out_of_line_declaration)
10127         << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
10128     }
10129   }
10130 
10131   // If this is the first declaration of a library builtin function, add
10132   // attributes as appropriate.
10133   if (!D.isRedeclaration()) {
10134     if (IdentifierInfo *II = Previous.getLookupName().getAsIdentifierInfo()) {
10135       if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
10136         bool InStdNamespace = Context.BuiltinInfo.isInStdNamespace(BuiltinID);
10137         if (!InStdNamespace &&
10138             NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext()) {
10139           if (NewFD->getLanguageLinkage() == CLanguageLinkage) {
10140             // Validate the type matches unless this builtin is specified as
10141             // matching regardless of its declared type.
10142             if (Context.BuiltinInfo.allowTypeMismatch(BuiltinID)) {
10143               NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10144             } else {
10145               ASTContext::GetBuiltinTypeError Error;
10146               LookupNecessaryTypesForBuiltin(S, BuiltinID);
10147               QualType BuiltinType = Context.GetBuiltinType(BuiltinID, Error);
10148 
10149               if (!Error && !BuiltinType.isNull() &&
10150                   Context.hasSameFunctionTypeIgnoringExceptionSpec(
10151                       NewFD->getType(), BuiltinType))
10152                 NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10153             }
10154           }
10155         } else if (InStdNamespace && NewFD->isInStdNamespace() &&
10156                    isStdBuiltin(Context, NewFD, BuiltinID)) {
10157           NewFD->addAttr(BuiltinAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, BuiltinID));
10158         }
10159       }
10160     }
10161   }
10162 
10163   ProcessPragmaWeak(S, NewFD);
10164   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *NewFD);
10165 
10166   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(NewFD);
10167 
10168   if (NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() &&
10169       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10170     Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
10171          diag::err_attribute_overloadable_no_prototype)
10172       << NewFD;
10173 
10174     // Turn this into a variadic function with no parameters.
10175     const auto *FT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
10176     FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI(
10177         Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(true, false));
10178     EPI.Variadic = true;
10179     EPI.ExtInfo = FT->getExtInfo();
10180 
10181     QualType R = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), None, EPI);
10182     NewFD->setType(R);
10183   }
10184 
10185   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
10186   // member, set the visibility of this function.
10187   if (!DC->isRecord() && NewFD->isExternallyVisible())
10188     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(NewFD);
10189 
10190   // If there's a #pragma clang arc_cf_code_audited in scope, consider
10191   // marking the function.
10192   AddCFAuditedAttribute(NewFD);
10193 
10194   // If this is a function definition, check if we have to apply any
10195   // attributes (i.e. optnone and no_builtin) due to a pragma.
10196   if (D.isFunctionDefinition()) {
10197     AddRangeBasedOptnone(NewFD);
10198     AddImplicitMSFunctionNoBuiltinAttr(NewFD);
10199     AddSectionMSAllocText(NewFD);
10200   }
10201 
10202   // If this is the first declaration of an extern C variable, update
10203   // the map of such variables.
10204   if (NewFD->isFirstDecl() && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
10205       isIncompleteDeclExternC(*this, NewFD))
10206     RegisterLocallyScopedExternCDecl(NewFD, S);
10207 
10208   // Set this FunctionDecl's range up to the right paren.
10209   NewFD->setRangeEnd(D.getSourceRange().getEnd());
10210 
10211   if (D.isRedeclaration() && !Previous.empty()) {
10212     NamedDecl *Prev = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
10213     checkDLLAttributeRedeclaration(*this, Prev, NewFD,
10214                                    isMemberSpecialization ||
10215                                        isFunctionTemplateSpecialization,
10216                                    D.isFunctionDefinition());
10217   }
10218 
10219   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
10220     IdentifierInfo *II = NewFD->getIdentifier();
10221     if (II && II->isStr(getCudaConfigureFuncName()) &&
10222         !NewFD->isInvalidDecl() &&
10223         NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) {
10224       if (!R->castAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType()->isScalarType())
10225         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_config_scalar_return)
10226             << getCudaConfigureFuncName();
10227       Context.setcudaConfigureCallDecl(NewFD);
10228     }
10229 
10230     // Variadic functions, other than a *declaration* of printf, are not allowed
10231     // in device-side CUDA code, unless someone passed
10232     // -fcuda-allow-variadic-functions.
10233     if (!getLangOpts().CUDAAllowVariadicFunctions && NewFD->isVariadic() &&
10234         (NewFD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() ||
10235          NewFD->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) &&
10236         !(II && II->isStr("printf") && NewFD->isExternC() &&
10237           !D.isFunctionDefinition())) {
10238       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_variadic_device_fn);
10239     }
10240   }
10241 
10242   MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(NewFD);
10243 
10244 
10245 
10246   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && NewFD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>()) {
10247     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.8 static is invalid for kernel functions.
10248     if (SC == SC_Static) {
10249       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_static_kernel);
10250       D.setInvalidType();
10251     }
10252 
10253     // OpenCL v1.2, s6.9 -- Kernels can only have return type void.
10254     if (!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) {
10255       SourceRange RTRange = NewFD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
10256       Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_expected_kernel_void_return_type)
10257           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "void")
10258                                 : FixItHint());
10259       D.setInvalidType();
10260     }
10261 
10262     llvm::SmallPtrSet<const Type *, 16> ValidTypes;
10263     for (auto Param : NewFD->parameters())
10264       checkIsValidOpenCLKernelParameter(*this, D, Param, ValidTypes);
10265 
10266     if (getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) {
10267       if (DC->isRecord()) {
10268         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_method_kernel);
10269         D.setInvalidType();
10270       }
10271       if (FunctionTemplate) {
10272         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_template_kernel);
10273         D.setInvalidType();
10274       }
10275     }
10276   }
10277 
10278   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
10279     if (FunctionTemplate) {
10280       if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10281         FunctionTemplate->setInvalidDecl();
10282       return FunctionTemplate;
10283     }
10284 
10285     if (isMemberSpecialization && !NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
10286       CompleteMemberSpecialization(NewFD, Previous);
10287   }
10288 
10289   for (const ParmVarDecl *Param : NewFD->parameters()) {
10290     QualType PT = Param->getType();
10291 
10292     // OpenCL 2.0 pipe restrictions forbids pipe packet types to be non-value
10293     // types.
10294     if (getLangOpts().getOpenCLCompatibleVersion() >= 200) {
10295       if(const PipeType *PipeTy = PT->getAs<PipeType>()) {
10296         QualType ElemTy = PipeTy->getElementType();
10297           if (ElemTy->isReferenceType() || ElemTy->isPointerType()) {
10298             Diag(Param->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_reference_pipe_type );
10299             D.setInvalidType();
10300           }
10301       }
10302     }
10303   }
10304 
10305   // Here we have an function template explicit specialization at class scope.
10306   // The actual specialization will be postponed to template instatiation
10307   // time via the ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl node.
10308   if (isDependentClassScopeExplicitSpecialization) {
10309     ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl *NewSpec =
10310                          ClassScopeFunctionSpecializationDecl::Create(
10311                                 Context, CurContext, NewFD->getLocation(),
10312                                 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD),
10313                                 HasExplicitTemplateArgs, TemplateArgs);
10314     CurContext->addDecl(NewSpec);
10315     AddToScope = false;
10316   }
10317 
10318   // Diagnose availability attributes. Availability cannot be used on functions
10319   // that are run during load/unload.
10320   if (const auto *attr = NewFD->getAttr<AvailabilityAttr>()) {
10321     if (NewFD->hasAttr<ConstructorAttr>()) {
10322       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10323           << 1;
10324       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10325     }
10326     if (NewFD->hasAttr<DestructorAttr>()) {
10327       Diag(attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_availability_on_static_initializer)
10328           << 2;
10329       NewFD->dropAttr<AvailabilityAttr>();
10330     }
10331   }
10332 
10333   // Diagnose no_builtin attribute on function declaration that are not a
10334   // definition.
10335   // FIXME: We should really be doing this in
10336   // SemaDeclAttr.cpp::handleNoBuiltinAttr, unfortunately we only have access to
10337   // the FunctionDecl and at this point of the code
10338   // FunctionDecl::isThisDeclarationADefinition() which always returns `false`
10339   // because Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef has not been called yet.
10340   if (const auto *NBA = NewFD->getAttr<NoBuiltinAttr>())
10341     switch (D.getFunctionDefinitionKind()) {
10342     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Defaulted:
10343     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Deleted:
10344       Diag(NBA->getLocation(),
10345            diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_defaulted_deleted_function)
10346           << NBA->getSpelling();
10347       break;
10348     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Declaration:
10349       Diag(NBA->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_no_builtin_on_non_definition)
10350           << NBA->getSpelling();
10351       break;
10352     case FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition:
10353       break;
10354     }
10355 
10356   return NewFD;
10357 }
10358 
10359 /// Return a CodeSegAttr from a containing class.  The Microsoft docs say
10360 /// when __declspec(code_seg) "is applied to a class, all member functions of
10361 /// the class and nested classes -- this includes compiler-generated special
10362 /// member functions -- are put in the specified segment."
10363 /// The actual behavior is a little more complicated. The Microsoft compiler
10364 /// won't check outer classes if there is an active value from #pragma code_seg.
10365 /// The CodeSeg is always applied from the direct parent but only from outer
10366 /// classes when the #pragma code_seg stack is empty. See:
10367 /// https://reviews.llvm.org/D22931, the Microsoft feedback page is no longer
10368 /// available since MS has removed the page.
10369 static Attr *getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10370   const auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
10371   if (!Method)
10372     return nullptr;
10373   const CXXRecordDecl *Parent = Method->getParent();
10374   if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10375     Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10376     NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10377     return NewAttr;
10378   }
10379 
10380   // The Microsoft compiler won't check outer classes for the CodeSeg
10381   // when the #pragma code_seg stack is active.
10382   if (S.CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10383    return nullptr;
10384 
10385   while ((Parent = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Parent->getParent()))) {
10386     if (const auto *SAttr = Parent->getAttr<CodeSegAttr>()) {
10387       Attr *NewAttr = SAttr->clone(S.getASTContext());
10388       NewAttr->setImplicit(true);
10389       return NewAttr;
10390     }
10391   }
10392   return nullptr;
10393 }
10394 
10395 /// Returns an implicit CodeSegAttr if a __declspec(code_seg) is found on a
10396 /// containing class. Otherwise it will return implicit SectionAttr if the
10397 /// function is a definition and there is an active value on CodeSegStack
10398 /// (from the current #pragma code-seg value).
10399 ///
10400 /// \param FD Function being declared.
10401 /// \param IsDefinition Whether it is a definition or just a declarartion.
10402 /// \returns A CodeSegAttr or SectionAttr to apply to the function or
10403 ///          nullptr if no attribute should be added.
10404 Attr *Sema::getImplicitCodeSegOrSectionAttrForFunction(const FunctionDecl *FD,
10405                                                        bool IsDefinition) {
10406   if (Attr *A = getImplicitCodeSegAttrFromClass(*this, FD))
10407     return A;
10408   if (!FD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>() && IsDefinition &&
10409       CodeSegStack.CurrentValue)
10410     return SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
10411         getASTContext(), CodeSegStack.CurrentValue->getString(),
10412         CodeSegStack.CurrentPragmaLocation, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma,
10413         SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate);
10414   return nullptr;
10415 }
10416 
10417 /// Determines if we can perform a correct type check for \p D as a
10418 /// redeclaration of \p PrevDecl. If not, we can generally still perform a
10419 /// best-effort check.
10420 ///
10421 /// \param NewD The new declaration.
10422 /// \param OldD The old declaration.
10423 /// \param NewT The portion of the type of the new declaration to check.
10424 /// \param OldT The portion of the type of the old declaration to check.
10425 bool Sema::canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(ValueDecl *NewD, ValueDecl *OldD,
10426                                           QualType NewT, QualType OldT) {
10427   if (!NewD->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10428     return true;
10429 
10430   // For dependently-typed local extern declarations and friends, we can't
10431   // perform a correct type check in general until instantiation:
10432   //
10433   //   int f();
10434   //   template<typename T> void g() { T f(); }
10435   //
10436   // (valid if g() is only instantiated with T = int).
10437   if (NewT->isDependentType() &&
10438       (NewD->isLocalExternDecl() || NewD->getFriendObjectKind()))
10439     return false;
10440 
10441   // Similarly, if the previous declaration was a dependent local extern
10442   // declaration, we don't really know its type yet.
10443   if (OldT->isDependentType() && OldD->isLocalExternDecl())
10444     return false;
10445 
10446   return true;
10447 }
10448 
10449 /// Checks if the new declaration declared in dependent context must be
10450 /// put in the same redeclaration chain as the specified declaration.
10451 ///
10452 /// \param D Declaration that is checked.
10453 /// \param PrevDecl Previous declaration found with proper lookup method for the
10454 ///                 same declaration name.
10455 /// \returns True if D must be added to the redeclaration chain which PrevDecl
10456 ///          belongs to.
10457 ///
10458 bool Sema::shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(Decl *D, Decl *PrevDecl) {
10459   if (!D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isDependentContext())
10460     return true;
10461 
10462   // Don't chain dependent friend function definitions until instantiation, to
10463   // permit cases like
10464   //
10465   //   void func();
10466   //   template<typename T> class C1 { friend void func() {} };
10467   //   template<typename T> class C2 { friend void func() {} };
10468   //
10469   // ... which is valid if only one of C1 and C2 is ever instantiated.
10470   //
10471   // FIXME: This need only apply to function definitions. For now, we proxy
10472   // this by checking for a file-scope function. We do not want this to apply
10473   // to friend declarations nominating member functions, because that gets in
10474   // the way of access checks.
10475   if (D->getFriendObjectKind() && D->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
10476     return false;
10477 
10478   auto *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
10479   auto *PrevVD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl);
10480   return !VD || !PrevVD ||
10481          canFullyTypeCheckRedeclaration(VD, PrevVD, VD->getType(),
10482                                         PrevVD->getType());
10483 }
10484 
10485 /// Check the target attribute of the function for MultiVersion
10486 /// validity.
10487 ///
10488 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10489 static bool CheckMultiVersionValue(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10490   const auto *TA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10491   assert(TA && "MultiVersion Candidate requires a target attribute");
10492   ParsedTargetAttr ParseInfo = TA->parse();
10493   const TargetInfo &TargetInfo = S.Context.getTargetInfo();
10494   enum ErrType { Feature = 0, Architecture = 1 };
10495 
10496   if (!ParseInfo.Architecture.empty() &&
10497       !TargetInfo.validateCpuIs(ParseInfo.Architecture)) {
10498     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10499         << Architecture << ParseInfo.Architecture;
10500     return true;
10501   }
10502 
10503   for (const auto &Feat : ParseInfo.Features) {
10504     auto BareFeat = StringRef{Feat}.substr(1);
10505     if (Feat[0] == '-') {
10506       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10507           << Feature << ("no-" + BareFeat).str();
10508       return true;
10509     }
10510 
10511     if (!TargetInfo.validateCpuSupports(BareFeat) ||
10512         !TargetInfo.isValidFeatureName(BareFeat)) {
10513       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_bad_multiversion_option)
10514           << Feature << BareFeat;
10515       return true;
10516     }
10517   }
10518   return false;
10519 }
10520 
10521 // Provide a white-list of attributes that are allowed to be combined with
10522 // multiversion functions.
10523 static bool AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(attr::Kind Kind,
10524                                            MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10525   // Note: this list/diagnosis must match the list in
10526   // checkMultiversionAttributesAllSame.
10527   switch (Kind) {
10528   default:
10529     return false;
10530   case attr::Used:
10531     return MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target;
10532   case attr::NonNull:
10533   case attr::NoThrow:
10534     return true;
10535   }
10536 }
10537 
10538 static bool checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(Sema &S,
10539                                                  const FunctionDecl *FD,
10540                                                  const FunctionDecl *CausedFD,
10541                                                  MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10542   const auto Diagnose = [FD, CausedFD, MVKind](Sema &S, const Attr *A) {
10543     S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_disallowed_other_attr)
10544         << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind) << A;
10545     if (CausedFD)
10546       S.Diag(CausedFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10547     return true;
10548   };
10549 
10550   for (const Attr *A : FD->attrs()) {
10551     switch (A->getKind()) {
10552     case attr::CPUDispatch:
10553     case attr::CPUSpecific:
10554       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10555           MVKind != MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific)
10556         return Diagnose(S, A);
10557       break;
10558     case attr::Target:
10559       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::Target)
10560         return Diagnose(S, A);
10561       break;
10562     case attr::TargetClones:
10563       if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones)
10564         return Diagnose(S, A);
10565       break;
10566     default:
10567       if (!AttrCompatibleWithMultiVersion(A->getKind(), MVKind))
10568         return Diagnose(S, A);
10569       break;
10570     }
10571   }
10572   return false;
10573 }
10574 
10575 bool Sema::areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10576     const FunctionDecl *OldFD, const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10577     const PartialDiagnostic &NoProtoDiagID,
10578     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoteCausedDiagIDAt,
10579     const PartialDiagnosticAt &NoSupportDiagIDAt,
10580     const PartialDiagnosticAt &DiffDiagIDAt, bool TemplatesSupported,
10581     bool ConstexprSupported, bool CLinkageMayDiffer) {
10582   enum DoesntSupport {
10583     FuncTemplates = 0,
10584     VirtFuncs = 1,
10585     DeducedReturn = 2,
10586     Constructors = 3,
10587     Destructors = 4,
10588     DeletedFuncs = 5,
10589     DefaultedFuncs = 6,
10590     ConstexprFuncs = 7,
10591     ConstevalFuncs = 8,
10592     Lambda = 9,
10593   };
10594   enum Different {
10595     CallingConv = 0,
10596     ReturnType = 1,
10597     ConstexprSpec = 2,
10598     InlineSpec = 3,
10599     Linkage = 4,
10600     LanguageLinkage = 5,
10601   };
10602 
10603   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 && OldFD &&
10604       !OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
10605     Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10606     Diag(NoteCausedDiagIDAt.first, NoteCausedDiagIDAt.second);
10607     return true;
10608   }
10609 
10610   if (NoProtoDiagID.getDiagID() != 0 &&
10611       !NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
10612     return Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), NoProtoDiagID);
10613 
10614   if (!TemplatesSupported &&
10615       NewFD->getTemplatedKind() == FunctionDecl::TK_FunctionTemplate)
10616     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10617            << FuncTemplates;
10618 
10619   if (const auto *NewCXXFD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
10620     if (NewCXXFD->isVirtual())
10621       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10622              << VirtFuncs;
10623 
10624     if (isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10625       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10626              << Constructors;
10627 
10628     if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewCXXFD))
10629       return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10630              << Destructors;
10631   }
10632 
10633   if (NewFD->isDeleted())
10634     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10635            << DeletedFuncs;
10636 
10637   if (NewFD->isDefaulted())
10638     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10639            << DefaultedFuncs;
10640 
10641   if (!ConstexprSupported && NewFD->isConstexpr())
10642     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10643            << (NewFD->isConsteval() ? ConstevalFuncs : ConstexprFuncs);
10644 
10645   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(NewFD->getType());
10646   const auto *NewType = cast<FunctionType>(NewQType);
10647   QualType NewReturnType = NewType->getReturnType();
10648 
10649   if (NewReturnType->isUndeducedType())
10650     return Diag(NoSupportDiagIDAt.first, NoSupportDiagIDAt.second)
10651            << DeducedReturn;
10652 
10653   // Ensure the return type is identical.
10654   if (OldFD) {
10655     QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(OldFD->getType());
10656     const auto *OldType = cast<FunctionType>(OldQType);
10657     FunctionType::ExtInfo OldTypeInfo = OldType->getExtInfo();
10658     FunctionType::ExtInfo NewTypeInfo = NewType->getExtInfo();
10659 
10660     if (OldTypeInfo.getCC() != NewTypeInfo.getCC())
10661       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << CallingConv;
10662 
10663     QualType OldReturnType = OldType->getReturnType();
10664 
10665     if (OldReturnType != NewReturnType)
10666       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ReturnType;
10667 
10668     if (OldFD->getConstexprKind() != NewFD->getConstexprKind())
10669       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << ConstexprSpec;
10670 
10671     if (OldFD->isInlineSpecified() != NewFD->isInlineSpecified())
10672       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << InlineSpec;
10673 
10674     if (OldFD->getFormalLinkage() != NewFD->getFormalLinkage())
10675       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << Linkage;
10676 
10677     if (!CLinkageMayDiffer && OldFD->isExternC() != NewFD->isExternC())
10678       return Diag(DiffDiagIDAt.first, DiffDiagIDAt.second) << LanguageLinkage;
10679 
10680     if (CheckEquivalentExceptionSpec(
10681             OldFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), OldFD->getLocation(),
10682             NewFD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(), NewFD->getLocation()))
10683       return true;
10684   }
10685   return false;
10686 }
10687 
10688 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *OldFD,
10689                                              const FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10690                                              bool CausesMV,
10691                                              MultiVersionKind MVKind) {
10692   if (!S.getASTContext().getTargetInfo().supportsMultiVersioning()) {
10693     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_supported);
10694     if (OldFD)
10695       S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10696     return true;
10697   }
10698 
10699   bool IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind =
10700       MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch ||
10701       MVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific;
10702 
10703   if (CausesMV && OldFD &&
10704       checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind))
10705     return true;
10706 
10707   if (checkNonMultiVersionCompatAttributes(S, NewFD, nullptr, MVKind))
10708     return true;
10709 
10710   // Only allow transition to MultiVersion if it hasn't been used.
10711   if (OldFD && CausesMV && OldFD->isUsed(false))
10712     return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used);
10713 
10714   return S.areMultiversionVariantFunctionsCompatible(
10715       OldFD, NewFD, S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_noproto),
10716       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10717                           S.PDiag(diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here)),
10718       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10719                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_doesnt_support)
10720                               << static_cast<unsigned>(MVKind)),
10721       PartialDiagnosticAt(NewFD->getLocation(),
10722                           S.PDiag(diag::err_multiversion_diff)),
10723       /*TemplatesSupported=*/false,
10724       /*ConstexprSupported=*/!IsCPUSpecificCPUDispatchMVKind,
10725       /*CLinkageMayDiffer=*/false);
10726 }
10727 
10728 /// Check the validity of a multiversion function declaration that is the
10729 /// first of its kind. Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
10730 ///
10731 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
10732 ///
10733 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
10734 static bool CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD,
10735                                            MultiVersionKind MVKind,
10736                                            const TargetAttr *TA) {
10737   assert(MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None &&
10738          "Function lacks multiversion attribute");
10739 
10740   // Target only causes MV if it is default, otherwise this is a normal
10741   // function.
10742   if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
10743     return false;
10744 
10745   if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && CheckMultiVersionValue(S, FD)) {
10746     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10747     return true;
10748   }
10749 
10750   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, nullptr, FD, true, MVKind)) {
10751     FD->setInvalidDecl();
10752     return true;
10753   }
10754 
10755   FD->setIsMultiVersion();
10756   return false;
10757 }
10758 
10759 static bool PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10760   for (const Decl *D = FD->getPreviousDecl(); D; D = D->getPreviousDecl()) {
10761     if (D->getAsFunction()->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::None)
10762       return true;
10763   }
10764 
10765   return false;
10766 }
10767 
10768 static bool CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(
10769     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10770     bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl, LookupResult &Previous) {
10771   const auto *OldTA = OldFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10772   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10773   // Sort order doesn't matter, it just needs to be consistent.
10774   llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10775 
10776   // If the old decl is NOT MultiVersioned yet, and we don't cause that
10777   // to change, this is a simple redeclaration.
10778   if (!NewTA->isDefaultVersion() &&
10779       (!OldTA || OldTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()))
10780     return false;
10781 
10782   // Otherwise, this decl causes MultiVersioning.
10783   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD, true,
10784                                        MultiVersionKind::Target)) {
10785     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10786     return true;
10787   }
10788 
10789   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
10790     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10791     return true;
10792   }
10793 
10794   // If this is 'default', permit the forward declaration.
10795   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && !OldTA && NewTA->isDefaultVersion()) {
10796     Redeclaration = true;
10797     OldDecl = OldFD;
10798     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10799     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10800     return false;
10801   }
10802 
10803   if (CheckMultiVersionValue(S, OldFD)) {
10804     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10805     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10806     return true;
10807   }
10808 
10809   ParsedTargetAttr OldParsed = OldTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10810 
10811   if (OldParsed == NewParsed) {
10812     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10813     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10814     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10815     return true;
10816   }
10817 
10818   for (const auto *FD : OldFD->redecls()) {
10819     const auto *CurTA = FD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10820     // We allow forward declarations before ANY multiversioning attributes, but
10821     // nothing after the fact.
10822     if (PreviousDeclsHaveMultiVersionAttribute(FD) &&
10823         (!CurTA || CurTA->isInherited())) {
10824       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
10825           << 0;
10826       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::note_multiversioning_caused_here);
10827       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10828       return true;
10829     }
10830   }
10831 
10832   OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10833   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10834   Redeclaration = false;
10835   OldDecl = nullptr;
10836   Previous.clear();
10837   return false;
10838 }
10839 
10840 static bool MultiVersionTypesCompatible(MultiVersionKind Old,
10841                                         MultiVersionKind New) {
10842   if (Old == New || Old == MultiVersionKind::None ||
10843       New == MultiVersionKind::None)
10844     return true;
10845 
10846   return (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10847           New == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific) ||
10848          (Old == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific &&
10849           New == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch);
10850 }
10851 
10852 /// Check the validity of a new function declaration being added to an existing
10853 /// multiversioned declaration collection.
10854 static bool CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(
10855     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *OldFD, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
10856     MultiVersionKind NewMVKind, const TargetAttr *NewTA,
10857     const CPUDispatchAttr *NewCPUDisp, const CPUSpecificAttr *NewCPUSpec,
10858     const TargetClonesAttr *NewClones, bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
10859     LookupResult &Previous) {
10860 
10861   MultiVersionKind OldMVKind = OldFD->getMultiVersionKind();
10862   // Disallow mixing of multiversioning types.
10863   if (!MultiVersionTypesCompatible(OldMVKind, NewMVKind)) {
10864     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_types_mixed);
10865     S.Diag(OldFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10866     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10867     return true;
10868   }
10869 
10870   ParsedTargetAttr NewParsed;
10871   if (NewTA) {
10872     NewParsed = NewTA->parse();
10873     llvm::sort(NewParsed.Features);
10874   }
10875 
10876   bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
10877       S.CurContext->isRecord() && !NewFD->getFriendObjectKind();
10878 
10879   bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks =
10880       AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, S.Context, NewFD);
10881 
10882   // Next, check ALL non-overloads to see if this is a redeclaration of a
10883   // previous member of the MultiVersion set.
10884   for (NamedDecl *ND : Previous) {
10885     FunctionDecl *CurFD = ND->getAsFunction();
10886     if (!CurFD)
10887       continue;
10888     if (MayNeedOverloadableChecks &&
10889         S.IsOverload(NewFD, CurFD, UseMemberUsingDeclRules))
10890       continue;
10891 
10892     switch (NewMVKind) {
10893     case MultiVersionKind::None:
10894       assert(OldMVKind == MultiVersionKind::TargetClones &&
10895              "Only target_clones can be omitted in subsequent declarations");
10896       break;
10897     case MultiVersionKind::Target: {
10898       const auto *CurTA = CurFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
10899       if (CurTA->getFeaturesStr() == NewTA->getFeaturesStr()) {
10900         NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10901         Redeclaration = true;
10902         OldDecl = ND;
10903         return false;
10904       }
10905 
10906       ParsedTargetAttr CurParsed = CurTA->parse(std::less<std::string>());
10907       if (CurParsed == NewParsed) {
10908         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_duplicate);
10909         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10910         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10911         return true;
10912       }
10913       break;
10914     }
10915     case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones: {
10916       const auto *CurClones = CurFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>();
10917       Redeclaration = true;
10918       OldDecl = CurFD;
10919       NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10920 
10921       if (CurClones && NewClones &&
10922           (CurClones->featuresStrs_size() != NewClones->featuresStrs_size() ||
10923            !std::equal(CurClones->featuresStrs_begin(),
10924                        CurClones->featuresStrs_end(),
10925                        NewClones->featuresStrs_begin()))) {
10926         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_target_clone_doesnt_match);
10927         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10928         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10929         return true;
10930       }
10931 
10932       return false;
10933     }
10934     case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific:
10935     case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch: {
10936       const auto *CurCPUSpec = CurFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
10937       const auto *CurCPUDisp = CurFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
10938       // Handle CPUDispatch/CPUSpecific versions.
10939       // Only 1 CPUDispatch function is allowed, this will make it go through
10940       // the redeclaration errors.
10941       if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch &&
10942           CurFD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>()) {
10943         if (CurCPUDisp->cpus_size() == NewCPUDisp->cpus_size() &&
10944             std::equal(
10945                 CurCPUDisp->cpus_begin(), CurCPUDisp->cpus_end(),
10946                 NewCPUDisp->cpus_begin(),
10947                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10948                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10949                 })) {
10950           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10951           Redeclaration = true;
10952           OldDecl = ND;
10953           return false;
10954         }
10955 
10956         // If the declarations don't match, this is an error condition.
10957         S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_dispatch_mismatch);
10958         S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10959         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10960         return true;
10961       }
10962       if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific && CurCPUSpec) {
10963         if (CurCPUSpec->cpus_size() == NewCPUSpec->cpus_size() &&
10964             std::equal(
10965                 CurCPUSpec->cpus_begin(), CurCPUSpec->cpus_end(),
10966                 NewCPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
10967                 [](const IdentifierInfo *Cur, const IdentifierInfo *New) {
10968                   return Cur->getName() == New->getName();
10969                 })) {
10970           NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
10971           Redeclaration = true;
10972           OldDecl = ND;
10973           return false;
10974         }
10975 
10976         // Only 1 version of CPUSpecific is allowed for each CPU.
10977         for (const IdentifierInfo *CurII : CurCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10978           for (const IdentifierInfo *NewII : NewCPUSpec->cpus()) {
10979             if (CurII == NewII) {
10980               S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_cpu_specific_multiple_defs)
10981                   << NewII;
10982               S.Diag(CurFD->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
10983               NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
10984               return true;
10985             }
10986           }
10987         }
10988       }
10989       break;
10990     }
10991     }
10992   }
10993 
10994   // Else, this is simply a non-redecl case.  Checking the 'value' is only
10995   // necessary in the Target case, since The CPUSpecific/Dispatch cases are
10996   // handled in the attribute adding step.
10997   if (NewMVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target &&
10998       CheckMultiVersionValue(S, NewFD)) {
10999     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11000     return true;
11001   }
11002 
11003   if (CheckMultiVersionAdditionalRules(S, OldFD, NewFD,
11004                                        !OldFD->isMultiVersion(), NewMVKind)) {
11005     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11006     return true;
11007   }
11008 
11009   // Permit forward declarations in the case where these two are compatible.
11010   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) {
11011     OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11012     NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11013     Redeclaration = true;
11014     OldDecl = OldFD;
11015     return false;
11016   }
11017 
11018   NewFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11019   Redeclaration = false;
11020   OldDecl = nullptr;
11021   Previous.clear();
11022   return false;
11023 }
11024 
11025 /// Check the validity of a mulitversion function declaration.
11026 /// Also sets the multiversion'ness' of the function itself.
11027 ///
11028 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
11029 ///
11030 /// Returns true if there was an error, false otherwise.
11031 static bool CheckMultiVersionFunction(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
11032                                       bool &Redeclaration, NamedDecl *&OldDecl,
11033                                       LookupResult &Previous) {
11034   const auto *NewTA = NewFD->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
11035   const auto *NewCPUDisp = NewFD->getAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
11036   const auto *NewCPUSpec = NewFD->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
11037   const auto *NewClones = NewFD->getAttr<TargetClonesAttr>();
11038   MultiVersionKind MVKind = NewFD->getMultiVersionKind();
11039 
11040   // Main isn't allowed to become a multiversion function, however it IS
11041   // permitted to have 'main' be marked with the 'target' optimization hint.
11042   if (NewFD->isMain()) {
11043     if (MVKind != MultiVersionKind::None &&
11044         !(MVKind == MultiVersionKind::Target && !NewTA->isDefaultVersion())) {
11045       S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_not_allowed_on_main);
11046       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11047       return true;
11048     }
11049     return false;
11050   }
11051 
11052   if (!OldDecl || !OldDecl->getAsFunction() ||
11053       OldDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext() !=
11054           NewFD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) {
11055     // If there's no previous declaration, AND this isn't attempting to cause
11056     // multiversioning, this isn't an error condition.
11057     if (MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None)
11058       return false;
11059     return CheckMultiVersionFirstFunction(S, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA);
11060   }
11061 
11062   FunctionDecl *OldFD = OldDecl->getAsFunction();
11063 
11064   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None)
11065     return false;
11066 
11067   // Multiversioned redeclarations aren't allowed to omit the attribute, except
11068   // for target_clones.
11069   if (OldFD->isMultiVersion() && MVKind == MultiVersionKind::None &&
11070       OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::TargetClones) {
11071     S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_required_in_redecl)
11072         << (OldFD->getMultiVersionKind() != MultiVersionKind::Target);
11073     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11074     return true;
11075   }
11076 
11077   if (!OldFD->isMultiVersion()) {
11078     switch (MVKind) {
11079     case MultiVersionKind::Target:
11080       return CheckTargetCausesMultiVersioning(S, OldFD, NewFD, NewTA,
11081                                               Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous);
11082     case MultiVersionKind::TargetClones:
11083       if (OldFD->isUsed(false)) {
11084         NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11085         return S.Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_multiversion_after_used);
11086       }
11087       OldFD->setIsMultiVersion();
11088       break;
11089     case MultiVersionKind::CPUDispatch:
11090     case MultiVersionKind::CPUSpecific:
11091     case MultiVersionKind::None:
11092       break;
11093     }
11094   }
11095 
11096   // At this point, we have a multiversion function decl (in OldFD) AND an
11097   // appropriate attribute in the current function decl.  Resolve that these are
11098   // still compatible with previous declarations.
11099   return CheckMultiVersionAdditionalDecl(S, OldFD, NewFD, MVKind, NewTA,
11100                                          NewCPUDisp, NewCPUSpec, NewClones,
11101                                          Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous);
11102 }
11103 
11104 /// Perform semantic checking of a new function declaration.
11105 ///
11106 /// Performs semantic analysis of the new function declaration
11107 /// NewFD. This routine performs all semantic checking that does not
11108 /// require the actual declarator involved in the declaration, and is
11109 /// used both for the declaration of functions as they are parsed
11110 /// (called via ActOnDeclarator) and for the declaration of functions
11111 /// that have been instantiated via C++ template instantiation (called
11112 /// via InstantiateDecl).
11113 ///
11114 /// \param IsMemberSpecialization whether this new function declaration is
11115 /// a member specialization (that replaces any definition provided by the
11116 /// previous declaration).
11117 ///
11118 /// This sets NewFD->isInvalidDecl() to true if there was an error.
11119 ///
11120 /// \returns true if the function declaration is a redeclaration.
11121 bool Sema::CheckFunctionDeclaration(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *NewFD,
11122                                     LookupResult &Previous,
11123                                     bool IsMemberSpecialization,
11124                                     bool DeclIsDefn) {
11125   assert(!NewFD->getReturnType()->isVariablyModifiedType() &&
11126          "Variably modified return types are not handled here");
11127 
11128   // Determine whether the type of this function should be merged with
11129   // a previous visible declaration. This never happens for functions in C++,
11130   // and always happens in C if the previous declaration was visible.
11131   bool MergeTypeWithPrevious = !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
11132                                !Previous.isShadowed();
11133 
11134   bool Redeclaration = false;
11135   NamedDecl *OldDecl = nullptr;
11136   bool MayNeedOverloadableChecks = false;
11137 
11138   // Merge or overload the declaration with an existing declaration of
11139   // the same name, if appropriate.
11140   if (!Previous.empty()) {
11141     // Determine whether NewFD is an overload of PrevDecl or
11142     // a declaration that requires merging. If it's an overload,
11143     // there's no more work to do here; we'll just add the new
11144     // function to the scope.
11145     if (!AllowOverloadingOfFunction(Previous, Context, NewFD)) {
11146       NamedDecl *Candidate = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
11147       if (shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(Candidate, NewFD)) {
11148         Redeclaration = true;
11149         OldDecl = Candidate;
11150       }
11151     } else {
11152       MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
11153       switch (CheckOverload(S, NewFD, Previous, OldDecl,
11154                             /*NewIsUsingDecl*/ false)) {
11155       case Ovl_Match:
11156         Redeclaration = true;
11157         break;
11158 
11159       case Ovl_NonFunction:
11160         Redeclaration = true;
11161         break;
11162 
11163       case Ovl_Overload:
11164         Redeclaration = false;
11165         break;
11166       }
11167     }
11168   }
11169 
11170   // Check for a previous extern "C" declaration with this name.
11171   if (!Redeclaration &&
11172       checkForConflictWithNonVisibleExternC(*this, NewFD, Previous)) {
11173     if (!Previous.empty()) {
11174       // This is an extern "C" declaration with the same name as a previous
11175       // declaration, and thus redeclares that entity...
11176       Redeclaration = true;
11177       OldDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
11178       MergeTypeWithPrevious = false;
11179 
11180       // ... except in the presence of __attribute__((overloadable)).
11181       if (OldDecl->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>() ||
11182           NewFD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
11183         if (IsOverload(NewFD, cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl), false)) {
11184           MayNeedOverloadableChecks = true;
11185           Redeclaration = false;
11186           OldDecl = nullptr;
11187         }
11188       }
11189     }
11190   }
11191 
11192   if (CheckMultiVersionFunction(*this, NewFD, Redeclaration, OldDecl, Previous))
11193     return Redeclaration;
11194 
11195   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function return types.
11196   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
11197       CheckPPCMMAType(NewFD->getReturnType(), NewFD->getLocation())) {
11198     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11199   }
11200 
11201   // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p8:
11202   //   A constexpr specifier for a non-static member function that is not
11203   //   a constructor declares that member function to be const.
11204   //
11205   // This needs to be delayed until we know whether this is an out-of-line
11206   // definition of a static member function.
11207   //
11208   // This rule is not present in C++1y, so we produce a backwards
11209   // compatibility warning whenever it happens in C++11.
11210   CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD);
11211   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && MD && MD->isConstexpr() &&
11212       !MD->isStatic() && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) &&
11213       !isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD) && !MD->getMethodQualifiers().hasConst()) {
11214     CXXMethodDecl *OldMD = nullptr;
11215     if (OldDecl)
11216       OldMD = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(OldDecl->getAsFunction());
11217     if (!OldMD || !OldMD->isStatic()) {
11218       const FunctionProtoType *FPT =
11219         MD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11220       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo();
11221       EPI.TypeQuals.addConst();
11222       MD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(FPT->getReturnType(),
11223                                           FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI));
11224 
11225       // Warn that we did this, if we're not performing template instantiation.
11226       // In that case, we'll have warned already when the template was defined.
11227       if (!inTemplateInstantiation()) {
11228         SourceLocation AddConstLoc;
11229         if (FunctionTypeLoc FTL = MD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc()
11230                 .IgnoreParens().getAs<FunctionTypeLoc>())
11231           AddConstLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(FTL.getRParenLoc());
11232 
11233         Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::warn_cxx14_compat_constexpr_not_const)
11234           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(AddConstLoc, " const");
11235       }
11236     }
11237   }
11238 
11239   if (Redeclaration) {
11240     // NewFD and OldDecl represent declarations that need to be
11241     // merged.
11242     if (MergeFunctionDecl(NewFD, OldDecl, S, MergeTypeWithPrevious,
11243                           DeclIsDefn)) {
11244       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11245       return Redeclaration;
11246     }
11247 
11248     Previous.clear();
11249     Previous.addDecl(OldDecl);
11250 
11251     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplateDecl =
11252             dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldDecl)) {
11253       auto *OldFD = OldTemplateDecl->getTemplatedDecl();
11254       FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplateDecl
11255         = NewFD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
11256       assert(NewTemplateDecl && "Template/non-template mismatch");
11257 
11258       // The call to MergeFunctionDecl above may have created some state in
11259       // NewTemplateDecl that needs to be merged with OldTemplateDecl before we
11260       // can add it as a redeclaration.
11261       NewTemplateDecl->mergePrevDecl(OldTemplateDecl);
11262 
11263       NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
11264       if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember()) {
11265         NewFD->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
11266         NewTemplateDecl->setAccess(OldTemplateDecl->getAccess());
11267       }
11268 
11269       // If this is an explicit specialization of a member that is a function
11270       // template, mark it as a member specialization.
11271       if (IsMemberSpecialization &&
11272           NewTemplateDecl->getInstantiatedFromMemberTemplate()) {
11273         NewTemplateDecl->setMemberSpecialization();
11274         assert(OldTemplateDecl->isMemberSpecialization());
11275         // Explicit specializations of a member template do not inherit deleted
11276         // status from the parent member template that they are specializing.
11277         if (OldFD->isDeleted()) {
11278           // FIXME: This assert will not hold in the presence of modules.
11279           assert(OldFD->getCanonicalDecl() == OldFD);
11280           // FIXME: We need an update record for this AST mutation.
11281           OldFD->setDeletedAsWritten(false);
11282         }
11283       }
11284 
11285     } else {
11286       if (shouldLinkDependentDeclWithPrevious(NewFD, OldDecl)) {
11287         auto *OldFD = cast<FunctionDecl>(OldDecl);
11288         // This needs to happen first so that 'inline' propagates.
11289         NewFD->setPreviousDeclaration(OldFD);
11290         if (NewFD->isCXXClassMember())
11291           NewFD->setAccess(OldFD->getAccess());
11292       }
11293     }
11294   } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && MayNeedOverloadableChecks &&
11295              !NewFD->getAttr<OverloadableAttr>()) {
11296     assert((Previous.empty() ||
11297             llvm::any_of(Previous,
11298                          [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
11299                            return ND->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
11300                          })) &&
11301            "Non-redecls shouldn't happen without overloadable present");
11302 
11303     auto OtherUnmarkedIter = llvm::find_if(Previous, [](const NamedDecl *ND) {
11304       const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(ND);
11305       return FD && !FD->hasAttr<OverloadableAttr>();
11306     });
11307 
11308     if (OtherUnmarkedIter != Previous.end()) {
11309       Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
11310            diag::err_attribute_overloadable_multiple_unmarked_overloads);
11311       Diag((*OtherUnmarkedIter)->getLocation(),
11312            diag::note_attribute_overloadable_prev_overload)
11313           << false;
11314 
11315       NewFD->addAttr(OverloadableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
11316     }
11317   }
11318 
11319   if (LangOpts.OpenMP)
11320     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPAssumeScope(NewFD);
11321 
11322   // Semantic checking for this function declaration (in isolation).
11323 
11324   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11325     // C++-specific checks.
11326     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11327       CheckConstructor(Constructor);
11328     } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
11329                 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(NewFD)) {
11330       CXXRecordDecl *Record = Destructor->getParent();
11331       QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Record);
11332 
11333       // FIXME: Shouldn't we be able to perform this check even when the class
11334       // type is dependent? Both gcc and edg can handle that.
11335       if (!ClassType->isDependentType()) {
11336         DeclarationName Name
11337           = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXDestructorName(
11338                                         Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType));
11339         if (NewFD->getDeclName() != Name) {
11340           Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::err_destructor_name);
11341           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11342           return Redeclaration;
11343         }
11344       }
11345     } else if (auto *Guide = dyn_cast<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(NewFD)) {
11346       if (auto *TD = Guide->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
11347         CheckDeductionGuideTemplate(TD);
11348 
11349       // A deduction guide is not on the list of entities that can be
11350       // explicitly specialized.
11351       if (Guide->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization)
11352         Diag(Guide->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_deduction_guide_specialized)
11353             << /*explicit specialization*/ 1;
11354     }
11355 
11356     // Find any virtual functions that this function overrides.
11357     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(NewFD)) {
11358       if (!Method->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization() &&
11359           !Method->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
11360           Method->isCanonicalDecl()) {
11361         AddOverriddenMethods(Method->getParent(), Method);
11362       }
11363       if (Method->isVirtual() && NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause())
11364         // C++2a [class.virtual]p6
11365         // A virtual method shall not have a requires-clause.
11366         Diag(NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()->getBeginLoc(),
11367              diag::err_constrained_virtual_method);
11368 
11369       if (Method->isStatic())
11370         checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionType(Method);
11371     }
11372 
11373     // C++20: dcl.decl.general p4:
11374     // The optional requires-clause ([temp.pre]) in an init-declarator or
11375     // member-declarator shall be present only if the declarator declares a
11376     // templated function ([dcl.fct]).
11377     if (Expr *TRC = NewFD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
11378       if (!NewFD->isTemplated() && !NewFD->isTemplateInstantiation())
11379         Diag(TRC->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_constrained_non_templated_function);
11380     }
11381 
11382     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(NewFD))
11383       ActOnConversionDeclarator(Conversion);
11384 
11385     // Extra checking for C++ overloaded operators (C++ [over.oper]).
11386     if (NewFD->isOverloadedOperator() &&
11387         CheckOverloadedOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11388       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11389       return Redeclaration;
11390     }
11391 
11392     // Extra checking for C++0x literal operators (C++0x [over.literal]).
11393     if (NewFD->getLiteralIdentifier() &&
11394         CheckLiteralOperatorDeclaration(NewFD)) {
11395       NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
11396       return Redeclaration;
11397     }
11398 
11399     // In C++, check default arguments now that we have merged decls. Unless
11400     // the lexical context is the class, because in this case this is done
11401     // during delayed parsing anyway.
11402     if (!CurContext->isRecord())
11403       CheckCXXDefaultArguments(NewFD);
11404 
11405     // If this function is declared as being extern "C", then check to see if
11406     // the function returns a UDT (class, struct, or union type) that is not C
11407     // compatible, and if it does, warn the user.
11408     // But, issue any diagnostic on the first declaration only.
11409     if (Previous.empty() && NewFD->isExternC()) {
11410       QualType R = NewFD->getReturnType();
11411       if (R->isIncompleteType() && !R->isVoidType())
11412         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt_incomplete)
11413             << NewFD << R;
11414       else if (!R.isPODType(Context) && !R->isVoidType() &&
11415                !R->isObjCObjectPointerType())
11416         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_udt) << NewFD << R;
11417     }
11418 
11419     // C++1z [dcl.fct]p6:
11420     //   [...] whether the function has a non-throwing exception-specification
11421     //   [is] part of the function type
11422     //
11423     // This results in an ABI break between C++14 and C++17 for functions whose
11424     // declared type includes an exception-specification in a parameter or
11425     // return type. (Exception specifications on the function itself are OK in
11426     // most cases, and exception specifications are not permitted in most other
11427     // contexts where they could make it into a mangling.)
11428     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 && !NewFD->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
11429       auto HasNoexcept = [&](QualType T) -> bool {
11430         // Strip off declarator chunks that could be between us and a function
11431         // type. We don't need to look far, exception specifications are very
11432         // restricted prior to C++17.
11433         if (auto *RT = T->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11434           T = RT->getPointeeType();
11435         else if (T->isAnyPointerType())
11436           T = T->getPointeeType();
11437         else if (auto *MPT = T->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11438           T = MPT->getPointeeType();
11439         if (auto *FPT = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
11440           if (FPT->isNothrow())
11441             return true;
11442         return false;
11443       };
11444 
11445       auto *FPT = NewFD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11446       bool AnyNoexcept = HasNoexcept(FPT->getReturnType());
11447       for (QualType T : FPT->param_types())
11448         AnyNoexcept |= HasNoexcept(T);
11449       if (AnyNoexcept)
11450         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(),
11451              diag::warn_cxx17_compat_exception_spec_in_signature)
11452             << NewFD;
11453     }
11454 
11455     if (!Redeclaration && LangOpts.CUDA)
11456       checkCUDATargetOverload(NewFD, Previous);
11457   }
11458   return Redeclaration;
11459 }
11460 
11461 void Sema::CheckMain(FunctionDecl* FD, const DeclSpec& DS) {
11462   // C++11 [basic.start.main]p3:
11463   //   A program that [...] declares main to be inline, static or
11464   //   constexpr is ill-formed.
11465   // C11 6.7.4p4:  In a hosted environment, no function specifier(s) shall
11466   //   appear in a declaration of main.
11467   // static main is not an error under C99, but we should warn about it.
11468   // We accept _Noreturn main as an extension.
11469   if (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_Static)
11470     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
11471          ? diag::err_static_main : diag::warn_static_main)
11472       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
11473   if (FD->isInlineSpecified())
11474     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_main)
11475       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getInlineSpecLoc());
11476   if (DS.isNoreturnSpecified()) {
11477     SourceLocation NoreturnLoc = DS.getNoreturnSpecLoc();
11478     SourceRange NoreturnRange(NoreturnLoc, getLocForEndOfToken(NoreturnLoc));
11479     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::ext_noreturn_main);
11480     Diag(NoreturnLoc, diag::note_main_remove_noreturn)
11481       << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(NoreturnRange);
11482   }
11483   if (FD->isConstexpr()) {
11484     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_constexpr_main)
11485         << FD->isConsteval()
11486         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc());
11487     FD->setConstexprKind(ConstexprSpecKind::Unspecified);
11488   }
11489 
11490   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
11491     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_no_main)
11492         << FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>();
11493     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11494     return;
11495   }
11496 
11497   // Functions named main in hlsl are default entries, but don't have specific
11498   // signatures they are required to conform to.
11499   if (getLangOpts().HLSL)
11500     return;
11501 
11502   QualType T = FD->getType();
11503   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11504   const FunctionType* FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11505 
11506   // Set default calling convention for main()
11507   if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11508     FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11509     FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11510     T = Context.getCanonicalType(FD->getType());
11511   }
11512 
11513   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
11514     // In C with GNU extensions we allow main() to have non-integer return
11515     // type, but we should warn about the extension, and we disable the
11516     // implicit-return-zero rule.
11517 
11518     // GCC in C mode accepts qualified 'int'.
11519     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11520       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11521     else {
11522       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::ext_main_returns_nonint);
11523       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11524       if (RTRange.isValid())
11525         Diag(RTRange.getBegin(), diag::note_main_change_return_type)
11526             << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int");
11527     }
11528   } else {
11529     // In C and C++, main magically returns 0 if you fall off the end;
11530     // set the flag which tells us that.
11531     // This is C++ [basic.start.main]p5 and C99 5.1.2.2.3.
11532 
11533     // All the standards say that main() should return 'int'.
11534     if (Context.hasSameType(FT->getReturnType(), Context.IntTy))
11535       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11536     else {
11537       // Otherwise, this is just a flat-out error.
11538       SourceRange RTRange = FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange();
11539       Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::err_main_returns_nonint)
11540           << (RTRange.isValid() ? FixItHint::CreateReplacement(RTRange, "int")
11541                                 : FixItHint());
11542       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11543     }
11544   }
11545 
11546   // Treat protoless main() as nullary.
11547   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FT)) return;
11548 
11549   const FunctionProtoType* FTP = cast<const FunctionProtoType>(FT);
11550   unsigned nparams = FTP->getNumParams();
11551   assert(FD->getNumParams() == nparams);
11552 
11553   bool HasExtraParameters = (nparams > 3);
11554 
11555   if (FTP->isVariadic()) {
11556     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variadic_main);
11557     // FIXME: if we had information about the location of the ellipsis, we
11558     // could add a FixIt hint to remove it as a parameter.
11559   }
11560 
11561   // Darwin passes an undocumented fourth argument of type char**.  If
11562   // other platforms start sprouting these, the logic below will start
11563   // getting shifty.
11564   if (nparams == 4 && Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSDarwin())
11565     HasExtraParameters = false;
11566 
11567   if (HasExtraParameters) {
11568     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_surplus_args) << nparams;
11569     FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11570     nparams = 3;
11571   }
11572 
11573   // FIXME: a lot of the following diagnostics would be improved
11574   // if we had some location information about types.
11575 
11576   QualType CharPP =
11577     Context.getPointerType(Context.getPointerType(Context.CharTy));
11578   QualType Expected[] = { Context.IntTy, CharPP, CharPP, CharPP };
11579 
11580   for (unsigned i = 0; i < nparams; ++i) {
11581     QualType AT = FTP->getParamType(i);
11582 
11583     bool mismatch = true;
11584 
11585     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(AT, Expected[i]))
11586       mismatch = false;
11587     else if (Expected[i] == CharPP) {
11588       // As an extension, the following forms are okay:
11589       //   char const **
11590       //   char const * const *
11591       //   char * const *
11592 
11593       QualifierCollector qs;
11594       const PointerType* PT;
11595       if ((PT = qs.strip(AT)->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11596           (PT = qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType())->getAs<PointerType>()) &&
11597           Context.hasSameType(QualType(qs.strip(PT->getPointeeType()), 0),
11598                               Context.CharTy)) {
11599         qs.removeConst();
11600         mismatch = !qs.empty();
11601       }
11602     }
11603 
11604     if (mismatch) {
11605       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_main_arg_wrong) << i << Expected[i];
11606       // TODO: suggest replacing given type with expected type
11607       FD->setInvalidDecl(true);
11608     }
11609   }
11610 
11611   if (nparams == 1 && !FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
11612     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_main_one_arg);
11613   }
11614 
11615   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11616     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11617     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11618   }
11619 }
11620 
11621 static bool isDefaultStdCall(FunctionDecl *FD, Sema &S) {
11622 
11623   // Default calling convention for main and wmain is __cdecl
11624   if (FD->getName() == "main" || FD->getName() == "wmain")
11625     return false;
11626 
11627   // Default calling convention for MinGW is __cdecl
11628   const llvm::Triple &T = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
11629   if (T.isWindowsGNUEnvironment())
11630     return false;
11631 
11632   // Default calling convention for WinMain, wWinMain and DllMain
11633   // is __stdcall on 32 bit Windows
11634   if (T.isOSWindows() && T.getArch() == llvm::Triple::x86)
11635     return true;
11636 
11637   return false;
11638 }
11639 
11640 void Sema::CheckMSVCRTEntryPoint(FunctionDecl *FD) {
11641   QualType T = FD->getType();
11642   assert(T->isFunctionType() && "function decl is not of function type");
11643   const FunctionType *FT = T->castAs<FunctionType>();
11644 
11645   // Set an implicit return of 'zero' if the function can return some integral,
11646   // enumeration, pointer or nullptr type.
11647   if (FT->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() ||
11648       FT->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() ||
11649       FT->getReturnType()->isNullPtrType())
11650     // DllMain is exempt because a return value of zero means it failed.
11651     if (FD->getName() != "DllMain")
11652       FD->setHasImplicitReturnZero(true);
11653 
11654   // Explicity specified calling conventions are applied to MSVC entry points
11655   if (!hasExplicitCallingConv(T)) {
11656     if (isDefaultStdCall(FD, *this)) {
11657       if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_X86StdCall) {
11658         FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(
11659             FT, FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_X86StdCall));
11660         FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11661       }
11662     } else if (FT->getCallConv() != CC_C) {
11663       FT = Context.adjustFunctionType(FT,
11664                                       FT->getExtInfo().withCallingConv(CC_C));
11665       FD->setType(QualType(FT, 0));
11666     }
11667   }
11668 
11669   if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()) {
11670     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_mainlike_template_decl) << FD;
11671     FD->setInvalidDecl();
11672   }
11673 }
11674 
11675 bool Sema::CheckForConstantInitializer(Expr *Init, QualType DclT) {
11676   // FIXME: Need strict checking.  In C89, we need to check for
11677   // any assignment, increment, decrement, function-calls, or
11678   // commas outside of a sizeof.  In C99, it's the same list,
11679   // except that the aforementioned are allowed in unevaluated
11680   // expressions.  Everything else falls under the
11681   // "may accept other forms of constant expressions" exception.
11682   //
11683   // Regular C++ code will not end up here (exceptions: language extensions,
11684   // OpenCL C++ etc), so the constant expression rules there don't matter.
11685   if (Init->isValueDependent()) {
11686     assert(Init->containsErrors() &&
11687            "Dependent code should only occur in error-recovery path.");
11688     return true;
11689   }
11690   const Expr *Culprit;
11691   if (Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit))
11692     return false;
11693   Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_init_element_not_constant)
11694     << Culprit->getSourceRange();
11695   return true;
11696 }
11697 
11698 namespace {
11699   // Visits an initialization expression to see if OrigDecl is evaluated in
11700   // its own initialization and throws a warning if it does.
11701   class SelfReferenceChecker
11702       : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> {
11703     Sema &S;
11704     Decl *OrigDecl;
11705     bool isRecordType;
11706     bool isPODType;
11707     bool isReferenceType;
11708 
11709     bool isInitList;
11710     llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> InitFieldIndex;
11711 
11712   public:
11713     typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<SelfReferenceChecker> Inherited;
11714 
11715     SelfReferenceChecker(Sema &S, Decl *OrigDecl) : Inherited(S.Context),
11716                                                     S(S), OrigDecl(OrigDecl) {
11717       isPODType = false;
11718       isRecordType = false;
11719       isReferenceType = false;
11720       isInitList = false;
11721       if (ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(OrigDecl)) {
11722         isPODType = VD->getType().isPODType(S.Context);
11723         isRecordType = VD->getType()->isRecordType();
11724         isReferenceType = VD->getType()->isReferenceType();
11725       }
11726     }
11727 
11728     // For most expressions, just call the visitor.  For initializer lists,
11729     // track the index of the field being initialized since fields are
11730     // initialized in order allowing use of previously initialized fields.
11731     void CheckExpr(Expr *E) {
11732       InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(E);
11733       if (!InitList) {
11734         Visit(E);
11735         return;
11736       }
11737 
11738       // Track and increment the index here.
11739       isInitList = true;
11740       InitFieldIndex.push_back(0);
11741       for (auto Child : InitList->children()) {
11742         CheckExpr(cast<Expr>(Child));
11743         ++InitFieldIndex.back();
11744       }
11745       InitFieldIndex.pop_back();
11746     }
11747 
11748     // Returns true if MemberExpr is checked and no further checking is needed.
11749     // Returns false if additional checking is required.
11750     bool CheckInitListMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E, bool CheckReference) {
11751       llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Fields;
11752       Expr *Base = E;
11753       bool ReferenceField = false;
11754 
11755       // Get the field members used.
11756       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11757         FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl());
11758         if (!FD)
11759           return false;
11760         Fields.push_back(FD);
11761         if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType())
11762           ReferenceField = true;
11763         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11764       }
11765 
11766       // Keep checking only if the base Decl is the same.
11767       DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base);
11768       if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl() != OrigDecl)
11769         return false;
11770 
11771       // A reference field can be bound to an unininitialized field.
11772       if (CheckReference && !ReferenceField)
11773         return true;
11774 
11775       // Convert FieldDecls to their index number.
11776       llvm::SmallVector<unsigned, 4> UsedFieldIndex;
11777       for (const FieldDecl *I : llvm::reverse(Fields))
11778         UsedFieldIndex.push_back(I->getFieldIndex());
11779 
11780       // See if a warning is needed by checking the first difference in index
11781       // numbers.  If field being used has index less than the field being
11782       // initialized, then the use is safe.
11783       for (auto UsedIter = UsedFieldIndex.begin(),
11784                 UsedEnd = UsedFieldIndex.end(),
11785                 OrigIter = InitFieldIndex.begin(),
11786                 OrigEnd = InitFieldIndex.end();
11787            UsedIter != UsedEnd && OrigIter != OrigEnd; ++UsedIter, ++OrigIter) {
11788         if (*UsedIter < *OrigIter)
11789           return true;
11790         if (*UsedIter > *OrigIter)
11791           break;
11792       }
11793 
11794       // TODO: Add a different warning which will print the field names.
11795       HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11796       return true;
11797     }
11798 
11799     // For most expressions, the cast is directly above the DeclRefExpr.
11800     // For conditional operators, the cast can be outside the conditional
11801     // operator if both expressions are DeclRefExpr's.
11802     void HandleValue(Expr *E) {
11803       E = E->IgnoreParens();
11804       if (DeclRefExpr* DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) {
11805         HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11806         return;
11807       }
11808 
11809       if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11810         Visit(CO->getCond());
11811         HandleValue(CO->getTrueExpr());
11812         HandleValue(CO->getFalseExpr());
11813         return;
11814       }
11815 
11816       if (BinaryConditionalOperator *BCO =
11817               dyn_cast<BinaryConditionalOperator>(E)) {
11818         Visit(BCO->getCond());
11819         HandleValue(BCO->getFalseExpr());
11820         return;
11821       }
11822 
11823       if (OpaqueValueExpr *OVE = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(E)) {
11824         HandleValue(OVE->getSourceExpr());
11825         return;
11826       }
11827 
11828       if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
11829         if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) {
11830           Visit(BO->getLHS());
11831           HandleValue(BO->getRHS());
11832           return;
11833         }
11834       }
11835 
11836       if (isa<MemberExpr>(E)) {
11837         if (isInitList) {
11838           if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(cast<MemberExpr>(E),
11839                                       false /*CheckReference*/))
11840             return;
11841         }
11842 
11843         Expr *Base = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11844         while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11845           // Check for static member variables and don't warn on them.
11846           if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11847             return;
11848           Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11849         }
11850         if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base))
11851           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11852         return;
11853       }
11854 
11855       Visit(E);
11856     }
11857 
11858     // Reference types not handled in HandleValue are handled here since all
11859     // uses of references are bad, not just r-value uses.
11860     void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
11861       if (isReferenceType)
11862         HandleDeclRefExpr(E);
11863     }
11864 
11865     void VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) {
11866       if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) {
11867         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11868         return;
11869       }
11870 
11871       Inherited::VisitImplicitCastExpr(E);
11872     }
11873 
11874     void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
11875       if (isInitList) {
11876         if (CheckInitListMemberExpr(E, true /*CheckReference*/))
11877           return;
11878       }
11879 
11880       // Don't warn on arrays since they can be treated as pointers.
11881       if (E->getType()->canDecayToPointerType()) return;
11882 
11883       // Warn when a non-static method call is followed by non-static member
11884       // field accesses, which is followed by a DeclRefExpr.
11885       CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl());
11886       bool Warn = (MD && !MD->isStatic());
11887       Expr *Base = E->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11888       while (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base)) {
11889         if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
11890           Warn = false;
11891         Base = ME->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts();
11892       }
11893 
11894       if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Base)) {
11895         if (Warn)
11896           HandleDeclRefExpr(DRE);
11897         return;
11898       }
11899 
11900       // The base of a MemberExpr is not a MemberExpr or a DeclRefExpr.
11901       // Visit that expression.
11902       Visit(Base);
11903     }
11904 
11905     void VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(CXXOperatorCallExpr *E) {
11906       Expr *Callee = E->getCallee();
11907 
11908       if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Callee))
11909         return Inherited::VisitCXXOperatorCallExpr(E);
11910 
11911       Visit(Callee);
11912       for (auto Arg: E->arguments())
11913         HandleValue(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts());
11914     }
11915 
11916     void VisitUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) {
11917       // For POD record types, addresses of its own members are well-defined.
11918       if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && isRecordType &&
11919           isa<MemberExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens())) {
11920         if (!isPODType)
11921           HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11922         return;
11923       }
11924 
11925       if (E->isIncrementDecrementOp()) {
11926         HandleValue(E->getSubExpr());
11927         return;
11928       }
11929 
11930       Inherited::VisitUnaryOperator(E);
11931     }
11932 
11933     void VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) {}
11934 
11935     void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
11936       if (E->getConstructor()->isCopyConstructor()) {
11937         Expr *ArgExpr = E->getArg(0);
11938         if (InitListExpr *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(ArgExpr))
11939           if (ILE->getNumInits() == 1)
11940             ArgExpr = ILE->getInit(0);
11941         if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(ArgExpr))
11942           if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_NoOp)
11943             ArgExpr = ICE->getSubExpr();
11944         HandleValue(ArgExpr);
11945         return;
11946       }
11947       Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
11948     }
11949 
11950     void VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) {
11951       // Treat std::move as a use.
11952       if (E->isCallToStdMove()) {
11953         HandleValue(E->getArg(0));
11954         return;
11955       }
11956 
11957       Inherited::VisitCallExpr(E);
11958     }
11959 
11960     void VisitBinaryOperator(BinaryOperator *E) {
11961       if (E->isCompoundAssignmentOp()) {
11962         HandleValue(E->getLHS());
11963         Visit(E->getRHS());
11964         return;
11965       }
11966 
11967       Inherited::VisitBinaryOperator(E);
11968     }
11969 
11970     // A custom visitor for BinaryConditionalOperator is needed because the
11971     // regular visitor would check the condition and true expression separately
11972     // but both point to the same place giving duplicate diagnostics.
11973     void VisitBinaryConditionalOperator(BinaryConditionalOperator *E) {
11974       Visit(E->getCond());
11975       Visit(E->getFalseExpr());
11976     }
11977 
11978     void HandleDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *DRE) {
11979       Decl* ReferenceDecl = DRE->getDecl();
11980       if (OrigDecl != ReferenceDecl) return;
11981       unsigned diag;
11982       if (isReferenceType) {
11983         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_reference_init;
11984       } else if (cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->isStaticLocal()) {
11985         diag = diag::warn_static_self_reference_in_init;
11986       } else if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11987                  isa<NamespaceDecl>(OrigDecl->getDeclContext()) ||
11988                  DRE->getDecl()->getType()->isRecordType()) {
11989         diag = diag::warn_uninit_self_reference_in_init;
11990       } else {
11991         // Local variables will be handled by the CFG analysis.
11992         return;
11993       }
11994 
11995       S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(DRE->getBeginLoc(), DRE,
11996                             S.PDiag(diag)
11997                                 << DRE->getDecl() << OrigDecl->getLocation()
11998                                 << DRE->getSourceRange());
11999     }
12000   };
12001 
12002   /// CheckSelfReference - Warns if OrigDecl is used in expression E.
12003   static void CheckSelfReference(Sema &S, Decl* OrigDecl, Expr *E,
12004                                  bool DirectInit) {
12005     // Parameters arguments are occassionially constructed with itself,
12006     // for instance, in recursive functions.  Skip them.
12007     if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(OrigDecl))
12008       return;
12009 
12010     E = E->IgnoreParens();
12011 
12012     // Skip checking T a = a where T is not a record or reference type.
12013     // Doing so is a way to silence uninitialized warnings.
12014     if (!DirectInit && !cast<VarDecl>(OrigDecl)->getType()->isRecordType())
12015       if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E))
12016         if (ICE->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue)
12017           if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(ICE->getSubExpr()))
12018             if (DRE->getDecl() == OrigDecl)
12019               return;
12020 
12021     SelfReferenceChecker(S, OrigDecl).CheckExpr(E);
12022   }
12023 } // end anonymous namespace
12024 
12025 namespace {
12026   // Simple wrapper to add the name of a variable or (if no variable is
12027   // available) a DeclarationName into a diagnostic.
12028   struct VarDeclOrName {
12029     VarDecl *VDecl;
12030     DeclarationName Name;
12031 
12032     friend const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &
12033     operator<<(const Sema::SemaDiagnosticBuilder &Diag, VarDeclOrName VN) {
12034       return VN.VDecl ? Diag << VN.VDecl : Diag << VN.Name;
12035     }
12036   };
12037 } // end anonymous namespace
12038 
12039 QualType Sema::deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(VarDecl *VDecl,
12040                                             DeclarationName Name, QualType Type,
12041                                             TypeSourceInfo *TSI,
12042                                             SourceRange Range, bool DirectInit,
12043                                             Expr *Init) {
12044   bool IsInitCapture = !VDecl;
12045   assert((!VDecl || !VDecl->isInitCapture()) &&
12046          "init captures are expected to be deduced prior to initialization");
12047 
12048   VarDeclOrName VN{VDecl, Name};
12049 
12050   DeducedType *Deduced = Type->getContainedDeducedType();
12051   assert(Deduced && "deduceVarTypeFromInitializer for non-deduced type");
12052 
12053   // C++11 [dcl.spec.auto]p3
12054   if (!Init) {
12055     assert(VDecl && "no init for init capture deduction?");
12056 
12057     // Except for class argument deduction, and then for an initializing
12058     // declaration only, i.e. no static at class scope or extern.
12059     if (!isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced) ||
12060         VDecl->hasExternalStorage() ||
12061         VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
12062       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_var_requires_init)
12063         << VDecl->getDeclName() << Type;
12064       return QualType();
12065     }
12066   }
12067 
12068   ArrayRef<Expr*> DeduceInits;
12069   if (Init)
12070     DeduceInits = Init;
12071 
12072   if (DirectInit) {
12073     if (auto *PL = dyn_cast_or_null<ParenListExpr>(Init))
12074       DeduceInits = PL->exprs();
12075   }
12076 
12077   if (isa<DeducedTemplateSpecializationType>(Deduced)) {
12078     assert(VDecl && "non-auto type for init capture deduction?");
12079     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
12080     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
12081         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
12082     // FIXME: Initialization should not be taking a mutable list of inits.
12083     SmallVector<Expr*, 8> InitsCopy(DeduceInits.begin(), DeduceInits.end());
12084     return DeduceTemplateSpecializationFromInitializer(TSI, Entity, Kind,
12085                                                        InitsCopy);
12086   }
12087 
12088   if (DirectInit) {
12089     if (auto *IL = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init))
12090       DeduceInits = IL->inits();
12091   }
12092 
12093   // Deduction only works if we have exactly one source expression.
12094   if (DeduceInits.empty()) {
12095     // It isn't possible to write this directly, but it is possible to
12096     // end up in this situation with "auto x(some_pack...);"
12097     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
12098                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_no_expression
12099                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_no_expression)
12100         << VN << Type << Range;
12101     return QualType();
12102   }
12103 
12104   if (DeduceInits.size() > 1) {
12105     Diag(DeduceInits[1]->getBeginLoc(),
12106          IsInitCapture ? diag::err_init_capture_multiple_expressions
12107                        : diag::err_auto_var_init_multiple_expressions)
12108         << VN << Type << Range;
12109     return QualType();
12110   }
12111 
12112   Expr *DeduceInit = DeduceInits[0];
12113   if (DirectInit && isa<InitListExpr>(DeduceInit)) {
12114     Diag(Init->getBeginLoc(), IsInitCapture
12115                                   ? diag::err_init_capture_paren_braces
12116                                   : diag::err_auto_var_init_paren_braces)
12117         << isa<InitListExpr>(Init) << VN << Type << Range;
12118     return QualType();
12119   }
12120 
12121   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger.
12122   bool DefaultedAnyToId = false;
12123   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId &&
12124       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && !IsInitCapture) {
12125     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
12126     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12127       return QualType();
12128     }
12129     Init = Result.get();
12130     DefaultedAnyToId = true;
12131   }
12132 
12133   // C++ [dcl.decomp]p1:
12134   //   If the assignment-expression [...] has array type A and no ref-qualifier
12135   //   is present, e has type cv A
12136   if (VDecl && isa<DecompositionDecl>(VDecl) &&
12137       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, Context.getAutoDeductType()) &&
12138       DeduceInit->getType()->isConstantArrayType())
12139     return Context.getQualifiedType(DeduceInit->getType(),
12140                                     Type.getQualifiers());
12141 
12142   QualType DeducedType;
12143   if (DeduceAutoType(TSI, DeduceInit, DeducedType) == DAR_Failed) {
12144     if (!IsInitCapture)
12145       DiagnoseAutoDeductionFailure(VDecl, DeduceInit);
12146     else if (isa<InitListExpr>(Init))
12147       Diag(Range.getBegin(),
12148            diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure_from_init_list)
12149           << VN
12150           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
12151                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
12152           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
12153     else
12154       Diag(Range.getBegin(), diag::err_init_capture_deduction_failure)
12155           << VN << TSI->getType()
12156           << (DeduceInit->getType().isNull() ? TSI->getType()
12157                                              : DeduceInit->getType())
12158           << DeduceInit->getSourceRange();
12159   }
12160 
12161   // Warn if we deduced 'id'. 'auto' usually implies type-safety, but using
12162   // 'id' instead of a specific object type prevents most of our usual
12163   // checks.
12164   // We only want to warn outside of template instantiations, though:
12165   // inside a template, the 'id' could have come from a parameter.
12166   if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && !DefaultedAnyToId && !IsInitCapture &&
12167       !DeducedType.isNull() && DeducedType->isObjCIdType()) {
12168     SourceLocation Loc = TSI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
12169     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_auto_var_is_id) << VN << Range;
12170   }
12171 
12172   return DeducedType;
12173 }
12174 
12175 bool Sema::DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VarDecl *VDecl, bool DirectInit,
12176                                          Expr *Init) {
12177   assert(!Init || !Init->containsErrors());
12178   QualType DeducedType = deduceVarTypeFromInitializer(
12179       VDecl, VDecl->getDeclName(), VDecl->getType(), VDecl->getTypeSourceInfo(),
12180       VDecl->getSourceRange(), DirectInit, Init);
12181   if (DeducedType.isNull()) {
12182     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12183     return true;
12184   }
12185 
12186   VDecl->setType(DeducedType);
12187   assert(VDecl->isLinkageValid());
12188 
12189   // In ARC, infer lifetime.
12190   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(VDecl))
12191     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12192 
12193   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
12194     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(VDecl);
12195 
12196   // If this is a redeclaration, check that the type we just deduced matches
12197   // the previously declared type.
12198   if (VarDecl *Old = VDecl->getPreviousDecl()) {
12199     // We never need to merge the type, because we cannot form an incomplete
12200     // array of auto, nor deduce such a type.
12201     MergeVarDeclTypes(VDecl, Old, /*MergeTypeWithPrevious*/ false);
12202   }
12203 
12204   // Check the deduced type is valid for a variable declaration.
12205   CheckVariableDeclarationType(VDecl);
12206   return VDecl->isInvalidDecl();
12207 }
12208 
12209 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(const Expr *Init,
12210                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
12211   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
12212     Init = EWC->getSubExpr();
12213 
12214   if (auto *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Init))
12215     Init = CE->getSubExpr();
12216 
12217   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
12218   assert((InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12219           InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
12220          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C struct");
12221   if (auto *ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
12222     for (auto I : ILE->inits()) {
12223       if (!I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() &&
12224           !I->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12225         continue;
12226       SourceLocation SL = I->getExprLoc();
12227       checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(I, SL.isValid() ? SL : Loc);
12228     }
12229     return;
12230   }
12231 
12232   if (isa<ImplicitValueInitExpr>(Init)) {
12233     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12234       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject,
12235                             NTCUK_Init);
12236   } else {
12237     // Assume all other explicit initializers involving copying some existing
12238     // object.
12239     // TODO: ignore any explicit initializers where we can guarantee
12240     // copy-elision.
12241     if (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12242       checkNonTrivialCUnion(InitType, Loc, NTCUC_CopyInit, NTCUK_Copy);
12243   }
12244 }
12245 
12246 namespace {
12247 
12248 bool shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(const FieldDecl *FD) {
12249   // Ignore unavailable fields. A field can be marked as unavailable explicitly
12250   // in the source code or implicitly by the compiler if it is in a union
12251   // defined in a system header and has non-trivial ObjC ownership
12252   // qualifications. We don't want those fields to participate in determining
12253   // whether the containing union is non-trivial.
12254   return FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>();
12255 }
12256 
12257 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor
12258     : DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
12259                                     void> {
12260   using Super =
12261       DefaultInitializedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor,
12262                                     void>;
12263 
12264   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(
12265       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12266       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
12267       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12268 
12269   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveDefaultInitializeKind PDIK, QualType QT,
12270                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12271     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12272       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12273                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12274     return Super::visitWithKind(PDIK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12275   }
12276 
12277   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12278                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12279     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12280       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12281           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
12282   }
12283 
12284   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12285     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12286       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12287           << 1 << 0 << QT << FD->getName();
12288   }
12289 
12290   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12291     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12292     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12293       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12294         bool IsUnion = false;
12295         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12296           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12297         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12298             << 0 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12299         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12300         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12301       }
12302       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12303     }
12304 
12305     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12306       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12307           << 0 << 0 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12308 
12309     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12310       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12311         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12312   }
12313 
12314   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12315 
12316   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12317   // non-trivial C union.
12318   QualType OrigTy;
12319   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12320   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12321   Sema &S;
12322 };
12323 
12324 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor
12325     : DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void> {
12326   using Super =
12327       DestructedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor, void>;
12328 
12329   DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(
12330       QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12331       Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext, Sema &S)
12332       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12333 
12334   void visitWithKind(QualType::DestructionKind DK, QualType QT,
12335                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12336     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12337       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12338                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12339     return Super::visitWithKind(DK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12340   }
12341 
12342   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12343                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12344     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12345       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12346           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12347   }
12348 
12349   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12350     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12351       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12352           << 1 << 1 << QT << FD->getName();
12353   }
12354 
12355   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12356     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12357     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12358       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12359         bool IsUnion = false;
12360         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12361           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12362         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12363             << 1 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12364         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12365         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12366       }
12367       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12368     }
12369 
12370     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12371       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12372           << 0 << 1 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12373 
12374     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12375       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12376         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12377   }
12378 
12379   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12380   void visitCXXDestructor(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12381                           bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12382 
12383   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12384   // non-trivial C union.
12385   QualType OrigTy;
12386   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12387   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12388   Sema &S;
12389 };
12390 
12391 struct DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor
12392     : CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void> {
12393   using Super = CopiedTypeVisitor<DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor, false, void>;
12394 
12395   DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QualType OrigTy, SourceLocation OrigLoc,
12396                                  Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12397                                  Sema &S)
12398       : OrigTy(OrigTy), OrigLoc(OrigLoc), UseContext(UseContext), S(S) {}
12399 
12400   void visitWithKind(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12401                      const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12402     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(QT))
12403       return this->asDerived().visit(S.Context.getBaseElementType(AT), FD,
12404                                      InNonTrivialUnion);
12405     return Super::visitWithKind(PCK, QT, FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12406   }
12407 
12408   void visitARCStrong(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12409                       bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12410     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12411       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12412           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12413   }
12414 
12415   void visitARCWeak(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12416     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12417       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12418           << 1 << 2 << QT << FD->getName();
12419   }
12420 
12421   void visitStruct(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {
12422     const RecordDecl *RD = QT->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
12423     if (RD->isUnion()) {
12424       if (OrigLoc.isValid()) {
12425         bool IsUnion = false;
12426         if (auto *OrigRD = OrigTy->getAsRecordDecl())
12427           IsUnion = OrigRD->isUnion();
12428         S.Diag(OrigLoc, diag::err_non_trivial_c_union_in_invalid_context)
12429             << 2 << OrigTy << IsUnion << UseContext;
12430         // Reset OrigLoc so that this diagnostic is emitted only once.
12431         OrigLoc = SourceLocation();
12432       }
12433       InNonTrivialUnion = true;
12434     }
12435 
12436     if (InNonTrivialUnion)
12437       S.Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::note_non_trivial_c_union)
12438           << 0 << 2 << QT.getUnqualifiedType() << "";
12439 
12440     for (const FieldDecl *FD : RD->fields())
12441       if (!shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD))
12442         asDerived().visit(FD->getType(), FD, InNonTrivialUnion);
12443   }
12444 
12445   void preVisit(QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK, QualType QT,
12446                 const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12447   void visitTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD, bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12448   void visitVolatileTrivial(QualType QT, const FieldDecl *FD,
12449                             bool InNonTrivialUnion) {}
12450 
12451   // The non-trivial C union type or the struct/union type that contains a
12452   // non-trivial C union.
12453   QualType OrigTy;
12454   SourceLocation OrigLoc;
12455   Sema::NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext;
12456   Sema &S;
12457 };
12458 
12459 } // namespace
12460 
12461 void Sema::checkNonTrivialCUnion(QualType QT, SourceLocation Loc,
12462                                  NonTrivialCUnionContext UseContext,
12463                                  unsigned NonTrivialKind) {
12464   assert((QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12465           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
12466           QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()) &&
12467          "shouldn't be called if type doesn't have a non-trivial C union");
12468 
12469   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Init) &&
12470       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
12471     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDefaultInitializeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12472         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12473   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Destruct) &&
12474       QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion())
12475     DiagNonTrivalCUnionDestructedTypeVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12476         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12477   if ((NonTrivialKind & NTCUK_Copy) && QT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
12478     DiagNonTrivalCUnionCopyVisitor(QT, Loc, UseContext, *this)
12479         .visit(QT, nullptr, false);
12480 }
12481 
12482 /// AddInitializerToDecl - Adds the initializer Init to the
12483 /// declaration dcl. If DirectInit is true, this is C++ direct
12484 /// initialization rather than copy initialization.
12485 void Sema::AddInitializerToDecl(Decl *RealDecl, Expr *Init, bool DirectInit) {
12486   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it.  Just ignore
12487   // the initializer.
12488   if (!RealDecl || RealDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12489     CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(RealDecl));
12490     return;
12491   }
12492 
12493   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12494     // Pure-specifiers are handled in ActOnPureSpecifier.
12495     Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::err_member_function_initialization)
12496       << Method->getDeclName() << Init->getSourceRange();
12497     Method->setInvalidDecl();
12498     return;
12499   }
12500 
12501   VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl);
12502   if (!VDecl) {
12503     assert(!isa<FieldDecl>(RealDecl) && "field init shouldn't get here");
12504     Diag(RealDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_illegal_initializer);
12505     RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12506     return;
12507   }
12508 
12509   // C++11 [decl.spec.auto]p6. Deduce the type which 'auto' stands in for.
12510   if (VDecl->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12511     // Attempt typo correction early so that the type of the init expression can
12512     // be deduced based on the chosen correction if the original init contains a
12513     // TypoExpr.
12514     ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Init, VDecl);
12515     if (!Res.isUsable()) {
12516       // There are unresolved typos in Init, just drop them.
12517       // FIXME: improve the recovery strategy to preserve the Init.
12518       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12519       return;
12520     }
12521     if (Res.get()->containsErrors()) {
12522       // Invalidate the decl as we don't know the type for recovery-expr yet.
12523       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12524       VDecl->setInit(Res.get());
12525       return;
12526     }
12527     Init = Res.get();
12528 
12529     if (DeduceVariableDeclarationType(VDecl, DirectInit, Init))
12530       return;
12531   }
12532 
12533   // dllimport cannot be used on variable definitions.
12534   if (VDecl->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !VDecl->isStaticDataMember()) {
12535     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_data_definition);
12536     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12537     return;
12538   }
12539 
12540   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl() && VDecl->hasExternalStorage()) {
12541     // C99 6.7.8p5. C++ has no such restriction, but that is a defect.
12542     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_block_extern_cant_init);
12543     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12544     return;
12545   }
12546 
12547   if (!VDecl->getType()->isDependentType()) {
12548     // A definition must end up with a complete type, which means it must be
12549     // complete with the restriction that an array type might be completed by
12550     // the initializer; note that later code assumes this restriction.
12551     QualType BaseDeclType = VDecl->getType();
12552     if (const ArrayType *Array = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(BaseDeclType))
12553       BaseDeclType = Array->getElementType();
12554     if (RequireCompleteType(VDecl->getLocation(), BaseDeclType,
12555                             diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12556       RealDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12557       return;
12558     }
12559 
12560     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
12561     if (RequireNonAbstractType(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(),
12562                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12563                                AbstractVariableType))
12564       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12565   }
12566 
12567   // If adding the initializer will turn this declaration into a definition,
12568   // and we already have a definition for this variable, diagnose or otherwise
12569   // handle the situation.
12570   if (VarDecl *Def = VDecl->getDefinition())
12571     if (Def != VDecl &&
12572         (!VDecl->isStaticDataMember() || VDecl->isOutOfLine()) &&
12573         !VDecl->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition() &&
12574         checkVarDeclRedefinition(Def, VDecl))
12575       return;
12576 
12577   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12578     // C++ [class.static.data]p4
12579     //   If a static data member is of const integral or const
12580     //   enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12581     //   specify a constant-initializer which shall be an integral
12582     //   constant expression (5.19). In that case, the member can appear
12583     //   in integral constant expressions. The member shall still be
12584     //   defined in a namespace scope if it is used in the program and the
12585     //   namespace scope definition shall not contain an initializer.
12586     //
12587     // We already performed a redefinition check above, but for static
12588     // data members we also need to check whether there was an in-class
12589     // declaration with an initializer.
12590     if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->hasInit()) {
12591       Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_static_data_member_reinitialization)
12592           << VDecl->getDeclName();
12593       Diag(VDecl->getCanonicalDecl()->getInit()->getExprLoc(),
12594            diag::note_previous_initializer)
12595           << 0;
12596       return;
12597     }
12598 
12599     if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12600       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
12601 
12602     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Init, UPPC_Initializer)) {
12603       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12604       return;
12605     }
12606   }
12607 
12608   // OpenCL 1.1 6.5.2: "Variables allocated in the __local address space inside
12609   // a kernel function cannot be initialized."
12610   if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local) {
12611     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_local_cant_init);
12612     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12613     return;
12614   }
12615 
12616   // The LoaderUninitialized attribute acts as a definition (of undef).
12617   if (VDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
12618     Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_cant_init);
12619     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12620     return;
12621   }
12622 
12623   // Get the decls type and save a reference for later, since
12624   // CheckInitializerTypes may change it.
12625   QualType DclT = VDecl->getType(), SavT = DclT;
12626 
12627   // Expressions default to 'id' when we're in a debugger
12628   // and we are assigning it to a variable of Objective-C pointer type.
12629   if (getLangOpts().DebuggerCastResultToId && DclT->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
12630       Init->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
12631     ExprResult Result = forceUnknownAnyToType(Init, Context.getObjCIdType());
12632     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12633       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12634       return;
12635     }
12636     Init = Result.get();
12637   }
12638 
12639   // Perform the initialization.
12640   ParenListExpr *CXXDirectInit = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(Init);
12641   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12642     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(VDecl);
12643     InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateForInit(
12644         VDecl->getLocation(), DirectInit, Init);
12645 
12646     MultiExprArg Args = Init;
12647     if (CXXDirectInit)
12648       Args = MultiExprArg(CXXDirectInit->getExprs(),
12649                           CXXDirectInit->getNumExprs());
12650 
12651     // Try to correct any TypoExprs in the initialization arguments.
12652     for (size_t Idx = 0; Idx < Args.size(); ++Idx) {
12653       ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(
12654           Args[Idx], VDecl, /*RecoverUncorrectedTypos=*/true,
12655           [this, Entity, Kind](Expr *E) {
12656             InitializationSequence Init(*this, Entity, Kind, MultiExprArg(E));
12657             return Init.Failed() ? ExprError() : E;
12658           });
12659       if (Res.isInvalid()) {
12660         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12661       } else if (Res.get() != Args[Idx]) {
12662         Args[Idx] = Res.get();
12663       }
12664     }
12665     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12666       return;
12667 
12668     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, Args,
12669                                    /*TopLevelOfInitList=*/false,
12670                                    /*TreatUnavailableAsInvalid=*/false);
12671     ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, Args, &DclT);
12672     if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12673       // If the provided initializer fails to initialize the var decl,
12674       // we attach a recovery expr for better recovery.
12675       auto RecoveryExpr =
12676           CreateRecoveryExpr(Init->getBeginLoc(), Init->getEndLoc(), Args);
12677       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
12678         VDecl->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
12679       return;
12680     }
12681 
12682     Init = Result.getAs<Expr>();
12683   }
12684 
12685   // Check for self-references within variable initializers.
12686   // Variables declared within a function/method body (except for references)
12687   // are handled by a dataflow analysis.
12688   // This is undefined behavior in C++, but valid in C.
12689   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
12690     if (!VDecl->hasLocalStorage() || VDecl->getType()->isRecordType() ||
12691         VDecl->getType()->isReferenceType())
12692       CheckSelfReference(*this, RealDecl, Init, DirectInit);
12693 
12694   // If the type changed, it means we had an incomplete type that was
12695   // completed by the initializer. For example:
12696   //   int ary[] = { 1, 3, 5 };
12697   // "ary" transitions from an IncompleteArrayType to a ConstantArrayType.
12698   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl() && (DclT != SavT))
12699     VDecl->setType(DclT);
12700 
12701   if (!VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12702     checkUnsafeAssigns(VDecl->getLocation(), VDecl->getType(), Init);
12703 
12704     if (VDecl->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
12705       checkRetainCycles(VDecl, Init);
12706 
12707     // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable.
12708     // Although this code can still have problems:
12709     //   id x = self.weakProp;
12710     //   id y = self.weakProp;
12711     // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate
12712     // paths through the function. This should be revisited if
12713     // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive.
12714     if (FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction())
12715       if ((VDecl->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
12716            VDecl->getType().isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) &&
12717           !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak,
12718                            Init->getBeginLoc()))
12719         FSI->markSafeWeakUse(Init);
12720   }
12721 
12722   // The initialization is usually a full-expression.
12723   //
12724   // FIXME: If this is a braced initialization of an aggregate, it is not
12725   // an expression, and each individual field initializer is a separate
12726   // full-expression. For instance, in:
12727   //
12728   //   struct Temp { ~Temp(); };
12729   //   struct S { S(Temp); };
12730   //   struct T { S a, b; } t = { Temp(), Temp() }
12731   //
12732   // we should destroy the first Temp before constructing the second.
12733   ExprResult Result =
12734       ActOnFinishFullExpr(Init, VDecl->getLocation(),
12735                           /*DiscardedValue*/ false, VDecl->isConstexpr());
12736   if (Result.isInvalid()) {
12737     VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12738     return;
12739   }
12740   Init = Result.get();
12741 
12742   // Attach the initializer to the decl.
12743   VDecl->setInit(Init);
12744 
12745   if (VDecl->isLocalVarDecl()) {
12746     // Don't check the initializer if the declaration is malformed.
12747     if (VDecl->isInvalidDecl()) {
12748       // do nothing
12749 
12750     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.5.3: __constant locals must be constant-initialized.
12751     // This is true even in C++ for OpenCL.
12752     } else if (VDecl->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant) {
12753       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12754 
12755     // Otherwise, C++ does not restrict the initializer.
12756     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
12757       // do nothing
12758 
12759     // C99 6.7.8p4: All the expressions in an initializer for an object that has
12760     // static storage duration shall be constant expressions or string literals.
12761     } else if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
12762       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12763 
12764     // C89 is stricter than C99 for aggregate initializers.
12765     // C89 6.5.7p3: All the expressions [...] in an initializer list
12766     // for an object that has aggregate or union type shall be
12767     // constant expressions.
12768     } else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && VDecl->getType()->isAggregateType() &&
12769                isa<InitListExpr>(Init)) {
12770       const Expr *Culprit;
12771       if (!Init->isConstantInitializer(Context, false, &Culprit)) {
12772         Diag(Culprit->getExprLoc(),
12773              diag::ext_aggregate_init_not_constant)
12774           << Culprit->getSourceRange();
12775       }
12776     }
12777 
12778     if (auto *E = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Init))
12779       if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(E->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens()))
12780         if (VDecl->hasLocalStorage())
12781           BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap();
12782   } else if (VDecl->isStaticDataMember() && !VDecl->isInline() &&
12783              VDecl->getLexicalDeclContext()->isRecord()) {
12784     // This is an in-class initialization for a static data member, e.g.,
12785     //
12786     // struct S {
12787     //   static const int value = 17;
12788     // };
12789 
12790     // C++ [class.mem]p4:
12791     //   A member-declarator can contain a constant-initializer only
12792     //   if it declares a static member (9.4) of const integral or
12793     //   const enumeration type, see 9.4.2.
12794     //
12795     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3:
12796     //   If a non-volatile non-inline const static data member is of integral
12797     //   or enumeration type, its declaration in the class definition can
12798     //   specify a brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause
12799     //   that is an assignment-expression is a constant expression. A static
12800     //   data member of literal type can be declared in the class definition
12801     //   with the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify a
12802     //   brace-or-equal-initializer in which every initializer-clause that is
12803     //   an assignment-expression is a constant expression.
12804 
12805     // Do nothing on dependent types.
12806     if (DclT->isDependentType()) {
12807 
12808     // Allow any 'static constexpr' members, whether or not they are of literal
12809     // type. We separately check that every constexpr variable is of literal
12810     // type.
12811     } else if (VDecl->isConstexpr()) {
12812 
12813     // Require constness.
12814     } else if (!DclT.isConstQualified()) {
12815       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_const)
12816         << Init->getSourceRange();
12817       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12818 
12819     // We allow integer constant expressions in all cases.
12820     } else if (DclT->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
12821       // Check whether the expression is a constant expression.
12822       SourceLocation Loc;
12823       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT.isVolatileQualified())
12824         // In C++11, a non-constexpr const static data member with an
12825         // in-class initializer cannot be volatile.
12826         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_volatile);
12827       else if (Init->isValueDependent())
12828         ; // Nothing to check.
12829       else if (Init->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context, &Loc))
12830         ; // Ok, it's an ICE!
12831       else if (Init->getType()->isScopedEnumeralType() &&
12832                Init->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Context))
12833         ; // Ok, it is a scoped-enum constant expression.
12834       else if (Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12835         // If we can constant fold the initializer through heroics, accept it,
12836         // but report this as a use of an extension for -pedantic.
12837         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12838           << Init->getSourceRange();
12839       } else {
12840         // Otherwise, this is some crazy unknown case.  Report the issue at the
12841         // location provided by the isIntegerConstantExpr failed check.
12842         Diag(Loc, diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12843           << Init->getSourceRange();
12844         VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12845       }
12846 
12847     // We allow foldable floating-point constants as an extension.
12848     } else if (DclT->isFloatingType()) { // also permits complex, which is ok
12849       // In C++98, this is a GNU extension. In C++11, it is not, but we support
12850       // it anyway and provide a fixit to add the 'constexpr'.
12851       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
12852         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(),
12853              diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12854             << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12855         Diag(VDecl->getBeginLoc(),
12856              diag::note_in_class_initializer_float_type_cxx11)
12857             << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12858       } else {
12859         Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::ext_in_class_initializer_float_type)
12860           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12861 
12862         if (!Init->isValueDependent() && !Init->isEvaluatable(Context)) {
12863           Diag(Init->getExprLoc(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_non_constant)
12864             << Init->getSourceRange();
12865           VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12866         }
12867       }
12868 
12869     // Suggest adding 'constexpr' in C++11 for literal types.
12870     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && DclT->isLiteralType(Context)) {
12871       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_literal_type)
12872           << DclT << Init->getSourceRange()
12873           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(VDecl->getBeginLoc(), "constexpr ");
12874       VDecl->setConstexpr(true);
12875 
12876     } else {
12877       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::err_in_class_initializer_bad_type)
12878         << DclT << Init->getSourceRange();
12879       VDecl->setInvalidDecl();
12880     }
12881   } else if (VDecl->isFileVarDecl()) {
12882     // In C, extern is typically used to avoid tentative definitions when
12883     // declaring variables in headers, but adding an intializer makes it a
12884     // definition. This is somewhat confusing, so GCC and Clang both warn on it.
12885     // In C++, extern is often used to give implictly static const variables
12886     // external linkage, so don't warn in that case. If selectany is present,
12887     // this might be header code intended for C and C++ inclusion, so apply the
12888     // C++ rules.
12889     if (VDecl->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern &&
12890         ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->hasAttr<SelectAnyAttr>()) ||
12891          !Context.getBaseElementType(VDecl->getType()).isConstQualified()) &&
12892         !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->isExternC()) &&
12893         !isTemplateInstantiation(VDecl->getTemplateSpecializationKind()))
12894       Diag(VDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_extern_init);
12895 
12896     // In Microsoft C++ mode, a const variable defined in namespace scope has
12897     // external linkage by default if the variable is declared with
12898     // __declspec(dllexport).
12899     if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft() &&
12900         getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && VDecl->getType().isConstQualified() &&
12901         VDecl->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>() && VDecl->getDefinition())
12902       VDecl->setStorageClass(SC_Extern);
12903 
12904     // C99 6.7.8p4. All file scoped initializers need to be constant.
12905     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !VDecl->isInvalidDecl())
12906       CheckForConstantInitializer(Init, DclT);
12907   }
12908 
12909   QualType InitType = Init->getType();
12910   if (!InitType.isNull() &&
12911       (InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
12912        InitType.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion()))
12913     checkNonTrivialCUnionInInitializer(Init, Init->getExprLoc());
12914 
12915   // We will represent direct-initialization similarly to copy-initialization:
12916   //    int x(1);  -as-> int x = 1;
12917   //    ClassType x(a,b,c); -as-> ClassType x = ClassType(a,b,c);
12918   //
12919   // Clients that want to distinguish between the two forms, can check for
12920   // direct initializer using VarDecl::getInitStyle().
12921   // A major benefit is that clients that don't particularly care about which
12922   // exactly form was it (like the CodeGen) can handle both cases without
12923   // special case code.
12924 
12925   // C++ 8.5p11:
12926   // The form of initialization (using parentheses or '=') is generally
12927   // insignificant, but does matter when the entity being initialized has a
12928   // class type.
12929   if (CXXDirectInit) {
12930     assert(DirectInit && "Call-style initializer must be direct init.");
12931     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
12932   } else if (DirectInit) {
12933     // This must be list-initialization. No other way is direct-initialization.
12934     VDecl->setInitStyle(VarDecl::ListInit);
12935   }
12936 
12937   if (LangOpts.OpenMP &&
12938       (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice || !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty()) &&
12939       VDecl->isFileVarDecl())
12940     DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(VDecl);
12941   CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VDecl);
12942 }
12943 
12944 /// ActOnInitializerError - Given that there was an error parsing an
12945 /// initializer for the given declaration, try to at least re-establish
12946 /// invariants such as whether a variable's type is either dependent or
12947 /// complete.
12948 void Sema::ActOnInitializerError(Decl *D) {
12949   // Our main concern here is re-establishing invariants like "a
12950   // variable's type is either dependent or complete".
12951   if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl()) return;
12952 
12953   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
12954   if (!VD) return;
12955 
12956   // Bindings are not usable if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12957   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D))
12958     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings())
12959       BD->setInvalidDecl();
12960 
12961   // Auto types are meaningless if we can't make sense of the initializer.
12962   if (VD->getType()->isUndeducedType()) {
12963     D->setInvalidDecl();
12964     return;
12965   }
12966 
12967   QualType Ty = VD->getType();
12968   if (Ty->isDependentType()) return;
12969 
12970   // Require a complete type.
12971   if (RequireCompleteType(VD->getLocation(),
12972                           Context.getBaseElementType(Ty),
12973                           diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
12974     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12975     return;
12976   }
12977 
12978   // Require a non-abstract type.
12979   if (RequireNonAbstractType(VD->getLocation(), Ty,
12980                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
12981                              AbstractVariableType)) {
12982     VD->setInvalidDecl();
12983     return;
12984   }
12985 
12986   // Don't bother complaining about constructors or destructors,
12987   // though.
12988 }
12989 
12990 void Sema::ActOnUninitializedDecl(Decl *RealDecl) {
12991   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Just ignore it.
12992   if (!RealDecl)
12993     return;
12994 
12995   if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(RealDecl)) {
12996     QualType Type = Var->getType();
12997 
12998     // C++1z [dcl.dcl]p1 grammar implies that an initializer is mandatory.
12999     if (isa<DecompositionDecl>(RealDecl)) {
13000       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_decomp_decl_requires_init) << Var;
13001       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13002       return;
13003     }
13004 
13005     if (Type->isUndeducedType() &&
13006         DeduceVariableDeclarationType(Var, false, nullptr))
13007       return;
13008 
13009     // C++11 [class.static.data]p3: A static data member can be declared with
13010     // the constexpr specifier; if so, its declaration shall specify
13011     // a brace-or-equal-initializer.
13012     // C++11 [dcl.constexpr]p1: The constexpr specifier shall be applied only to
13013     // the definition of a variable [...] or the declaration of a static data
13014     // member.
13015     if (Var->isConstexpr() && !Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13016         !Var->isThisDeclarationADemotedDefinition()) {
13017       if (Var->isStaticDataMember()) {
13018         // C++1z removes the relevant rule; the in-class declaration is always
13019         // a definition there.
13020         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
13021             !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
13022           Diag(Var->getLocation(),
13023                diag::err_constexpr_static_mem_var_requires_init)
13024               << Var;
13025           Var->setInvalidDecl();
13026           return;
13027         }
13028       } else {
13029         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr_var_decl);
13030         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13031         return;
13032       }
13033     }
13034 
13035     // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5.3: variables declared in the constant address space must
13036     // be initialized.
13037     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13038         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_constant &&
13039         Var->getStorageClass() != SC_Extern && !Var->getInit()) {
13040       bool HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = false;
13041       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
13042         for (auto *Ctor : RD->ctors()) {
13043           if (Ctor->isConstexpr() && Ctor->getNumParams() == 0 &&
13044               Ctor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace() ==
13045                   LangAS::opencl_constant) {
13046             HasConstExprDefaultConstructor = true;
13047           }
13048         }
13049       }
13050       if (!HasConstExprDefaultConstructor) {
13051         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_constant_no_init);
13052         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13053         return;
13054       }
13055     }
13056 
13057     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && RealDecl->hasAttr<LoaderUninitializedAttr>()) {
13058       if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern) {
13059         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_extern_decl)
13060             << Var;
13061         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13062         return;
13063       }
13064       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Var->getType(),
13065                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
13066         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13067         return;
13068       }
13069       if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = Var->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) {
13070         if (!RD->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor()) {
13071           Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_loader_uninitialized_trivial_ctor);
13072           Var->setInvalidDecl();
13073           return;
13074         }
13075       }
13076       // The declaration is unitialized, no need for further checks.
13077       return;
13078     }
13079 
13080     VarDecl::DefinitionKind DefKind = Var->isThisDeclarationADefinition();
13081     if (!Var->isInvalidDecl() && DefKind != VarDecl::DeclarationOnly &&
13082         Var->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion())
13083       checkNonTrivialCUnion(Var->getType(), Var->getLocation(),
13084                             NTCUC_DefaultInitializedObject, NTCUK_Init);
13085 
13086 
13087     switch (DefKind) {
13088     case VarDecl::Definition:
13089       if (!Var->isStaticDataMember() || !Var->getAnyInitializer())
13090         break;
13091 
13092       // We have an out-of-line definition of a static data member
13093       // that has an in-class initializer, so we type-check this like
13094       // a declaration.
13095       //
13096       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
13097 
13098     case VarDecl::DeclarationOnly:
13099       // It's only a declaration.
13100 
13101       // Block scope. C99 6.7p7: If an identifier for an object is
13102       // declared with no linkage (C99 6.2.2p6), the type for the
13103       // object shall be complete.
13104       if (!Type->isDependentType() && Var->isLocalVarDecl() &&
13105           !Var->hasLinkage() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13106           RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13107                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type))
13108         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13109 
13110       // Make sure that the type is not abstract.
13111       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13112           RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13113                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
13114                                  AbstractVariableType))
13115         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13116       if (!Type->isDependentType() && !Var->isInvalidDecl() &&
13117           Var->getStorageClass() == SC_PrivateExtern) {
13118         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::warn_private_extern);
13119         Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_private_extern);
13120       }
13121 
13122       if (Context.getTargetInfo().allowDebugInfoForExternalRef() &&
13123           !Var->isInvalidDecl() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13124         ExternalDeclarations.push_back(Var);
13125 
13126       return;
13127 
13128     case VarDecl::TentativeDefinition:
13129       // File scope. C99 6.9.2p2: A declaration of an identifier for an
13130       // object that has file scope without an initializer, and without a
13131       // storage-class specifier or with the storage-class specifier "static",
13132       // constitutes a tentative definition. Note: A tentative definition with
13133       // external linkage is valid (C99 6.2.2p5).
13134       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl()) {
13135         if (const IncompleteArrayType *ArrayT
13136                                     = Context.getAsIncompleteArrayType(Type)) {
13137           if (RequireCompleteSizedType(
13138                   Var->getLocation(), ArrayT->getElementType(),
13139                   diag::err_array_incomplete_or_sizeless_type))
13140             Var->setInvalidDecl();
13141         } else if (Var->getStorageClass() == SC_Static) {
13142           // C99 6.9.2p3: If the declaration of an identifier for an object is
13143           // a tentative definition and has internal linkage (C99 6.2.2p3), the
13144           // declared type shall not be an incomplete type.
13145           // NOTE: code such as the following
13146           //     static struct s;
13147           //     struct s { int a; };
13148           // is accepted by gcc. Hence here we issue a warning instead of
13149           // an error and we do not invalidate the static declaration.
13150           // NOTE: to avoid multiple warnings, only check the first declaration.
13151           if (Var->isFirstDecl())
13152             RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13153                                 diag::ext_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type);
13154         }
13155       }
13156 
13157       // Record the tentative definition; we're done.
13158       if (!Var->isInvalidDecl())
13159         TentativeDefinitions.push_back(Var);
13160       return;
13161     }
13162 
13163     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
13164     // definitions with incomplete array type.
13165     if (Type->isIncompleteArrayType()) {
13166       Diag(Var->getLocation(),
13167            diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_array_needs_initializer);
13168       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13169       return;
13170     }
13171 
13172     // Provide a specific diagnostic for uninitialized variable
13173     // definitions with reference type.
13174     if (Type->isReferenceType()) {
13175       Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::err_reference_var_requires_init)
13176           << Var << SourceRange(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation());
13177       return;
13178     }
13179 
13180     // Do not attempt to type-check the default initializer for a
13181     // variable with dependent type.
13182     if (Type->isDependentType())
13183       return;
13184 
13185     if (Var->isInvalidDecl())
13186       return;
13187 
13188     if (!Var->hasAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
13189       if (RequireCompleteType(Var->getLocation(),
13190                               Context.getBaseElementType(Type),
13191                               diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)) {
13192         Var->setInvalidDecl();
13193         return;
13194       }
13195     } else {
13196       return;
13197     }
13198 
13199     // The variable can not have an abstract class type.
13200     if (RequireNonAbstractType(Var->getLocation(), Type,
13201                                diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
13202                                AbstractVariableType)) {
13203       Var->setInvalidDecl();
13204       return;
13205     }
13206 
13207     // Check for jumps past the implicit initializer.  C++0x
13208     // clarifies that this applies to a "variable with automatic
13209     // storage duration", not a "local variable".
13210     // C++11 [stmt.dcl]p3
13211     //   A program that jumps from a point where a variable with automatic
13212     //   storage duration is not in scope to a point where it is in scope is
13213     //   ill-formed unless the variable has scalar type, class type with a
13214     //   trivial default constructor and a trivial destructor, a cv-qualified
13215     //   version of one of these types, or an array of one of the preceding
13216     //   types and is declared without an initializer.
13217     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Var->hasLocalStorage()) {
13218       if (const RecordType *Record
13219             = Context.getBaseElementType(Type)->getAs<RecordType>()) {
13220         CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl());
13221         // Mark the function (if we're in one) for further checking even if the
13222         // looser rules of C++11 do not require such checks, so that we can
13223         // diagnose incompatibilities with C++98.
13224         if (!CXXRecord->isPOD())
13225           setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13226       }
13227     }
13228     // In OpenCL, we can't initialize objects in the __local address space,
13229     // even implicitly, so don't synthesize an implicit initializer.
13230     if (getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
13231         Var->getType().getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_local)
13232       return;
13233     // C++03 [dcl.init]p9:
13234     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, and the
13235     //   object is of (possibly cv-qualified) non-POD class type (or
13236     //   array thereof), the object shall be default-initialized; if
13237     //   the object is of const-qualified type, the underlying class
13238     //   type shall have a user-declared default
13239     //   constructor. Otherwise, if no initializer is specified for
13240     //   a non- static object, the object and its subobjects, if
13241     //   any, have an indeterminate initial value); if the object
13242     //   or any of its subobjects are of const-qualified type, the
13243     //   program is ill-formed.
13244     // C++0x [dcl.init]p11:
13245     //   If no initializer is specified for an object, the object is
13246     //   default-initialized; [...].
13247     InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeVariable(Var);
13248     InitializationKind Kind
13249       = InitializationKind::CreateDefault(Var->getLocation());
13250 
13251     InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
13252     ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, None);
13253 
13254     if (Init.get()) {
13255       Var->setInit(MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Init.get()));
13256       // This is important for template substitution.
13257       Var->setInitStyle(VarDecl::CallInit);
13258     } else if (Init.isInvalid()) {
13259       // If default-init fails, attach a recovery-expr initializer to track
13260       // that initialization was attempted and failed.
13261       auto RecoveryExpr =
13262           CreateRecoveryExpr(Var->getLocation(), Var->getLocation(), {});
13263       if (RecoveryExpr.get())
13264         Var->setInit(RecoveryExpr.get());
13265     }
13266 
13267     CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(Var);
13268   }
13269 }
13270 
13271 void Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeDecl(Decl *D) {
13272   // If there is no declaration, there was an error parsing it. Ignore it.
13273   if (!D)
13274     return;
13275 
13276   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D);
13277   if (!VD) {
13278     Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::err_for_range_decl_must_be_var);
13279     D->setInvalidDecl();
13280     return;
13281   }
13282 
13283   VD->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
13284 
13285   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier.
13286   int Error = -1;
13287   switch (VD->getStorageClass()) {
13288   case SC_None:
13289     break;
13290   case SC_Extern:
13291     Error = 0;
13292     break;
13293   case SC_Static:
13294     Error = 1;
13295     break;
13296   case SC_PrivateExtern:
13297     Error = 2;
13298     break;
13299   case SC_Auto:
13300     Error = 3;
13301     break;
13302   case SC_Register:
13303     Error = 4;
13304     break;
13305   }
13306 
13307   // for-range-declaration cannot be given a storage class specifier con't.
13308   switch (VD->getTSCSpec()) {
13309   case TSCS_thread_local:
13310     Error = 6;
13311     break;
13312   case TSCS___thread:
13313   case TSCS__Thread_local:
13314   case TSCS_unspecified:
13315     break;
13316   }
13317 
13318   if (Error != -1) {
13319     Diag(VD->getOuterLocStart(), diag::err_for_range_storage_class)
13320         << VD << Error;
13321     D->setInvalidDecl();
13322   }
13323 }
13324 
13325 StmtResult Sema::ActOnCXXForRangeIdentifier(Scope *S, SourceLocation IdentLoc,
13326                                             IdentifierInfo *Ident,
13327                                             ParsedAttributes &Attrs) {
13328   // C++1y [stmt.iter]p1:
13329   //   A range-based for statement of the form
13330   //      for ( for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13331   //   is equivalent to
13332   //      for ( auto&& for-range-identifier : for-range-initializer ) statement
13333   DeclSpec DS(Attrs.getPool().getFactory());
13334 
13335   const char *PrevSpec;
13336   unsigned DiagID;
13337   DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_auto, IdentLoc, PrevSpec, DiagID,
13338                      getPrintingPolicy());
13339 
13340   Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::ForInit);
13341   D.SetIdentifier(Ident, IdentLoc);
13342   D.takeAttributes(Attrs);
13343 
13344   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getReference(0, IdentLoc, /*lvalue*/ false),
13345                 IdentLoc);
13346   Decl *Var = ActOnDeclarator(S, D);
13347   cast<VarDecl>(Var)->setCXXForRangeDecl(true);
13348   FinalizeDeclaration(Var);
13349   return ActOnDeclStmt(FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(S, DS, Var), IdentLoc,
13350                        Attrs.Range.getEnd().isValid() ? Attrs.Range.getEnd()
13351                                                       : IdentLoc);
13352 }
13353 
13354 void Sema::CheckCompleteVariableDeclaration(VarDecl *var) {
13355   if (var->isInvalidDecl()) return;
13356 
13357   MaybeAddCUDAConstantAttr(var);
13358 
13359   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) {
13360     // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Every block variable declaration must have an
13361     // initialiser
13362     if (var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType()->isBlockPointerType() &&
13363         !var->hasInit()) {
13364       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_opencl_invalid_block_declaration)
13365           << 1 /*Init*/;
13366       var->setInvalidDecl();
13367       return;
13368     }
13369   }
13370 
13371   // In Objective-C, don't allow jumps past the implicit initialization of a
13372   // local retaining variable.
13373   if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
13374       var->hasLocalStorage()) {
13375     switch (var->getType().getObjCLifetime()) {
13376     case Qualifiers::OCL_None:
13377     case Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone:
13378     case Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing:
13379       break;
13380 
13381     case Qualifiers::OCL_Weak:
13382     case Qualifiers::OCL_Strong:
13383       setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13384       break;
13385     }
13386   }
13387 
13388   if (var->hasLocalStorage() &&
13389       var->getType().isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct)
13390     setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope();
13391 
13392   // Warn about externally-visible variables being defined without a
13393   // prior declaration.  We only want to do this for global
13394   // declarations, but we also specifically need to avoid doing it for
13395   // class members because the linkage of an anonymous class can
13396   // change if it's later given a typedef name.
13397   if (var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13398       var->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() &&
13399       var->isExternallyVisible() && var->hasLinkage() &&
13400       !var->isInline() && !var->getDescribedVarTemplate() &&
13401       !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(var) &&
13402       !isTemplateInstantiation(var->getTemplateSpecializationKind()) &&
13403       !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations,
13404                                   var->getLocation())) {
13405     // Find a previous declaration that's not a definition.
13406     VarDecl *prev = var->getPreviousDecl();
13407     while (prev && prev->isThisDeclarationADefinition())
13408       prev = prev->getPreviousDecl();
13409 
13410     if (!prev) {
13411       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_variable_declarations) << var;
13412       Diag(var->getTypeSpecStartLoc(), diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
13413           << /* variable */ 0;
13414     }
13415   }
13416 
13417   // Cache the result of checking for constant initialization.
13418   Optional<bool> CacheHasConstInit;
13419   const Expr *CacheCulprit = nullptr;
13420   auto checkConstInit = [&]() mutable {
13421     if (!CacheHasConstInit)
13422       CacheHasConstInit = var->getInit()->isConstantInitializer(
13423             Context, var->getType()->isReferenceType(), &CacheCulprit);
13424     return *CacheHasConstInit;
13425   };
13426 
13427   if (var->getTLSKind() == VarDecl::TLS_Static) {
13428     if (var->getType().isDestructedType()) {
13429       // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.term]p3:
13430       //   The type of an object with thread storage duration shall not
13431       //   have a non-trivial destructor.
13432       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_thread_nontrivial_dtor);
13433       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13434         Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13435     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && var->hasInit()) {
13436       if (!checkConstInit()) {
13437         // GNU C++98 edits for __thread, [basic.start.init]p4:
13438         //   An object of thread storage duration shall not require dynamic
13439         //   initialization.
13440         // FIXME: Need strict checking here.
13441         Diag(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(), diag::err_thread_dynamic_init)
13442           << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13443         if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
13444           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_use_thread_local);
13445       }
13446     }
13447   }
13448 
13449 
13450   if (!var->getType()->isStructureType() && var->hasInit() &&
13451       isa<InitListExpr>(var->getInit())) {
13452     const auto *ILE = cast<InitListExpr>(var->getInit());
13453     unsigned NumInits = ILE->getNumInits();
13454     if (NumInits > 2)
13455       for (unsigned I = 0; I < NumInits; ++I) {
13456         const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(I);
13457         if (!Init)
13458           break;
13459         const auto *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13460         if (!SL)
13461           break;
13462 
13463         unsigned NumConcat = SL->getNumConcatenated();
13464         // Diagnose missing comma in string array initialization.
13465         // Do not warn when all the elements in the initializer are concatenated
13466         // together. Do not warn for macros too.
13467         if (NumConcat == 2 && !SL->getBeginLoc().isMacroID()) {
13468           bool OnlyOneMissingComma = true;
13469           for (unsigned J = I + 1; J < NumInits; ++J) {
13470             const auto *Init = ILE->getInit(J);
13471             if (!Init)
13472               break;
13473             const auto *SLJ = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(Init->IgnoreImpCasts());
13474             if (!SLJ || SLJ->getNumConcatenated() > 1) {
13475               OnlyOneMissingComma = false;
13476               break;
13477             }
13478           }
13479 
13480           if (OnlyOneMissingComma) {
13481             SmallVector<FixItHint, 1> Hints;
13482             for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumConcat - 1; ++i)
13483               Hints.push_back(FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
13484                   PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SL->getStrTokenLoc(i)), ","));
13485 
13486             Diag(SL->getStrTokenLoc(1),
13487                  diag::warn_concatenated_literal_array_init)
13488                 << Hints;
13489             Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(),
13490                  diag::note_concatenated_string_literal_silence);
13491           }
13492           // In any case, stop now.
13493           break;
13494         }
13495       }
13496   }
13497 
13498 
13499   QualType type = var->getType();
13500 
13501   if (var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>())
13502     getCurFunction()->addByrefBlockVar(var);
13503 
13504   Expr *Init = var->getInit();
13505   bool GlobalStorage = var->hasGlobalStorage();
13506   bool IsGlobal = GlobalStorage && !var->isStaticLocal();
13507   QualType baseType = Context.getBaseElementType(type);
13508   bool HasConstInit = true;
13509 
13510   // Check whether the initializer is sufficiently constant.
13511   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !type->isDependentType() && Init &&
13512       !Init->isValueDependent() &&
13513       (GlobalStorage || var->isConstexpr() ||
13514        var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(Context))) {
13515     // If this variable might have a constant initializer or might be usable in
13516     // constant expressions, check whether or not it actually is now.  We can't
13517     // do this lazily, because the result might depend on things that change
13518     // later, such as which constexpr functions happen to be defined.
13519     SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
13520     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
13521       // Prior to C++11, in contexts where a constant initializer is required,
13522       // the set of valid constant initializers is described by syntactic rules
13523       // in [expr.const]p2-6.
13524       // FIXME: Stricter checking for these rules would be useful for constinit /
13525       // -Wglobal-constructors.
13526       HasConstInit = checkConstInit();
13527 
13528       // Compute and cache the constant value, and remember that we have a
13529       // constant initializer.
13530       if (HasConstInit) {
13531         (void)var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13532         Notes.clear();
13533       } else if (CacheCulprit) {
13534         Notes.emplace_back(CacheCulprit->getExprLoc(),
13535                            PDiag(diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr));
13536         Notes.back().second << CacheCulprit->getSourceRange();
13537       }
13538     } else {
13539       // Evaluate the initializer to see if it's a constant initializer.
13540       HasConstInit = var->checkForConstantInitialization(Notes);
13541     }
13542 
13543     if (HasConstInit) {
13544       // FIXME: Consider replacing the initializer with a ConstantExpr.
13545     } else if (var->isConstexpr()) {
13546       SourceLocation DiagLoc = var->getLocation();
13547       // If the note doesn't add any useful information other than a source
13548       // location, fold it into the primary diagnostic.
13549       if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
13550                                    diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
13551         DiagLoc = Notes[0].first;
13552         Notes.clear();
13553       }
13554       Diag(DiagLoc, diag::err_constexpr_var_requires_const_init)
13555           << var << Init->getSourceRange();
13556       for (unsigned I = 0, N = Notes.size(); I != N; ++I)
13557         Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
13558     } else if (GlobalStorage && var->hasAttr<ConstInitAttr>()) {
13559       auto *Attr = var->getAttr<ConstInitAttr>();
13560       Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::err_require_constant_init_failed)
13561           << Init->getSourceRange();
13562       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_required_constant_init_here)
13563           << Attr->getRange() << Attr->isConstinit();
13564       for (auto &it : Notes)
13565         Diag(it.first, it.second);
13566     } else if (IsGlobal &&
13567                !getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_global_constructor,
13568                                            var->getLocation())) {
13569       // Warn about globals which don't have a constant initializer.  Don't
13570       // warn about globals with a non-trivial destructor because we already
13571       // warned about them.
13572       CXXRecordDecl *RD = baseType->getAsCXXRecordDecl();
13573       if (!(RD && !RD->hasTrivialDestructor())) {
13574         // checkConstInit() here permits trivial default initialization even in
13575         // C++11 onwards, where such an initializer is not a constant initializer
13576         // but nonetheless doesn't require a global constructor.
13577         if (!checkConstInit())
13578           Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::warn_global_constructor)
13579               << Init->getSourceRange();
13580       }
13581     }
13582   }
13583 
13584   // Apply section attributes and pragmas to global variables.
13585   if (GlobalStorage && var->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13586       !inTemplateInstantiation()) {
13587     PragmaStack<StringLiteral *> *Stack = nullptr;
13588     int SectionFlags = ASTContext::PSF_Read;
13589     if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) {
13590       if (HasConstInit)
13591         Stack = &ConstSegStack;
13592       else {
13593         Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13594         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13595       }
13596     } else if (var->hasInit() && HasConstInit) {
13597       Stack = &DataSegStack;
13598       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13599     } else {
13600       Stack = &BSSSegStack;
13601       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Write;
13602     }
13603     if (const SectionAttr *SA = var->getAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13604       if (SA->getSyntax() == AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Declspec)
13605         SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13606       UnifySection(SA->getName(), SectionFlags, var);
13607     } else if (Stack->CurrentValue) {
13608       SectionFlags |= ASTContext::PSF_Implicit;
13609       auto SectionName = Stack->CurrentValue->getString();
13610       var->addAttr(SectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13611           Context, SectionName, Stack->CurrentPragmaLocation,
13612           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma, SectionAttr::Declspec_allocate));
13613       if (UnifySection(SectionName, SectionFlags, var))
13614         var->dropAttr<SectionAttr>();
13615     }
13616 
13617     // Apply the init_seg attribute if this has an initializer.  If the
13618     // initializer turns out to not be dynamic, we'll end up ignoring this
13619     // attribute.
13620     if (CurInitSeg && var->getInit())
13621       var->addAttr(InitSegAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, CurInitSeg->getString(),
13622                                                CurInitSegLoc,
13623                                                AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13624   }
13625 
13626   // All the following checks are C++ only.
13627   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
13628     // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the
13629     // current module.
13630     if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13631       Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13632     return;
13633   }
13634 
13635   // Require the destructor.
13636   if (!type->isDependentType())
13637     if (const RecordType *recordType = baseType->getAs<RecordType>())
13638       FinalizeVarWithDestructor(var, recordType);
13639 
13640   // If this variable must be emitted, add it as an initializer for the current
13641   // module.
13642   if (Context.DeclMustBeEmitted(var) && !ModuleScopes.empty())
13643     Context.addModuleInitializer(ModuleScopes.back().Module, var);
13644 
13645   // Build the bindings if this is a structured binding declaration.
13646   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(var))
13647     CheckCompleteDecompositionDeclaration(DD);
13648 }
13649 
13650 /// Check if VD needs to be dllexport/dllimport due to being in a
13651 /// dllexport/import function.
13652 void Sema::CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VarDecl *VD) {
13653   assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13654 
13655   auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13656 
13657   // Find outermost function when VD is in lambda function.
13658   while (FD && !getDLLAttr(FD) &&
13659          !FD->hasAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>() &&
13660          !FD->hasAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13661     FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(FD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13662   }
13663 
13664   if (!FD)
13665     return;
13666 
13667   // Static locals inherit dll attributes from their function.
13668   if (Attr *A = getDLLAttr(FD)) {
13669     auto *NewAttr = cast<InheritableAttr>(A->clone(getASTContext()));
13670     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13671     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13672   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLExportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13673     auto *NewAttr = DLLExportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13674     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13675     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13676 
13677     // Export this function to enforce exporting this static variable even
13678     // if it is not used in this compilation unit.
13679     if (!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>())
13680       FD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13681 
13682   } else if (Attr *A = FD->getAttr<DLLImportStaticLocalAttr>()) {
13683     auto *NewAttr = DLLImportAttr::CreateImplicit(getASTContext(), *A);
13684     NewAttr->setInherited(true);
13685     VD->addAttr(NewAttr);
13686   }
13687 }
13688 
13689 /// FinalizeDeclaration - called by ParseDeclarationAfterDeclarator to perform
13690 /// any semantic actions necessary after any initializer has been attached.
13691 void Sema::FinalizeDeclaration(Decl *ThisDecl) {
13692   // Note that we are no longer parsing the initializer for this declaration.
13693   ParsingInitForAutoVars.erase(ThisDecl);
13694 
13695   VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(ThisDecl);
13696   if (!VD)
13697     return;
13698 
13699   // Apply an implicit SectionAttr if '#pragma clang section bss|data|rodata' is active
13700   if (VD->hasGlobalStorage() && VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition() &&
13701       !inTemplateInstantiation() && !VD->hasAttr<SectionAttr>()) {
13702     if (PragmaClangBSSSection.Valid)
13703       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangBSSSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13704           Context, PragmaClangBSSSection.SectionName,
13705           PragmaClangBSSSection.PragmaLocation,
13706           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13707     if (PragmaClangDataSection.Valid)
13708       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangDataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13709           Context, PragmaClangDataSection.SectionName,
13710           PragmaClangDataSection.PragmaLocation,
13711           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13712     if (PragmaClangRodataSection.Valid)
13713       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRodataSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13714           Context, PragmaClangRodataSection.SectionName,
13715           PragmaClangRodataSection.PragmaLocation,
13716           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13717     if (PragmaClangRelroSection.Valid)
13718       VD->addAttr(PragmaClangRelroSectionAttr::CreateImplicit(
13719           Context, PragmaClangRelroSection.SectionName,
13720           PragmaClangRelroSection.PragmaLocation,
13721           AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
13722   }
13723 
13724   if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(ThisDecl)) {
13725     for (auto *BD : DD->bindings()) {
13726       FinalizeDeclaration(BD);
13727     }
13728   }
13729 
13730   checkAttributesAfterMerging(*this, *VD);
13731 
13732   // Perform TLS alignment check here after attributes attached to the variable
13733   // which may affect the alignment have been processed. Only perform the check
13734   // if the target has a maximum TLS alignment (zero means no constraints).
13735   if (unsigned MaxAlign = Context.getTargetInfo().getMaxTLSAlign()) {
13736     // Protect the check so that it's not performed on dependent types and
13737     // dependent alignments (we can't determine the alignment in that case).
13738     if (VD->getTLSKind() && !VD->hasDependentAlignment()) {
13739       CharUnits MaxAlignChars = Context.toCharUnitsFromBits(MaxAlign);
13740       if (Context.getDeclAlign(VD) > MaxAlignChars) {
13741         Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_tls_var_aligned_over_maximum)
13742           << (unsigned)Context.getDeclAlign(VD).getQuantity() << VD
13743           << (unsigned)MaxAlignChars.getQuantity();
13744       }
13745     }
13746   }
13747 
13748   if (VD->isStaticLocal())
13749     CheckStaticLocalForDllExport(VD);
13750 
13751   // Perform check for initializers of device-side global variables.
13752   // CUDA allows empty constructors as initializers (see E.2.3.1, CUDA
13753   // 7.5). We must also apply the same checks to all __shared__
13754   // variables whether they are local or not. CUDA also allows
13755   // constant initializers for __constant__ and __device__ variables.
13756   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
13757     checkAllowedCUDAInitializer(VD);
13758 
13759   // Grab the dllimport or dllexport attribute off of the VarDecl.
13760   const InheritableAttr *DLLAttr = getDLLAttr(VD);
13761 
13762   // Imported static data members cannot be defined out-of-line.
13763   if (const auto *IA = dyn_cast_or_null<DLLImportAttr>(DLLAttr)) {
13764     if (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isOutOfLine() &&
13765         VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13766       // We allow definitions of dllimport class template static data members
13767       // with a warning.
13768       CXXRecordDecl *Context =
13769         cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VD->getFirstDecl()->getDeclContext());
13770       bool IsClassTemplateMember =
13771           isa<ClassTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Context) ||
13772           Context->getDescribedClassTemplate();
13773 
13774       Diag(VD->getLocation(),
13775            IsClassTemplateMember
13776                ? diag::warn_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition
13777                : diag::err_attribute_dllimport_static_field_definition);
13778       Diag(IA->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
13779       if (!IsClassTemplateMember)
13780         VD->setInvalidDecl();
13781     }
13782   }
13783 
13784   // dllimport/dllexport variables cannot be thread local, their TLS index
13785   // isn't exported with the variable.
13786   if (DLLAttr && VD->getTLSKind()) {
13787     auto *F = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(VD->getParentFunctionOrMethod());
13788     if (F && getDLLAttr(F)) {
13789       assert(VD->isStaticLocal());
13790       // But if this is a static local in a dlimport/dllexport function, the
13791       // function will never be inlined, which means the var would never be
13792       // imported, so having it marked import/export is safe.
13793     } else {
13794       Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dll_thread_local) << VD
13795                                                                     << DLLAttr;
13796       VD->setInvalidDecl();
13797     }
13798   }
13799 
13800   if (UsedAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<UsedAttr>()) {
13801     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13802       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13803           << Attr;
13804       VD->dropAttr<UsedAttr>();
13805     }
13806   }
13807   if (RetainAttr *Attr = VD->getAttr<RetainAttr>()) {
13808     if (!Attr->isInherited() && !VD->isThisDeclarationADefinition()) {
13809       Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::warn_attribute_ignored_on_non_definition)
13810           << Attr;
13811       VD->dropAttr<RetainAttr>();
13812     }
13813   }
13814 
13815   const DeclContext *DC = VD->getDeclContext();
13816   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, and this isn't a class
13817   // member, set the visibility of this variable.
13818   if (DC->getRedeclContext()->isFileContext() && VD->isExternallyVisible())
13819     AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(VD);
13820 
13821   // FIXME: Warn on unused var template partial specializations.
13822   if (VD->isFileVarDecl() && !isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(VD))
13823     MarkUnusedFileScopedDecl(VD);
13824 
13825   // Now we have parsed the initializer and can update the table of magic
13826   // tag values.
13827   if (!VD->hasAttr<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>() ||
13828       !VD->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
13829     return;
13830 
13831   for (const auto *I : ThisDecl->specific_attrs<TypeTagForDatatypeAttr>()) {
13832     const Expr *MagicValueExpr = VD->getInit();
13833     if (!MagicValueExpr) {
13834       continue;
13835     }
13836     Optional<llvm::APSInt> MagicValueInt;
13837     if (!(MagicValueInt = MagicValueExpr->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
13838       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13839            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_not_ice)
13840         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13841       continue;
13842     }
13843     if (MagicValueInt->getActiveBits() > 64) {
13844       Diag(I->getRange().getBegin(),
13845            diag::err_type_tag_for_datatype_too_large)
13846         << LangOpts.CPlusPlus << MagicValueExpr->getSourceRange();
13847       continue;
13848     }
13849     uint64_t MagicValue = MagicValueInt->getZExtValue();
13850     RegisterTypeTagForDatatype(I->getArgumentKind(),
13851                                MagicValue,
13852                                I->getMatchingCType(),
13853                                I->getLayoutCompatible(),
13854                                I->getMustBeNull());
13855   }
13856 }
13857 
13858 static bool hasDeducedAuto(DeclaratorDecl *DD) {
13859   auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DD);
13860   return VD && !VD->getType()->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType();
13861 }
13862 
13863 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy Sema::FinalizeDeclaratorGroup(Scope *S, const DeclSpec &DS,
13864                                                    ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13865   SmallVector<Decl*, 8> Decls;
13866 
13867   if (DS.isTypeSpecOwned())
13868     Decls.push_back(DS.getRepAsDecl());
13869 
13870   DeclaratorDecl *FirstDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13871   DecompositionDecl *FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = nullptr;
13872   bool DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = false;
13873   DeclaratorDecl *FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = nullptr;
13874   bool DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = false;
13875 
13876   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13877     if (Decl *D = Group[i]) {
13878       // For declarators, there are some additional syntactic-ish checks we need
13879       // to perform.
13880       if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<DeclaratorDecl>(D)) {
13881         if (!FirstDeclaratorInGroup)
13882           FirstDeclaratorInGroup = DD;
13883         if (!FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup)
13884           FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup = dyn_cast<DecompositionDecl>(D);
13885         if (!FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && DS.hasAutoTypeSpec() &&
13886             !hasDeducedAuto(DD))
13887           FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup = DD;
13888 
13889         if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup != DD) {
13890           // A decomposition declaration cannot be combined with any other
13891           // declaration in the same group.
13892           if (FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup && !DiagnosedMultipleDecomps) {
13893             Diag(FirstDecompDeclaratorInGroup->getLocation(),
13894                  diag::err_decomp_decl_not_alone)
13895                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13896                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13897             DiagnosedMultipleDecomps = true;
13898           }
13899 
13900           // A declarator that uses 'auto' in any way other than to declare a
13901           // variable with a deduced type cannot be combined with any other
13902           // declarator in the same group.
13903           if (FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup && !DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto) {
13904             Diag(FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getLocation(),
13905                  diag::err_auto_non_deduced_not_alone)
13906                 << FirstNonDeducedAutoInGroup->getType()
13907                        ->hasAutoForTrailingReturnType()
13908                 << FirstDeclaratorInGroup->getSourceRange()
13909                 << DD->getSourceRange();
13910             DiagnosedNonDeducedAuto = true;
13911           }
13912         }
13913       }
13914 
13915       Decls.push_back(D);
13916     }
13917   }
13918 
13919   if (DeclSpec::isDeclRep(DS.getTypeSpecType())) {
13920     if (TagDecl *Tag = dyn_cast_or_null<TagDecl>(DS.getRepAsDecl())) {
13921       handleTagNumbering(Tag, S);
13922       if (FirstDeclaratorInGroup && !Tag->hasNameForLinkage() &&
13923           getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
13924         Context.addDeclaratorForUnnamedTagDecl(Tag, FirstDeclaratorInGroup);
13925     }
13926   }
13927 
13928   return BuildDeclaratorGroup(Decls);
13929 }
13930 
13931 /// BuildDeclaratorGroup - convert a list of declarations into a declaration
13932 /// group, performing any necessary semantic checking.
13933 Sema::DeclGroupPtrTy
13934 Sema::BuildDeclaratorGroup(MutableArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13935   // C++14 [dcl.spec.auto]p7: (DR1347)
13936   //   If the type that replaces the placeholder type is not the same in each
13937   //   deduction, the program is ill-formed.
13938   if (Group.size() > 1) {
13939     QualType Deduced;
13940     VarDecl *DeducedDecl = nullptr;
13941     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Group.size(); i != e; ++i) {
13942       VarDecl *D = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Group[i]);
13943       if (!D || D->isInvalidDecl())
13944         break;
13945       DeducedType *DT = D->getType()->getContainedDeducedType();
13946       if (!DT || DT->getDeducedType().isNull())
13947         continue;
13948       if (Deduced.isNull()) {
13949         Deduced = DT->getDeducedType();
13950         DeducedDecl = D;
13951       } else if (!Context.hasSameType(DT->getDeducedType(), Deduced)) {
13952         auto *AT = dyn_cast<AutoType>(DT);
13953         auto Dia = Diag(D->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(),
13954                         diag::err_auto_different_deductions)
13955                    << (AT ? (unsigned)AT->getKeyword() : 3) << Deduced
13956                    << DeducedDecl->getDeclName() << DT->getDeducedType()
13957                    << D->getDeclName();
13958         if (DeducedDecl->hasInit())
13959           Dia << DeducedDecl->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13960         if (D->getInit())
13961           Dia << D->getInit()->getSourceRange();
13962         D->setInvalidDecl();
13963         break;
13964       }
13965     }
13966   }
13967 
13968   ActOnDocumentableDecls(Group);
13969 
13970   return DeclGroupPtrTy::make(
13971       DeclGroupRef::Create(Context, Group.data(), Group.size()));
13972 }
13973 
13974 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecl(Decl *D) {
13975   ActOnDocumentableDecls(D);
13976 }
13977 
13978 void Sema::ActOnDocumentableDecls(ArrayRef<Decl *> Group) {
13979   // Don't parse the comment if Doxygen diagnostics are ignored.
13980   if (Group.empty() || !Group[0])
13981     return;
13982 
13983   if (Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_doc_param_not_found,
13984                       Group[0]->getLocation()) &&
13985       Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_unknown_comment_command_name,
13986                       Group[0]->getLocation()))
13987     return;
13988 
13989   if (Group.size() >= 2) {
13990     // This is a decl group.  Normally it will contain only declarations
13991     // produced from declarator list.  But in case we have any definitions or
13992     // additional declaration references:
13993     //   'typedef struct S {} S;'
13994     //   'typedef struct S *S;'
13995     //   'struct S *pS;'
13996     // FinalizeDeclaratorGroup adds these as separate declarations.
13997     Decl *MaybeTagDecl = Group[0];
13998     if (MaybeTagDecl && isa<TagDecl>(MaybeTagDecl)) {
13999       Group = Group.slice(1);
14000     }
14001   }
14002 
14003   // FIMXE: We assume every Decl in the group is in the same file.
14004   // This is false when preprocessor constructs the group from decls in
14005   // different files (e. g. macros or #include).
14006   Context.attachCommentsToJustParsedDecls(Group, &getPreprocessor());
14007 }
14008 
14009 /// Common checks for a parameter-declaration that should apply to both function
14010 /// parameters and non-type template parameters.
14011 void Sema::CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
14012   // Check that there are no default arguments inside the type of this
14013   // parameter.
14014   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
14015     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
14016 
14017   // Parameter declarators cannot be qualified (C++ [dcl.meaning]p1).
14018   if (D.getCXXScopeSpec().isSet()) {
14019     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_qualified_param_declarator)
14020       << D.getCXXScopeSpec().getRange();
14021   }
14022 
14023   // [dcl.meaning]p1: An unqualified-id occurring in a declarator-id shall be a
14024   // simple identifier except [...irrelevant cases...].
14025   switch (D.getName().getKind()) {
14026   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_Identifier:
14027     break;
14028 
14029   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_OperatorFunctionId:
14030   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConversionFunctionId:
14031   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_LiteralOperatorId:
14032   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorName:
14033   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DestructorName:
14034   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam:
14035   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_DeductionGuideName:
14036     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name)
14037       << GetNameForDeclarator(D).getName();
14038     break;
14039 
14040   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId:
14041   case UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ConstructorTemplateId:
14042     // GetNameForDeclarator would not produce a useful name in this case.
14043     Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_bad_parameter_name_template_id);
14044     break;
14045   }
14046 }
14047 
14048 /// ActOnParamDeclarator - Called from Parser::ParseFunctionDeclarator()
14049 /// to introduce parameters into function prototype scope.
14050 Decl *Sema::ActOnParamDeclarator(Scope *S, Declarator &D) {
14051   const DeclSpec &DS = D.getDeclSpec();
14052 
14053   // Verify C99 6.7.5.3p2: The only SCS allowed is 'register'.
14054 
14055   // C++03 [dcl.stc]p2 also permits 'auto'.
14056   StorageClass SC = SC_None;
14057   if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_register) {
14058     SC = SC_Register;
14059     // In C++11, the 'register' storage class specifier is deprecated.
14060     // In C++17, it is not allowed, but we tolerate it as an extension.
14061     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
14062       Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
14063            getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_register_storage_class
14064                                      : diag::warn_deprecated_register)
14065         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc());
14066     }
14067   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
14068              DS.getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_auto) {
14069     SC = SC_Auto;
14070   } else if (DS.getStorageClassSpec() != DeclSpec::SCS_unspecified) {
14071     Diag(DS.getStorageClassSpecLoc(),
14072          diag::err_invalid_storage_class_in_func_decl);
14073     D.getMutableDeclSpec().ClearStorageClassSpecs();
14074   }
14075 
14076   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = DS.getThreadStorageClassSpec())
14077     Diag(DS.getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_thread)
14078       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
14079   if (DS.isInlineSpecified())
14080     Diag(DS.getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
14081         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
14082   if (DS.hasConstexprSpecifier())
14083     Diag(DS.getConstexprSpecLoc(), diag::err_invalid_constexpr)
14084         << 0 << static_cast<int>(D.getDeclSpec().getConstexprSpecifier());
14085 
14086   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(DS);
14087 
14088   CheckFunctionOrTemplateParamDeclarator(S, D);
14089 
14090   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
14091   QualType parmDeclType = TInfo->getType();
14092 
14093   // Check for redeclaration of parameters, e.g. int foo(int x, int x);
14094   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
14095   if (II) {
14096     LookupResult R(*this, II, D.getIdentifierLoc(), LookupOrdinaryName,
14097                    ForVisibleRedeclaration);
14098     LookupName(R, S);
14099     if (R.isSingleResult()) {
14100       NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
14101       if (PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
14102         // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
14103         DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
14104         // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
14105         PrevDecl = nullptr;
14106       } else if (S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
14107         Diag(D.getIdentifierLoc(), diag::err_param_redefinition) << II;
14108         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
14109 
14110         // Recover by removing the name
14111         II = nullptr;
14112         D.SetIdentifier(nullptr, D.getIdentifierLoc());
14113         D.setInvalidType(true);
14114       }
14115     }
14116   }
14117 
14118   // Temporarily put parameter variables in the translation unit, not
14119   // the enclosing context.  This prevents them from accidentally
14120   // looking like class members in C++.
14121   ParmVarDecl *New =
14122       CheckParameter(Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(), D.getBeginLoc(),
14123                      D.getIdentifierLoc(), II, parmDeclType, TInfo, SC);
14124 
14125   if (D.isInvalidType())
14126     New->setInvalidDecl();
14127 
14128   assert(S->isFunctionPrototypeScope());
14129   assert(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() >= 1);
14130   New->setScopeInfo(S->getFunctionPrototypeDepth() - 1,
14131                     S->getNextFunctionPrototypeIndex());
14132 
14133   // Add the parameter declaration into this scope.
14134   S->AddDecl(New);
14135   if (II)
14136     IdResolver.AddDecl(New);
14137 
14138   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, New, D);
14139 
14140   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
14141     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
14142         << 1 << New << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
14143         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
14144 
14145   if (New->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) {
14146     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_block_on_nonlocal);
14147   }
14148 
14149   if (getLangOpts().OpenCL)
14150     deduceOpenCLAddressSpace(New);
14151 
14152   return New;
14153 }
14154 
14155 /// Synthesizes a variable for a parameter arising from a
14156 /// typedef.
14157 ParmVarDecl *Sema::BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(DeclContext *DC,
14158                                               SourceLocation Loc,
14159                                               QualType T) {
14160   /* FIXME: setting StartLoc == Loc.
14161      Would it be worth to modify callers so as to provide proper source
14162      location for the unnamed parameters, embedding the parameter's type? */
14163   ParmVarDecl *Param = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, Loc, Loc, nullptr,
14164                                 T, Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc),
14165                                            SC_None, nullptr);
14166   Param->setImplicit();
14167   return Param;
14168 }
14169 
14170 void Sema::DiagnoseUnusedParameters(ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters) {
14171   // Don't diagnose unused-parameter errors in template instantiations; we
14172   // will already have done so in the template itself.
14173   if (inTemplateInstantiation())
14174     return;
14175 
14176   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
14177     if (!Parameter->isReferenced() && Parameter->getDeclName() &&
14178         !Parameter->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) {
14179       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_unused_parameter)
14180         << Parameter->getDeclName();
14181     }
14182   }
14183 }
14184 
14185 void Sema::DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(
14186     ArrayRef<ParmVarDecl *> Parameters, QualType ReturnTy, NamedDecl *D) {
14187   if (LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy == 0) // No check.
14188     return;
14189 
14190   // Warn if the return value is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
14191   // threshold.
14192   if (!ReturnTy->isDependentType() && ReturnTy.isPODType(Context)) {
14193     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ReturnTy).getQuantity();
14194     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
14195       Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::warn_return_value_size) << D << Size;
14196   }
14197 
14198   // Warn if any parameter is pass-by-value and larger than the specified
14199   // threshold.
14200   for (const ParmVarDecl *Parameter : Parameters) {
14201     QualType T = Parameter->getType();
14202     if (T->isDependentType() || !T.isPODType(Context))
14203       continue;
14204     unsigned Size = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(T).getQuantity();
14205     if (Size > LangOpts.NumLargeByValueCopy)
14206       Diag(Parameter->getLocation(), diag::warn_parameter_size)
14207           << Parameter << Size;
14208   }
14209 }
14210 
14211 ParmVarDecl *Sema::CheckParameter(DeclContext *DC, SourceLocation StartLoc,
14212                                   SourceLocation NameLoc, IdentifierInfo *Name,
14213                                   QualType T, TypeSourceInfo *TSInfo,
14214                                   StorageClass SC) {
14215   // In ARC, infer a lifetime qualifier for appropriate parameter types.
14216   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
14217       T.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_None &&
14218       T->isObjCLifetimeType()) {
14219 
14220     Qualifiers::ObjCLifetime lifetime;
14221 
14222     // Special cases for arrays:
14223     //   - if it's const, use __unsafe_unretained
14224     //   - otherwise, it's an error
14225     if (T->isArrayType()) {
14226       if (!T.isConstQualified()) {
14227         if (DelayedDiagnostics.shouldDelayDiagnostics())
14228           DelayedDiagnostics.add(
14229               sema::DelayedDiagnostic::makeForbiddenType(
14230               NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership, T, false));
14231         else
14232           Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arc_array_param_no_ownership)
14233               << TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange();
14234       }
14235       lifetime = Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone;
14236     } else {
14237       lifetime = T->getObjCARCImplicitLifetime();
14238     }
14239     T = Context.getLifetimeQualifiedType(T, lifetime);
14240   }
14241 
14242   ParmVarDecl *New = ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, DC, StartLoc, NameLoc, Name,
14243                                          Context.getAdjustedParameterType(T),
14244                                          TSInfo, SC, nullptr);
14245 
14246   // Make a note if we created a new pack in the scope of a lambda, so that
14247   // we know that references to that pack must also be expanded within the
14248   // lambda scope.
14249   if (New->isParameterPack())
14250     if (auto *LSI = getEnclosingLambda())
14251       LSI->LocalPacks.push_back(New);
14252 
14253   if (New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() ||
14254       New->getType().hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion())
14255     checkNonTrivialCUnion(New->getType(), New->getLocation(),
14256                           NTCUC_FunctionParam, NTCUK_Destruct|NTCUK_Copy);
14257 
14258   // Parameters can not be abstract class types.
14259   // For record types, this is done by the AbstractClassUsageDiagnoser once
14260   // the class has been completely parsed.
14261   if (!CurContext->isRecord() &&
14262       RequireNonAbstractType(NameLoc, T, diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
14263                              AbstractParamType))
14264     New->setInvalidDecl();
14265 
14266   // Parameter declarators cannot be interface types. All ObjC objects are
14267   // passed by reference.
14268   if (T->isObjCObjectType()) {
14269     SourceLocation TypeEndLoc =
14270         getLocForEndOfToken(TSInfo->getTypeLoc().getEndLoc());
14271     Diag(NameLoc,
14272          diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 1 << T
14273       << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(TypeEndLoc, "*");
14274     T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(T);
14275     New->setType(T);
14276   }
14277 
14278   // ISO/IEC TR 18037 S6.7.3: "The type of an object with automatic storage
14279   // duration shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier."
14280   // Since all parameters have automatic store duration, they can not have
14281   // an address space.
14282   if (T.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default &&
14283       // OpenCL allows function arguments declared to be an array of a type
14284       // to be qualified with an address space.
14285       !(getLangOpts().OpenCL &&
14286         (T->isArrayType() || T.getAddressSpace() == LangAS::opencl_private))) {
14287     Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_arg_with_address_space);
14288     New->setInvalidDecl();
14289   }
14290 
14291   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as function argument types.
14292   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
14293       CheckPPCMMAType(New->getOriginalType(), New->getLocation())) {
14294     New->setInvalidDecl();
14295   }
14296 
14297   return New;
14298 }
14299 
14300 void Sema::ActOnFinishKNRParamDeclarations(Scope *S, Declarator &D,
14301                                            SourceLocation LocAfterDecls) {
14302   DeclaratorChunk::FunctionTypeInfo &FTI = D.getFunctionTypeInfo();
14303 
14304   // C99 6.9.1p6 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, each declaration
14305   // in the declaration list shall have at least one declarator, those
14306   // declarators shall only declare identifiers from the identifier list, and
14307   // every identifier in the identifier list shall be declared.
14308   //
14309   // C89 3.7.1p5 "If a declarator includes an identifier list, only the
14310   // identifiers it names shall be declared in the declaration list."
14311   //
14312   // This is why we only diagnose in C99 and later. Note, the other conditions
14313   // listed are checked elsewhere.
14314   if (!FTI.hasPrototype) {
14315     for (int i = FTI.NumParams; i != 0; /* decrement in loop */) {
14316       --i;
14317       if (FTI.Params[i].Param == nullptr) {
14318         if (getLangOpts().C99) {
14319           SmallString<256> Code;
14320           llvm::raw_svector_ostream(Code)
14321               << "  int " << FTI.Params[i].Ident->getName() << ";\n";
14322           Diag(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, diag::ext_param_not_declared)
14323               << FTI.Params[i].Ident
14324               << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LocAfterDecls, Code);
14325         }
14326 
14327         // Implicitly declare the argument as type 'int' for lack of a better
14328         // type.
14329         AttributeFactory attrs;
14330         DeclSpec DS(attrs);
14331         const char* PrevSpec; // unused
14332         unsigned DiagID; // unused
14333         DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc, PrevSpec,
14334                            DiagID, Context.getPrintingPolicy());
14335         // Use the identifier location for the type source range.
14336         DS.SetRangeStart(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14337         DS.SetRangeEnd(FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14338         Declarator ParamD(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(),
14339                           DeclaratorContext::KNRTypeList);
14340         ParamD.SetIdentifier(FTI.Params[i].Ident, FTI.Params[i].IdentLoc);
14341         FTI.Params[i].Param = ActOnParamDeclarator(S, ParamD);
14342       }
14343     }
14344   }
14345 }
14346 
14347 Decl *
14348 Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Declarator &D,
14349                               MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
14350                               SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody, FnBodyKind BodyKind) {
14351   assert(getCurFunctionDecl() == nullptr && "Function parsing confused");
14352   assert(D.isFunctionDeclarator() && "Not a function declarator!");
14353   Scope *ParentScope = FnBodyScope->getParent();
14354 
14355   // Check if we are in an `omp begin/end declare variant` scope. If we are, and
14356   // we define a non-templated function definition, we will create a declaration
14357   // instead (=BaseFD), and emit the definition with a mangled name afterwards.
14358   // The base function declaration will have the equivalent of an `omp declare
14359   // variant` annotation which specifies the mangled definition as a
14360   // specialization function under the OpenMP context defined as part of the
14361   // `omp begin declare variant`.
14362   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 4> Bases;
14363   if (LangOpts.OpenMP && isInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope())
14364     ActOnStartOfFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(
14365         ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists, Bases);
14366 
14367   D.setFunctionDefinitionKind(FunctionDefinitionKind::Definition);
14368   Decl *DP = HandleDeclarator(ParentScope, D, TemplateParameterLists);
14369   Decl *Dcl = ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(FnBodyScope, DP, SkipBody, BodyKind);
14370 
14371   if (!Bases.empty())
14372     ActOnFinishedFunctionDefinitionInOpenMPDeclareVariantScope(Dcl, Bases);
14373 
14374   return Dcl;
14375 }
14376 
14377 void Sema::ActOnFinishInlineFunctionDef(FunctionDecl *D) {
14378   Consumer.HandleInlineFunctionDefinition(D);
14379 }
14380 
14381 static bool
14382 ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(const FunctionDecl *FD,
14383                                 const FunctionDecl *&PossiblePrototype) {
14384   // Don't warn about invalid declarations.
14385   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
14386     return false;
14387 
14388   // Or declarations that aren't global.
14389   if (!FD->isGlobal())
14390     return false;
14391 
14392   // Don't warn about C++ member functions.
14393   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD))
14394     return false;
14395 
14396   // Don't warn about 'main'.
14397   if (isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
14398     if (IdentifierInfo *II = FD->getIdentifier())
14399       if (II->isStr("main") || II->isStr("efi_main"))
14400         return false;
14401 
14402   // Don't warn about inline functions.
14403   if (FD->isInlined())
14404     return false;
14405 
14406   // Don't warn about function templates.
14407   if (FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14408     return false;
14409 
14410   // Don't warn about function template specializations.
14411   if (FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
14412     return false;
14413 
14414   // Don't warn for OpenCL kernels.
14415   if (FD->hasAttr<OpenCLKernelAttr>())
14416     return false;
14417 
14418   // Don't warn on explicitly deleted functions.
14419   if (FD->isDeleted())
14420     return false;
14421 
14422   // Don't warn on implicitly local functions (such as having local-typed
14423   // parameters).
14424   if (!FD->isExternallyVisible())
14425     return false;
14426 
14427   for (const FunctionDecl *Prev = FD->getPreviousDecl();
14428        Prev; Prev = Prev->getPreviousDecl()) {
14429     // Ignore any declarations that occur in function or method
14430     // scope, because they aren't visible from the header.
14431     if (Prev->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
14432       continue;
14433 
14434     PossiblePrototype = Prev;
14435     return Prev->getType()->isFunctionNoProtoType();
14436   }
14437 
14438   return true;
14439 }
14440 
14441 void
14442 Sema::CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FunctionDecl *FD,
14443                                    const FunctionDecl *EffectiveDefinition,
14444                                    SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
14445   const FunctionDecl *Definition = EffectiveDefinition;
14446   if (!Definition &&
14447       !FD->isDefined(Definition, /*CheckForPendingFriendDefinition*/ true))
14448     return;
14449 
14450   if (Definition->getFriendObjectKind() != Decl::FOK_None) {
14451     if (FunctionDecl *OrigDef = Definition->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14452       if (FunctionDecl *OrigFD = FD->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction()) {
14453         // A merged copy of the same function, instantiated as a member of
14454         // the same class, is OK.
14455         if (declaresSameEntity(OrigFD, OrigDef) &&
14456             declaresSameEntity(cast<Decl>(Definition->getLexicalDeclContext()),
14457                                cast<Decl>(FD->getLexicalDeclContext())))
14458           return;
14459       }
14460     }
14461   }
14462 
14463   if (canRedefineFunction(Definition, getLangOpts()))
14464     return;
14465 
14466   // Don't emit an error when this is redefinition of a typo-corrected
14467   // definition.
14468   if (TypoCorrectedFunctionDefinitions.count(Definition))
14469     return;
14470 
14471   // If we don't have a visible definition of the function, and it's inline or
14472   // a template, skip the new definition.
14473   if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Definition) &&
14474       (Definition->getFormalLinkage() == InternalLinkage ||
14475        Definition->isInlined() ||
14476        Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() ||
14477        Definition->getNumTemplateParameterLists())) {
14478     SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
14479     SkipBody->Previous = const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition);
14480     if (auto *TD = Definition->getDescribedFunctionTemplate())
14481       makeMergedDefinitionVisible(TD);
14482     makeMergedDefinitionVisible(const_cast<FunctionDecl*>(Definition));
14483     return;
14484   }
14485 
14486   if (getLangOpts().GNUMode && Definition->isInlineSpecified() &&
14487       Definition->getStorageClass() == SC_Extern)
14488     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition_extern_inline)
14489         << FD << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
14490   else
14491     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_redefinition) << FD;
14492 
14493   Diag(Definition->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
14494   FD->setInvalidDecl();
14495 }
14496 
14497 static void RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(CXXMethodDecl *CallOperator,
14498                                    Sema &S) {
14499   CXXRecordDecl *const LambdaClass = CallOperator->getParent();
14500 
14501   LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.PushLambdaScope();
14502   LSI->CallOperator = CallOperator;
14503   LSI->Lambda = LambdaClass;
14504   LSI->ReturnType = CallOperator->getReturnType();
14505   const LambdaCaptureDefault LCD = LambdaClass->getLambdaCaptureDefault();
14506 
14507   if (LCD == LCD_None)
14508     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None;
14509   else if (LCD == LCD_ByCopy)
14510     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByval;
14511   else if (LCD == LCD_ByRef)
14512     LSI->ImpCaptureStyle = CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref;
14513   DeclarationNameInfo DNI = CallOperator->getNameInfo();
14514 
14515   LSI->IntroducerRange = DNI.getCXXOperatorNameRange();
14516   LSI->Mutable = !CallOperator->isConst();
14517 
14518   // Add the captures to the LSI so they can be noted as already
14519   // captured within tryCaptureVar.
14520   auto I = LambdaClass->field_begin();
14521   for (const auto &C : LambdaClass->captures()) {
14522     if (C.capturesVariable()) {
14523       VarDecl *VD = C.getCapturedVar();
14524       if (VD->isInitCapture())
14525         S.CurrentInstantiationScope->InstantiatedLocal(VD, VD);
14526       const bool ByRef = C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_ByRef;
14527       LSI->addCapture(VD, /*IsBlock*/false, ByRef,
14528           /*RefersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture*/true, C.getLocation(),
14529           /*EllipsisLoc*/C.isPackExpansion()
14530                          ? C.getEllipsisLoc() : SourceLocation(),
14531           I->getType(), /*Invalid*/false);
14532 
14533     } else if (C.capturesThis()) {
14534       LSI->addThisCapture(/*Nested*/ false, C.getLocation(), I->getType(),
14535                           C.getCaptureKind() == LCK_StarThis);
14536     } else {
14537       LSI->addVLATypeCapture(C.getLocation(), I->getCapturedVLAType(),
14538                              I->getType());
14539     }
14540     ++I;
14541   }
14542 }
14543 
14544 Decl *Sema::ActOnStartOfFunctionDef(Scope *FnBodyScope, Decl *D,
14545                                     SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody,
14546                                     FnBodyKind BodyKind) {
14547   if (!D) {
14548     // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Push on a fake scope
14549     // anyway so we can try to parse the function body.
14550     PushFunctionScope();
14551     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14552     return D;
14553   }
14554 
14555   FunctionDecl *FD = nullptr;
14556 
14557   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14558     FD = FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
14559   else
14560     FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
14561 
14562   // Do not push if it is a lambda because one is already pushed when building
14563   // the lambda in ActOnStartOfLambdaDefinition().
14564   if (!isLambdaCallOperator(FD))
14565     PushExpressionEvaluationContext(
14566         FD->isConsteval() ? ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated
14567                           : ExprEvalContexts.back().Context);
14568 
14569   // Check for defining attributes before the check for redefinition.
14570   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<AliasAttr>()) {
14571     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 0;
14572     FD->dropAttr<AliasAttr>();
14573     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14574   }
14575   if (const auto *Attr = FD->getAttr<IFuncAttr>()) {
14576     Diag(Attr->getLocation(), diag::err_alias_is_definition) << FD << 1;
14577     FD->dropAttr<IFuncAttr>();
14578     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14579   }
14580 
14581   if (auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)) {
14582     if (Ctor->getTemplateSpecializationKind() == TSK_ExplicitSpecialization &&
14583         Ctor->isDefaultConstructor() &&
14584         Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) {
14585       // If this is an MS ABI dllexport default constructor, instantiate any
14586       // default arguments.
14587       InstantiateDefaultCtorDefaultArgs(Ctor);
14588     }
14589   }
14590 
14591   // See if this is a redefinition. If 'will have body' (or similar) is already
14592   // set, then these checks were already performed when it was set.
14593   if (!FD->willHaveBody() && !FD->isLateTemplateParsed() &&
14594       !FD->isThisDeclarationInstantiatedFromAFriendDefinition()) {
14595     CheckForFunctionRedefinition(FD, nullptr, SkipBody);
14596 
14597     // If we're skipping the body, we're done. Don't enter the scope.
14598     if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip)
14599       return D;
14600   }
14601 
14602   // Mark this function as "will have a body eventually".  This lets users to
14603   // call e.g. isInlineDefinitionExternallyVisible while we're still parsing
14604   // this function.
14605   FD->setWillHaveBody();
14606 
14607   // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator, push
14608   // a LambdaScopeInfo onto the function stack.  But use the information
14609   // that's already been calculated (ActOnLambdaExpr) to prime the current
14610   // LambdaScopeInfo.
14611   // When the template operator is being specialized, the LambdaScopeInfo,
14612   // has to be properly restored so that tryCaptureVariable doesn't try
14613   // and capture any new variables. In addition when calculating potential
14614   // captures during transformation of nested lambdas, it is necessary to
14615   // have the LSI properly restored.
14616   if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(FD)) {
14617     assert(inTemplateInstantiation() &&
14618            "There should be an active template instantiation on the stack "
14619            "when instantiating a generic lambda!");
14620     RebuildLambdaScopeInfo(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D), *this);
14621   } else {
14622     // Enter a new function scope
14623     PushFunctionScope();
14624   }
14625 
14626   // Builtin functions cannot be defined.
14627   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
14628     if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID) &&
14629         !Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedRuntimeFunction(BuiltinID)) {
14630       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_builtin_definition) << FD;
14631       FD->setInvalidDecl();
14632     }
14633   }
14634 
14635   // The return type of a function definition must be complete (C99 6.9.1p3),
14636   // unless the function is deleted (C++ specifc, C++ [dcl.fct.def.general]p2)
14637   QualType ResultType = FD->getReturnType();
14638   if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && !ResultType->isVoidType() &&
14639       !FD->isInvalidDecl() && BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete &&
14640       RequireCompleteType(FD->getLocation(), ResultType,
14641                           diag::err_func_def_incomplete_result))
14642     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14643 
14644   if (FnBodyScope)
14645     PushDeclContext(FnBodyScope, FD);
14646 
14647   // Check the validity of our function parameters
14648   if (BodyKind != FnBodyKind::Delete)
14649     CheckParmsForFunctionDef(FD->parameters(),
14650                              /*CheckParameterNames=*/true);
14651 
14652   // Add non-parameter declarations already in the function to the current
14653   // scope.
14654   if (FnBodyScope) {
14655     for (Decl *NPD : FD->decls()) {
14656       auto *NonParmDecl = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(NPD);
14657       if (!NonParmDecl)
14658         continue;
14659       assert(!isa<ParmVarDecl>(NonParmDecl) &&
14660              "parameters should not be in newly created FD yet");
14661 
14662       // If the decl has a name, make it accessible in the current scope.
14663       if (NonParmDecl->getDeclName())
14664         PushOnScopeChains(NonParmDecl, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14665 
14666       // Similarly, dive into enums and fish their constants out, making them
14667       // accessible in this scope.
14668       if (auto *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(NonParmDecl)) {
14669         for (auto *EI : ED->enumerators())
14670           PushOnScopeChains(EI, FnBodyScope, /*AddToContext=*/false);
14671       }
14672     }
14673   }
14674 
14675   // Introduce our parameters into the function scope
14676   for (auto Param : FD->parameters()) {
14677     Param->setOwningFunction(FD);
14678 
14679     // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
14680     if (Param->getIdentifier() && FnBodyScope) {
14681       CheckShadow(FnBodyScope, Param);
14682 
14683       PushOnScopeChains(Param, FnBodyScope);
14684     }
14685   }
14686 
14687   // Ensure that the function's exception specification is instantiated.
14688   if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14689     ResolveExceptionSpec(D->getLocation(), FPT);
14690 
14691   // dllimport cannot be applied to non-inline function definitions.
14692   if (FD->hasAttr<DLLImportAttr>() && !FD->isInlined() &&
14693       !FD->isTemplateInstantiation()) {
14694     assert(!FD->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>());
14695     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_attribute_dllimport_function_definition);
14696     FD->setInvalidDecl();
14697     return D;
14698   }
14699   // We want to attach documentation to original Decl (which might be
14700   // a function template).
14701   ActOnDocumentableDecl(D);
14702   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
14703       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCCategoryImpl &&
14704       getCurLexicalContext()->getDeclKind() != Decl::ObjCImplementation)
14705     Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_function_def_in_objc_container);
14706 
14707   return D;
14708 }
14709 
14710 /// Given the set of return statements within a function body,
14711 /// compute the variables that are subject to the named return value
14712 /// optimization.
14713 ///
14714 /// Each of the variables that is subject to the named return value
14715 /// optimization will be marked as NRVO variables in the AST, and any
14716 /// return statement that has a marked NRVO variable as its NRVO candidate can
14717 /// use the named return value optimization.
14718 ///
14719 /// This function applies a very simplistic algorithm for NRVO: if every return
14720 /// statement in the scope of a variable has the same NRVO candidate, that
14721 /// candidate is an NRVO variable.
14722 void Sema::computeNRVO(Stmt *Body, FunctionScopeInfo *Scope) {
14723   ReturnStmt **Returns = Scope->Returns.data();
14724 
14725   for (unsigned I = 0, E = Scope->Returns.size(); I != E; ++I) {
14726     if (const VarDecl *NRVOCandidate = Returns[I]->getNRVOCandidate()) {
14727       if (!NRVOCandidate->isNRVOVariable())
14728         Returns[I]->setNRVOCandidate(nullptr);
14729     }
14730   }
14731 }
14732 
14733 bool Sema::canDelayFunctionBody(const Declarator &D) {
14734   // We can't delay parsing the body of a constexpr function template (yet).
14735   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasConstexprSpecifier())
14736     return false;
14737 
14738   // We can't delay parsing the body of a function template with a deduced
14739   // return type (yet).
14740   if (D.getDeclSpec().hasAutoTypeSpec()) {
14741     // If the placeholder introduces a non-deduced trailing return type,
14742     // we can still delay parsing it.
14743     if (D.getNumTypeObjects()) {
14744       const auto &Outer = D.getTypeObject(D.getNumTypeObjects() - 1);
14745       if (Outer.Kind == DeclaratorChunk::Function &&
14746           Outer.Fun.hasTrailingReturnType()) {
14747         QualType Ty = GetTypeFromParser(Outer.Fun.getTrailingReturnType());
14748         return Ty.isNull() || !Ty->isUndeducedType();
14749       }
14750     }
14751     return false;
14752   }
14753 
14754   return true;
14755 }
14756 
14757 bool Sema::canSkipFunctionBody(Decl *D) {
14758   // We cannot skip the body of a function (or function template) which is
14759   // constexpr, since we may need to evaluate its body in order to parse the
14760   // rest of the file.
14761   // We cannot skip the body of a function with an undeduced return type,
14762   // because any callers of that function need to know the type.
14763   if (const FunctionDecl *FD = D->getAsFunction()) {
14764     if (FD->isConstexpr())
14765       return false;
14766     // We can't simply call Type::isUndeducedType here, because inside template
14767     // auto can be deduced to a dependent type, which is not considered
14768     // "undeduced".
14769     if (FD->getReturnType()->getContainedDeducedType())
14770       return false;
14771   }
14772   return Consumer.shouldSkipFunctionBody(D);
14773 }
14774 
14775 Decl *Sema::ActOnSkippedFunctionBody(Decl *Decl) {
14776   if (!Decl)
14777     return nullptr;
14778   if (FunctionDecl *FD = Decl->getAsFunction())
14779     FD->setHasSkippedBody();
14780   else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(Decl))
14781     MD->setHasSkippedBody();
14782   return Decl;
14783 }
14784 
14785 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *D, Stmt *BodyArg) {
14786   return ActOnFinishFunctionBody(D, BodyArg, false);
14787 }
14788 
14789 /// RAII object that pops an ExpressionEvaluationContext when exiting a function
14790 /// body.
14791 class ExitFunctionBodyRAII {
14792 public:
14793   ExitFunctionBodyRAII(Sema &S, bool IsLambda) : S(S), IsLambda(IsLambda) {}
14794   ~ExitFunctionBodyRAII() {
14795     if (!IsLambda)
14796       S.PopExpressionEvaluationContext();
14797   }
14798 
14799 private:
14800   Sema &S;
14801   bool IsLambda = false;
14802 };
14803 
14804 static void diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(Sema &S) {
14805   llvm::DenseMap<const BlockDecl *, bool> EscapeInfo;
14806 
14807   auto IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock = [&](const BlockDecl *BD) {
14808     if (EscapeInfo.count(BD))
14809       return EscapeInfo[BD];
14810 
14811     bool R = false;
14812     const BlockDecl *CurBD = BD;
14813 
14814     do {
14815       R = !CurBD->doesNotEscape();
14816       if (R)
14817         break;
14818       CurBD = CurBD->getParent()->getInnermostBlockDecl();
14819     } while (CurBD);
14820 
14821     return EscapeInfo[BD] = R;
14822   };
14823 
14824   // If the location where 'self' is implicitly retained is inside a escaping
14825   // block, emit a diagnostic.
14826   for (const std::pair<SourceLocation, const BlockDecl *> &P :
14827        S.ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs)
14828     if (IsOrNestedInEscapingBlock(P.second))
14829       S.Diag(P.first, diag::warn_implicitly_retains_self)
14830           << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(P.first, "self->");
14831 }
14832 
14833 Decl *Sema::ActOnFinishFunctionBody(Decl *dcl, Stmt *Body,
14834                                     bool IsInstantiation) {
14835   FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = getCurFunction();
14836   FunctionDecl *FD = dcl ? dcl->getAsFunction() : nullptr;
14837 
14838   if (FSI->UsesFPIntrin && FD && !FD->hasAttr<StrictFPAttr>())
14839     FD->addAttr(StrictFPAttr::CreateImplicit(Context));
14840 
14841   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
14842   sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy *ActivePolicy = nullptr;
14843 
14844   if (getLangOpts().Coroutines && FSI->isCoroutine())
14845     CheckCompletedCoroutineBody(FD, Body);
14846 
14847   {
14848     // Do not call PopExpressionEvaluationContext() if it is a lambda because
14849     // one is already popped when finishing the lambda in BuildLambdaExpr().
14850     // This is meant to pop the context added in ActOnStartOfFunctionDef().
14851     ExitFunctionBodyRAII ExitRAII(*this, isLambdaCallOperator(FD));
14852 
14853     if (FD) {
14854       FD->setBody(Body);
14855       FD->setWillHaveBody(false);
14856 
14857       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
14858         if (!FD->isInvalidDecl() && Body && !FD->isDependentContext() &&
14859             FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType()) {
14860           // For a function with a deduced result type to return void,
14861           // the result type as written must be 'auto' or 'decltype(auto)',
14862           // possibly cv-qualified or constrained, but not ref-qualified.
14863           if (!FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()) {
14864             Diag(dcl->getLocation(), diag::err_auto_fn_no_return_but_not_auto)
14865                 << FD->getReturnType();
14866             FD->setInvalidDecl();
14867           } else {
14868             // Falling off the end of the function is the same as 'return;'.
14869             Expr *Dummy = nullptr;
14870             if (DeduceFunctionTypeFromReturnExpr(
14871                     FD, dcl->getLocation(), Dummy,
14872                     FD->getReturnType()->getAs<AutoType>()))
14873               FD->setInvalidDecl();
14874           }
14875         }
14876       } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isLambdaCallOperator(FD)) {
14877         // In C++11, we don't use 'auto' deduction rules for lambda call
14878         // operators because we don't support return type deduction.
14879         auto *LSI = getCurLambda();
14880         if (LSI->HasImplicitReturnType) {
14881           deduceClosureReturnType(*LSI);
14882 
14883           // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p4:
14884           //   [...] if there are no return statements in the compound-statement
14885           //   [the deduced type is] the type void
14886           QualType RetType =
14887               LSI->ReturnType.isNull() ? Context.VoidTy : LSI->ReturnType;
14888 
14889           // Update the return type to the deduced type.
14890           const auto *Proto = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14891           FD->setType(Context.getFunctionType(RetType, Proto->getParamTypes(),
14892                                               Proto->getExtProtoInfo()));
14893         }
14894       }
14895 
14896       // If the function implicitly returns zero (like 'main') or is naked,
14897       // don't complain about missing return statements.
14898       if (FD->hasImplicitReturnZero() || FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>())
14899         WP.disableCheckFallThrough();
14900 
14901       // MSVC permits the use of pure specifier (=0) on function definition,
14902       // defined at class scope, warn about this non-standard construct.
14903       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && FD->isPure() && !FD->isOutOfLine())
14904         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_pure_function_definition);
14905 
14906       if (!FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
14907         // Don't diagnose unused parameters of defaulted, deleted or naked
14908         // functions.
14909         if (!FD->isDeleted() && !FD->isDefaulted() && !FD->hasSkippedBody() &&
14910             !FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>())
14911           DiagnoseUnusedParameters(FD->parameters());
14912         DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(FD->parameters(),
14913                                                FD->getReturnType(), FD);
14914 
14915         // If this is a structor, we need a vtable.
14916         if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD))
14917           MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Constructor->getParent());
14918         else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor =
14919                      dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(FD))
14920           MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), Destructor->getParent());
14921 
14922         // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check
14923         // if we can do this here because lambdas keep return statements around
14924         // to deduce an implicit return type.
14925         if (FD->getReturnType()->isRecordType() &&
14926             (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !FD->isDependentContext()))
14927           computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
14928       }
14929 
14930       // GNU warning -Wmissing-prototypes:
14931       //   Warn if a global function is defined without a previous
14932       //   prototype declaration. This warning is issued even if the
14933       //   definition itself provides a prototype. The aim is to detect
14934       //   global functions that fail to be declared in header files.
14935       const FunctionDecl *PossiblePrototype = nullptr;
14936       if (ShouldWarnAboutMissingPrototype(FD, PossiblePrototype)) {
14937         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_missing_prototype) << FD;
14938 
14939         if (PossiblePrototype) {
14940           // We found a declaration that is not a prototype,
14941           // but that could be a zero-parameter prototype
14942           if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = PossiblePrototype->getTypeSourceInfo()) {
14943             TypeLoc TL = TI->getTypeLoc();
14944             if (FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc FTL = TL.getAs<FunctionNoProtoTypeLoc>())
14945               Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(),
14946                    diag::note_declaration_not_a_prototype)
14947                   << (FD->getNumParams() != 0)
14948                   << (FD->getNumParams() == 0 ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
14949                                                     FTL.getRParenLoc(), "void")
14950                                               : FixItHint{});
14951           }
14952         } else {
14953           // Returns true if the token beginning at this Loc is `const`.
14954           auto isLocAtConst = [&](SourceLocation Loc, const SourceManager &SM,
14955                                   const LangOptions &LangOpts) {
14956             std::pair<FileID, unsigned> LocInfo = SM.getDecomposedLoc(Loc);
14957             if (LocInfo.first.isInvalid())
14958               return false;
14959 
14960             bool Invalid = false;
14961             StringRef Buffer = SM.getBufferData(LocInfo.first, &Invalid);
14962             if (Invalid)
14963               return false;
14964 
14965             if (LocInfo.second > Buffer.size())
14966               return false;
14967 
14968             const char *LexStart = Buffer.data() + LocInfo.second;
14969             StringRef StartTok(LexStart, Buffer.size() - LocInfo.second);
14970 
14971             return StartTok.consume_front("const") &&
14972                    (StartTok.empty() || isWhitespace(StartTok[0]) ||
14973                     StartTok.startswith("/*") || StartTok.startswith("//"));
14974           };
14975 
14976           auto findBeginLoc = [&]() {
14977             // If the return type has `const` qualifier, we want to insert
14978             // `static` before `const` (and not before the typename).
14979             if ((FD->getReturnType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
14980                  FD->getReturnType()->getPointeeType().isConstQualified()) ||
14981                 FD->getReturnType().isConstQualified()) {
14982               // But only do this if we can determine where the `const` is.
14983 
14984               if (isLocAtConst(FD->getBeginLoc(), getSourceManager(),
14985                                getLangOpts()))
14986 
14987                 return FD->getBeginLoc();
14988             }
14989             return FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc();
14990           };
14991           Diag(FD->getTypeSpecStartLoc(),
14992                diag::note_static_for_internal_linkage)
14993               << /* function */ 1
14994               << (FD->getStorageClass() == SC_None
14995                       ? FixItHint::CreateInsertion(findBeginLoc(), "static ")
14996                       : FixItHint{});
14997         }
14998       }
14999 
15000       // If the function being defined does not have a prototype, then we may
15001       // need to diagnose it as changing behavior in C2x because we now know
15002       // whether the function accepts arguments or not. This only handles the
15003       // case where the definition has no prototype but does have parameters
15004       // and either there is no previous potential prototype, or the previous
15005       // potential prototype also has no actual prototype. This handles cases
15006       // like:
15007       //   void f(); void f(a) int a; {}
15008       //   void g(a) int a; {}
15009       // See MergeFunctionDecl() for other cases of the behavior change
15010       // diagnostic. See GetFullTypeForDeclarator() for handling of a function
15011       // type without a prototype.
15012       if (!FD->hasWrittenPrototype() && FD->getNumParams() != 0 &&
15013           (!PossiblePrototype || (!PossiblePrototype->hasWrittenPrototype() &&
15014                                   !PossiblePrototype->isImplicit()))) {
15015         // The function definition has parameters, so this will change behavior
15016         // in C2x. If there is a possible prototype, it comes before the
15017         // function definition.
15018         // FIXME: The declaration may have already been diagnosed as being
15019         // deprecated in GetFullTypeForDeclarator() if it had no arguments, but
15020         // there's no way to test for the "changes behavior" condition in
15021         // SemaType.cpp when forming the declaration's function type. So, we do
15022         // this awkward dance instead.
15023         //
15024         // If we have a possible prototype and it declares a function with a
15025         // prototype, we don't want to diagnose it; if we have a possible
15026         // prototype and it has no prototype, it may have already been
15027         // diagnosed in SemaType.cpp as deprecated depending on whether
15028         // -Wstrict-prototypes is enabled. If we already warned about it being
15029         // deprecated, add a note that it also changes behavior. If we didn't
15030         // warn about it being deprecated (because the diagnostic is not
15031         // enabled), warn now that it is deprecated and changes behavior.
15032 
15033         // This K&R C function definition definitely changes behavior in C2x,
15034         // so diagnose it.
15035         Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
15036             << /*definition*/ 1 << /* not supported in C2x */ 0;
15037 
15038         // If we have a possible prototype for the function which is a user-
15039         // visible declaration, we already tested that it has no prototype.
15040         // This will change behavior in C2x. This gets a warning rather than a
15041         // note because it's the same behavior-changing problem as with the
15042         // definition.
15043         if (PossiblePrototype)
15044           Diag(PossiblePrototype->getLocation(),
15045                diag::warn_non_prototype_changes_behavior)
15046               << /*declaration*/ 0 << /* conflicting */ 1 << /*subsequent*/ 1
15047               << /*definition*/ 1;
15048       }
15049 
15050       // Warn on CPUDispatch with an actual body.
15051       if (FD->isMultiVersion() && FD->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>() && Body)
15052         if (const auto *CmpndBody = dyn_cast<CompoundStmt>(Body))
15053           if (!CmpndBody->body_empty())
15054             Diag(CmpndBody->body_front()->getBeginLoc(),
15055                  diag::warn_dispatch_body_ignored);
15056 
15057       if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) {
15058         const CXXMethodDecl *KeyFunction;
15059         if (MD->isOutOfLine() && (MD = MD->getCanonicalDecl()) &&
15060             MD->isVirtual() &&
15061             (KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent())) &&
15062             MD == KeyFunction->getCanonicalDecl()) {
15063           // Update the key-function state if necessary for this ABI.
15064           if (FD->isInlined() &&
15065               !Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().canKeyFunctionBeInline()) {
15066             Context.setNonKeyFunction(MD);
15067 
15068             // If the newly-chosen key function is already defined, then we
15069             // need to mark the vtable as used retroactively.
15070             KeyFunction = Context.getCurrentKeyFunction(MD->getParent());
15071             const FunctionDecl *Definition;
15072             if (KeyFunction && KeyFunction->isDefined(Definition))
15073               MarkVTableUsed(Definition->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
15074           } else {
15075             // We just defined they key function; mark the vtable as used.
15076             MarkVTableUsed(FD->getLocation(), MD->getParent(), true);
15077           }
15078         }
15079       }
15080 
15081       assert(
15082           (FD == getCurFunctionDecl() || getCurLambda()->CallOperator == FD) &&
15083           "Function parsing confused");
15084     } else if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCMethodDecl>(dcl)) {
15085       assert(MD == getCurMethodDecl() && "Method parsing confused");
15086       MD->setBody(Body);
15087       if (!MD->isInvalidDecl()) {
15088         DiagnoseSizeOfParametersAndReturnValue(MD->parameters(),
15089                                                MD->getReturnType(), MD);
15090 
15091         if (Body)
15092           computeNRVO(Body, FSI);
15093       }
15094       if (FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper) {
15095         Diag(MD->getEndLoc(), diag::warn_objc_missing_super_call)
15096             << MD->getSelector().getAsString();
15097         FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper = false;
15098       }
15099       if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain) {
15100         const ObjCMethodDecl *InitMethod = nullptr;
15101         bool isDesignated =
15102             MD->isDesignatedInitializerForTheInterface(&InitMethod);
15103         assert(isDesignated && InitMethod);
15104         (void)isDesignated;
15105 
15106         auto superIsNSObject = [&](const ObjCMethodDecl *MD) {
15107           auto IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
15108           if (!IFace)
15109             return false;
15110           auto SuperD = IFace->getSuperClass();
15111           if (!SuperD)
15112             return false;
15113           return SuperD->getIdentifier() ==
15114                  NSAPIObj->getNSClassId(NSAPI::ClassId_NSObject);
15115         };
15116         // Don't issue this warning for unavailable inits or direct subclasses
15117         // of NSObject.
15118         if (!MD->isUnavailable() && !superIsNSObject(MD)) {
15119           Diag(MD->getLocation(),
15120                diag::warn_objc_designated_init_missing_super_call);
15121           Diag(InitMethod->getLocation(),
15122                diag::note_objc_designated_init_marked_here);
15123         }
15124         FSI->ObjCWarnForNoDesignatedInitChain = false;
15125       }
15126       if (FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation) {
15127         // Don't issue this warning for unavaialable inits.
15128         if (!MD->isUnavailable())
15129           Diag(MD->getLocation(),
15130                diag::warn_objc_secondary_init_missing_init_call);
15131         FSI->ObjCWarnForNoInitDelegation = false;
15132       }
15133 
15134       diagnoseImplicitlyRetainedSelf(*this);
15135     } else {
15136       // Parsing the function declaration failed in some way. Pop the fake scope
15137       // we pushed on.
15138       PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
15139       return nullptr;
15140     }
15141 
15142     if (Body && FSI->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations)
15143       DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(dcl);
15144 
15145     assert(!FSI->ObjCShouldCallSuper &&
15146            "This should only be set for ObjC methods, which should have been "
15147            "handled in the block above.");
15148 
15149     // Verify and clean out per-function state.
15150     if (Body && (!FD || !FD->isDefaulted())) {
15151       // C++ constructors that have function-try-blocks can't have return
15152       // statements in the handlers of that block. (C++ [except.handle]p14)
15153       // Verify this.
15154       if (FD && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD) && isa<CXXTryStmt>(Body))
15155         DiagnoseReturnInConstructorExceptionHandler(cast<CXXTryStmt>(Body));
15156 
15157       // Verify that gotos and switch cases don't jump into scopes illegally.
15158       if (FSI->NeedsScopeChecking() && !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled())
15159         DiagnoseInvalidJumps(Body);
15160 
15161       if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(dcl)) {
15162         if (!Destructor->getParent()->isDependentType())
15163           CheckDestructor(Destructor);
15164 
15165         MarkBaseAndMemberDestructorsReferenced(Destructor->getLocation(),
15166                                                Destructor->getParent());
15167       }
15168 
15169       // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
15170       // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up
15171       // for deletion in some later function.
15172       if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() ||
15173           getDiagnostics().getSuppressAllDiagnostics()) {
15174         DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
15175       }
15176       if (!hasUncompilableErrorOccurred() && !isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
15177         // Since the body is valid, issue any analysis-based warnings that are
15178         // enabled.
15179         ActivePolicy = &WP;
15180       }
15181 
15182       if (!IsInstantiation && FD && FD->isConstexpr() && !FD->isInvalidDecl() &&
15183           !CheckConstexprFunctionDefinition(FD, CheckConstexprKind::Diagnose))
15184         FD->setInvalidDecl();
15185 
15186       if (FD && FD->hasAttr<NakedAttr>()) {
15187         for (const Stmt *S : Body->children()) {
15188           // Allow local register variables without initializer as they don't
15189           // require prologue.
15190           bool RegisterVariables = false;
15191           if (auto *DS = dyn_cast<DeclStmt>(S)) {
15192             for (const auto *Decl : DS->decls()) {
15193               if (const auto *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(Decl)) {
15194                 RegisterVariables =
15195                     Var->hasAttr<AsmLabelAttr>() && !Var->hasInit();
15196                 if (!RegisterVariables)
15197                   break;
15198               }
15199             }
15200           }
15201           if (RegisterVariables)
15202             continue;
15203           if (!isa<AsmStmt>(S) && !isa<NullStmt>(S)) {
15204             Diag(S->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_non_asm_stmt_in_naked_function);
15205             Diag(FD->getAttr<NakedAttr>()->getLocation(), diag::note_attribute);
15206             FD->setInvalidDecl();
15207             break;
15208           }
15209         }
15210       }
15211 
15212       assert(ExprCleanupObjects.size() ==
15213                  ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects &&
15214              "Leftover temporaries in function");
15215       assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() &&
15216              "Unaccounted cleanups in function");
15217       assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() &&
15218              "Leftover expressions for odr-use checking");
15219     }
15220   } // Pops the ExitFunctionBodyRAII scope, which needs to happen before we pop
15221     // the declaration context below. Otherwise, we're unable to transform
15222     // 'this' expressions when transforming immediate context functions.
15223 
15224   if (!IsInstantiation)
15225     PopDeclContext();
15226 
15227   PopFunctionScopeInfo(ActivePolicy, dcl);
15228   // If any errors have occurred, clear out any temporaries that may have
15229   // been leftover. This ensures that these temporaries won't be picked up for
15230   // deletion in some later function.
15231   if (hasUncompilableErrorOccurred()) {
15232     DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext();
15233   }
15234 
15235   if (FD && ((LangOpts.OpenMP && (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice ||
15236                                   !LangOpts.OMPTargetTriples.empty())) ||
15237              LangOpts.CUDA || LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice)) {
15238     auto ES = getEmissionStatus(FD);
15239     if (ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted ||
15240         ES == Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown)
15241       DeclsToCheckForDeferredDiags.insert(FD);
15242   }
15243 
15244   if (FD && !FD->isDeleted())
15245     checkTypeSupport(FD->getType(), FD->getLocation(), FD);
15246 
15247   return dcl;
15248 }
15249 
15250 /// When we finish delayed parsing of an attribute, we must attach it to the
15251 /// relevant Decl.
15252 void Sema::ActOnFinishDelayedAttribute(Scope *S, Decl *D,
15253                                        ParsedAttributes &Attrs) {
15254   // Always attach attributes to the underlying decl.
15255   if (TemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D))
15256     D = TD->getTemplatedDecl();
15257   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, D, Attrs);
15258 
15259   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(D))
15260     if (Method->isStatic())
15261       checkThisInStaticMemberFunctionAttributes(Method);
15262 }
15263 
15264 /// ImplicitlyDefineFunction - An undeclared identifier was used in a function
15265 /// call, forming a call to an implicitly defined function (per C99 6.5.1p2).
15266 NamedDecl *Sema::ImplicitlyDefineFunction(SourceLocation Loc,
15267                                           IdentifierInfo &II, Scope *S) {
15268   // It is not valid to implicitly define a function in C2x.
15269   assert(LangOpts.implicitFunctionsAllowed() &&
15270          "Implicit function declarations aren't allowed in this language mode");
15271 
15272   // Find the scope in which the identifier is injected and the corresponding
15273   // DeclContext.
15274   // FIXME: C89 does not say what happens if there is no enclosing block scope.
15275   // In that case, we inject the declaration into the translation unit scope
15276   // instead.
15277   Scope *BlockScope = S;
15278   while (!BlockScope->isCompoundStmtScope() && BlockScope->getParent())
15279     BlockScope = BlockScope->getParent();
15280 
15281   Scope *ContextScope = BlockScope;
15282   while (!ContextScope->getEntity())
15283     ContextScope = ContextScope->getParent();
15284   ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, ContextScope->getEntity());
15285 
15286   // Before we produce a declaration for an implicitly defined
15287   // function, see whether there was a locally-scoped declaration of
15288   // this name as a function or variable. If so, use that
15289   // (non-visible) declaration, and complain about it.
15290   NamedDecl *ExternCPrev = findLocallyScopedExternCDecl(&II);
15291   if (ExternCPrev) {
15292     // We still need to inject the function into the enclosing block scope so
15293     // that later (non-call) uses can see it.
15294     PushOnScopeChains(ExternCPrev, BlockScope, /*AddToContext*/false);
15295 
15296     // C89 footnote 38:
15297     //   If in fact it is not defined as having type "function returning int",
15298     //   the behavior is undefined.
15299     if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev) ||
15300         !Context.typesAreCompatible(
15301             cast<FunctionDecl>(ExternCPrev)->getType(),
15302             Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Context.IntTy))) {
15303       Diag(Loc, diag::ext_use_out_of_scope_declaration)
15304           << ExternCPrev << !getLangOpts().C99;
15305       Diag(ExternCPrev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15306       return ExternCPrev;
15307     }
15308   }
15309 
15310   // Extension in C99 (defaults to error). Legal in C89, but warn about it.
15311   unsigned diag_id;
15312   if (II.getName().startswith("__builtin_"))
15313     diag_id = diag::warn_builtin_unknown;
15314   // OpenCL v2.0 s6.9.u - Implicit function declaration is not supported.
15315   else if (getLangOpts().C99)
15316     diag_id = diag::ext_implicit_function_decl_c99;
15317   else
15318     diag_id = diag::warn_implicit_function_decl;
15319 
15320   TypoCorrection Corrected;
15321   // Because typo correction is expensive, only do it if the implicit
15322   // function declaration is going to be treated as an error.
15323   //
15324   // Perform the corection before issuing the main diagnostic, as some consumers
15325   // use typo-correction callbacks to enhance the main diagnostic.
15326   if (S && !ExternCPrev &&
15327       (Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag_id, Loc) >= DiagnosticsEngine::Error)) {
15328     DeclFilterCCC<FunctionDecl> CCC{};
15329     Corrected = CorrectTypo(DeclarationNameInfo(&II, Loc), LookupOrdinaryName,
15330                             S, nullptr, CCC, CTK_NonError);
15331   }
15332 
15333   Diag(Loc, diag_id) << &II;
15334   if (Corrected) {
15335     // If the correction is going to suggest an implicitly defined function,
15336     // skip the correction as not being a particularly good idea.
15337     bool Diagnose = true;
15338     if (const auto *D = Corrected.getCorrectionDecl())
15339       Diagnose = !D->isImplicit();
15340     if (Diagnose)
15341       diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::note_function_suggestion),
15342                    /*ErrorRecovery*/ false);
15343   }
15344 
15345   // If we found a prior declaration of this function, don't bother building
15346   // another one. We've already pushed that one into scope, so there's nothing
15347   // more to do.
15348   if (ExternCPrev)
15349     return ExternCPrev;
15350 
15351   // Set a Declarator for the implicit definition: int foo();
15352   const char *Dummy;
15353   AttributeFactory attrFactory;
15354   DeclSpec DS(attrFactory);
15355   unsigned DiagID;
15356   bool Error = DS.SetTypeSpecType(DeclSpec::TST_int, Loc, Dummy, DiagID,
15357                                   Context.getPrintingPolicy());
15358   (void)Error; // Silence warning.
15359   assert(!Error && "Error setting up implicit decl!");
15360   SourceLocation NoLoc;
15361   Declarator D(DS, ParsedAttributesView::none(), DeclaratorContext::Block);
15362   D.AddTypeInfo(DeclaratorChunk::getFunction(/*HasProto=*/false,
15363                                              /*IsAmbiguous=*/false,
15364                                              /*LParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
15365                                              /*Params=*/nullptr,
15366                                              /*NumParams=*/0,
15367                                              /*EllipsisLoc=*/NoLoc,
15368                                              /*RParenLoc=*/NoLoc,
15369                                              /*RefQualifierIsLvalueRef=*/true,
15370                                              /*RefQualifierLoc=*/NoLoc,
15371                                              /*MutableLoc=*/NoLoc, EST_None,
15372                                              /*ESpecRange=*/SourceRange(),
15373                                              /*Exceptions=*/nullptr,
15374                                              /*ExceptionRanges=*/nullptr,
15375                                              /*NumExceptions=*/0,
15376                                              /*NoexceptExpr=*/nullptr,
15377                                              /*ExceptionSpecTokens=*/nullptr,
15378                                              /*DeclsInPrototype=*/None, Loc,
15379                                              Loc, D),
15380                 std::move(DS.getAttributes()), SourceLocation());
15381   D.SetIdentifier(&II, Loc);
15382 
15383   // Insert this function into the enclosing block scope.
15384   FunctionDecl *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(ActOnDeclarator(BlockScope, D));
15385   FD->setImplicit();
15386 
15387   AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FD);
15388 
15389   return FD;
15390 }
15391 
15392 /// If this function is a C++ replaceable global allocation function
15393 /// (C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation], C++2a [new.delete]),
15394 /// adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on the standard.
15395 ///
15396 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
15397 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
15398 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(
15399     FunctionDecl *FD) {
15400   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
15401     return;
15402 
15403   if (FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_New &&
15404       FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Array_New)
15405     return;
15406 
15407   Optional<unsigned> AlignmentParam;
15408   bool IsNothrow = false;
15409   if (!FD->isReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(&AlignmentParam, &IsNothrow))
15410     return;
15411 
15412   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p4:
15413   //   An allocation function that has a non-throwing exception specification
15414   //   indicates failure by returning a null pointer value. Any other allocation
15415   //   function never returns a null pointer value and indicates failure only by
15416   //   throwing an exception [...]
15417   if (!IsNothrow && !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsNonNullAttr>())
15418     FD->addAttr(ReturnsNonNullAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15419 
15420   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15421   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15422   //   storage. [...] If the request succeeds, the value returned by a
15423   //   replaceable allocation function is a [...] pointer value p0 different
15424   //   from any previously returned value p1 [...]
15425   //
15426   // However, this particular information is being added in codegen,
15427   // because there is an opt-out switch for it (-fno-assume-sane-operator-new)
15428 
15429   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p2:
15430   //   An allocation function attempts to allocate the requested amount of
15431   //   storage. If it is successful, it returns the address of the start of a
15432   //   block of storage whose length in bytes is at least as large as the
15433   //   requested size.
15434   if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocSizeAttr>()) {
15435     FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(
15436         Context, /*ElemSizeParam=*/ParamIdx(1, FD),
15437         /*NumElemsParam=*/ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15438   }
15439 
15440   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15441   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15442   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15443   //   (3.1) If the allocation function takes an argument of type
15444   //         std​::​align_­val_­t, the storage will have the alignment
15445   //         specified by the value of this argument.
15446   if (AlignmentParam.hasValue() && !FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>()) {
15447     FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(
15448         Context, ParamIdx(AlignmentParam.getValue(), FD), FD->getLocation()));
15449   }
15450 
15451   // FIXME:
15452   // C++2a [basic.stc.dynamic.allocation]p3:
15453   //   For an allocation function [...], the pointer returned on a successful
15454   //   call shall represent the address of storage that is aligned as follows:
15455   //   (3.2) Otherwise, if the allocation function is named operator new[],
15456   //         the storage is aligned for any object that does not have
15457   //         new-extended alignment ([basic.align]) and is no larger than the
15458   //         requested size.
15459   //   (3.3) Otherwise, the storage is aligned for any object that does not
15460   //         have new-extended alignment and is of the requested size.
15461 }
15462 
15463 /// Adds any function attributes that we know a priori based on
15464 /// the declaration of this function.
15465 ///
15466 /// These attributes can apply both to implicitly-declared builtins
15467 /// (like __builtin___printf_chk) or to library-declared functions
15468 /// like NSLog or printf.
15469 ///
15470 /// We need to check for duplicate attributes both here and where user-written
15471 /// attributes are applied to declarations.
15472 void Sema::AddKnownFunctionAttributes(FunctionDecl *FD) {
15473   if (FD->isInvalidDecl())
15474     return;
15475 
15476   // If this is a built-in function, map its builtin attributes to
15477   // actual attributes.
15478   if (unsigned BuiltinID = FD->getBuiltinID()) {
15479     // Handle printf-formatting attributes.
15480     unsigned FormatIdx;
15481     bool HasVAListArg;
15482     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPrintfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx, HasVAListArg)) {
15483       if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>()) {
15484         const char *fmt = "printf";
15485         unsigned int NumParams = FD->getNumParams();
15486         if (FormatIdx < NumParams && // NumParams may be 0 (e.g. vfprintf)
15487             FD->getParamDecl(FormatIdx)->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType())
15488           fmt = "NSString";
15489         FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15490                                                &Context.Idents.get(fmt),
15491                                                FormatIdx+1,
15492                                                HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15493                                                FD->getLocation()));
15494       }
15495     }
15496     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isScanfLike(BuiltinID, FormatIdx,
15497                                              HasVAListArg)) {
15498      if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15499        FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15500                                               &Context.Idents.get("scanf"),
15501                                               FormatIdx+1,
15502                                               HasVAListArg ? 0 : FormatIdx+2,
15503                                               FD->getLocation()));
15504     }
15505 
15506     // Handle automatically recognized callbacks.
15507     SmallVector<int, 4> Encoding;
15508     if (!FD->hasAttr<CallbackAttr>() &&
15509         Context.BuiltinInfo.performsCallback(BuiltinID, Encoding))
15510       FD->addAttr(CallbackAttr::CreateImplicit(
15511           Context, Encoding.data(), Encoding.size(), FD->getLocation()));
15512 
15513     // Mark const if we don't care about errno and that is the only thing
15514     // preventing the function from being const. This allows IRgen to use LLVM
15515     // intrinsics for such functions.
15516     if (!getLangOpts().MathErrno && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>() &&
15517         Context.BuiltinInfo.isConstWithoutErrno(BuiltinID))
15518       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15519 
15520     // We make "fma" on GNU or Windows const because we know it does not set
15521     // errno in those environments even though it could set errno based on the
15522     // C standard.
15523     const llvm::Triple &Trip = Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple();
15524     if ((Trip.isGNUEnvironment() || Trip.isOSMSVCRT()) &&
15525         !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>()) {
15526       switch (BuiltinID) {
15527       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fma:
15528       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmaf:
15529       case Builtin::BI__builtin_fmal:
15530       case Builtin::BIfma:
15531       case Builtin::BIfmaf:
15532       case Builtin::BIfmal:
15533         FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15534         break;
15535       default:
15536         break;
15537       }
15538     }
15539 
15540     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isReturnsTwice(BuiltinID) &&
15541         !FD->hasAttr<ReturnsTwiceAttr>())
15542       FD->addAttr(ReturnsTwiceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15543                                          FD->getLocation()));
15544     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isNoThrow(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>())
15545       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15546     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isPure(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<PureAttr>())
15547       FD->addAttr(PureAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15548     if (Context.BuiltinInfo.isConst(BuiltinID) && !FD->hasAttr<ConstAttr>())
15549       FD->addAttr(ConstAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15550     if (getLangOpts().CUDA && Context.BuiltinInfo.isTSBuiltin(BuiltinID) &&
15551         !FD->hasAttr<CUDADeviceAttr>() && !FD->hasAttr<CUDAHostAttr>()) {
15552       // Add the appropriate attribute, depending on the CUDA compilation mode
15553       // and which target the builtin belongs to. For example, during host
15554       // compilation, aux builtins are __device__, while the rest are __host__.
15555       if (getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice !=
15556           Context.BuiltinInfo.isAuxBuiltinID(BuiltinID))
15557         FD->addAttr(CUDADeviceAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15558       else
15559         FD->addAttr(CUDAHostAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15560     }
15561 
15562     // Add known guaranteed alignment for allocation functions.
15563     switch (BuiltinID) {
15564     case Builtin::BImemalign:
15565     case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc:
15566       if (!FD->hasAttr<AllocAlignAttr>())
15567         FD->addAttr(AllocAlignAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15568                                                    FD->getLocation()));
15569       break;
15570     default:
15571       break;
15572     }
15573 
15574     // Add allocsize attribute for allocation functions.
15575     switch (BuiltinID) {
15576     case Builtin::BIcalloc:
15577       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(
15578           Context, ParamIdx(1, FD), ParamIdx(2, FD), FD->getLocation()));
15579       break;
15580     case Builtin::BImemalign:
15581     case Builtin::BIaligned_alloc:
15582     case Builtin::BIrealloc:
15583       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(2, FD),
15584                                                 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15585       break;
15586     case Builtin::BImalloc:
15587       FD->addAttr(AllocSizeAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15588                                                 ParamIdx(), FD->getLocation()));
15589       break;
15590     default:
15591       break;
15592     }
15593   }
15594 
15595   AddKnownFunctionAttributesForReplaceableGlobalAllocationFunction(FD);
15596 
15597   // If C++ exceptions are enabled but we are told extern "C" functions cannot
15598   // throw, add an implicit nothrow attribute to any extern "C" function we come
15599   // across.
15600   if (getLangOpts().CXXExceptions && getLangOpts().ExternCNoUnwind &&
15601       FD->isExternC() && !FD->hasAttr<NoThrowAttr>()) {
15602     const auto *FPT = FD->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
15603     if (!FPT || FPT->getExceptionSpecType() == EST_None)
15604       FD->addAttr(NoThrowAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, FD->getLocation()));
15605   }
15606 
15607   IdentifierInfo *Name = FD->getIdentifier();
15608   if (!Name)
15609     return;
15610   if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
15611        FD->getDeclContext()->isTranslationUnit()) ||
15612       (isa<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext()) &&
15613        cast<LinkageSpecDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getLanguage() ==
15614        LinkageSpecDecl::lang_c)) {
15615     // Okay: this could be a libc/libm/Objective-C function we know
15616     // about.
15617   } else
15618     return;
15619 
15620   if (Name->isStr("asprintf") || Name->isStr("vasprintf")) {
15621     // FIXME: asprintf and vasprintf aren't C99 functions. Should they be
15622     // target-specific builtins, perhaps?
15623     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatAttr>())
15624       FD->addAttr(FormatAttr::CreateImplicit(Context,
15625                                              &Context.Idents.get("printf"), 2,
15626                                              Name->isStr("vasprintf") ? 0 : 3,
15627                                              FD->getLocation()));
15628   }
15629 
15630   if (Name->isStr("__CFStringMakeConstantString")) {
15631     // We already have a __builtin___CFStringMakeConstantString,
15632     // but builds that use -fno-constant-cfstrings don't go through that.
15633     if (!FD->hasAttr<FormatArgAttr>())
15634       FD->addAttr(FormatArgAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, ParamIdx(1, FD),
15635                                                 FD->getLocation()));
15636   }
15637 }
15638 
15639 TypedefDecl *Sema::ParseTypedefDecl(Scope *S, Declarator &D, QualType T,
15640                                     TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
15641   assert(D.getIdentifier() && "Wrong callback for declspec without declarator");
15642   assert(!T.isNull() && "GetTypeForDeclarator() returned null type");
15643 
15644   if (!TInfo) {
15645     assert(D.isInvalidType() && "no declarator info for valid type");
15646     TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T);
15647   }
15648 
15649   // Scope manipulation handled by caller.
15650   TypedefDecl *NewTD =
15651       TypedefDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, D.getBeginLoc(),
15652                           D.getIdentifierLoc(), D.getIdentifier(), TInfo);
15653 
15654   // Bail out immediately if we have an invalid declaration.
15655   if (D.isInvalidType()) {
15656     NewTD->setInvalidDecl();
15657     return NewTD;
15658   }
15659 
15660   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified()) {
15661     if (CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod())
15662       Diag(NewTD->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_local)
15663           << 2 << NewTD
15664           << SourceRange(D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc())
15665           << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
15666                  D.getDeclSpec().getModulePrivateSpecLoc());
15667     else
15668       NewTD->setModulePrivate();
15669   }
15670 
15671   // C++ [dcl.typedef]p8:
15672   //   If the typedef declaration defines an unnamed class (or
15673   //   enum), the first typedef-name declared by the declaration
15674   //   to be that class type (or enum type) is used to denote the
15675   //   class type (or enum type) for linkage purposes only.
15676   // We need to check whether the type was declared in the declaration.
15677   switch (D.getDeclSpec().getTypeSpecType()) {
15678   case TST_enum:
15679   case TST_struct:
15680   case TST_interface:
15681   case TST_union:
15682   case TST_class: {
15683     TagDecl *tagFromDeclSpec = cast<TagDecl>(D.getDeclSpec().getRepAsDecl());
15684     setTagNameForLinkagePurposes(tagFromDeclSpec, NewTD);
15685     break;
15686   }
15687 
15688   default:
15689     break;
15690   }
15691 
15692   return NewTD;
15693 }
15694 
15695 /// Check that this is a valid underlying type for an enum declaration.
15696 bool Sema::CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TypeSourceInfo *TI) {
15697   SourceLocation UnderlyingLoc = TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc();
15698   QualType T = TI->getType();
15699 
15700   if (T->isDependentType())
15701     return false;
15702 
15703   // This doesn't use 'isIntegralType' despite the error message mentioning
15704   // integral type because isIntegralType would also allow enum types in C.
15705   if (const BuiltinType *BT = T->getAs<BuiltinType>())
15706     if (BT->isInteger())
15707       return false;
15708 
15709   if (T->isBitIntType())
15710     return false;
15711 
15712   return Diag(UnderlyingLoc, diag::err_enum_invalid_underlying) << T;
15713 }
15714 
15715 /// Check whether this is a valid redeclaration of a previous enumeration.
15716 /// \return true if the redeclaration was invalid.
15717 bool Sema::CheckEnumRedeclaration(SourceLocation EnumLoc, bool IsScoped,
15718                                   QualType EnumUnderlyingTy, bool IsFixed,
15719                                   const EnumDecl *Prev) {
15720   if (IsScoped != Prev->isScoped()) {
15721     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_scoped_mismatch)
15722       << Prev->isScoped();
15723     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15724     return true;
15725   }
15726 
15727   if (IsFixed && Prev->isFixed()) {
15728     if (!EnumUnderlyingTy->isDependentType() &&
15729         !Prev->getIntegerType()->isDependentType() &&
15730         !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(EnumUnderlyingTy,
15731                                         Prev->getIntegerType())) {
15732       // TODO: Highlight the underlying type of the redeclaration.
15733       Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_type_mismatch)
15734         << EnumUnderlyingTy << Prev->getIntegerType();
15735       Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration)
15736           << Prev->getIntegerTypeRange();
15737       return true;
15738     }
15739   } else if (IsFixed != Prev->isFixed()) {
15740     Diag(EnumLoc, diag::err_enum_redeclare_fixed_mismatch)
15741       << Prev->isFixed();
15742     Diag(Prev->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
15743     return true;
15744   }
15745 
15746   return false;
15747 }
15748 
15749 /// Get diagnostic %select index for tag kind for
15750 /// redeclaration diagnostic message.
15751 /// WARNING: Indexes apply to particular diagnostics only!
15752 ///
15753 /// \returns diagnostic %select index.
15754 static unsigned getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag) {
15755   switch (Tag) {
15756   case TTK_Struct: return 0;
15757   case TTK_Interface: return 1;
15758   case TTK_Class:  return 2;
15759   default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid tag kind for redecl diagnostic!");
15760   }
15761 }
15762 
15763 /// Determine if tag kind is a class-key compatible with
15764 /// class for redeclaration (class, struct, or __interface).
15765 ///
15766 /// \returns true iff the tag kind is compatible.
15767 static bool isClassCompatTagKind(TagTypeKind Tag)
15768 {
15769   return Tag == TTK_Struct || Tag == TTK_Class || Tag == TTK_Interface;
15770 }
15771 
15772 Sema::NonTagKind Sema::getNonTagTypeDeclKind(const Decl *PrevDecl,
15773                                              TagTypeKind TTK) {
15774   if (isa<TypedefDecl>(PrevDecl))
15775     return NTK_Typedef;
15776   else if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl))
15777     return NTK_TypeAlias;
15778   else if (isa<ClassTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15779     return NTK_Template;
15780   else if (isa<TypeAliasTemplateDecl>(PrevDecl))
15781     return NTK_TypeAliasTemplate;
15782   else if (isa<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(PrevDecl))
15783     return NTK_TemplateTemplateArgument;
15784   switch (TTK) {
15785   case TTK_Struct:
15786   case TTK_Interface:
15787   case TTK_Class:
15788     return getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ? NTK_NonClass : NTK_NonStruct;
15789   case TTK_Union:
15790     return NTK_NonUnion;
15791   case TTK_Enum:
15792     return NTK_NonEnum;
15793   }
15794   llvm_unreachable("invalid TTK");
15795 }
15796 
15797 /// Determine whether a tag with a given kind is acceptable
15798 /// as a redeclaration of the given tag declaration.
15799 ///
15800 /// \returns true if the new tag kind is acceptable, false otherwise.
15801 bool Sema::isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(const TagDecl *Previous,
15802                                         TagTypeKind NewTag, bool isDefinition,
15803                                         SourceLocation NewTagLoc,
15804                                         const IdentifierInfo *Name) {
15805   // C++ [dcl.type.elab]p3:
15806   //   The class-key or enum keyword present in the
15807   //   elaborated-type-specifier shall agree in kind with the
15808   //   declaration to which the name in the elaborated-type-specifier
15809   //   refers. This rule also applies to the form of
15810   //   elaborated-type-specifier that declares a class-name or
15811   //   friend class since it can be construed as referring to the
15812   //   definition of the class. Thus, in any
15813   //   elaborated-type-specifier, the enum keyword shall be used to
15814   //   refer to an enumeration (7.2), the union class-key shall be
15815   //   used to refer to a union (clause 9), and either the class or
15816   //   struct class-key shall be used to refer to a class (clause 9)
15817   //   declared using the class or struct class-key.
15818   TagTypeKind OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15819   if (OldTag != NewTag &&
15820       !(isClassCompatTagKind(OldTag) && isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag)))
15821     return false;
15822 
15823   // Tags are compatible, but we might still want to warn on mismatched tags.
15824   // Non-class tags can't be mismatched at this point.
15825   if (!isClassCompatTagKind(NewTag))
15826     return true;
15827 
15828   // Declarations for which -Wmismatched-tags is disabled are entirely ignored
15829   // by our warning analysis. We don't want to warn about mismatches with (eg)
15830   // declarations in system headers that are designed to be specialized, but if
15831   // a user asks us to warn, we should warn if their code contains mismatched
15832   // declarations.
15833   auto IsIgnoredLoc = [&](SourceLocation Loc) {
15834     return getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch,
15835                                       Loc);
15836   };
15837   if (IsIgnoredLoc(NewTagLoc))
15838     return true;
15839 
15840   auto IsIgnored = [&](const TagDecl *Tag) {
15841     return IsIgnoredLoc(Tag->getLocation());
15842   };
15843   while (IsIgnored(Previous)) {
15844     Previous = Previous->getPreviousDecl();
15845     if (!Previous)
15846       return true;
15847     OldTag = Previous->getTagKind();
15848   }
15849 
15850   bool isTemplate = false;
15851   if (const CXXRecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Previous))
15852     isTemplate = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate();
15853 
15854   if (inTemplateInstantiation()) {
15855     if (OldTag != NewTag) {
15856       // In a template instantiation, do not offer fix-its for tag mismatches
15857       // since they usually mess up the template instead of fixing the problem.
15858       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15859         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15860         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15861       // FIXME: Note previous location?
15862     }
15863     return true;
15864   }
15865 
15866   if (isDefinition) {
15867     // On definitions, check all previous tags and issue a fix-it for each
15868     // one that doesn't match the current tag.
15869     if (Previous->getDefinition()) {
15870       // Don't suggest fix-its for redefinitions.
15871       return true;
15872     }
15873 
15874     bool previousMismatch = false;
15875     for (const TagDecl *I : Previous->redecls()) {
15876       if (I->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15877         // Ignore previous declarations for which the warning was disabled.
15878         if (IsIgnored(I))
15879           continue;
15880 
15881         if (!previousMismatch) {
15882           previousMismatch = true;
15883           Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_previous_tag_mismatch)
15884             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15885             << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(I->getTagKind());
15886         }
15887         Diag(I->getInnerLocStart(), diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15888           << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag)
15889           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(I->getInnerLocStart(),
15890                TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(NewTag));
15891       }
15892     }
15893     return true;
15894   }
15895 
15896   // Identify the prevailing tag kind: this is the kind of the definition (if
15897   // there is a non-ignored definition), or otherwise the kind of the prior
15898   // (non-ignored) declaration.
15899   const TagDecl *PrevDef = Previous->getDefinition();
15900   if (PrevDef && IsIgnored(PrevDef))
15901     PrevDef = nullptr;
15902   const TagDecl *Redecl = PrevDef ? PrevDef : Previous;
15903   if (Redecl->getTagKind() != NewTag) {
15904     Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::warn_struct_class_tag_mismatch)
15905       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(NewTag) << isTemplate << Name
15906       << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(OldTag);
15907     Diag(Redecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
15908 
15909     // If there is a previous definition, suggest a fix-it.
15910     if (PrevDef) {
15911       Diag(NewTagLoc, diag::note_struct_class_suggestion)
15912         << getRedeclDiagFromTagKind(Redecl->getTagKind())
15913         << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(NewTagLoc),
15914              TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Redecl->getTagKind()));
15915     }
15916   }
15917 
15918   return true;
15919 }
15920 
15921 /// Add a minimal nested name specifier fixit hint to allow lookup of a tag name
15922 /// from an outer enclosing namespace or file scope inside a friend declaration.
15923 /// This should provide the commented out code in the following snippet:
15924 ///   namespace N {
15925 ///     struct X;
15926 ///     namespace M {
15927 ///       struct Y { friend struct /*N::*/ X; };
15928 ///     }
15929 ///   }
15930 static FixItHint createFriendTagNNSFixIt(Sema &SemaRef, NamedDecl *ND, Scope *S,
15931                                          SourceLocation NameLoc) {
15932   // While the decl is in a namespace, do repeated lookup of that name and see
15933   // if we get the same namespace back.  If we do not, continue until
15934   // translation unit scope, at which point we have a fully qualified NNS.
15935   SmallVector<IdentifierInfo *, 4> Namespaces;
15936   DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
15937   for (; !DC->isTranslationUnit(); DC = DC->getParent()) {
15938     // This tag should be declared in a namespace, which can only be enclosed by
15939     // other namespaces.  Bail if there's an anonymous namespace in the chain.
15940     NamespaceDecl *Namespace = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(DC);
15941     if (!Namespace || Namespace->isAnonymousNamespace())
15942       return FixItHint();
15943     IdentifierInfo *II = Namespace->getIdentifier();
15944     Namespaces.push_back(II);
15945     NamedDecl *Lookup = SemaRef.LookupSingleName(
15946         S, II, NameLoc, Sema::LookupNestedNameSpecifierName);
15947     if (Lookup == Namespace)
15948       break;
15949   }
15950 
15951   // Once we have all the namespaces, reverse them to go outermost first, and
15952   // build an NNS.
15953   SmallString<64> Insertion;
15954   llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Insertion);
15955   if (DC->isTranslationUnit())
15956     OS << "::";
15957   std::reverse(Namespaces.begin(), Namespaces.end());
15958   for (auto *II : Namespaces)
15959     OS << II->getName() << "::";
15960   return FixItHint::CreateInsertion(NameLoc, Insertion);
15961 }
15962 
15963 /// Determine whether a tag originally declared in context \p OldDC can
15964 /// be redeclared with an unqualified name in \p NewDC (assuming name lookup
15965 /// found a declaration in \p OldDC as a previous decl, perhaps through a
15966 /// using-declaration).
15967 static bool isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(Sema &S, DeclContext *OldDC,
15968                                          DeclContext *NewDC) {
15969   OldDC = OldDC->getRedeclContext();
15970   NewDC = NewDC->getRedeclContext();
15971 
15972   if (OldDC->Equals(NewDC))
15973     return true;
15974 
15975   // In MSVC mode, we allow a redeclaration if the contexts are related (either
15976   // encloses the other).
15977   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
15978       (OldDC->Encloses(NewDC) || NewDC->Encloses(OldDC)))
15979     return true;
15980 
15981   return false;
15982 }
15983 
15984 /// This is invoked when we see 'struct foo' or 'struct {'.  In the
15985 /// former case, Name will be non-null.  In the later case, Name will be null.
15986 /// TagSpec indicates what kind of tag this is. TUK indicates whether this is a
15987 /// reference/declaration/definition of a tag.
15988 ///
15989 /// \param IsTypeSpecifier \c true if this is a type-specifier (or
15990 /// trailing-type-specifier) other than one in an alias-declaration.
15991 ///
15992 /// \param SkipBody If non-null, will be set to indicate if the caller should
15993 /// skip the definition of this tag and treat it as if it were a declaration.
15994 Decl *Sema::ActOnTag(Scope *S, unsigned TagSpec, TagUseKind TUK,
15995                      SourceLocation KWLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
15996                      IdentifierInfo *Name, SourceLocation NameLoc,
15997                      const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs, AccessSpecifier AS,
15998                      SourceLocation ModulePrivateLoc,
15999                      MultiTemplateParamsArg TemplateParameterLists,
16000                      bool &OwnedDecl, bool &IsDependent,
16001                      SourceLocation ScopedEnumKWLoc,
16002                      bool ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, TypeResult UnderlyingType,
16003                      bool IsTypeSpecifier, bool IsTemplateParamOrArg,
16004                      SkipBodyInfo *SkipBody) {
16005   // If this is not a definition, it must have a name.
16006   IdentifierInfo *OrigName = Name;
16007   assert((Name != nullptr || TUK == TUK_Definition) &&
16008          "Nameless record must be a definition!");
16009   assert(TemplateParameterLists.size() == 0 || TUK != TUK_Reference);
16010 
16011   OwnedDecl = false;
16012   TagTypeKind Kind = TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindForTypeSpec(TagSpec);
16013   bool ScopedEnum = ScopedEnumKWLoc.isValid();
16014 
16015   // FIXME: Check member specializations more carefully.
16016   bool isMemberSpecialization = false;
16017   bool Invalid = false;
16018 
16019   // We only need to do this matching if we have template parameters
16020   // or a scope specifier, which also conveniently avoids this work
16021   // for non-C++ cases.
16022   if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0 ||
16023       (SS.isNotEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference)) {
16024     if (TemplateParameterList *TemplateParams =
16025             MatchTemplateParametersToScopeSpecifier(
16026                 KWLoc, NameLoc, SS, nullptr, TemplateParameterLists,
16027                 TUK == TUK_Friend, isMemberSpecialization, Invalid)) {
16028       if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16029         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_enum_template);
16030         return nullptr;
16031       }
16032 
16033       if (TemplateParams->size() > 0) {
16034         // This is a declaration or definition of a class template (which may
16035         // be a member of another template).
16036 
16037         if (Invalid)
16038           return nullptr;
16039 
16040         OwnedDecl = false;
16041         DeclResult Result = CheckClassTemplate(
16042             S, TagSpec, TUK, KWLoc, SS, Name, NameLoc, Attrs, TemplateParams,
16043             AS, ModulePrivateLoc,
16044             /*FriendLoc*/ SourceLocation(), TemplateParameterLists.size() - 1,
16045             TemplateParameterLists.data(), SkipBody);
16046         return Result.get();
16047       } else {
16048         // The "template<>" header is extraneous.
16049         Diag(TemplateParams->getTemplateLoc(), diag::err_template_tag_noparams)
16050           << TypeWithKeyword::getTagTypeKindName(Kind) << Name;
16051         isMemberSpecialization = true;
16052       }
16053     }
16054 
16055     if (!TemplateParameterLists.empty() && isMemberSpecialization &&
16056         CheckTemplateDeclScope(S, TemplateParameterLists.back()))
16057       return nullptr;
16058   }
16059 
16060   // Figure out the underlying type if this a enum declaration. We need to do
16061   // this early, because it's needed to detect if this is an incompatible
16062   // redeclaration.
16063   llvm::PointerUnion<const Type*, TypeSourceInfo*> EnumUnderlying;
16064   bool IsFixed = !UnderlyingType.isUnset() || ScopedEnum;
16065 
16066   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16067     if (UnderlyingType.isInvalid() || (!UnderlyingType.get() && ScopedEnum)) {
16068       // No underlying type explicitly specified, or we failed to parse the
16069       // type, default to int.
16070       EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16071     } else if (UnderlyingType.get()) {
16072       // C++0x 7.2p2: The type-specifier-seq of an enum-base shall name an
16073       // integral type; any cv-qualification is ignored.
16074       TypeSourceInfo *TI = nullptr;
16075       GetTypeFromParser(UnderlyingType.get(), &TI);
16076       EnumUnderlying = TI;
16077 
16078       if (CheckEnumUnderlyingType(TI))
16079         // Recover by falling back to int.
16080         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16081 
16082       if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(TI->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TI,
16083                                           UPPC_FixedUnderlyingType))
16084         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16085 
16086     } else if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
16087       // For MSVC ABI compatibility, unfixed enums must use an underlying type
16088       // of 'int'. However, if this is an unfixed forward declaration, don't set
16089       // the underlying type unless the user enables -fms-compatibility. This
16090       // makes unfixed forward declared enums incomplete and is more conforming.
16091       if (TUK == TUK_Definition || getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16092         EnumUnderlying = Context.IntTy.getTypePtr();
16093     }
16094   }
16095 
16096   DeclContext *SearchDC = CurContext;
16097   DeclContext *DC = CurContext;
16098   bool isStdBadAlloc = false;
16099   bool isStdAlignValT = false;
16100 
16101   RedeclarationKind Redecl = forRedeclarationInCurContext();
16102   if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference)
16103     Redecl = NotForRedeclaration;
16104 
16105   /// Create a new tag decl in C/ObjC. Since the ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C
16106   /// implemented asks for structural equivalence checking, the returned decl
16107   /// here is passed back to the parser, allowing the tag body to be parsed.
16108   auto createTagFromNewDecl = [&]() -> TagDecl * {
16109     assert(!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "not meant for C++ usage");
16110     // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
16111     // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
16112     // keyword.
16113     SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
16114     TagDecl *New = nullptr;
16115 
16116     if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16117       New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name, nullptr,
16118                              ScopedEnum, ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
16119       // If this is an undefined enum, bail.
16120       if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid)
16121         return nullptr;
16122       if (EnumUnderlying) {
16123         EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16124         if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo *>())
16125           ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
16126         else
16127           ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type *>(), 0));
16128         ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
16129       }
16130     } else { // struct/union
16131       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16132                                nullptr);
16133     }
16134 
16135     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
16136       // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked
16137       // when the ASTContext lays out the structure.
16138       //
16139       // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
16140       // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
16141       // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
16142       // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
16143       // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
16144       // parsing of the struct).
16145       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
16146         AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
16147         AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
16148       }
16149     }
16150     New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
16151     return New;
16152   };
16153 
16154   LookupResult Previous(*this, Name, NameLoc, LookupTagName, Redecl);
16155   if (Name && SS.isNotEmpty()) {
16156     // We have a nested-name tag ('struct foo::bar').
16157 
16158     // Check for invalid 'foo::'.
16159     if (SS.isInvalid()) {
16160       Name = nullptr;
16161       goto CreateNewDecl;
16162     }
16163 
16164     // If this is a friend or a reference to a class in a dependent
16165     // context, don't try to make a decl for it.
16166     if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
16167       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
16168       if (!DC) {
16169         IsDependent = true;
16170         return nullptr;
16171       }
16172     } else {
16173       DC = computeDeclContext(SS, true);
16174       if (!DC) {
16175         Diag(SS.getRange().getBegin(), diag::err_dependent_nested_name_spec)
16176           << SS.getRange();
16177         return nullptr;
16178       }
16179     }
16180 
16181     if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
16182       return nullptr;
16183 
16184     SearchDC = DC;
16185     // Look-up name inside 'foo::'.
16186     LookupQualifiedName(Previous, DC);
16187 
16188     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
16189       return nullptr;
16190 
16191     if (Previous.empty()) {
16192       // Name lookup did not find anything. However, if the
16193       // nested-name-specifier refers to the current instantiation,
16194       // and that current instantiation has any dependent base
16195       // classes, we might find something at instantiation time: treat
16196       // this as a dependent elaborated-type-specifier.
16197       // But this only makes any sense for reference-like lookups.
16198       if (Previous.wasNotFoundInCurrentInstantiation() &&
16199           (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)) {
16200         IsDependent = true;
16201         return nullptr;
16202       }
16203 
16204       // A tag 'foo::bar' must already exist.
16205       Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_not_tag_in_scope)
16206         << Kind << Name << DC << SS.getRange();
16207       Name = nullptr;
16208       Invalid = true;
16209       goto CreateNewDecl;
16210     }
16211   } else if (Name) {
16212     // C++14 [class.mem]p14:
16213     //   If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a
16214     //   name different from T:
16215     //    -- every member of class T that is itself a type
16216     if (TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
16217         DiagnoseClassNameShadow(SearchDC, DeclarationNameInfo(Name, NameLoc)))
16218       return nullptr;
16219 
16220     // If this is a named struct, check to see if there was a previous forward
16221     // declaration or definition.
16222     // FIXME: We're looking into outer scopes here, even when we
16223     // shouldn't be. Doing so can result in ambiguities that we
16224     // shouldn't be diagnosing.
16225     LookupName(Previous, S);
16226 
16227     // When declaring or defining a tag, ignore ambiguities introduced
16228     // by types using'ed into this scope.
16229     if (Previous.isAmbiguous() &&
16230         (TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration)) {
16231       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
16232       while (F.hasNext()) {
16233         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
16234         if (!ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
16235                 SearchDC->getRedeclContext()))
16236           F.erase();
16237       }
16238       F.done();
16239     }
16240 
16241     // C++11 [namespace.memdef]p3:
16242     //   If the name in a friend declaration is neither qualified nor
16243     //   a template-id and the declaration is a function or an
16244     //   elaborated-type-specifier, the lookup to determine whether
16245     //   the entity has been previously declared shall not consider
16246     //   any scopes outside the innermost enclosing namespace.
16247     //
16248     // MSVC doesn't implement the above rule for types, so a friend tag
16249     // declaration may be a redeclaration of a type declared in an enclosing
16250     // scope.  They do implement this rule for friend functions.
16251     //
16252     // Does it matter that this should be by scope instead of by
16253     // semantic context?
16254     if (!Previous.empty() && TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16255       DeclContext *EnclosingNS = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
16256       LookupResult::Filter F = Previous.makeFilter();
16257       bool FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = false;
16258       while (F.hasNext()) {
16259         NamedDecl *ND = F.next();
16260         DeclContext *DC = ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
16261         if (DC->isFileContext() &&
16262             !EnclosingNS->Encloses(ND->getDeclContext())) {
16263           if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16264             FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace = true;
16265           else
16266             F.erase();
16267         }
16268       }
16269       F.done();
16270 
16271       // Diagnose this MSVC extension in the easy case where lookup would have
16272       // unambiguously found something outside the enclosing namespace.
16273       if (Previous.isSingleResult() && FriendSawTagOutsideEnclosingNamespace) {
16274         NamedDecl *ND = Previous.getFoundDecl();
16275         Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_friend_tag_redecl_outside_namespace)
16276             << createFriendTagNNSFixIt(*this, ND, S, NameLoc);
16277       }
16278     }
16279 
16280     // Note:  there used to be some attempt at recovery here.
16281     if (Previous.isAmbiguous())
16282       return nullptr;
16283 
16284     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK != TUK_Reference) {
16285       // FIXME: This makes sure that we ignore the contexts associated
16286       // with C structs, unions, and enums when looking for a matching
16287       // tag declaration or definition. See the similar lookup tweak
16288       // in Sema::LookupName; is there a better way to deal with this?
16289       while (isa<RecordDecl, EnumDecl, ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16290         SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16291     } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16292       // Inside ObjCContainer want to keep it as a lexical decl context but go
16293       // past it (most often to TranslationUnit) to find the semantic decl
16294       // context.
16295       while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16296         SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16297     }
16298   } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16299     // Don't use ObjCContainerDecl as the semantic decl context for anonymous
16300     // TagDecl the same way as we skip it for named TagDecl.
16301     while (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(SearchDC))
16302       SearchDC = SearchDC->getParent();
16303   }
16304 
16305   if (Previous.isSingleResult() &&
16306       Previous.getFoundDecl()->isTemplateParameter()) {
16307     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
16308     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(NameLoc, Previous.getFoundDecl());
16309     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
16310     Previous.clear();
16311   }
16312 
16313   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Name && DC && StdNamespace &&
16314       DC->Equals(getStdNamespace())) {
16315     if (Name->isStr("bad_alloc")) {
16316       // This is a declaration of or a reference to "std::bad_alloc".
16317       isStdBadAlloc = true;
16318 
16319       // If std::bad_alloc has been implicitly declared (but made invisible to
16320       // name lookup), fill in this implicit declaration as the previous
16321       // declaration, so that the declarations get chained appropriately.
16322       if (Previous.empty() && StdBadAlloc)
16323         Previous.addDecl(getStdBadAlloc());
16324     } else if (Name->isStr("align_val_t")) {
16325       isStdAlignValT = true;
16326       if (Previous.empty() && StdAlignValT)
16327         Previous.addDecl(getStdAlignValT());
16328     }
16329   }
16330 
16331   // If we didn't find a previous declaration, and this is a reference
16332   // (or friend reference), move to the correct scope.  In C++, we
16333   // also need to do a redeclaration lookup there, just in case
16334   // there's a shadow friend decl.
16335   if (Name && Previous.empty() &&
16336       (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend || IsTemplateParamOrArg)) {
16337     if (Invalid) goto CreateNewDecl;
16338     assert(SS.isEmpty());
16339 
16340     if (TUK == TUK_Reference || IsTemplateParamOrArg) {
16341       // C++ [basic.scope.pdecl]p5:
16342       //   -- for an elaborated-type-specifier of the form
16343       //
16344       //          class-key identifier
16345       //
16346       //      if the elaborated-type-specifier is used in the
16347       //      decl-specifier-seq or parameter-declaration-clause of a
16348       //      function defined in namespace scope, the identifier is
16349       //      declared as a class-name in the namespace that contains
16350       //      the declaration; otherwise, except as a friend
16351       //      declaration, the identifier is declared in the smallest
16352       //      non-class, non-function-prototype scope that contains the
16353       //      declaration.
16354       //
16355       // C99 6.7.2.3p8 has a similar (but not identical!) provision for
16356       // C structs and unions.
16357       //
16358       // It is an error in C++ to declare (rather than define) an enum
16359       // type, including via an elaborated type specifier.  We'll
16360       // diagnose that later; for now, declare the enum in the same
16361       // scope as we would have picked for any other tag type.
16362       //
16363       // GNU C also supports this behavior as part of its incomplete
16364       // enum types extension, while GNU C++ does not.
16365       //
16366       // Find the context where we'll be declaring the tag.
16367       // FIXME: We would like to maintain the current DeclContext as the
16368       // lexical context,
16369       SearchDC = getTagInjectionContext(SearchDC);
16370 
16371       // Find the scope where we'll be declaring the tag.
16372       S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
16373     } else {
16374       assert(TUK == TUK_Friend);
16375       // C++ [namespace.memdef]p3:
16376       //   If a friend declaration in a non-local class first declares a
16377       //   class or function, the friend class or function is a member of
16378       //   the innermost enclosing namespace.
16379       SearchDC = SearchDC->getEnclosingNamespaceContext();
16380     }
16381 
16382     // In C++, we need to do a redeclaration lookup to properly
16383     // diagnose some problems.
16384     // FIXME: redeclaration lookup is also used (with and without C++) to find a
16385     // hidden declaration so that we don't get ambiguity errors when using a
16386     // type declared by an elaborated-type-specifier.  In C that is not correct
16387     // and we should instead merge compatible types found by lookup.
16388     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16389       // FIXME: This can perform qualified lookups into function contexts,
16390       // which are meaningless.
16391       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
16392       LookupQualifiedName(Previous, SearchDC);
16393     } else {
16394       Previous.setRedeclarationKind(forRedeclarationInCurContext());
16395       LookupName(Previous, S);
16396     }
16397   }
16398 
16399   // If we have a known previous declaration to use, then use it.
16400   if (Previous.empty() && SkipBody && SkipBody->Previous)
16401     Previous.addDecl(SkipBody->Previous);
16402 
16403   if (!Previous.empty()) {
16404     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = Previous.getFoundDecl();
16405     NamedDecl *DirectPrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
16406 
16407     // It's okay to have a tag decl in the same scope as a typedef
16408     // which hides a tag decl in the same scope.  Finding this
16409     // with a redeclaration lookup can only actually happen in C++.
16410     //
16411     // This is also okay for elaborated-type-specifiers, which is
16412     // technically forbidden by the current standard but which is
16413     // okay according to the likely resolution of an open issue;
16414     // see http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#407
16415     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16416       if (TypedefNameDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16417         if (const TagType *TT = TD->getUnderlyingType()->getAs<TagType>()) {
16418           TagDecl *Tag = TT->getDecl();
16419           if (Tag->getDeclName() == Name &&
16420               Tag->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()
16421                           ->Equals(TD->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext())) {
16422             PrevDecl = Tag;
16423             Previous.clear();
16424             Previous.addDecl(Tag);
16425             Previous.resolveKind();
16426           }
16427         }
16428       }
16429     }
16430 
16431     // If this is a redeclaration of a using shadow declaration, it must
16432     // declare a tag in the same context. In MSVC mode, we allow a
16433     // redefinition if either context is within the other.
16434     if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<UsingShadowDecl>(DirectPrevDecl)) {
16435       auto *OldTag = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl);
16436       if (SS.isEmpty() && TUK != TUK_Reference && TUK != TUK_Friend &&
16437           isDeclInScope(Shadow, SearchDC, S, isMemberSpecialization) &&
16438           !(OldTag && isAcceptableTagRedeclContext(
16439                           *this, OldTag->getDeclContext(), SearchDC))) {
16440         Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_using_decl_conflict_reverse);
16441         Diag(Shadow->getTargetDecl()->getLocation(),
16442              diag::note_using_decl_target);
16443         Diag(Shadow->getIntroducer()->getLocation(), diag::note_using_decl)
16444             << 0;
16445         // Recover by ignoring the old declaration.
16446         Previous.clear();
16447         goto CreateNewDecl;
16448       }
16449     }
16450 
16451     if (TagDecl *PrevTagDecl = dyn_cast<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16452       // If this is a use of a previous tag, or if the tag is already declared
16453       // in the same scope (so that the definition/declaration completes or
16454       // rementions the tag), reuse the decl.
16455       if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend ||
16456           isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16457                         SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16458         // Make sure that this wasn't declared as an enum and now used as a
16459         // struct or something similar.
16460         if (!isAcceptableTagRedeclaration(PrevTagDecl, Kind,
16461                                           TUK == TUK_Definition, KWLoc,
16462                                           Name)) {
16463           bool SafeToContinue
16464             = (PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() != TTK_Enum &&
16465                Kind != TTK_Enum);
16466           if (SafeToContinue)
16467             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag)
16468               << Name
16469               << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(KWLoc),
16470                                               PrevTagDecl->getKindName());
16471           else
16472             Diag(KWLoc, diag::err_use_with_wrong_tag) << Name;
16473           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_use);
16474 
16475           if (SafeToContinue)
16476             Kind = PrevTagDecl->getTagKind();
16477           else {
16478             // Recover by making this an anonymous redefinition.
16479             Name = nullptr;
16480             Previous.clear();
16481             Invalid = true;
16482           }
16483         }
16484 
16485         if (Kind == TTK_Enum && PrevTagDecl->getTagKind() == TTK_Enum) {
16486           const EnumDecl *PrevEnum = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevTagDecl);
16487           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend)
16488             return PrevTagDecl;
16489 
16490           QualType EnumUnderlyingTy;
16491           if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16492             EnumUnderlyingTy = TI->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
16493           else if (const Type *T = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<const Type*>())
16494             EnumUnderlyingTy = QualType(T, 0);
16495 
16496           // All conflicts with previous declarations are recovered by
16497           // returning the previous declaration, unless this is a definition,
16498           // in which case we want the caller to bail out.
16499           if (CheckEnumRedeclaration(NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc,
16500                                      ScopedEnum, EnumUnderlyingTy,
16501                                      IsFixed, PrevEnum))
16502             return TUK == TUK_Declaration ? PrevTagDecl : nullptr;
16503         }
16504 
16505         // C++11 [class.mem]p1:
16506         //   A member shall not be declared twice in the member-specification,
16507         //   except that a nested class or member class template can be declared
16508         //   and then later defined.
16509         if (TUK == TUK_Declaration && PrevDecl->isCXXClassMember() &&
16510             S->isDeclScope(PrevDecl)) {
16511           Diag(NameLoc, diag::ext_member_redeclared);
16512           Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
16513         }
16514 
16515         if (!Invalid) {
16516           // If this is a use, just return the declaration we found, unless
16517           // we have attributes.
16518           if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16519             if (!Attrs.empty()) {
16520               // FIXME: Diagnose these attributes. For now, we create a new
16521               // declaration to hold them.
16522             } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference &&
16523                        (PrevTagDecl->getFriendObjectKind() ==
16524                             Decl::FOK_Undeclared ||
16525                         PrevDecl->getOwningModule() != getCurrentModule()) &&
16526                        SS.isEmpty()) {
16527               // This declaration is a reference to an existing entity, but
16528               // has different visibility from that entity: it either makes
16529               // a friend visible or it makes a type visible in a new module.
16530               // In either case, create a new declaration. We only do this if
16531               // the declaration would have meant the same thing if no prior
16532               // declaration were found, that is, if it was found in the same
16533               // scope where we would have injected a declaration.
16534               if (!getTagInjectionContext(CurContext)->getRedeclContext()
16535                        ->Equals(PrevDecl->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()))
16536                 return PrevTagDecl;
16537               // This is in the injected scope, create a new declaration in
16538               // that scope.
16539               S = getTagInjectionScope(S, getLangOpts());
16540             } else {
16541               return PrevTagDecl;
16542             }
16543           }
16544 
16545           // Diagnose attempts to redefine a tag.
16546           if (TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16547             if (NamedDecl *Def = PrevTagDecl->getDefinition()) {
16548               // If we're defining a specialization and the previous definition
16549               // is from an implicit instantiation, don't emit an error
16550               // here; we'll catch this in the general case below.
16551               bool IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation = false;
16552               if (isMemberSpecialization) {
16553                 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Def))
16554                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16555                     RD->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16556                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16557                 else if (EnumDecl *ED = dyn_cast<EnumDecl>(Def))
16558                   IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation =
16559                     ED->getTemplateSpecializationKind() !=
16560                     TSK_ExplicitSpecialization;
16561               }
16562 
16563               // Note that clang allows ODR-like semantics for ObjC/C, i.e., do
16564               // not keep more that one definition around (merge them). However,
16565               // ensure the decl passes the structural compatibility check in
16566               // C11 6.2.7/1 (or 6.1.2.6/1 in C89).
16567               NamedDecl *Hidden = nullptr;
16568               if (SkipBody && !hasVisibleDefinition(Def, &Hidden)) {
16569                 // There is a definition of this tag, but it is not visible. We
16570                 // explicitly make use of C++'s one definition rule here, and
16571                 // assume that this definition is identical to the hidden one
16572                 // we already have. Make the existing definition visible and
16573                 // use it in place of this one.
16574                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16575                   // Postpone making the old definition visible until after we
16576                   // complete parsing the new one and do the structural
16577                   // comparison.
16578                   SkipBody->CheckSameAsPrevious = true;
16579                   SkipBody->New = createTagFromNewDecl();
16580                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16581                   return Def;
16582                 } else {
16583                   SkipBody->ShouldSkip = true;
16584                   SkipBody->Previous = Def;
16585                   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(Hidden);
16586                   // Carry on and handle it like a normal definition. We'll
16587                   // skip starting the definitiion later.
16588                 }
16589               } else if (!IsExplicitSpecializationAfterInstantiation) {
16590                 // A redeclaration in function prototype scope in C isn't
16591                 // visible elsewhere, so merely issue a warning.
16592                 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && S->containedInPrototypeScope())
16593                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_redefinition_in_param_list) << Name;
16594                 else
16595                   Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Name;
16596                 notePreviousDefinition(Def,
16597                                        NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc);
16598                 // If this is a redefinition, recover by making this
16599                 // struct be anonymous, which will make any later
16600                 // references get the previous definition.
16601                 Name = nullptr;
16602                 Previous.clear();
16603                 Invalid = true;
16604               }
16605             } else {
16606               // If the type is currently being defined, complain
16607               // about a nested redefinition.
16608               auto *TD = Context.getTagDeclType(PrevTagDecl)->getAsTagDecl();
16609               if (TD->isBeingDefined()) {
16610                 Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_nested_redefinition) << Name;
16611                 Diag(PrevTagDecl->getLocation(),
16612                      diag::note_previous_definition);
16613                 Name = nullptr;
16614                 Previous.clear();
16615                 Invalid = true;
16616               }
16617             }
16618 
16619             // Okay, this is definition of a previously declared or referenced
16620             // tag. We're going to create a new Decl for it.
16621           }
16622 
16623           // Okay, we're going to make a redeclaration.  If this is some kind
16624           // of reference, make sure we build the redeclaration in the same DC
16625           // as the original, and ignore the current access specifier.
16626           if (TUK == TUK_Friend || TUK == TUK_Reference) {
16627             SearchDC = PrevTagDecl->getDeclContext();
16628             AS = AS_none;
16629           }
16630         }
16631         // If we get here we have (another) forward declaration or we
16632         // have a definition.  Just create a new decl.
16633 
16634       } else {
16635         // If we get here, this is a definition of a new tag type in a nested
16636         // scope, e.g. "struct foo; void bar() { struct foo; }", just create a
16637         // new decl/type.  We set PrevDecl to NULL so that the entities
16638         // have distinct types.
16639         Previous.clear();
16640       }
16641       // If we get here, we're going to create a new Decl. If PrevDecl
16642       // is non-NULL, it's a definition of the tag declared by
16643       // PrevDecl. If it's NULL, we have a new definition.
16644 
16645     // Otherwise, PrevDecl is not a tag, but was found with tag
16646     // lookup.  This is only actually possible in C++, where a few
16647     // things like templates still live in the tag namespace.
16648     } else {
16649       // Use a better diagnostic if an elaborated-type-specifier
16650       // found the wrong kind of type on the first
16651       // (non-redeclaration) lookup.
16652       if ((TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) &&
16653           !Previous.isForRedeclaration()) {
16654         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16655         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_non_tag) << PrevDecl << NTK
16656                                                        << Kind;
16657         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
16658         Invalid = true;
16659 
16660       // Otherwise, only diagnose if the declaration is in scope.
16661       } else if (!isDeclInScope(DirectPrevDecl, SearchDC, S,
16662                                 SS.isNotEmpty() || isMemberSpecialization)) {
16663         // do nothing
16664 
16665       // Diagnose implicit declarations introduced by elaborated types.
16666       } else if (TUK == TUK_Reference || TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16667         NonTagKind NTK = getNonTagTypeDeclKind(PrevDecl, Kind);
16668         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_reference_conflict) << NTK;
16669         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16670         Invalid = true;
16671 
16672       // Otherwise it's a declaration.  Call out a particularly common
16673       // case here.
16674       } else if (TypedefNameDecl *TND = dyn_cast<TypedefNameDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
16675         unsigned Kind = 0;
16676         if (isa<TypeAliasDecl>(PrevDecl)) Kind = 1;
16677         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_tag_definition_of_typedef)
16678           << Name << Kind << TND->getUnderlyingType();
16679         Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << PrevDecl;
16680         Invalid = true;
16681 
16682       // Otherwise, diagnose.
16683       } else {
16684         // The tag name clashes with something else in the target scope,
16685         // issue an error and recover by making this tag be anonymous.
16686         Diag(NameLoc, diag::err_redefinition_different_kind) << Name;
16687         notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, NameLoc);
16688         Name = nullptr;
16689         Invalid = true;
16690       }
16691 
16692       // The existing declaration isn't relevant to us; we're in a
16693       // new scope, so clear out the previous declaration.
16694       Previous.clear();
16695     }
16696   }
16697 
16698 CreateNewDecl:
16699 
16700   TagDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
16701   if (Previous.isSingleResult())
16702     PrevDecl = cast<TagDecl>(Previous.getFoundDecl());
16703 
16704   // If there is an identifier, use the location of the identifier as the
16705   // location of the decl, otherwise use the location of the struct/union
16706   // keyword.
16707   SourceLocation Loc = NameLoc.isValid() ? NameLoc : KWLoc;
16708 
16709   // Otherwise, create a new declaration. If there is a previous
16710   // declaration of the same entity, the two will be linked via
16711   // PrevDecl.
16712   TagDecl *New;
16713 
16714   if (Kind == TTK_Enum) {
16715     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16716     // enum X { A, B, C } D;    D should chain to X.
16717     New = EnumDecl::Create(Context, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16718                            cast_or_null<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl), ScopedEnum,
16719                            ScopedEnumUsesClassTag, IsFixed);
16720 
16721     if (isStdAlignValT && (!StdAlignValT || getStdAlignValT()->isImplicit()))
16722       StdAlignValT = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16723 
16724     // If this is an undefined enum, warn.
16725     if (TUK != TUK_Definition && !Invalid) {
16726       TagDecl *Def;
16727       if (IsFixed && cast<EnumDecl>(New)->isFixed()) {
16728         // C++0x: 7.2p2: opaque-enum-declaration.
16729         // Conflicts are diagnosed above. Do nothing.
16730       }
16731       else if (PrevDecl && (Def = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevDecl)->getDefinition())) {
16732         Diag(Loc, diag::ext_forward_ref_enum_def)
16733           << New;
16734         Diag(Def->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
16735       } else {
16736         unsigned DiagID = diag::ext_forward_ref_enum;
16737         if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat)
16738           DiagID = diag::ext_ms_forward_ref_enum;
16739         else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
16740           DiagID = diag::err_forward_ref_enum;
16741         Diag(Loc, DiagID);
16742       }
16743     }
16744 
16745     if (EnumUnderlying) {
16746       EnumDecl *ED = cast<EnumDecl>(New);
16747       if (TypeSourceInfo *TI = EnumUnderlying.dyn_cast<TypeSourceInfo*>())
16748         ED->setIntegerTypeSourceInfo(TI);
16749       else
16750         ED->setIntegerType(QualType(EnumUnderlying.get<const Type*>(), 0));
16751       ED->setPromotionType(ED->getIntegerType());
16752       assert(ED->isComplete() && "enum with type should be complete");
16753     }
16754   } else {
16755     // struct/union/class
16756 
16757     // FIXME: Tag decls should be chained to any simultaneous vardecls, e.g.:
16758     // struct X { int A; } D;    D should chain to X.
16759     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16760       // FIXME: Look for a way to use RecordDecl for simple structs.
16761       New = CXXRecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16762                                   cast_or_null<CXXRecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16763 
16764       if (isStdBadAlloc && (!StdBadAlloc || getStdBadAlloc()->isImplicit()))
16765         StdBadAlloc = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New);
16766     } else
16767       New = RecordDecl::Create(Context, Kind, SearchDC, KWLoc, Loc, Name,
16768                                cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(PrevDecl));
16769   }
16770 
16771   // C++11 [dcl.type]p3:
16772   //   A type-specifier-seq shall not define a class or enumeration [...].
16773   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && (IsTypeSpecifier || IsTemplateParamOrArg) &&
16774       TUK == TUK_Definition) {
16775     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_type_specifier)
16776       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16777     Invalid = true;
16778   }
16779 
16780   if (!Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TUK == TUK_Definition &&
16781       DC->getDeclKind() == Decl::Enum) {
16782     Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_type_defined_in_enum)
16783       << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16784     Invalid = true;
16785   }
16786 
16787   // Maybe add qualifier info.
16788   if (SS.isNotEmpty()) {
16789     if (SS.isSet()) {
16790       // If this is either a declaration or a definition, check the
16791       // nested-name-specifier against the current context.
16792       if ((TUK == TUK_Definition || TUK == TUK_Declaration) &&
16793           diagnoseQualifiedDeclaration(SS, DC, OrigName, Loc,
16794                                        isMemberSpecialization))
16795         Invalid = true;
16796 
16797       New->setQualifierInfo(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context));
16798       if (TemplateParameterLists.size() > 0) {
16799         New->setTemplateParameterListsInfo(Context, TemplateParameterLists);
16800       }
16801     }
16802     else
16803       Invalid = true;
16804   }
16805 
16806   if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New)) {
16807     // Add alignment attributes if necessary; these attributes are checked when
16808     // the ASTContext lays out the structure.
16809     //
16810     // It is important for implementing the correct semantics that this
16811     // happen here (in ActOnTag). The #pragma pack stack is
16812     // maintained as a result of parser callbacks which can occur at
16813     // many points during the parsing of a struct declaration (because
16814     // the #pragma tokens are effectively skipped over during the
16815     // parsing of the struct).
16816     if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip)) {
16817       AddAlignmentAttributesForRecord(RD);
16818       AddMsStructLayoutForRecord(RD);
16819     }
16820   }
16821 
16822   if (ModulePrivateLoc.isValid()) {
16823     if (isMemberSpecialization)
16824       Diag(New->getLocation(), diag::err_module_private_specialization)
16825         << 2
16826         << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ModulePrivateLoc);
16827     // __module_private__ does not apply to local classes. However, we only
16828     // diagnose this as an error when the declaration specifiers are
16829     // freestanding. Here, we just ignore the __module_private__.
16830     else if (!SearchDC->isFunctionOrMethod())
16831       New->setModulePrivate();
16832   }
16833 
16834   // If this is a specialization of a member class (of a class template),
16835   // check the specialization.
16836   if (isMemberSpecialization && CheckMemberSpecialization(New, Previous))
16837     Invalid = true;
16838 
16839   // If we're declaring or defining a tag in function prototype scope in C,
16840   // note that this type can only be used within the function and add it to
16841   // the list of decls to inject into the function definition scope.
16842   if ((Name || Kind == TTK_Enum) &&
16843       getNonFieldDeclScope(S)->isFunctionPrototypeScope()) {
16844     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16845       // C++ [dcl.fct]p6:
16846       //   Types shall not be defined in return or parameter types.
16847       if (TUK == TUK_Definition && !IsTypeSpecifier) {
16848         Diag(Loc, diag::err_type_defined_in_param_type)
16849             << Name;
16850         Invalid = true;
16851       }
16852     } else if (!PrevDecl) {
16853       Diag(Loc, diag::warn_decl_in_param_list) << Context.getTagDeclType(New);
16854     }
16855   }
16856 
16857   if (Invalid)
16858     New->setInvalidDecl();
16859 
16860   // Set the lexical context. If the tag has a C++ scope specifier, the
16861   // lexical context will be different from the semantic context.
16862   New->setLexicalDeclContext(CurContext);
16863 
16864   // Mark this as a friend decl if applicable.
16865   // In Microsoft mode, a friend declaration also acts as a forward
16866   // declaration so we always pass true to setObjectOfFriendDecl to make
16867   // the tag name visible.
16868   if (TUK == TUK_Friend)
16869     New->setObjectOfFriendDecl(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat);
16870 
16871   // Set the access specifier.
16872   if (!Invalid && SearchDC->isRecord())
16873     SetMemberAccessSpecifier(New, PrevDecl, AS);
16874 
16875   if (PrevDecl)
16876     CheckRedeclarationInModule(New, PrevDecl);
16877 
16878   if (TUK == TUK_Definition && (!SkipBody || !SkipBody->ShouldSkip))
16879     New->startDefinition();
16880 
16881   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
16882   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
16883 
16884   // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
16885   if (TUK == TUK_Friend) {
16886     // We might be replacing an existing declaration in the lookup tables;
16887     // if so, borrow its access specifier.
16888     if (PrevDecl)
16889       New->setAccess(PrevDecl->getAccess());
16890 
16891     DeclContext *DC = New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext();
16892     DC->makeDeclVisibleInContext(New);
16893     if (Name) // can be null along some error paths
16894       if (Scope *EnclosingScope = getScopeForDeclContext(S, DC))
16895         PushOnScopeChains(New, EnclosingScope, /* AddToContext = */ false);
16896   } else if (Name) {
16897     S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
16898     PushOnScopeChains(New, S, true);
16899   } else {
16900     CurContext->addDecl(New);
16901   }
16902 
16903   // If this is the C FILE type, notify the AST context.
16904   if (IdentifierInfo *II = New->getIdentifier())
16905     if (!New->isInvalidDecl() &&
16906         New->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->isTranslationUnit() &&
16907         II->isStr("FILE"))
16908       Context.setFILEDecl(New);
16909 
16910   if (PrevDecl)
16911     mergeDeclAttributes(New, PrevDecl);
16912 
16913   if (auto *CXXRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(New))
16914     inferGslOwnerPointerAttribute(CXXRD);
16915 
16916   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16917   // record.
16918   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(New);
16919 
16920   if (isMemberSpecialization && !New->isInvalidDecl())
16921     CompleteMemberSpecialization(New, Previous);
16922 
16923   OwnedDecl = true;
16924   // In C++, don't return an invalid declaration. We can't recover well from
16925   // the cases where we make the type anonymous.
16926   if (Invalid && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
16927     if (New->isBeingDefined())
16928       if (auto RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(New))
16929         RD->completeDefinition();
16930     return nullptr;
16931   } else if (SkipBody && SkipBody->ShouldSkip) {
16932     return SkipBody->Previous;
16933   } else {
16934     return New;
16935   }
16936 }
16937 
16938 void Sema::ActOnTagStartDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
16939   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16940   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
16941 
16942   // Enter the tag context.
16943   PushDeclContext(S, Tag);
16944 
16945   ActOnDocumentableDecl(TagD);
16946 
16947   // If there's a #pragma GCC visibility in scope, set the visibility of this
16948   // record.
16949   AddPushedVisibilityAttribute(Tag);
16950 }
16951 
16952 bool Sema::ActOnDuplicateDefinition(Decl *Prev, SkipBodyInfo &SkipBody) {
16953   if (!hasStructuralCompatLayout(Prev, SkipBody.New))
16954     return false;
16955 
16956   // Make the previous decl visible.
16957   makeMergedDefinitionVisible(SkipBody.Previous);
16958   return true;
16959 }
16960 
16961 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCContainerDecl *IDecl) {
16962   assert(IDecl->getLexicalParent() == CurContext &&
16963       "The next DeclContext should be lexically contained in the current one.");
16964   CurContext = IDecl;
16965 }
16966 
16967 void Sema::ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
16968                                            SourceLocation FinalLoc,
16969                                            bool IsFinalSpelledSealed,
16970                                            bool IsAbstract,
16971                                            SourceLocation LBraceLoc) {
16972   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
16973   CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TagD);
16974 
16975   FieldCollector->StartClass();
16976 
16977   if (!Record->getIdentifier())
16978     return;
16979 
16980   if (IsAbstract)
16981     Record->markAbstract();
16982 
16983   if (FinalLoc.isValid()) {
16984     Record->addAttr(FinalAttr::Create(
16985         Context, FinalLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Keyword,
16986         static_cast<FinalAttr::Spelling>(IsFinalSpelledSealed)));
16987   }
16988   // C++ [class]p2:
16989   //   [...] The class-name is also inserted into the scope of the
16990   //   class itself; this is known as the injected-class-name. For
16991   //   purposes of access checking, the injected-class-name is treated
16992   //   as if it were a public member name.
16993   CXXRecordDecl *InjectedClassName = CXXRecordDecl::Create(
16994       Context, Record->getTagKind(), CurContext, Record->getBeginLoc(),
16995       Record->getLocation(), Record->getIdentifier(),
16996       /*PrevDecl=*/nullptr,
16997       /*DelayTypeCreation=*/true);
16998   Context.getTypeDeclType(InjectedClassName, Record);
16999   InjectedClassName->setImplicit();
17000   InjectedClassName->setAccess(AS_public);
17001   if (ClassTemplateDecl *Template = Record->getDescribedClassTemplate())
17002       InjectedClassName->setDescribedClassTemplate(Template);
17003   PushOnScopeChains(InjectedClassName, S);
17004   assert(InjectedClassName->isInjectedClassName() &&
17005          "Broken injected-class-name");
17006 }
17007 
17008 void Sema::ActOnTagFinishDefinition(Scope *S, Decl *TagD,
17009                                     SourceRange BraceRange) {
17010   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
17011   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
17012   Tag->setBraceRange(BraceRange);
17013 
17014   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
17015   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
17016     assert(Tag->isInvalidDecl() && "We should already have completed it");
17017     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
17018       RD->completeDefinition();
17019   }
17020 
17021   if (auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Tag)) {
17022     FieldCollector->FinishClass();
17023     if (RD->hasAttr<SYCLSpecialClassAttr>()) {
17024       auto *Def = RD->getDefinition();
17025       assert(Def && "The record is expected to have a completed definition");
17026       unsigned NumInitMethods = 0;
17027       for (auto *Method : Def->methods()) {
17028         if (!Method->getIdentifier())
17029             continue;
17030         if (Method->getName() == "__init")
17031           NumInitMethods++;
17032       }
17033       if (NumInitMethods > 1 || !Def->hasInitMethod())
17034         Diag(RD->getLocation(), diag::err_sycl_special_type_num_init_method);
17035     }
17036   }
17037 
17038   // Exit this scope of this tag's definition.
17039   PopDeclContext();
17040 
17041   if (getCurLexicalContext()->isObjCContainer() &&
17042       Tag->getDeclContext()->isFileContext())
17043     Tag->setTopLevelDeclInObjCContainer();
17044 
17045   // Notify the consumer that we've defined a tag.
17046   if (!Tag->isInvalidDecl())
17047     Consumer.HandleTagDeclDefinition(Tag);
17048 
17049   // Clangs implementation of #pragma align(packed) differs in bitfield layout
17050   // from XLs and instead matches the XL #pragma pack(1) behavior.
17051   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isOSAIX() &&
17052       AlignPackStack.hasValue()) {
17053     AlignPackInfo APInfo = AlignPackStack.CurrentValue;
17054     // Only diagnose #pragma align(packed).
17055     if (!APInfo.IsAlignAttr() || APInfo.getAlignMode() != AlignPackInfo::Packed)
17056       return;
17057     const RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag);
17058     if (!RD)
17059       return;
17060     // Only warn if there is at least 1 bitfield member.
17061     if (llvm::any_of(RD->fields(),
17062                      [](const FieldDecl *FD) { return FD->isBitField(); }))
17063       Diag(BraceRange.getBegin(), diag::warn_pragma_align_not_xl_compatible);
17064   }
17065 }
17066 
17067 void Sema::ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition() {
17068   // Exit this scope of this interface definition.
17069   PopDeclContext();
17070 }
17071 
17072 void Sema::ActOnObjCTemporaryExitContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) {
17073   assert(ObjCCtx == CurContext && "Mismatch of container contexts");
17074   OriginalLexicalContext = ObjCCtx;
17075   ActOnObjCContainerFinishDefinition();
17076 }
17077 
17078 void Sema::ActOnObjCReenterContainerContext(ObjCContainerDecl *ObjCCtx) {
17079   ActOnObjCContainerStartDefinition(ObjCCtx);
17080   OriginalLexicalContext = nullptr;
17081 }
17082 
17083 void Sema::ActOnTagDefinitionError(Scope *S, Decl *TagD) {
17084   AdjustDeclIfTemplate(TagD);
17085   TagDecl *Tag = cast<TagDecl>(TagD);
17086   Tag->setInvalidDecl();
17087 
17088   // Make sure we "complete" the definition even it is invalid.
17089   if (Tag->isBeingDefined()) {
17090     if (RecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(Tag))
17091       RD->completeDefinition();
17092   }
17093 
17094   // We're undoing ActOnTagStartDefinition here, not
17095   // ActOnStartCXXMemberDeclarations, so we don't have to mess with
17096   // the FieldCollector.
17097 
17098   PopDeclContext();
17099 }
17100 
17101 // Note that FieldName may be null for anonymous bitfields.
17102 ExprResult Sema::VerifyBitField(SourceLocation FieldLoc,
17103                                 IdentifierInfo *FieldName, QualType FieldTy,
17104                                 bool IsMsStruct, Expr *BitWidth) {
17105   assert(BitWidth);
17106   if (BitWidth->containsErrors())
17107     return ExprError();
17108 
17109   // C99 6.7.2.1p4 - verify the field type.
17110   // C++ 9.6p3: A bit-field shall have integral or enumeration type.
17111   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType() && !FieldTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
17112     // Handle incomplete and sizeless types with a specific error.
17113     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(FieldLoc, FieldTy,
17114                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless))
17115       return ExprError();
17116     if (FieldName)
17117       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_bitfield)
17118         << FieldName << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
17119     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_not_integral_type_anon_bitfield)
17120       << FieldTy << BitWidth->getSourceRange();
17121   } else if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(const_cast<Expr *>(BitWidth),
17122                                              UPPC_BitFieldWidth))
17123     return ExprError();
17124 
17125   // If the bit-width is type- or value-dependent, don't try to check
17126   // it now.
17127   if (BitWidth->isValueDependent() || BitWidth->isTypeDependent())
17128     return BitWidth;
17129 
17130   llvm::APSInt Value;
17131   ExprResult ICE = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(BitWidth, &Value, AllowFold);
17132   if (ICE.isInvalid())
17133     return ICE;
17134   BitWidth = ICE.get();
17135 
17136   // Zero-width bitfield is ok for anonymous field.
17137   if (Value == 0 && FieldName)
17138     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_zero_width) << FieldName;
17139 
17140   if (Value.isSigned() && Value.isNegative()) {
17141     if (FieldName)
17142       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_has_negative_width)
17143                << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
17144     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_has_negative_width)
17145       << toString(Value, 10);
17146   }
17147 
17148   // The size of the bit-field must not exceed our maximum permitted object
17149   // size.
17150   if (Value.getActiveBits() > ConstantArrayType::getMaxSizeBits(Context)) {
17151     return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_too_wide)
17152            << !FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10);
17153   }
17154 
17155   if (!FieldTy->isDependentType()) {
17156     uint64_t TypeStorageSize = Context.getTypeSize(FieldTy);
17157     uint64_t TypeWidth = Context.getIntWidth(FieldTy);
17158     bool BitfieldIsOverwide = Value.ugt(TypeWidth);
17159 
17160     // Over-wide bitfields are an error in C or when using the MSVC bitfield
17161     // ABI.
17162     bool CStdConstraintViolation =
17163         BitfieldIsOverwide && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus;
17164     bool MSBitfieldViolation =
17165         Value.ugt(TypeStorageSize) &&
17166         (IsMsStruct || Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft());
17167     if (CStdConstraintViolation || MSBitfieldViolation) {
17168       unsigned DiagWidth =
17169           CStdConstraintViolation ? TypeWidth : TypeStorageSize;
17170       return Diag(FieldLoc, diag::err_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
17171              << (bool)FieldName << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
17172              << !CStdConstraintViolation << DiagWidth;
17173     }
17174 
17175     // Warn on types where the user might conceivably expect to get all
17176     // specified bits as value bits: that's all integral types other than
17177     // 'bool'.
17178     if (BitfieldIsOverwide && !FieldTy->isBooleanType() && FieldName) {
17179       Diag(FieldLoc, diag::warn_bitfield_width_exceeds_type_width)
17180           << FieldName << toString(Value, 10)
17181           << (unsigned)TypeWidth;
17182     }
17183   }
17184 
17185   return BitWidth;
17186 }
17187 
17188 /// ActOnField - Each field of a C struct/union is passed into this in order
17189 /// to create a FieldDecl object for it.
17190 Decl *Sema::ActOnField(Scope *S, Decl *TagD, SourceLocation DeclStart,
17191                        Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth) {
17192   FieldDecl *Res = HandleField(S, cast_or_null<RecordDecl>(TagD),
17193                                DeclStart, D, static_cast<Expr*>(BitfieldWidth),
17194                                /*InitStyle=*/ICIS_NoInit, AS_public);
17195   return Res;
17196 }
17197 
17198 /// HandleField - Analyze a field of a C struct or a C++ data member.
17199 ///
17200 FieldDecl *Sema::HandleField(Scope *S, RecordDecl *Record,
17201                              SourceLocation DeclStart,
17202                              Declarator &D, Expr *BitWidth,
17203                              InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
17204                              AccessSpecifier AS) {
17205   if (D.isDecompositionDeclarator()) {
17206     const DecompositionDeclarator &Decomp = D.getDecompositionDeclarator();
17207     Diag(Decomp.getLSquareLoc(), diag::err_decomp_decl_context)
17208       << Decomp.getSourceRange();
17209     return nullptr;
17210   }
17211 
17212   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
17213   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
17214   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
17215 
17216   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
17217   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
17218   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17219     CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D);
17220 
17221     if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(D.getIdentifierLoc(), TInfo,
17222                                         UPPC_DataMemberType)) {
17223       D.setInvalidType();
17224       T = Context.IntTy;
17225       TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T, Loc);
17226     }
17227   }
17228 
17229   DiagnoseFunctionSpecifiers(D.getDeclSpec());
17230 
17231   if (D.getDeclSpec().isInlineSpecified())
17232     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getInlineSpecLoc(), diag::err_inline_non_function)
17233         << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17;
17234   if (DeclSpec::TSCS TSCS = D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpec())
17235     Diag(D.getDeclSpec().getThreadStorageClassSpecLoc(),
17236          diag::err_invalid_thread)
17237       << DeclSpec::getSpecifierName(TSCS);
17238 
17239   // Check to see if this name was declared as a member previously
17240   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = nullptr;
17241   LookupResult Previous(*this, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
17242                         ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17243   LookupName(Previous, S);
17244   switch (Previous.getResultKind()) {
17245     case LookupResult::Found:
17246     case LookupResult::FoundUnresolvedValue:
17247       PrevDecl = Previous.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
17248       break;
17249 
17250     case LookupResult::FoundOverloaded:
17251       PrevDecl = Previous.getRepresentativeDecl();
17252       break;
17253 
17254     case LookupResult::NotFound:
17255     case LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation:
17256     case LookupResult::Ambiguous:
17257       break;
17258   }
17259   Previous.suppressDiagnostics();
17260 
17261   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
17262     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
17263     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(D.getIdentifierLoc(), PrevDecl);
17264     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
17265     PrevDecl = nullptr;
17266   }
17267 
17268   if (PrevDecl && !isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, Record, S))
17269     PrevDecl = nullptr;
17270 
17271   bool Mutable
17272     = (D.getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpec() == DeclSpec::SCS_mutable);
17273   SourceLocation TSSL = D.getBeginLoc();
17274   FieldDecl *NewFD
17275     = CheckFieldDecl(II, T, TInfo, Record, Loc, Mutable, BitWidth, InitStyle,
17276                      TSSL, AS, PrevDecl, &D);
17277 
17278   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl())
17279     Record->setInvalidDecl();
17280 
17281   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
17282     NewFD->setModulePrivate();
17283 
17284   if (NewFD->isInvalidDecl() && PrevDecl) {
17285     // Don't introduce NewFD into scope; there's already something
17286     // with the same name in the same scope.
17287   } else if (II) {
17288     PushOnScopeChains(NewFD, S);
17289   } else
17290     Record->addDecl(NewFD);
17291 
17292   return NewFD;
17293 }
17294 
17295 /// Build a new FieldDecl and check its well-formedness.
17296 ///
17297 /// This routine builds a new FieldDecl given the fields name, type,
17298 /// record, etc. \p PrevDecl should refer to any previous declaration
17299 /// with the same name and in the same scope as the field to be
17300 /// created.
17301 ///
17302 /// \returns a new FieldDecl.
17303 ///
17304 /// \todo The Declarator argument is a hack. It will be removed once
17305 FieldDecl *Sema::CheckFieldDecl(DeclarationName Name, QualType T,
17306                                 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
17307                                 RecordDecl *Record, SourceLocation Loc,
17308                                 bool Mutable, Expr *BitWidth,
17309                                 InClassInitStyle InitStyle,
17310                                 SourceLocation TSSL,
17311                                 AccessSpecifier AS, NamedDecl *PrevDecl,
17312                                 Declarator *D) {
17313   IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
17314   bool InvalidDecl = false;
17315   if (D) InvalidDecl = D->isInvalidType();
17316 
17317   // If we receive a broken type, recover by assuming 'int' and
17318   // marking this declaration as invalid.
17319   if (T.isNull() || T->containsErrors()) {
17320     InvalidDecl = true;
17321     T = Context.IntTy;
17322   }
17323 
17324   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(T);
17325   if (!EltTy->isDependentType() && !EltTy->containsErrors()) {
17326     if (RequireCompleteSizedType(Loc, EltTy,
17327                                  diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
17328       // Fields of incomplete type force their record to be invalid.
17329       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17330       InvalidDecl = true;
17331     } else {
17332       NamedDecl *Def;
17333       EltTy->isIncompleteType(&Def);
17334       if (Def && Def->isInvalidDecl()) {
17335         Record->setInvalidDecl();
17336         InvalidDecl = true;
17337       }
17338     }
17339   }
17340 
17341   // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address space
17342   if (T.hasAddressSpace() || T->isDependentAddressSpaceType() ||
17343       T->getBaseElementTypeUnsafe()->isDependentAddressSpaceType()) {
17344     Diag(Loc, diag::err_field_with_address_space);
17345     Record->setInvalidDecl();
17346     InvalidDecl = true;
17347   }
17348 
17349   if (LangOpts.OpenCL) {
17350     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9b,r & OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - The following types cannot be
17351     // used as structure or union field: image, sampler, event or block types.
17352     if (T->isEventT() || T->isImageType() || T->isSamplerT() ||
17353         T->isBlockPointerType()) {
17354       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_type_struct_or_union_field) << T;
17355       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17356       InvalidDecl = true;
17357     }
17358     // OpenCL v1.2 s6.9.c: bitfields are not supported, unless Clang extension
17359     // is enabled.
17360     if (BitWidth && !getOpenCLOptions().isAvailableOption(
17361                         "__cl_clang_bitfields", LangOpts)) {
17362       Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_bitfields);
17363       InvalidDecl = true;
17364     }
17365   }
17366 
17367   // Anonymous bit-fields cannot be cv-qualified (CWG 2229).
17368   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !II && BitWidth &&
17369       T.hasQualifiers()) {
17370     InvalidDecl = true;
17371     Diag(Loc, diag::err_anon_bitfield_qualifiers);
17372   }
17373 
17374   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
17375   // than a variably modified type.
17376   if (!InvalidDecl && T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
17377     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
17378             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_field_variable_size))
17379       InvalidDecl = true;
17380   }
17381 
17382   // Fields can not have abstract class types
17383   if (!InvalidDecl && RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, T,
17384                                              diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
17385                                              AbstractFieldType))
17386     InvalidDecl = true;
17387 
17388   if (InvalidDecl)
17389     BitWidth = nullptr;
17390   // If this is declared as a bit-field, check the bit-field.
17391   if (BitWidth) {
17392     BitWidth =
17393         VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, Record->isMsStruct(Context), BitWidth).get();
17394     if (!BitWidth) {
17395       InvalidDecl = true;
17396       BitWidth = nullptr;
17397     }
17398   }
17399 
17400   // Check that 'mutable' is consistent with the type of the declaration.
17401   if (!InvalidDecl && Mutable) {
17402     unsigned DiagID = 0;
17403     if (T->isReferenceType())
17404       DiagID = getLangOpts().MSVCCompat ? diag::ext_mutable_reference
17405                                         : diag::err_mutable_reference;
17406     else if (T.isConstQualified())
17407       DiagID = diag::err_mutable_const;
17408 
17409     if (DiagID) {
17410       SourceLocation ErrLoc = Loc;
17411       if (D && D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc().isValid())
17412         ErrLoc = D->getDeclSpec().getStorageClassSpecLoc();
17413       Diag(ErrLoc, DiagID);
17414       if (DiagID != diag::ext_mutable_reference) {
17415         Mutable = false;
17416         InvalidDecl = true;
17417       }
17418     }
17419   }
17420 
17421   // C++11 [class.union]p8 (DR1460):
17422   //   At most one variant member of a union may have a
17423   //   brace-or-equal-initializer.
17424   if (InitStyle != ICIS_NoInit)
17425     checkDuplicateDefaultInit(*this, cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record), Loc);
17426 
17427   FieldDecl *NewFD = FieldDecl::Create(Context, Record, TSSL, Loc, II, T, TInfo,
17428                                        BitWidth, Mutable, InitStyle);
17429   if (InvalidDecl)
17430     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17431 
17432   if (PrevDecl && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17433     Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
17434     Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
17435     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17436   }
17437 
17438   if (!InvalidDecl && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
17439     if (Record->isUnion()) {
17440       if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17441         CXXRecordDecl* RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
17442         if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
17443           // C++ [class.union]p1: An object of a class with a non-trivial
17444           // constructor, a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial
17445           // destructor, or a non-trivial copy assignment operator
17446           // cannot be a member of a union, nor can an array of such
17447           // objects.
17448           if (CheckNontrivialField(NewFD))
17449             NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17450         }
17451       }
17452 
17453       // C++ [class.union]p1: If a union contains a member of reference type,
17454       // the program is ill-formed, except when compiling with MSVC extensions
17455       // enabled.
17456       if (EltTy->isReferenceType()) {
17457         Diag(NewFD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt ?
17458                                     diag::ext_union_member_of_reference_type :
17459                                     diag::err_union_member_of_reference_type)
17460           << NewFD->getDeclName() << EltTy;
17461         if (!getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt)
17462           NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17463       }
17464     }
17465   }
17466 
17467   // FIXME: We need to pass in the attributes given an AST
17468   // representation, not a parser representation.
17469   if (D) {
17470     // FIXME: The current scope is almost... but not entirely... correct here.
17471     ProcessDeclAttributes(getCurScope(), NewFD, *D);
17472 
17473     if (NewFD->hasAttrs())
17474       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(NewFD);
17475   }
17476 
17477   // In auto-retain/release, infer strong retension for fields of
17478   // retainable type.
17479   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewFD))
17480     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17481 
17482   if (T.isObjCGCWeak())
17483     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_attribute_weak_on_field);
17484 
17485   // PPC MMA non-pointer types are not allowed as field types.
17486   if (Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isPPC64() &&
17487       CheckPPCMMAType(T, NewFD->getLocation()))
17488     NewFD->setInvalidDecl();
17489 
17490   NewFD->setAccess(AS);
17491   return NewFD;
17492 }
17493 
17494 bool Sema::CheckNontrivialField(FieldDecl *FD) {
17495   assert(FD);
17496   assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "valid check only for C++");
17497 
17498   if (FD->isInvalidDecl() || FD->getType()->isDependentType())
17499     return false;
17500 
17501   QualType EltTy = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17502   if (const RecordType *RT = EltTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17503     CXXRecordDecl *RDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RT->getDecl());
17504     if (RDecl->getDefinition()) {
17505       // We check for copy constructors before constructors
17506       // because otherwise we'll never get complaints about
17507       // copy constructors.
17508 
17509       CXXSpecialMember member = CXXInvalid;
17510       // We're required to check for any non-trivial constructors. Since the
17511       // implicit default constructor is suppressed if there are any
17512       // user-declared constructors, we just need to check that there is a
17513       // trivial default constructor and a trivial copy constructor. (We don't
17514       // worry about move constructors here, since this is a C++98 check.)
17515       if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor())
17516         member = CXXCopyConstructor;
17517       else if (!RDecl->hasTrivialDefaultConstructor())
17518         member = CXXDefaultConstructor;
17519       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialCopyAssignment())
17520         member = CXXCopyAssignment;
17521       else if (RDecl->hasNonTrivialDestructor())
17522         member = CXXDestructor;
17523 
17524       if (member != CXXInvalid) {
17525         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
17526             getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && RDecl->hasObjectMember()) {
17527           // Objective-C++ ARC: it is an error to have a non-trivial field of
17528           // a union. However, system headers in Objective-C programs
17529           // occasionally have Objective-C lifetime objects within unions,
17530           // and rather than cause the program to fail, we make those
17531           // members unavailable.
17532           SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation();
17533           if (getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(Loc)) {
17534             if (!FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>())
17535               FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, "",
17536                             UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership, Loc));
17537             return false;
17538           }
17539         }
17540 
17541         Diag(FD->getLocation(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ?
17542                diag::warn_cxx98_compat_nontrivial_union_or_anon_struct_member :
17543                diag::err_illegal_union_or_anon_struct_member)
17544           << FD->getParent()->isUnion() << FD->getDeclName() << member;
17545         DiagnoseNontrivial(RDecl, member);
17546         return !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11;
17547       }
17548     }
17549   }
17550 
17551   return false;
17552 }
17553 
17554 /// TranslateIvarVisibility - Translate visibility from a token ID to an
17555 ///  AST enum value.
17556 static ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl
17557 TranslateIvarVisibility(tok::ObjCKeywordKind ivarVisibility) {
17558   switch (ivarVisibility) {
17559   default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown visitibility kind");
17560   case tok::objc_private: return ObjCIvarDecl::Private;
17561   case tok::objc_public: return ObjCIvarDecl::Public;
17562   case tok::objc_protected: return ObjCIvarDecl::Protected;
17563   case tok::objc_package: return ObjCIvarDecl::Package;
17564   }
17565 }
17566 
17567 /// ActOnIvar - Each ivar field of an objective-c class is passed into this
17568 /// in order to create an IvarDecl object for it.
17569 Decl *Sema::ActOnIvar(Scope *S,
17570                                 SourceLocation DeclStart,
17571                                 Declarator &D, Expr *BitfieldWidth,
17572                                 tok::ObjCKeywordKind Visibility) {
17573 
17574   IdentifierInfo *II = D.getIdentifier();
17575   Expr *BitWidth = (Expr*)BitfieldWidth;
17576   SourceLocation Loc = DeclStart;
17577   if (II) Loc = D.getIdentifierLoc();
17578 
17579   // FIXME: Unnamed fields can be handled in various different ways, for
17580   // example, unnamed unions inject all members into the struct namespace!
17581 
17582   TypeSourceInfo *TInfo = GetTypeForDeclarator(D, S);
17583   QualType T = TInfo->getType();
17584 
17585   if (BitWidth) {
17586     // 6.7.2.1p3, 6.7.2.1p4
17587     BitWidth = VerifyBitField(Loc, II, T, /*IsMsStruct*/false, BitWidth).get();
17588     if (!BitWidth)
17589       D.setInvalidType();
17590   } else {
17591     // Not a bitfield.
17592 
17593     // validate II.
17594 
17595   }
17596   if (T->isReferenceType()) {
17597     Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_reference_type);
17598     D.setInvalidType();
17599   }
17600   // C99 6.7.2.1p8: A member of a structure or union may have any type other
17601   // than a variably modified type.
17602   else if (T->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
17603     if (!tryToFixVariablyModifiedVarType(
17604             TInfo, T, Loc, diag::err_typecheck_ivar_variable_size))
17605       D.setInvalidType();
17606   }
17607 
17608   // Get the visibility (access control) for this ivar.
17609   ObjCIvarDecl::AccessControl ac =
17610     Visibility != tok::objc_not_keyword ? TranslateIvarVisibility(Visibility)
17611                                         : ObjCIvarDecl::None;
17612   // Must set ivar's DeclContext to its enclosing interface.
17613   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingDecl = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext);
17614   if (!EnclosingDecl || EnclosingDecl->isInvalidDecl())
17615     return nullptr;
17616   ObjCContainerDecl *EnclosingContext;
17617   if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
17618       dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17619     if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile()) {
17620     // Case of ivar declared in an implementation. Context is that of its class.
17621       EnclosingContext = IMPDecl->getClassInterface();
17622       assert(EnclosingContext && "Implementation has no class interface!");
17623     }
17624     else
17625       EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17626   } else {
17627     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
17628         dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17629       if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || !CDecl->IsClassExtension()) {
17630         Diag(Loc, diag::err_misplaced_ivar) << CDecl->IsClassExtension();
17631         return nullptr;
17632       }
17633     }
17634     EnclosingContext = EnclosingDecl;
17635   }
17636 
17637   // Construct the decl.
17638   ObjCIvarDecl *NewID = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, EnclosingContext,
17639                                              DeclStart, Loc, II, T,
17640                                              TInfo, ac, (Expr *)BitfieldWidth);
17641 
17642   if (II) {
17643     NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, Loc, LookupMemberName,
17644                                            ForVisibleRedeclaration);
17645     if (PrevDecl && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, EnclosingContext, S)
17646         && !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
17647       Diag(Loc, diag::err_duplicate_member) << II;
17648       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
17649       NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17650     }
17651   }
17652 
17653   // Process attributes attached to the ivar.
17654   ProcessDeclAttributes(S, NewID, D);
17655 
17656   if (D.isInvalidType())
17657     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17658 
17659   // In ARC, infer 'retaining' for ivars of retainable type.
17660   if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && inferObjCARCLifetime(NewID))
17661     NewID->setInvalidDecl();
17662 
17663   if (D.getDeclSpec().isModulePrivateSpecified())
17664     NewID->setModulePrivate();
17665 
17666   if (II) {
17667     // FIXME: When interfaces are DeclContexts, we'll need to add
17668     // these to the interface.
17669     S->AddDecl(NewID);
17670     IdResolver.AddDecl(NewID);
17671   }
17672 
17673   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isNonFragile() &&
17674       !NewID->isInvalidDecl() && isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl))
17675     Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivars_in_interface);
17676 
17677   return NewID;
17678 }
17679 
17680 /// ActOnLastBitfield - This routine handles synthesized bitfields rules for
17681 /// class and class extensions. For every class \@interface and class
17682 /// extension \@interface, if the last ivar is a bitfield of any type,
17683 /// then add an implicit `char :0` ivar to the end of that interface.
17684 void Sema::ActOnLastBitfield(SourceLocation DeclLoc,
17685                              SmallVectorImpl<Decl *> &AllIvarDecls) {
17686   if (LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.isFragile() || AllIvarDecls.empty())
17687     return;
17688 
17689   Decl *ivarDecl = AllIvarDecls[AllIvarDecls.size()-1];
17690   ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(ivarDecl);
17691 
17692   if (!Ivar->isBitField() || Ivar->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
17693     return;
17694   ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(CurContext);
17695   if (!ID) {
17696     if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CD = dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(CurContext)) {
17697       if (!CD->IsClassExtension())
17698         return;
17699     }
17700     // No need to add this to end of @implementation.
17701     else
17702       return;
17703   }
17704   // All conditions are met. Add a new bitfield to the tail end of ivars.
17705   llvm::APInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), 0);
17706   Expr * BW = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, DeclLoc);
17707 
17708   Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(Context, cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext),
17709                               DeclLoc, DeclLoc, nullptr,
17710                               Context.CharTy,
17711                               Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(Context.CharTy,
17712                                                                DeclLoc),
17713                               ObjCIvarDecl::Private, BW,
17714                               true);
17715   AllIvarDecls.push_back(Ivar);
17716 }
17717 
17718 namespace {
17719 /// [class.dtor]p4:
17720 ///   At the end of the definition of a class, overload resolution is
17721 ///   performed among the prospective destructors declared in that class with
17722 ///   an empty argument list to select the destructor for the class, also
17723 ///   known as the selected destructor.
17724 ///
17725 /// We do the overload resolution here, then mark the selected constructor in the AST.
17726 /// Later CXXRecordDecl::getDestructor() will return the selected constructor.
17727 void ComputeSelectedDestructor(Sema &S, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
17728   if (!Record->hasUserDeclaredDestructor()) {
17729     return;
17730   }
17731 
17732   SourceLocation Loc = Record->getLocation();
17733   OverloadCandidateSet OCS(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
17734 
17735   for (auto *Decl : Record->decls()) {
17736     if (auto *DD = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Decl)) {
17737       if (DD->isInvalidDecl())
17738         continue;
17739       S.AddOverloadCandidate(DD, DeclAccessPair::make(DD, DD->getAccess()), {},
17740                              OCS);
17741       assert(DD->isIneligibleOrNotSelected() && "Selecting a destructor but a destructor was already selected.");
17742     }
17743   }
17744 
17745   if (OCS.empty()) {
17746     return;
17747   }
17748   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
17749   unsigned Msg = 0;
17750   OverloadCandidateDisplayKind DisplayKind;
17751 
17752   switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, Loc, Best)) {
17753   case OR_Success:
17754   case OR_Deleted:
17755     Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Best->Function));
17756     break;
17757 
17758   case OR_Ambiguous:
17759     Msg = diag::err_ambiguous_destructor;
17760     DisplayKind = OCD_AmbiguousCandidates;
17761     break;
17762 
17763   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
17764     Msg = diag::err_no_viable_destructor;
17765     DisplayKind = OCD_AllCandidates;
17766     break;
17767   }
17768 
17769   if (Msg) {
17770     // OpenCL have got their own thing going with destructors. It's slightly broken,
17771     // but we allow it.
17772     if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL) {
17773       PartialDiagnostic Diag = S.PDiag(Msg) << Record;
17774       OCS.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(Loc, Diag), S, DisplayKind, {});
17775       Record->setInvalidDecl();
17776     }
17777     // It's a bit hacky: At this point we've raised an error but we want the
17778     // rest of the compiler to continue somehow working. However almost
17779     // everything we'll try to do with the class will depend on there being a
17780     // destructor. So let's pretend the first one is selected and hope for the
17781     // best.
17782     Record->addedSelectedDestructor(dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(OCS.begin()->Function));
17783   }
17784 }
17785 } // namespace
17786 
17787 void Sema::ActOnFields(Scope *S, SourceLocation RecLoc, Decl *EnclosingDecl,
17788                        ArrayRef<Decl *> Fields, SourceLocation LBrac,
17789                        SourceLocation RBrac,
17790                        const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
17791   assert(EnclosingDecl && "missing record or interface decl");
17792 
17793   // If this is an Objective-C @implementation or category and we have
17794   // new fields here we should reset the layout of the interface since
17795   // it will now change.
17796   if (!Fields.empty() && isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
17797     ObjCContainerDecl *DC = cast<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17798     switch (DC->getKind()) {
17799     default: break;
17800     case Decl::ObjCCategory:
17801       Context.ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17802       break;
17803     case Decl::ObjCImplementation:
17804       Context.
17805         ResetObjCLayout(cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(DC)->getClassInterface());
17806       break;
17807     }
17808   }
17809 
17810   RecordDecl *Record = dyn_cast<RecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17811   CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(EnclosingDecl);
17812 
17813   if (CXXRecord && !CXXRecord->isDependentType())
17814     ComputeSelectedDestructor(*this, CXXRecord);
17815 
17816   // Start counting up the number of named members; make sure to include
17817   // members of anonymous structs and unions in the total.
17818   unsigned NumNamedMembers = 0;
17819   if (Record) {
17820     for (const auto *I : Record->decls()) {
17821       if (const auto *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(I))
17822         if (IFD->getDeclName())
17823           ++NumNamedMembers;
17824     }
17825   }
17826 
17827   // Verify that all the fields are okay.
17828   SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 32> RecFields;
17829 
17830   for (ArrayRef<Decl *>::iterator i = Fields.begin(), end = Fields.end();
17831        i != end; ++i) {
17832     FieldDecl *FD = cast<FieldDecl>(*i);
17833 
17834     // Get the type for the field.
17835     const Type *FDTy = FD->getType().getTypePtr();
17836 
17837     if (!FD->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
17838       // Remember all fields written by the user.
17839       RecFields.push_back(FD);
17840     }
17841 
17842     // If the field is already invalid for some reason, don't emit more
17843     // diagnostics about it.
17844     if (FD->isInvalidDecl()) {
17845       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17846       continue;
17847     }
17848 
17849     // C99 6.7.2.1p2:
17850     //   A structure or union shall not contain a member with
17851     //   incomplete or function type (hence, a structure shall not
17852     //   contain an instance of itself, but may contain a pointer to
17853     //   an instance of itself), except that the last member of a
17854     //   structure with more than one named member may have incomplete
17855     //   array type; such a structure (and any union containing,
17856     //   possibly recursively, a member that is such a structure)
17857     //   shall not be a member of a structure or an element of an
17858     //   array.
17859     bool IsLastField = (i + 1 == Fields.end());
17860     if (FDTy->isFunctionType()) {
17861       // Field declared as a function.
17862       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_field_declared_as_function)
17863         << FD->getDeclName();
17864       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17865       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17866       continue;
17867     } else if (FDTy->isIncompleteArrayType() &&
17868                (Record || isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl))) {
17869       if (Record) {
17870         // Flexible array member.
17871         // Microsoft and g++ is more permissive regarding flexible array.
17872         // It will accept flexible array in union and also
17873         // as the sole element of a struct/class.
17874         unsigned DiagID = 0;
17875         if (!Record->isUnion() && !IsLastField) {
17876           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_not_at_end)
17877             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType() << Record->getTagKind();
17878           Diag((*(i + 1))->getLocation(), diag::note_next_field_declaration);
17879           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17880           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17881           continue;
17882         } else if (Record->isUnion())
17883           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17884                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_ms
17885                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17886                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_union_gnu
17887                              : diag::err_flexible_array_union;
17888         else if (NumNamedMembers < 1)
17889           DiagID = getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt
17890                        ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_ms
17891                        : getLangOpts().CPlusPlus
17892                              ? diag::ext_flexible_array_empty_aggregate_gnu
17893                              : diag::err_flexible_array_empty_aggregate;
17894 
17895         if (DiagID)
17896           Diag(FD->getLocation(), DiagID) << FD->getDeclName()
17897                                           << Record->getTagKind();
17898         // While the layout of types that contain virtual bases is not specified
17899         // by the C++ standard, both the Itanium and Microsoft C++ ABIs place
17900         // virtual bases after the derived members.  This would make a flexible
17901         // array member declared at the end of an object not adjacent to the end
17902         // of the type.
17903         if (CXXRecord && CXXRecord->getNumVBases() != 0)
17904           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_virtual_base)
17905               << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17906         if (!getLangOpts().C99)
17907           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_flexible_array_member)
17908             << FD->getDeclName() << Record->getTagKind();
17909 
17910         // If the element type has a non-trivial destructor, we would not
17911         // implicitly destroy the elements, so disallow it for now.
17912         //
17913         // FIXME: GCC allows this. We should probably either implicitly delete
17914         // the destructor of the containing class, or just allow this.
17915         QualType BaseElem = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17916         if (!BaseElem->isDependentType() && BaseElem.isDestructedType()) {
17917           Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_flexible_array_has_nontrivial_dtor)
17918             << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17919           FD->setInvalidDecl();
17920           EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17921           continue;
17922         }
17923         // Okay, we have a legal flexible array member at the end of the struct.
17924         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17925       } else {
17926         // In ObjCContainerDecl ivars with incomplete array type are accepted,
17927         // unless they are followed by another ivar. That check is done
17928         // elsewhere, after synthesized ivars are known.
17929       }
17930     } else if (!FDTy->isDependentType() &&
17931                RequireCompleteSizedType(
17932                    FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17933                    diag::err_field_incomplete_or_sizeless)) {
17934       // Incomplete type
17935       FD->setInvalidDecl();
17936       EnclosingDecl->setInvalidDecl();
17937       continue;
17938     } else if (const RecordType *FDTTy = FDTy->getAs<RecordType>()) {
17939       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) {
17940         // A type which contains a flexible array member is considered to be a
17941         // flexible array member.
17942         Record->setHasFlexibleArrayMember(true);
17943         if (!Record->isUnion()) {
17944           // If this is a struct/class and this is not the last element, reject
17945           // it.  Note that GCC supports variable sized arrays in the middle of
17946           // structures.
17947           if (!IsLastField)
17948             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_variable_sized_type_in_struct)
17949               << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
17950           else {
17951             // We support flexible arrays at the end of structs in
17952             // other structs as an extension.
17953             Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::ext_flexible_array_in_struct)
17954               << FD->getDeclName();
17955           }
17956         }
17957       }
17958       if (isa<ObjCContainerDecl>(EnclosingDecl) &&
17959           RequireNonAbstractType(FD->getLocation(), FD->getType(),
17960                                  diag::err_abstract_type_in_decl,
17961                                  AbstractIvarType)) {
17962         // Ivars can not have abstract class types
17963         FD->setInvalidDecl();
17964       }
17965       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
17966         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17967       if (Record && FDTTy->getDecl()->hasVolatileMember())
17968         Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
17969     } else if (FDTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
17970       /// A field cannot be an Objective-c object
17971       Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::err_statically_allocated_object)
17972         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FD->getLocation(), "*");
17973       QualType T = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(FD->getType());
17974       FD->setType(T);
17975     } else if (Record && Record->isUnion() &&
17976                FD->getType().hasNonTrivialObjCLifetime() &&
17977                getSourceManager().isInSystemHeader(FD->getLocation()) &&
17978                !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->hasAttr<UnavailableAttr>() &&
17979                (FD->getType().getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong ||
17980                 !Context.hasDirectOwnershipQualifier(FD->getType()))) {
17981       // For backward compatibility, fields of C unions declared in system
17982       // headers that have non-trivial ObjC ownership qualifications are marked
17983       // as unavailable unless the qualifier is explicit and __strong. This can
17984       // break ABI compatibility between programs compiled with ARC and MRR, but
17985       // is a better option than rejecting programs using those unions under
17986       // ARC.
17987       FD->addAttr(UnavailableAttr::CreateImplicit(
17988           Context, "", UnavailableAttr::IR_ARCFieldWithOwnership,
17989           FD->getLocation()));
17990     } else if (getLangOpts().ObjC &&
17991                getLangOpts().getGC() != LangOptions::NonGC && Record &&
17992                !Record->hasObjectMember()) {
17993       if (FD->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
17994           FD->getType().isObjCGCStrong())
17995         Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
17996       else if (Context.getAsArrayType(FD->getType())) {
17997         QualType BaseType = Context.getBaseElementType(FD->getType());
17998         if (BaseType->isRecordType() &&
17999             BaseType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->hasObjectMember())
18000           Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
18001         else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
18002                  BaseType.isObjCGCStrong())
18003                Record->setHasObjectMember(true);
18004       }
18005     }
18006 
18007     if (Record && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18008         !shouldIgnoreForRecordTriviality(FD)) {
18009       QualType FT = FD->getType();
18010       if (FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize()) {
18011         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitialize(true);
18012         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion() ||
18013             Record->isUnion())
18014           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDefaultInitializeCUnion(true);
18015       }
18016       QualType::PrimitiveCopyKind PCK = FT.isNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy();
18017       if (PCK != QualType::PCK_Trivial && PCK != QualType::PCK_VolatileTrivial) {
18018         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopy(true);
18019         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
18020           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveCopyCUnion(true);
18021       }
18022       if (FT.isDestructedType()) {
18023         Record->setNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestroy(true);
18024         Record->setParamDestroyedInCallee(true);
18025         if (FT.hasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion() || Record->isUnion())
18026           Record->setHasNonTrivialToPrimitiveDestructCUnion(true);
18027       }
18028 
18029       if (const auto *RT = FT->getAs<RecordType>()) {
18030         if (RT->getDecl()->getArgPassingRestrictions() ==
18031             RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs)
18032           Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
18033       } else if (FT.getQualifiers().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak)
18034         Record->setArgPassingRestrictions(RecordDecl::APK_CanNeverPassInRegs);
18035     }
18036 
18037     if (Record && FD->getType().isVolatileQualified())
18038       Record->setHasVolatileMember(true);
18039     // Keep track of the number of named members.
18040     if (FD->getIdentifier())
18041       ++NumNamedMembers;
18042   }
18043 
18044   // Okay, we successfully defined 'Record'.
18045   if (Record) {
18046     bool Completed = false;
18047     if (CXXRecord) {
18048       if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
18049         // Set access bits correctly on the directly-declared conversions.
18050         for (CXXRecordDecl::conversion_iterator
18051                I = CXXRecord->conversion_begin(),
18052                E = CXXRecord->conversion_end(); I != E; ++I)
18053           I.setAccess((*I)->getAccess());
18054       }
18055 
18056       // Add any implicitly-declared members to this class.
18057       AddImplicitlyDeclaredMembersToClass(CXXRecord);
18058 
18059       if (!CXXRecord->isDependentType()) {
18060         if (!CXXRecord->isInvalidDecl()) {
18061           // If we have virtual base classes, we may end up finding multiple
18062           // final overriders for a given virtual function. Check for this
18063           // problem now.
18064           if (CXXRecord->getNumVBases()) {
18065             CXXFinalOverriderMap FinalOverriders;
18066             CXXRecord->getFinalOverriders(FinalOverriders);
18067 
18068             for (CXXFinalOverriderMap::iterator M = FinalOverriders.begin(),
18069                                              MEnd = FinalOverriders.end();
18070                  M != MEnd; ++M) {
18071               for (OverridingMethods::iterator SO = M->second.begin(),
18072                                             SOEnd = M->second.end();
18073                    SO != SOEnd; ++SO) {
18074                 assert(SO->second.size() > 0 &&
18075                        "Virtual function without overriding functions?");
18076                 if (SO->second.size() == 1)
18077                   continue;
18078 
18079                 // C++ [class.virtual]p2:
18080                 //   In a derived class, if a virtual member function of a base
18081                 //   class subobject has more than one final overrider the
18082                 //   program is ill-formed.
18083                 Diag(Record->getLocation(), diag::err_multiple_final_overriders)
18084                   << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << Record;
18085                 Diag(M->first->getLocation(),
18086                      diag::note_overridden_virtual_function);
18087                 for (OverridingMethods::overriding_iterator
18088                           OM = SO->second.begin(),
18089                        OMEnd = SO->second.end();
18090                      OM != OMEnd; ++OM)
18091                   Diag(OM->Method->getLocation(), diag::note_final_overrider)
18092                     << (const NamedDecl *)M->first << OM->Method->getParent();
18093 
18094                 Record->setInvalidDecl();
18095               }
18096             }
18097             CXXRecord->completeDefinition(&FinalOverriders);
18098             Completed = true;
18099           }
18100         }
18101       }
18102     }
18103 
18104     if (!Completed)
18105       Record->completeDefinition();
18106 
18107     // Handle attributes before checking the layout.
18108     ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Record, Attrs);
18109 
18110     // Check to see if a FieldDecl is a pointer to a function.
18111     auto IsFunctionPointer = [&](const Decl *D) {
18112       const FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D);
18113       if (!FD)
18114         return false;
18115       QualType FieldType = FD->getType().getDesugaredType(Context);
18116       if (isa<PointerType>(FieldType)) {
18117         QualType PointeeType = cast<PointerType>(FieldType)->getPointeeType();
18118         return PointeeType.getDesugaredType(Context)->isFunctionType();
18119       }
18120       return false;
18121     };
18122 
18123     // Maybe randomize the record's decls. We automatically randomize a record
18124     // of function pointers, unless it has the "no_randomize_layout" attribute.
18125     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18126         (Record->hasAttr<RandomizeLayoutAttr>() ||
18127          (!Record->hasAttr<NoRandomizeLayoutAttr>() &&
18128           llvm::all_of(Record->decls(), IsFunctionPointer))) &&
18129         !Record->isUnion() && !getLangOpts().RandstructSeed.empty() &&
18130         !Record->isRandomized()) {
18131       SmallVector<Decl *, 32> NewDeclOrdering;
18132       if (randstruct::randomizeStructureLayout(Context, Record,
18133                                                NewDeclOrdering))
18134         Record->reorderDecls(NewDeclOrdering);
18135     }
18136 
18137     // We may have deferred checking for a deleted destructor. Check now.
18138     if (CXXRecord) {
18139       auto *Dtor = CXXRecord->getDestructor();
18140       if (Dtor && Dtor->isImplicit() &&
18141           ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Dtor, CXXDestructor)) {
18142         CXXRecord->setImplicitDestructorIsDeleted();
18143         SetDeclDeleted(Dtor, CXXRecord->getLocation());
18144       }
18145     }
18146 
18147     if (Record->hasAttrs()) {
18148       CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Record);
18149 
18150       if (const MSInheritanceAttr *IA = Record->getAttr<MSInheritanceAttr>())
18151         checkMSInheritanceAttrOnDefinition(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record),
18152                                            IA->getRange(), IA->getBestCase(),
18153                                            IA->getInheritanceModel());
18154     }
18155 
18156     // Check if the structure/union declaration is a type that can have zero
18157     // size in C. For C this is a language extension, for C++ it may cause
18158     // compatibility problems.
18159     bool CheckForZeroSize;
18160     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18161       CheckForZeroSize = true;
18162     } else {
18163       // For C++ filter out types that cannot be referenced in C code.
18164       CXXRecordDecl *CXXRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record);
18165       CheckForZeroSize =
18166           CXXRecord->getLexicalDeclContext()->isExternCContext() &&
18167           !CXXRecord->isDependentType() && !inTemplateInstantiation() &&
18168           CXXRecord->isCLike();
18169     }
18170     if (CheckForZeroSize) {
18171       bool ZeroSize = true;
18172       bool IsEmpty = true;
18173       unsigned NonBitFields = 0;
18174       for (RecordDecl::field_iterator I = Record->field_begin(),
18175                                       E = Record->field_end();
18176            (NonBitFields == 0 || ZeroSize) && I != E; ++I) {
18177         IsEmpty = false;
18178         if (I->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
18179           if (!I->isZeroLengthBitField(Context))
18180             ZeroSize = false;
18181         } else {
18182           ++NonBitFields;
18183           QualType FieldType = I->getType();
18184           if (FieldType->isIncompleteType() ||
18185               !Context.getTypeSizeInChars(FieldType).isZero())
18186             ZeroSize = false;
18187         }
18188       }
18189 
18190       // Empty structs are an extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7). They are
18191       // allowed in C++, but warn if its declaration is inside
18192       // extern "C" block.
18193       if (ZeroSize) {
18194         Diag(RecLoc, getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ?
18195                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_in_extern_c :
18196                          diag::warn_zero_size_struct_union_compat)
18197           << IsEmpty << Record->isUnion() << (NonBitFields > 1);
18198       }
18199 
18200       // Structs without named members are extension in C (C99 6.7.2.1p7),
18201       // but are accepted by GCC.
18202       if (NonBitFields == 0 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18203         Diag(RecLoc, IsEmpty ? diag::ext_empty_struct_union :
18204                                diag::ext_no_named_members_in_struct_union)
18205           << Record->isUnion();
18206       }
18207     }
18208   } else {
18209     ObjCIvarDecl **ClsFields =
18210       reinterpret_cast<ObjCIvarDecl**>(RecFields.data());
18211     if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = dyn_cast<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18212       ID->setEndOfDefinitionLoc(RBrac);
18213       // Add ivar's to class's DeclContext.
18214       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18215         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(ID);
18216         ID->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
18217       }
18218       // Must enforce the rule that ivars in the base classes may not be
18219       // duplicates.
18220       if (ID->getSuperClass())
18221         DiagnoseDuplicateIvars(ID, ID->getSuperClass());
18222     } else if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPDecl =
18223                   dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18224       assert(IMPDecl && "ActOnFields - missing ObjCImplementationDecl");
18225       for (unsigned I = 0, N = RecFields.size(); I != N; ++I)
18226         // Ivar declared in @implementation never belongs to the implementation.
18227         // Only it is in implementation's lexical context.
18228         ClsFields[I]->setLexicalDeclContext(IMPDecl);
18229       CheckImplementationIvars(IMPDecl, ClsFields, RecFields.size(), RBrac);
18230       IMPDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
18231       IMPDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
18232     } else if (ObjCCategoryDecl *CDecl =
18233                 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryDecl>(EnclosingDecl)) {
18234       // case of ivars in class extension; all other cases have been
18235       // reported as errors elsewhere.
18236       // FIXME. Class extension does not have a LocEnd field.
18237       // CDecl->setLocEnd(RBrac);
18238       // Add ivar's to class extension's DeclContext.
18239       // Diagnose redeclaration of private ivars.
18240       ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CDecl->getClassInterface();
18241       for (unsigned i = 0, e = RecFields.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18242         if (IDecl) {
18243           if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsIvar =
18244               IDecl->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
18245             Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
18246                  diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
18247             Diag(ClsIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
18248             continue;
18249           }
18250           for (const auto *Ext : IDecl->known_extensions()) {
18251             if (const ObjCIvarDecl *ClsExtIvar
18252                   = Ext->getIvarDecl(ClsFields[i]->getIdentifier())) {
18253               Diag(ClsFields[i]->getLocation(),
18254                    diag::err_duplicate_ivar_declaration);
18255               Diag(ClsExtIvar->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_definition);
18256               continue;
18257             }
18258           }
18259         }
18260         ClsFields[i]->setLexicalDeclContext(CDecl);
18261         CDecl->addDecl(ClsFields[i]);
18262       }
18263       CDecl->setIvarLBraceLoc(LBrac);
18264       CDecl->setIvarRBraceLoc(RBrac);
18265     }
18266   }
18267 }
18268 
18269 /// Determine whether the given integral value is representable within
18270 /// the given type T.
18271 static bool isRepresentableIntegerValue(ASTContext &Context,
18272                                         llvm::APSInt &Value,
18273                                         QualType T) {
18274   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) || T->isEnumeralType()) &&
18275          "Integral type required!");
18276   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getIntWidth(T);
18277 
18278   if (Value.isUnsigned() || Value.isNonNegative()) {
18279     if (T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType())
18280       --BitWidth;
18281     return Value.getActiveBits() <= BitWidth;
18282   }
18283   return Value.getMinSignedBits() <= BitWidth;
18284 }
18285 
18286 // Given an integral type, return the next larger integral type
18287 // (or a NULL type of no such type exists).
18288 static QualType getNextLargerIntegralType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T) {
18289   // FIXME: Int128/UInt128 support, which also needs to be introduced into
18290   // enum checking below.
18291   assert((T->isIntegralType(Context) ||
18292          T->isEnumeralType()) && "Integral type required!");
18293   const unsigned NumTypes = 4;
18294   QualType SignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
18295     Context.ShortTy, Context.IntTy, Context.LongTy, Context.LongLongTy
18296   };
18297   QualType UnsignedIntegralTypes[NumTypes] = {
18298     Context.UnsignedShortTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy,
18299     Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
18300   };
18301 
18302   unsigned BitWidth = Context.getTypeSize(T);
18303   QualType *Types = T->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType()? SignedIntegralTypes
18304                                                         : UnsignedIntegralTypes;
18305   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumTypes; ++I)
18306     if (Context.getTypeSize(Types[I]) > BitWidth)
18307       return Types[I];
18308 
18309   return QualType();
18310 }
18311 
18312 EnumConstantDecl *Sema::CheckEnumConstant(EnumDecl *Enum,
18313                                           EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst,
18314                                           SourceLocation IdLoc,
18315                                           IdentifierInfo *Id,
18316                                           Expr *Val) {
18317   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
18318   llvm::APSInt EnumVal(IntWidth);
18319   QualType EltTy;
18320 
18321   if (Val && DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(Val, UPPC_EnumeratorValue))
18322     Val = nullptr;
18323 
18324   if (Val)
18325     Val = DefaultLvalueConversion(Val).get();
18326 
18327   if (Val) {
18328     if (Enum->isDependentType() || Val->isTypeDependent() ||
18329         Val->containsErrors())
18330       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
18331     else {
18332       // FIXME: We don't allow folding in C++11 mode for an enum with a fixed
18333       // underlying type, but do allow it in all other contexts.
18334       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Enum->isFixed()) {
18335         // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5: If the underlying type is fixed, [...] the
18336         // constant-expression in the enumerator-definition shall be a converted
18337         // constant expression of the underlying type.
18338         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18339         ExprResult Converted =
18340           CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Val, EltTy, EnumVal,
18341                                            CCEK_Enumerator);
18342         if (Converted.isInvalid())
18343           Val = nullptr;
18344         else
18345           Val = Converted.get();
18346       } else if (!Val->isValueDependent() &&
18347                  !(Val =
18348                        VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Val, &EnumVal, AllowFold)
18349                            .get())) {
18350         // C99 6.7.2.2p2: Make sure we have an integer constant expression.
18351       } else {
18352         if (Enum->isComplete()) {
18353           EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18354 
18355           // In Obj-C and Microsoft mode, require the enumeration value to be
18356           // representable in the underlying type of the enumeration. In C++11,
18357           // we perform a non-narrowing conversion as part of converted constant
18358           // expression checking.
18359           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
18360             if (Context.getTargetInfo()
18361                     .getTriple()
18362                     .isWindowsMSVCEnvironment()) {
18363               Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
18364             } else {
18365               Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_too_large) << EltTy;
18366             }
18367           }
18368 
18369           // Cast to the underlying type.
18370           Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, EltTy,
18371                                   EltTy->isBooleanType() ? CK_IntegralToBoolean
18372                                                          : CK_IntegralCast)
18373                     .get();
18374         } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
18375           // C++11 [dcl.enum]p5:
18376           //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18377           //   is the type of its initializing value:
18378           //     - If an initializer is specified for an enumerator, the
18379           //       initializing value has the same type as the expression.
18380           EltTy = Val->getType();
18381         } else {
18382           // C99 6.7.2.2p2:
18383           //   The expression that defines the value of an enumeration constant
18384           //   shall be an integer constant expression that has a value
18385           //   representable as an int.
18386 
18387           // Complain if the value is not representable in an int.
18388           if (!isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, Context.IntTy))
18389             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
18390               << toString(EnumVal, 10) << Val->getSourceRange()
18391               << (EnumVal.isUnsigned() || EnumVal.isNonNegative());
18392           else if (!Context.hasSameType(Val->getType(), Context.IntTy)) {
18393             // Force the type of the expression to 'int'.
18394             Val = ImpCastExprToType(Val, Context.IntTy, CK_IntegralCast).get();
18395           }
18396           EltTy = Val->getType();
18397         }
18398       }
18399     }
18400   }
18401 
18402   if (!Val) {
18403     if (Enum->isDependentType())
18404       EltTy = Context.DependentTy;
18405     else if (!LastEnumConst) {
18406       // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
18407       //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18408       //   is the type of its initializing value:
18409       //     - If no initializer is specified for the first enumerator, the
18410       //       initializing value has an unspecified integral type.
18411       //
18412       // GCC uses 'int' for its unspecified integral type, as does
18413       // C99 6.7.2.2p3.
18414       if (Enum->isFixed()) {
18415         EltTy = Enum->getIntegerType();
18416       }
18417       else {
18418         EltTy = Context.IntTy;
18419       }
18420     } else {
18421       // Assign the last value + 1.
18422       EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18423       ++EnumVal;
18424       EltTy = LastEnumConst->getType();
18425 
18426       // Check for overflow on increment.
18427       if (EnumVal < LastEnumConst->getInitVal()) {
18428         // C++0x [dcl.enum]p5:
18429         //   If the underlying type is not fixed, the type of each enumerator
18430         //   is the type of its initializing value:
18431         //
18432         //     - Otherwise the type of the initializing value is the same as
18433         //       the type of the initializing value of the preceding enumerator
18434         //       unless the incremented value is not representable in that type,
18435         //       in which case the type is an unspecified integral type
18436         //       sufficient to contain the incremented value. If no such type
18437         //       exists, the program is ill-formed.
18438         QualType T = getNextLargerIntegralType(Context, EltTy);
18439         if (T.isNull() || Enum->isFixed()) {
18440           // There is no integral type larger enough to represent this
18441           // value. Complain, then allow the value to wrap around.
18442           EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18443           EnumVal = EnumVal.zext(EnumVal.getBitWidth() * 2);
18444           ++EnumVal;
18445           if (Enum->isFixed())
18446             // When the underlying type is fixed, this is ill-formed.
18447             Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_enumerator_wrapped)
18448               << toString(EnumVal, 10)
18449               << EltTy;
18450           else
18451             Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enumerator_increment_too_large)
18452               << toString(EnumVal, 10);
18453         } else {
18454           EltTy = T;
18455         }
18456 
18457         // Retrieve the last enumerator's value, extent that type to the
18458         // type that is supposed to be large enough to represent the incremented
18459         // value, then increment.
18460         EnumVal = LastEnumConst->getInitVal();
18461         EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
18462         EnumVal = EnumVal.zextOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
18463         ++EnumVal;
18464 
18465         // If we're not in C++, diagnose the overflow of enumerator values,
18466         // which in C99 means that the enumerator value is not representable in
18467         // an int (C99 6.7.2.2p2). However, we support GCC's extension that
18468         // permits enumerator values that are representable in some larger
18469         // integral type.
18470         if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !T.isNull())
18471           Diag(IdLoc, diag::warn_enum_value_overflow);
18472       } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18473                  !isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, EnumVal, EltTy)) {
18474         // Enforce C99 6.7.2.2p2 even when we compute the next value.
18475         Diag(IdLoc, diag::ext_enum_value_not_int)
18476           << toString(EnumVal, 10) << 1;
18477       }
18478     }
18479   }
18480 
18481   if (!EltTy->isDependentType()) {
18482     // Make the enumerator value match the signedness and size of the
18483     // enumerator's type.
18484     EnumVal = EnumVal.extOrTrunc(Context.getIntWidth(EltTy));
18485     EnumVal.setIsSigned(EltTy->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType());
18486   }
18487 
18488   return EnumConstantDecl::Create(Context, Enum, IdLoc, Id, EltTy,
18489                                   Val, EnumVal);
18490 }
18491 
18492 Sema::SkipBodyInfo Sema::shouldSkipAnonEnumBody(Scope *S, IdentifierInfo *II,
18493                                                 SourceLocation IILoc) {
18494   if (!(getLangOpts().Modules || getLangOpts().ModulesLocalVisibility) ||
18495       !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18496     return SkipBodyInfo();
18497 
18498   // We have an anonymous enum definition. Look up the first enumerator to
18499   // determine if we should merge the definition with an existing one and
18500   // skip the body.
18501   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(S, II, IILoc, LookupOrdinaryName,
18502                                          forRedeclarationInCurContext());
18503   auto *PrevECD = dyn_cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl);
18504   if (!PrevECD)
18505     return SkipBodyInfo();
18506 
18507   EnumDecl *PrevED = cast<EnumDecl>(PrevECD->getDeclContext());
18508   NamedDecl *Hidden;
18509   if (!PrevED->getDeclName() && !hasVisibleDefinition(PrevED, &Hidden)) {
18510     SkipBodyInfo Skip;
18511     Skip.Previous = Hidden;
18512     return Skip;
18513   }
18514 
18515   return SkipBodyInfo();
18516 }
18517 
18518 Decl *Sema::ActOnEnumConstant(Scope *S, Decl *theEnumDecl, Decl *lastEnumConst,
18519                               SourceLocation IdLoc, IdentifierInfo *Id,
18520                               const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs,
18521                               SourceLocation EqualLoc, Expr *Val) {
18522   EnumDecl *TheEnumDecl = cast<EnumDecl>(theEnumDecl);
18523   EnumConstantDecl *LastEnumConst =
18524     cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(lastEnumConst);
18525 
18526   // The scope passed in may not be a decl scope.  Zip up the scope tree until
18527   // we find one that is.
18528   S = getNonFieldDeclScope(S);
18529 
18530   // Verify that there isn't already something declared with this name in this
18531   // scope.
18532   LookupResult R(*this, Id, IdLoc, LookupOrdinaryName, ForVisibleRedeclaration);
18533   LookupName(R, S);
18534   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>();
18535 
18536   if (PrevDecl && PrevDecl->isTemplateParameter()) {
18537     // Maybe we will complain about the shadowed template parameter.
18538     DiagnoseTemplateParameterShadow(IdLoc, PrevDecl);
18539     // Just pretend that we didn't see the previous declaration.
18540     PrevDecl = nullptr;
18541   }
18542 
18543   // C++ [class.mem]p15:
18544   // If T is the name of a class, then each of the following shall have a name
18545   // different from T:
18546   // - every enumerator of every member of class T that is an unscoped
18547   // enumerated type
18548   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !TheEnumDecl->isScoped())
18549     DiagnoseClassNameShadow(TheEnumDecl->getDeclContext(),
18550                             DeclarationNameInfo(Id, IdLoc));
18551 
18552   EnumConstantDecl *New =
18553     CheckEnumConstant(TheEnumDecl, LastEnumConst, IdLoc, Id, Val);
18554   if (!New)
18555     return nullptr;
18556 
18557   if (PrevDecl) {
18558     if (!TheEnumDecl->isScoped() && isa<ValueDecl>(PrevDecl)) {
18559       // Check for other kinds of shadowing not already handled.
18560       CheckShadow(New, PrevDecl, R);
18561     }
18562 
18563     // When in C++, we may get a TagDecl with the same name; in this case the
18564     // enum constant will 'hide' the tag.
18565     assert((getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl)) &&
18566            "Received TagDecl when not in C++!");
18567     if (!isa<TagDecl>(PrevDecl) && isDeclInScope(PrevDecl, CurContext, S)) {
18568       if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(PrevDecl))
18569         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition_of_enumerator) << Id;
18570       else
18571         Diag(IdLoc, diag::err_redefinition) << Id;
18572       notePreviousDefinition(PrevDecl, IdLoc);
18573       return nullptr;
18574     }
18575   }
18576 
18577   // Process attributes.
18578   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, New, Attrs);
18579   AddPragmaAttributes(S, New);
18580 
18581   // Register this decl in the current scope stack.
18582   New->setAccess(TheEnumDecl->getAccess());
18583   PushOnScopeChains(New, S);
18584 
18585   ActOnDocumentableDecl(New);
18586 
18587   return New;
18588 }
18589 
18590 // Returns true when the enum initial expression does not trigger the
18591 // duplicate enum warning.  A few common cases are exempted as follows:
18592 // Element2 = Element1
18593 // Element2 = Element1 + 1
18594 // Element2 = Element1 - 1
18595 // Where Element2 and Element1 are from the same enum.
18596 static bool ValidDuplicateEnum(EnumConstantDecl *ECD, EnumDecl *Enum) {
18597   Expr *InitExpr = ECD->getInitExpr();
18598   if (!InitExpr)
18599     return true;
18600   InitExpr = InitExpr->IgnoreImpCasts();
18601 
18602   if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(InitExpr)) {
18603     if (!BO->isAdditiveOp())
18604       return true;
18605     IntegerLiteral *IL = dyn_cast<IntegerLiteral>(BO->getRHS());
18606     if (!IL)
18607       return true;
18608     if (IL->getValue() != 1)
18609       return true;
18610 
18611     InitExpr = BO->getLHS();
18612   }
18613 
18614   // This checks if the elements are from the same enum.
18615   DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InitExpr);
18616   if (!DRE)
18617     return true;
18618 
18619   EnumConstantDecl *EnumConstant = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
18620   if (!EnumConstant)
18621     return true;
18622 
18623   if (cast<EnumDecl>(TagDecl::castFromDeclContext(ECD->getDeclContext())) !=
18624       Enum)
18625     return true;
18626 
18627   return false;
18628 }
18629 
18630 // Emits a warning when an element is implicitly set a value that
18631 // a previous element has already been set to.
18632 static void CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements,
18633                                         EnumDecl *Enum, QualType EnumType) {
18634   // Avoid anonymous enums
18635   if (!Enum->getIdentifier())
18636     return;
18637 
18638   // Only check for small enums.
18639   if (Enum->getNumPositiveBits() > 63 || Enum->getNumNegativeBits() > 64)
18640     return;
18641 
18642   if (S.Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values, Enum->getLocation()))
18643     return;
18644 
18645   typedef SmallVector<EnumConstantDecl *, 3> ECDVector;
18646   typedef SmallVector<std::unique_ptr<ECDVector>, 3> DuplicatesVector;
18647 
18648   typedef llvm::PointerUnion<EnumConstantDecl*, ECDVector*> DeclOrVector;
18649 
18650   // DenseMaps cannot contain the all ones int64_t value, so use unordered_map.
18651   typedef std::unordered_map<int64_t, DeclOrVector> ValueToVectorMap;
18652 
18653   // Use int64_t as a key to avoid needing special handling for map keys.
18654   auto EnumConstantToKey = [](const EnumConstantDecl *D) {
18655     llvm::APSInt Val = D->getInitVal();
18656     return Val.isSigned() ? Val.getSExtValue() : Val.getZExtValue();
18657   };
18658 
18659   DuplicatesVector DupVector;
18660   ValueToVectorMap EnumMap;
18661 
18662   // Populate the EnumMap with all values represented by enum constants without
18663   // an initializer.
18664   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18665     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18666 
18667     // Null EnumConstantDecl means a previous diagnostic has been emitted for
18668     // this constant.  Skip this enum since it may be ill-formed.
18669     if (!ECD) {
18670       return;
18671     }
18672 
18673     // Constants with initalizers are handled in the next loop.
18674     if (ECD->getInitExpr())
18675       continue;
18676 
18677     // Duplicate values are handled in the next loop.
18678     EnumMap.insert({EnumConstantToKey(ECD), ECD});
18679   }
18680 
18681   if (EnumMap.size() == 0)
18682     return;
18683 
18684   // Create vectors for any values that has duplicates.
18685   for (auto *Element : Elements) {
18686     // The last loop returned if any constant was null.
18687     EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast<EnumConstantDecl>(Element);
18688     if (!ValidDuplicateEnum(ECD, Enum))
18689       continue;
18690 
18691     auto Iter = EnumMap.find(EnumConstantToKey(ECD));
18692     if (Iter == EnumMap.end())
18693       continue;
18694 
18695     DeclOrVector& Entry = Iter->second;
18696     if (EnumConstantDecl *D = Entry.dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl*>()) {
18697       // Ensure constants are different.
18698       if (D == ECD)
18699         continue;
18700 
18701       // Create new vector and push values onto it.
18702       auto Vec = std::make_unique<ECDVector>();
18703       Vec->push_back(D);
18704       Vec->push_back(ECD);
18705 
18706       // Update entry to point to the duplicates vector.
18707       Entry = Vec.get();
18708 
18709       // Store the vector somewhere we can consult later for quick emission of
18710       // diagnostics.
18711       DupVector.emplace_back(std::move(Vec));
18712       continue;
18713     }
18714 
18715     ECDVector *Vec = Entry.get<ECDVector*>();
18716     // Make sure constants are not added more than once.
18717     if (*Vec->begin() == ECD)
18718       continue;
18719 
18720     Vec->push_back(ECD);
18721   }
18722 
18723   // Emit diagnostics.
18724   for (const auto &Vec : DupVector) {
18725     assert(Vec->size() > 1 && "ECDVector should have at least 2 elements.");
18726 
18727     // Emit warning for one enum constant.
18728     auto *FirstECD = Vec->front();
18729     S.Diag(FirstECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_duplicate_enum_values)
18730       << FirstECD << toString(FirstECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18731       << FirstECD->getSourceRange();
18732 
18733     // Emit one note for each of the remaining enum constants with
18734     // the same value.
18735     for (auto *ECD : llvm::drop_begin(*Vec))
18736       S.Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::note_duplicate_element)
18737         << ECD << toString(ECD->getInitVal(), 10)
18738         << ECD->getSourceRange();
18739   }
18740 }
18741 
18742 bool Sema::IsValueInFlagEnum(const EnumDecl *ED, const llvm::APInt &Val,
18743                              bool AllowMask) const {
18744   assert(ED->isClosedFlag() && "looking for value in non-flag or open enum");
18745   assert(ED->isCompleteDefinition() && "expected enum definition");
18746 
18747   auto R = FlagBitsCache.insert(std::make_pair(ED, llvm::APInt()));
18748   llvm::APInt &FlagBits = R.first->second;
18749 
18750   if (R.second) {
18751     for (auto *E : ED->enumerators()) {
18752       const auto &EVal = E->getInitVal();
18753       // Only single-bit enumerators introduce new flag values.
18754       if (EVal.isPowerOf2())
18755         FlagBits = FlagBits.zext(EVal.getBitWidth()) | EVal;
18756     }
18757   }
18758 
18759   // A value is in a flag enum if either its bits are a subset of the enum's
18760   // flag bits (the first condition) or we are allowing masks and the same is
18761   // true of its complement (the second condition). When masks are allowed, we
18762   // allow the common idiom of ~(enum1 | enum2) to be a valid enum value.
18763   //
18764   // While it's true that any value could be used as a mask, the assumption is
18765   // that a mask will have all of the insignificant bits set. Anything else is
18766   // likely a logic error.
18767   llvm::APInt FlagMask = ~FlagBits.zextOrTrunc(Val.getBitWidth());
18768   return !(FlagMask & Val) || (AllowMask && !(FlagMask & ~Val));
18769 }
18770 
18771 void Sema::ActOnEnumBody(SourceLocation EnumLoc, SourceRange BraceRange,
18772                          Decl *EnumDeclX, ArrayRef<Decl *> Elements, Scope *S,
18773                          const ParsedAttributesView &Attrs) {
18774   EnumDecl *Enum = cast<EnumDecl>(EnumDeclX);
18775   QualType EnumType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Enum);
18776 
18777   ProcessDeclAttributeList(S, Enum, Attrs);
18778 
18779   if (Enum->isDependentType()) {
18780     for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18781       EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18782         cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18783       if (!ECD) continue;
18784 
18785       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18786     }
18787 
18788     Enum->completeDefinition(Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, 0, 0);
18789     return;
18790   }
18791 
18792   // TODO: If the result value doesn't fit in an int, it must be a long or long
18793   // long value.  ISO C does not support this, but GCC does as an extension,
18794   // emit a warning.
18795   unsigned IntWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth();
18796   unsigned CharWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getCharWidth();
18797   unsigned ShortWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getShortWidth();
18798 
18799   // Verify that all the values are okay, compute the size of the values, and
18800   // reverse the list.
18801   unsigned NumNegativeBits = 0;
18802   unsigned NumPositiveBits = 0;
18803 
18804   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Elements.size(); i != e; ++i) {
18805     EnumConstantDecl *ECD =
18806       cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(Elements[i]);
18807     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18808 
18809     const llvm::APSInt &InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18810 
18811     // Keep track of the size of positive and negative values.
18812     if (InitVal.isUnsigned() || InitVal.isNonNegative())
18813       NumPositiveBits = std::max(NumPositiveBits,
18814                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getActiveBits());
18815     else
18816       NumNegativeBits = std::max(NumNegativeBits,
18817                                  (unsigned)InitVal.getMinSignedBits());
18818   }
18819 
18820   // Figure out the type that should be used for this enum.
18821   QualType BestType;
18822   unsigned BestWidth;
18823 
18824   // C++0x N3000 [conv.prom]p3:
18825   //   An rvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying
18826   //   type is not fixed can be converted to an rvalue of the first
18827   //   of the following types that can represent all the values of
18828   //   the enumeration: int, unsigned int, long int, unsigned long
18829   //   int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
18830   // C99 6.4.4.3p2:
18831   //   An identifier declared as an enumeration constant has type int.
18832   // The C99 rule is modified by a gcc extension
18833   QualType BestPromotionType;
18834 
18835   bool Packed = Enum->hasAttr<PackedAttr>();
18836   // -fshort-enums is the equivalent to specifying the packed attribute on all
18837   // enum definitions.
18838   if (LangOpts.ShortEnums)
18839     Packed = true;
18840 
18841   // If the enum already has a type because it is fixed or dictated by the
18842   // target, promote that type instead of analyzing the enumerators.
18843   if (Enum->isComplete()) {
18844     BestType = Enum->getIntegerType();
18845     if (BestType->isPromotableIntegerType())
18846       BestPromotionType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(BestType);
18847     else
18848       BestPromotionType = BestType;
18849 
18850     BestWidth = Context.getIntWidth(BestType);
18851   }
18852   else if (NumNegativeBits) {
18853     // If there is a negative value, figure out the smallest integer type (of
18854     // int/long/longlong) that fits.
18855     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18856     if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= CharWidth && NumPositiveBits < CharWidth) {
18857       BestType = Context.SignedCharTy;
18858       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18859     } else if (Packed && NumNegativeBits <= ShortWidth &&
18860                NumPositiveBits < ShortWidth) {
18861       BestType = Context.ShortTy;
18862       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18863     } else if (NumNegativeBits <= IntWidth && NumPositiveBits < IntWidth) {
18864       BestType = Context.IntTy;
18865       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18866     } else {
18867       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth();
18868 
18869       if (NumNegativeBits <= BestWidth && NumPositiveBits < BestWidth) {
18870         BestType = Context.LongTy;
18871       } else {
18872         BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18873 
18874         if (NumNegativeBits > BestWidth || NumPositiveBits >= BestWidth)
18875           Diag(Enum->getLocation(), diag::ext_enum_too_large);
18876         BestType = Context.LongLongTy;
18877       }
18878     }
18879     BestPromotionType = (BestWidth <= IntWidth ? Context.IntTy : BestType);
18880   } else {
18881     // If there is no negative value, figure out the smallest type that fits
18882     // all of the enumerator values.
18883     // If it's packed, check also if it fits a char or a short.
18884     if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= CharWidth) {
18885       BestType = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
18886       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18887       BestWidth = CharWidth;
18888     } else if (Packed && NumPositiveBits <= ShortWidth) {
18889       BestType = Context.UnsignedShortTy;
18890       BestPromotionType = Context.IntTy;
18891       BestWidth = ShortWidth;
18892     } else if (NumPositiveBits <= IntWidth) {
18893       BestType = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
18894       BestWidth = IntWidth;
18895       BestPromotionType
18896         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18897                            ? Context.UnsignedIntTy : Context.IntTy;
18898     } else if (NumPositiveBits <=
18899                (BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth())) {
18900       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
18901       BestPromotionType
18902         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18903                            ? Context.UnsignedLongTy : Context.LongTy;
18904     } else {
18905       BestWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth();
18906       assert(NumPositiveBits <= BestWidth &&
18907              "How could an initializer get larger than ULL?");
18908       BestType = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
18909       BestPromotionType
18910         = (NumPositiveBits == BestWidth || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18911                            ? Context.UnsignedLongLongTy : Context.LongLongTy;
18912     }
18913   }
18914 
18915   // Loop over all of the enumerator constants, changing their types to match
18916   // the type of the enum if needed.
18917   for (auto *D : Elements) {
18918     auto *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18919     if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18920 
18921     // Standard C says the enumerators have int type, but we allow, as an
18922     // extension, the enumerators to be larger than int size.  If each
18923     // enumerator value fits in an int, type it as an int, otherwise type it the
18924     // same as the enumerator decl itself.  This means that in "enum { X = 1U }"
18925     // that X has type 'int', not 'unsigned'.
18926 
18927     // Determine whether the value fits into an int.
18928     llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18929 
18930     // If it fits into an integer type, force it.  Otherwise force it to match
18931     // the enum decl type.
18932     QualType NewTy;
18933     unsigned NewWidth;
18934     bool NewSign;
18935     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
18936         !Enum->isFixed() &&
18937         isRepresentableIntegerValue(Context, InitVal, Context.IntTy)) {
18938       NewTy = Context.IntTy;
18939       NewWidth = IntWidth;
18940       NewSign = true;
18941     } else if (ECD->getType() == BestType) {
18942       // Already the right type!
18943       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18944         // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18945         // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18946         // enumeration.
18947         ECD->setType(EnumType);
18948       continue;
18949     } else {
18950       NewTy = BestType;
18951       NewWidth = BestWidth;
18952       NewSign = BestType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
18953     }
18954 
18955     // Adjust the APSInt value.
18956     InitVal = InitVal.extOrTrunc(NewWidth);
18957     InitVal.setIsSigned(NewSign);
18958     ECD->setInitVal(InitVal);
18959 
18960     // Adjust the Expr initializer and type.
18961     if (ECD->getInitExpr() &&
18962         !Context.hasSameType(NewTy, ECD->getInitExpr()->getType()))
18963       ECD->setInitExpr(ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
18964           Context, NewTy, CK_IntegralCast, ECD->getInitExpr(),
18965           /*base paths*/ nullptr, VK_PRValue, FPOptionsOverride()));
18966     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
18967       // C++ [dcl.enum]p4: Following the closing brace of an
18968       // enum-specifier, each enumerator has the type of its
18969       // enumeration.
18970       ECD->setType(EnumType);
18971     else
18972       ECD->setType(NewTy);
18973   }
18974 
18975   Enum->completeDefinition(BestType, BestPromotionType,
18976                            NumPositiveBits, NumNegativeBits);
18977 
18978   CheckForDuplicateEnumValues(*this, Elements, Enum, EnumType);
18979 
18980   if (Enum->isClosedFlag()) {
18981     for (Decl *D : Elements) {
18982       EnumConstantDecl *ECD = cast_or_null<EnumConstantDecl>(D);
18983       if (!ECD) continue;  // Already issued a diagnostic.
18984 
18985       llvm::APSInt InitVal = ECD->getInitVal();
18986       if (InitVal != 0 && !InitVal.isPowerOf2() &&
18987           !IsValueInFlagEnum(Enum, InitVal, true))
18988         Diag(ECD->getLocation(), diag::warn_flag_enum_constant_out_of_range)
18989           << ECD << Enum;
18990     }
18991   }
18992 
18993   // Now that the enum type is defined, ensure it's not been underaligned.
18994   if (Enum->hasAttrs())
18995     CheckAlignasUnderalignment(Enum);
18996 }
18997 
18998 Decl *Sema::ActOnFileScopeAsmDecl(Expr *expr,
18999                                   SourceLocation StartLoc,
19000                                   SourceLocation EndLoc) {
19001   StringLiteral *AsmString = cast<StringLiteral>(expr);
19002 
19003   FileScopeAsmDecl *New = FileScopeAsmDecl::Create(Context, CurContext,
19004                                                    AsmString, StartLoc,
19005                                                    EndLoc);
19006   CurContext->addDecl(New);
19007   return New;
19008 }
19009 
19010 void Sema::ActOnPragmaRedefineExtname(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19011                                       IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
19012                                       SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19013                                       SourceLocation NameLoc,
19014                                       SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
19015   NamedDecl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc,
19016                                          LookupOrdinaryName);
19017   AttributeCommonInfo Info(AliasName, SourceRange(AliasNameLoc),
19018                            AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma);
19019   AsmLabelAttr *Attr = AsmLabelAttr::CreateImplicit(
19020       Context, AliasName->getName(), /*IsLiteralLabel=*/true, Info);
19021 
19022   // If a declaration that:
19023   // 1) declares a function or a variable
19024   // 2) has external linkage
19025   // already exists, add a label attribute to it.
19026   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
19027     if (isDeclExternC(PrevDecl))
19028       PrevDecl->addAttr(Attr);
19029     else
19030       Diag(PrevDecl->getLocation(), diag::warn_redefine_extname_not_applied)
19031           << /*Variable*/(isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) ? 0 : 1) << PrevDecl;
19032   // Otherwise, add a label atttibute to ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.
19033   } else
19034     (void)ExtnameUndeclaredIdentifiers.insert(std::make_pair(Name, Attr));
19035 }
19036 
19037 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakID(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19038                              SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19039                              SourceLocation NameLoc) {
19040   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, Name, NameLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
19041 
19042   if (PrevDecl) {
19043     PrevDecl->addAttr(WeakAttr::CreateImplicit(Context, PragmaLoc, AttributeCommonInfo::AS_Pragma));
19044   } else {
19045     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[Name].insert(WeakInfo(nullptr, NameLoc));
19046   }
19047 }
19048 
19049 void Sema::ActOnPragmaWeakAlias(IdentifierInfo* Name,
19050                                 IdentifierInfo* AliasName,
19051                                 SourceLocation PragmaLoc,
19052                                 SourceLocation NameLoc,
19053                                 SourceLocation AliasNameLoc) {
19054   Decl *PrevDecl = LookupSingleName(TUScope, AliasName, AliasNameLoc,
19055                                     LookupOrdinaryName);
19056   WeakInfo W = WeakInfo(Name, NameLoc);
19057 
19058   if (PrevDecl && (isa<FunctionDecl>(PrevDecl) || isa<VarDecl>(PrevDecl))) {
19059     if (!PrevDecl->hasAttr<AliasAttr>())
19060       if (NamedDecl *ND = dyn_cast<NamedDecl>(PrevDecl))
19061         DeclApplyPragmaWeak(TUScope, ND, W);
19062   } else {
19063     (void)WeakUndeclaredIdentifiers[AliasName].insert(W);
19064   }
19065 }
19066 
19067 ObjCContainerDecl *Sema::getObjCDeclContext() const {
19068   return (dyn_cast_or_null<ObjCContainerDecl>(CurContext));
19069 }
19070 
19071 Sema::FunctionEmissionStatus Sema::getEmissionStatus(FunctionDecl *FD,
19072                                                      bool Final) {
19073   assert(FD && "Expected non-null FunctionDecl");
19074 
19075   // SYCL functions can be template, so we check if they have appropriate
19076   // attribute prior to checking if it is a template.
19077   if (LangOpts.SYCLIsDevice && FD->hasAttr<SYCLKernelAttr>())
19078     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19079 
19080   // Templates are emitted when they're instantiated.
19081   if (FD->isDependentContext())
19082     return FunctionEmissionStatus::TemplateDiscarded;
19083 
19084   // Check whether this function is an externally visible definition.
19085   auto IsEmittedForExternalSymbol = [this, FD]() {
19086     // We have to check the GVA linkage of the function's *definition* -- if we
19087     // only have a declaration, we don't know whether or not the function will
19088     // be emitted, because (say) the definition could include "inline".
19089     FunctionDecl *Def = FD->getDefinition();
19090 
19091     return Def && !isDiscardableGVALinkage(
19092                       getASTContext().GetGVALinkageForFunction(Def));
19093   };
19094 
19095   if (LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) {
19096     // In OpenMP device mode we will not emit host only functions, or functions
19097     // we don't need due to their linkage.
19098     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
19099         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
19100     // DevTy may be changed later by
19101     //  #pragma omp declare target to(*) device_type(*).
19102     // Therefore DevTy having no value does not imply host. The emission status
19103     // will be checked again at the end of compilation unit with Final = true.
19104     if (DevTy.hasValue())
19105       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_Host)
19106         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19107     // If we have an explicit value for the device type, or we are in a target
19108     // declare context, we need to emit all extern and used symbols.
19109     if (isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext() || DevTy.hasValue())
19110       if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
19111         return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19112     // Device mode only emits what it must, if it wasn't tagged yet and needed,
19113     // we'll omit it.
19114     if (Final)
19115       return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19116   } else if (LangOpts.OpenMP > 45) {
19117     // In OpenMP host compilation prior to 5.0 everything was an emitted host
19118     // function. In 5.0, no_host was introduced which might cause a function to
19119     // be ommitted.
19120     Optional<OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DevTypeTy> DevTy =
19121         OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::getDeviceType(FD->getCanonicalDecl());
19122     if (DevTy)
19123       if (*DevTy == OMPDeclareTargetDeclAttr::DT_NoHost)
19124         return FunctionEmissionStatus::OMPDiscarded;
19125   }
19126 
19127   if (Final && LangOpts.OpenMP && !LangOpts.CUDA)
19128     return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19129 
19130   if (LangOpts.CUDA) {
19131     // When compiling for device, host functions are never emitted.  Similarly,
19132     // when compiling for host, device and global functions are never emitted.
19133     // (Technically, we do emit a host-side stub for global functions, but this
19134     // doesn't count for our purposes here.)
19135     Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(FD);
19136     if (LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice && T == Sema::CFT_Host)
19137       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
19138     if (!LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
19139         (T == Sema::CFT_Device || T == Sema::CFT_Global))
19140       return FunctionEmissionStatus::CUDADiscarded;
19141 
19142     if (IsEmittedForExternalSymbol())
19143       return FunctionEmissionStatus::Emitted;
19144   }
19145 
19146   // Otherwise, the function is known-emitted if it's in our set of
19147   // known-emitted functions.
19148   return FunctionEmissionStatus::Unknown;
19149 }
19150 
19151 bool Sema::shouldIgnoreInHostDeviceCheck(FunctionDecl *Callee) {
19152   // Host-side references to a __global__ function refer to the stub, so the
19153   // function itself is never emitted and therefore should not be marked.
19154   // If we have host fn calls kernel fn calls host+device, the HD function
19155   // does not get instantiated on the host. We model this by omitting at the
19156   // call to the kernel from the callgraph. This ensures that, when compiling
19157   // for host, only HD functions actually called from the host get marked as
19158   // known-emitted.
19159   return LangOpts.CUDA && !LangOpts.CUDAIsDevice &&
19160          IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee) == CFT_Global;
19161 }
19162